‫ﺯﻭﺍﻝ ﺇﺳﺮﺍﺋﻴﻞ‬ ‫‪١‬‬ ‫ﺑﺴﻢ ﺍﷲ ﺍﻟﺮﲪﻦ ﺍﻟﺮﺣﻴﻢ‬ ‫‪٢‬‬ ‫ﺯﻭﺍﻝ ﺇﺳﺮﺍﺋﻴﻞ‬ ‫‪٢٠٢٢‬ﻡ‬ ‫ﻧﺒﻮﺀﺓ‬ ‫ﺃﻡ‬ ‫ﺻُﺪﻑ ﺭﻗﻤّﻴﺔ‬ ‫ﺑﺴّﺎﻡ ﻬﻧﺎﺩ ﺟﺮّﺍﺭ‬ ‫‪٣‬‬ ‫ﺍﻟﻄﺒﻌﺔ ﺍﻷﻭﱃ ‪١٤١٥‬ﻫـ ‪١٩٩٥ -‬ﻡ‬ ‫ﺍﻟﻄﺒﻌﺔ ﺍﻟﺜﺎﻧﻴﺔ ‪ ١٤١٧‬ﻫـ ‪١٩٩٦ -‬ﻡ‬ ‫ﺍﻟﻄﺒﻌﺔ ﺍﻟﺜﺎﻟﺜﺔ ‪ ١٤٢٣‬ﻫـ‪ ٢٠٠٢ -‬ﻡ‬ ‫‪٤‬‬ ‫ﺇﻬﻧﺎ ﻣﻼﺣﻈﺎﺕ‬ ‫ﻟﻌﻠﻨﺎ ﻧﻌﻴﺪ ﺍﻟﻨﻈﺮ ﰲ ﺩﺭﺍﺳﺔ ﺍﻟﺘﺎﺭﻳﺦ‬ ‫ﻫﻞ ﻫﻨﺎﻙ ﻗﺎﻧﻮﻥ ﳛﻜﻢ ﺍﻟﺘﺎﺭﻳﺦ ﻭﻓﻖ ﻣﻌﺎﺩﻻﺕ ﺭﻳﺎﺿّﻴﺔ‬ ‫ﺷﺎﻣﻠﺔ ؟!‬ ‫‪٥‬‬ ‫اﻋﺘﺬار‬ ‫ﻧﻀﺠﺖ ﻓﻜﺮﺓ ﻫﺬﺍ ﺍﻟﺒﺤﺚ ﹸﻗﺒْﻴﻞ ﻋﻤﻠﻴﺔ ﺍﻹﺑﻌﺎﺩ‪ ،‬ﺍﻟـﱵ ﻧﻔﹼـﺬﻬﺗﺎ‬ ‫ﺇﺳﺮﺍﺋﻴﻞ ﺑﺘﺎﺭﻳﺦ ‪١٩٩٢/١٢/١٨‬ﻡ‪ .‬ﺇﻻ ﺃﻧﲏ ﲤﻜﻨﺖ ﻣﻦ ﺗﺪﻭﻳﻨـﻬﺎ ﰲ‬ ‫ﺃﺭﺽ ﺍﳌﻨﻔﻰ‪ ،‬ﺑﺎﻟﻘﺮﺏ ﻣﻦ ﻗﺮﻳﺔ ﻣﺮﺝ ﺍﻟﺰﻫﻮﺭ ﰲ ﺍﳉﻨﻮﺏ ﺍﻟﻠﺒﻨﺎﱐ‪ .‬ﻟـﺬﺍ‬ ‫ﱂ ﺃﲤﻜﹼﻦ ﻣﻦ ﲢﻘﻴﻖ ﺷﻜﻠﻴﺎﺕ ﺍﻟﺮﺟﻮﻉ ﺇﱃ ﺍﳌﺼﺎﺩﺭ ﻭﺍﳌﺮﺍﺟﻊ‪ ،‬ﺇﻻ ﻣـﺎ‬ ‫ﺗﻴﺴﺮ ﱄ ﰲ ﻫﺬﺍ ﺍﳌﻜﺎﻥ ﺍﻟﻘﻔﺮ‪.‬‬ ‫‪٦‬‬ ‫ﺑﺴﻢ اﷲ اﻟﺮﺣﻤﻦ اﻟﺮﺣﻴﻢ‬ ‫ﹶﻓِﺈﺫﹶﺍ ﺟَﺎ َﺀ َﻭ ْﻋﺪُ ﺍﻵ ِﺧ َﺮ ِﺓ ﻟِﻴَﺴُﻮﺀُﻭﺍ ﻭُﺟُﻮﻫَﻜﹸﻢْ َﻭِﻟَﻴ ْﺪﺧُﻠﹸﻮﺍ‬ ‫ﺠ َﺪ ﹶﻛﻤَﺎ َﺩ َﺧﻠﹸﻮ ُﻩ ﹶﺃ ﱠﻭ ﹶﻝ َﻣ ﱠﺮ ٍﺓ َﻭِﻟﻴَُﺘﱢﺒﺮُﻭﺍ ﻣَﺎ َﻋ ﹶﻠﻮْﺍ‬ ‫ﺴِ‬ ‫ﺍﹾﻟ َﻤ ْ‬ ‫َﺗ ْﺘﺒِﲑﺍ ً‬ ‫]ﺍﻹﺳﺮﺍﺀ‪ ،‬ﺍﻵﻳﺔ‪[٧:‬‬ ‫‪٧‬‬ ‫ﻣﻘﺪّﻣﺔ ﺍﻟﻄﺒﻌﺔ ﺍﻟﺜﺎﻟﺜﺔ‬ ‫ﻛﺎﻧﺖ ﺍﻟﺒﺪﺍﻳﺔ ﰲ ﺍﻟﻨﺼﻒ ﺍﻟﺜﺎﱐ ﻣﻦ ﺍﻟﻌﺎﻡ ‪١٩٩٢‬ﻡ‪ ،‬ﻭﻛﺎﻧﺖ ﺍﻟﻔﻜﺮﺓ ﺟﺪﻳﺪﺓ‬ ‫ﻭﻏﺮﻳﺒﺔ‪ .‬ﻭﻻ ﺷﻚ ﺃﻧّﻪ ﻣﺴﻠﻚ ﱂ ُﻳﺴﻠﻚ ﻣﻦ ﻗﺒﻞ‪ ١،‬ﻭﻻ ﻳﻘﺎﺱ ﻋﻠﻰ ﻏﲑﻩ‪ ،‬ﻭﻻ‬ ‫ﻳﻘﺎﺱ ﻏﲑ ُﻩ ﻋﻠﻴﻪ‪ .‬ﻣﻦ ﻫﻨﺎ ﻛﺎﻥ ﺍﻷﻣﺮ ﻣﻔﺎﺟﺄﺓ ﻟﻜﻞ ﻣﻦ ﲰﻌﻪ‪ ،‬ﺑﻞ ﻛﺎﻥ ﻣﻔﺎﺟﺄﺓ‬ ‫ﻟﻨﺎ ﻗﺒﻞ ﻏﲑﻧﺎ‪ .‬ﻭﻗﺒﻞ ﻧﻀﻮﺝ ﺍﻟﺒﺤﺚ ﻛﺎﻥ ﺍﻹﺑﻌﺎﺩ ﺇﱃ ﻣﺮﺝ ﺍﻟﺰﻫﻮﺭ‪ ،‬ﰲ ﺍﳉﻨﻮﺏ‬ ‫ﺍﻟﻠﺒﻨﺎﱐ‪ .‬ﻭﻫﻨﺎﻙ ﻛﺎﻥ ﺍﻟﻘﺮﺍﺭ ﺑﺘﺪﻭﻳﻦ ﺍﻟﺒﺤﺚ؛ ﻓﻜﺎﻥ ﰲ ﺍﻟﺒﺪﺍﻳﺔ ﻭُﺭَﻳﻘﺎﺕ ﻻ ﺗﺰﻳﺪ‬ ‫ﻋﻦ ﻋﺸﺮﻳﻦ ﺻﻔﺤﺔ‪ ،‬ﺍﻧﺘﺸﺮﺕ ﺑﲔ ﺍﻟﻨﺎﺱ ﻛﺎﻟﻨﺎﺭ ﰲ ﺍﳍﺸﻴﻢ‪ ٢،‬ﻭﱂ ﻳﻜﻦ ﺫﻟﻚ‬ ‫ﻣﺴﺘﻐﺮﺑﺎ؛ ﻓﻤﻨﻬﺠﻴّﺔ ﺍﻟﺒﺤﺚ ﱂ ُﺗﻌﻬﺪ ﻣﻦ ﻗﺒﻞ‪ ،‬ﻭﺍﳌﻮﺿﻮﻉ ﰲ ﺍﻷﺻﻞ ﻣﺜﲑ‬ ‫ﺚ ﰲ ﻛﺘﺎﺏ‪ ،‬ﻓﻜﺎﻥ ﺗﺪﻭﻳﻨﻪ ﻋﻠﻰ ﻋﺠﻞ‪،‬‬ ‫ﻟﻼﻫﺘﻤﺎﻡ‪ .‬ﹼﰒ ﺑﺪﺍ ﻟﻨﺎ ﺃﻥ ُﻧﺨﺮﺝ ﺍﻟﺒﺤ ﹶ‬ ‫ﻗﺒﻞ ﺭﺟﻮﻋﻨﺎ ﺇﱃ ﺍﻟﻮﻃﻦ‪ ،‬ﻟﺬﺍ ﱂ ﻳﺘﻴﺴّﺮ ﻟﻨﺎ ﺃﻥ ﻧﺸﺮﻑ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺍﻟﻄﺒﺎﻋﺔ‪ .‬ﺃﻣّﺎ ﺍﻟﻄﺒﻌﺔ‬ ‫ﳊﻘﺖ ﻣﻦ ﻏﲑ ﺇﻋﺎﺩ ٍﺓ ﻟﻠﺼﻴﺎﻏﺔ‪.‬‬ ‫ﺍﻟﺜﺎﻧﻴﺔ ﻓﻜﺎﻧﺖ ﺯﻳﺎﺩﺍﺕ ﹸﺃ ِ‬ ‫ﻭﻳﺒﻘﻰ ﺍﻟﻘﻠ ُﻢ ﻋﺎﺟﺰﹰﺍ ﻋﻦ ﺇﻳﺼﺎﻝ ﺍﻟﻔﻜﺮﺓ؛ ﻓﻘﺪ ﻻﺣﻈﻨﺎ ﺗﻔﺎﻭﺗﺎﹰ ﻛﺒﲑﹰﺍ ﰲ‬ ‫ﺭﺩﻭﺩ ﻓﻌﻞ ﻣﻦ ﻳﻘﺮﺃ ﺍﻟﻜﺘﺎﺏ‪ ،‬ﻭﻣﻦ ﻳﺴﺘﻤﻊ ﺇﱃ ﺍﶈﺎﺿﺮﺓ‪ ،‬ﻟﺬﺍ ﳒﺪ ﺃ ﹼﻥ ﺃﺷ ّﺪ ﺍﻟﻨﺎﺱ‬ ‫‪١‬‬ ‫ﻫﺬﺍ ﻃﺒﻌﹰﺎ ﰲ ﺣﺪﻭﺩ ﻋﻠﻤﻨﺎ‪ ،‬ﺃﻣّﺎ ﺍﳌﻼﺣﻈﺎﺕ ﺍﻟﻌﺪﺩﻳّﺔ ﺍﻟﺒﺴﻴﻄﺔ‪ ،‬ﻓﻮﺭﺩ ﻓﻴﻬﺎ ﻋﻦ ﺍﻟﺴﻠﻒ ﺍﻟﺸﻰﺀ ﺍﻟﻘﻠﻴﻞ‪.‬‬ ‫‪٢‬‬ ‫ﻻ ﺗﻘﻮﻡ ﺍﳊﺠّﺔ ﺑﺎﻟﻜﺜﺮﺓ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺻﺪﻕ ﺍﻟﻔﻜﺮﺓ‪.‬‬ ‫‪٨‬‬ ‫ﺡ ﻟﻠﻜﺘﺎﺏ‪ .‬ﻣﻦ‬ ‫ﲢﻤﺴﹰﺎ ﻟﻠﻔﻜﺮﺓ ﻫﻢ ﺃﻭﻟﺌﻚ ﺍﻟﺬﻳﻦ ﺗﻴﺴّﺮ ﳍﻢ ﺃﻥ ﻳﺴﺘﻤﻌﻮﺍ ﺇﱃ ﺷﺮ ٍ‬ ‫ﻫﻨﺎ ﺟﺎﺀﺕ ﻓﻜﺮﺓ ﺇﻋﺎﺩﺕ ﺻﻴﺎﻏﺔ ﺍﻟﻜﺘﺎﺏ‪ ،‬ﰲ ﳏﺎﻭﻟﺔ ﻟﺘﺒﺴﻴﻄﻪ‪ ،‬ﻭﺗﻘﺮﻳﺒﻪ‪،‬‬ ‫ﻭﺗﺒﻮﻳﺒﻪ؛ ﻓﻜﺎﻥ ﺍﳊﺬﻑ ﻭﺍﻹﺿﺎﻓﺔ‪ ،‬ﻭﺍﻻﻋﺘﻨﺎﺀ ﺑﺎﻟﺸّﻜﻠﻴّﺎﺕ‪ .‬ﻭﺇﻧّﺎ ﻟﻨﺮﺟﻮ ﺃﻥ ﻧﻜﻮﻥ‬ ‫ﻗﺪ ﳒﺤﻨﺎ ﰲ ﺫﻟﻚ‪ ،‬ﻭﺇ ﹾﻥ ﻛﻨﺎ ﻟﻨﺸﻌﺮ ﺑﻌﺪﻡ ﺍﻟﺮﺿﻰ ﻋﻤّﺎ ُﻳﻘﺪّﻣﻪ ﺍﻟﻜﺘﺎﺏ ﰲ ﻣﻘﺎﺑﻞ‬ ‫ﺍﶈﺎﺿﺮﺓ‪ .‬ﻭﻟﻜﻦ ﻣﺎ ﻋﺴﺎﻧﺎ ﺃ ﹾﻥ ﻧﻔﻌﻞ ؟!‬ ‫ﻻ ﺃﻛﺘﻢ ﺍﻟﻘﺎﺭﺉ ﺍﻟﻜﺮﱘ ﺃﻧّﻪ ﻭﺑﻌﺪ ﺗﻄﻮّﺭ ﺍﻟ ّﺪﺭﺍﺳﺎﺕ ﺍﻟﻌﺪﺩﻳّﺔ ﻟﺪﻳﻨﺎ‪ ،‬ﻭﺑﻌﺪ‬ ‫ﺃﻥ ﺃﺧﺮﺟﻨﺎ ﻛﺘﺎﺏ‪ ) :‬ﻭﻟﺘﻌﻠﻤﻮﺍ ﻋﺪﺩ ﺍﻟﺴﻨﲔ ﻭﺍﳊﺴﺎﺏ ‪ ( ٣٠٩‬ﻭﻛﺬﻟﻚ‬ ‫ﻛﺘﺎﺏ ) ﺍﳌﻴﺰﺍﻥ ‪ ٤٥٦‬ﲝﻮﺙ ﰲ ﺍﻟﻌﺪﺩ ﺍﻟﻘﺮﺁﱐ ( ﺑﺪﺃﻧﺎ ﻧﺸﻌﺮ ﺃ ﹼﻥ ﻫﺬﺍ ﺍﻟﻜﺘﺎﺏ‬ ‫ﻻ ﻳﻌﻄﻲ ﺍﻟﻔﻜﺮﺓ ﺣﻘﹼﻬﺎ‪ .‬ﻭﻟﻌﻠﹼﻨﺎ‪ ،‬ﺇﻥ ﺷﺎﺀ ﺍﷲ‪ ،‬ﻧﺼﺪﺭ ﺍﻟﻜﺘﺐ ﺍﻟﺜﻼﺛﺔ ﰲ ﳎﻠ ٍﺪ‬ ‫ﻭﺍﺣﺪ‪ .‬ﻭﺣﱴ ﺫﻟﻚ ﺍﻟﻮﻗﺖ ﳝﻜﻦ ﻟﻠﻘﺎﺭﺉ ﺃﻥ ﻳﻄﺎﻟﻊ ﻫﺬﻩ ﺍﻟﻜﺘﺐ ﰲ ﺍﻟﺼﻔﺤﺔ‬ ‫ﺍﻹﻟﻜﺘﺮﻭﻧﻴّﺔ ﳌﺮﻛﺰ ﻧﻮﻥ ﻟﻠﺪﺭﺍﺳﺎﺕ ﺍﻟﻘﺮﺁﻧﻴّﺔ‪www.noon-cqs.org :‬‬ ‫ﻧﺘﻴﺠﺔ ﻟﻠﺨﻠﻂ ﺑﲔ ﺍﻟﺒﺤﻮﺙ ﺍﳉﺎﺩّﺓ ﰲ ﺍﻟﻌﺪﺩ ﺍﻟﻘﺮﺁﱐ‪ ،‬ﻭﺍﻟﺒﺤﻮﺙ ﺍﳌﻔﺘﻘﺮﺓ‬ ‫ﺴﻠﻴﻤﺔ‪ ،‬ﺑﺪﺃﻧﺎ ﻧﻠﻤﺲ ﻭﺟﻮﺩ ﺑﻌﺾ ﺍﳌﻌﺎﺭﺿﺎﺕ ﻟﻘﻀﻴّﺔ ﺍﻹﻋﺠﺎﺯ‬ ‫ﺇﱃ ﺍﳌﻨﻬﺠﻴّﺔ ﺍﻟ ّ‬ ‫ﺍﻟﻌﺪﺩﻱ‪ ،‬ﻭﻫﺬﺍ ﺃﻣ ٌﺮ ﻣﺘﻮﻗﹼﻊ‪ ،‬ﻷ ﹼﻥ ﺍﻷﻣﺮ ﻳﺘﻌﻠﹼﻖ ﺑﺎﻟﻘﺮﺁﻥ ﺍﻟﻜﺮﱘ‪ .‬ﻭﻣﻦ ﺍﻟﻄﺒﻴﻌﻲ ﺃﻥ‬ ‫ﻳﺄﺧﺬ ﺍﻟﻨﺎﺱ ِﺣﺬﺭﻫﻢ ﻣﻦ ﻛ ﹼﻞ ﺟﺪﻳﺪ‪ ،‬ﺣﱴ ﻳﻄﻤﺌﻨﻮﺍ ﺇﱃ ﺳﻼﻣﺔ ﺍﳌﻮﻗﻒ‪ .‬ﻭﻧﺮﻯ‬ ‫ﺃ ﹼﻥ ﺫﻟﻚ ﻣﻦ ﻭﺍﺟﺒﻨﺎ‪ ،‬ﻭﻻ ﻧﻠﻮﻡ ﺍﻟﻐﲑ ﻋﻠﻰ ﻣﻮﺍﻗﻔﻬﻢ‪ ،‬ﻭﻟﻜﻦ ﻟﻨﺎ ﺃﻥ ﻧﺘﻤﻨّﻰ ﻋﻠﻰ‬ ‫ﺍﳌﺨﻠﺼﲔ ﻣﻨﻬﻢ ﺃﻥ ﻳﺪﺭﺳﻮﺍ ﺍﳌﺴﺄﻟﺔ‪ ،‬ﺣﱴ ﺗﻜﻮﻥ ﻣﻮﺍﻗﻔﻬﻢ ﻗﺎﺋﻤﺔ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺃﺳﺲ‬ ‫ﺳﻠﻴﻤﺔ ﻭﻣﻨﻬﺠﻴّﺔ‪ .‬ﻭﳍﻢ ﻋﻠﻴﻨﺎ ﺃﻥ ﻧﻜﻮﻥ ﺃ ّﻭﻝ ﺍﻟﺮﺍﺟﻌﲔ ﺇﱃ ﺍﳊ ّﻖ ﺑﺈﺫﻥ ﺍﷲ ﺗﻌﺎﱃ‪.‬‬ ‫ﺼﻴﺖ‪ ،‬ﻭﻟﺪﻳﻪ ﻣﻨﻬﺠﻴّﺔ ﺳﻮﻳّﺔ ﰲ ﺍﻟﺘﻔﻜﲑ ﻭﺍﻟﺒﺤﺚ‪،‬‬ ‫ُﺳﺌﻞ ﻋﺎﱂ ﺫﺍﺋ ُﻊ ﺍﻟ ﱢ‬ ‫ﻭﻛﺘﺒﻪ ﲤﻸ ﺍﻷﺳﻮﺍﻕ‪ ،‬ﻭﻧﻨﺼﺢ ﺍﻟﻨﺎﺱ ﺑﺎﻗﺘﻨﺎﺋﻬﺎ‪ ،‬ﻋﻦ ﺭﺃﻳﻪ ﰲ ﻣﺴﺄﻟﺔ ﺍﻹﻋﺠﺎﺯ‬ ‫‪٩‬‬ ‫ﺍﻟﻌﺪﺩﻱ‪ ،‬ﻭﻋﻠﻰ ﻭﺟﻪ ﺍﳋﺼﻮﺹ ﻗﻀﻴّﺔ ﺍﻟﻌﺪﺩ ‪ .١٩‬ﻓﺴﺎﺭﻉ ﺇﱃ ﺭﻓﺾ ﺍﻟﻔﻜﺮﺓ‪،‬‬ ‫ﻼ ﻳﺆﻳّﺪ ﻣﻮﻗﻔﻪ ﻓﻘﺎﻝ‪ :‬ﺇﻧّﻬﻢ ﻳﻘﻮﻟﻮﻥ ﺇ ﹼﻥ "ﺑﺴﻢ ﺍﷲ ﺍﻟﺮﲪﻦ ﺍﻟﺮﺣﻴﻢ"‬ ‫ﻭﻗﺪّﻡ ﺩﻟﻴ ﹰ‬ ‫ﺗﺴﻌﺔ ﻋﺸﺮ ﺣﺮﻓﹰﺎ‪ .‬ﻭﺃﺿﺎﻑ‪ :‬ﻭﻫﺬﺍ ﻏﲑ ﺻﺤﻴﺢ‪ .‬ﹼﰒ ﺑﲔ ﻣﻮﺿﻊ ﺍﳋﻄﺄ ﰲ‬ ‫ﺍﻟﻘﻮﻝ‪ .‬ﻓﻘﻠﺖ ﰲ ﻧﻔﺴﻲ ﻧﻌﻢ‪ ،‬ﺣﱴ ﻳﻌﻠﻢ ﺍﻟﻨﺎﺱ ﺃﻥ ﻻﻋﺼﻤﺔ ﻟﺒﺸﺮ‪ ،‬ﺑﻞ ﺇ ﹼﻥ‬ ‫ﻋﺼﻤﺔ ﺍﻟﺮﺳﻞ ﻛﺎﻧﺖ ﻣﻦ ﺃﺟﻞ ﺍﻟﺮﺳﺎﻻﺕ‪٣.‬ﻭﺣﺪﺙ ﺃ ﹾﻥ ﻛﺎﻥ ﻟﻨﺎ ﻣﺸﺎﺭﻛﺔ ﰲ‬ ‫ﻓﻀﺎﺋﻴّﺔ ﻋﺮﺑﻴّﺔ‪ ،‬ﺗﻨﺎﻗﺶ ﻛﺘﺎﺑﻨﺎ ﻫﺬﺍ‪ ،‬ﻭﺗﺼﺪّﻯ ﻟﻨﺎ ﻋﺎﳌﺎﻥ ﺟﻠﻴﻼﻥ‪ ،‬ﻣﺎ ﻟﺒﺜﺎ ﺃﻥ ﻻﻧﺎ‪.‬‬ ‫ﺕ‬ ‫ﺖ ﺃ ﹼﻥ ﺍﻟﺮﻓﺾ ﻻﻳﻘﻮﻡ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺩﻟﻴﻞ‪ ،‬ﻓﺴﺄﻟﺖ ﺍﳌﺘﺸﺪﺩ ﻣﻨﻬﻤﺎ‪ :‬ﻫﻞ ﻗﺮﺃ َ‬ ‫ﻭﻻﺣﻈ ُ‬ ‫ﺖ ﺃﺧﹰﺎ ﻳﻈﻬﺮ ﻋﻠﻴﻪ‬ ‫ﺕ ﺑﺎﳊﺮﺝ‪ ،‬ﻷﻧﲏ ﹶﺃﺣﺮﺟ ُ‬ ‫ﺍﻟﻜﺘﺎﺏ ؟ ﻓﻘﺎﻝ ﻻ!! ﻓﺸﻌﺮ ُ‬ ‫ﺍﻟﺼّﺪﻕ‪ ،‬ﻭﻟﻜﻨّﻪ ﺿﺤﻴّﺔ ﺍﳌﻼﺑﺴﺎﺕ‪ .‬ﻭﺇّﻧﻨﺎ ﻟﻌﻠﻰ ﻗﻨﺎﻋﺔ ﺑﺄ ﹼﻥ ﺃﻛﺜﺮ ﺍﻟﺮﺍﻓﻀﲔ ﳌﺴﺄﻟﺔ‬ ‫ﺍﻹﻋﺠﺎﺯ ﺍﻟﻌﺪﺩﻱ ﻫﻢ ﻣﻦ ﺍﳌﺨﻠﺼﲔ‪ ،‬ﺍﳌﺸﻔﻘﲔ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺍﻷﻣّﺔ ﺃﻥ ﻳﻐﺘﺎﳍﺎ ﺍﻻﳓﺮﺍﻑ‪.‬‬ ‫ﻭﰲ ﺍﳌﻘﺎﺑﻞ ﳓﻦ ﻋﻠﻰ ﻳﻘﲔ ﺑﺄ ﹼﻥ ﻗﻀﻴّﺔ ﺍﻹﻋﺠﺎﺯ ﺍﻟﻌﺪﺩﻱ ﺳﺘﻔﺮﺽ ﻧﻔﺴﻬﺎ ﻋﻠﻰ‬ ‫ﺍﳉﻤﻴﻊ‪ ،‬ﻷﻧّﻨﺎ ﻧﻌﺮﻑ ﺿﺨﺎﻣﺔ ﺍﳌﻌﻄﻴﺎﺕ‪ ،‬ﻭﺍﻟﻘﻀﻴّﺔ ﺍﺳﺘﻘﺮﺍﺋﻴّﺔ‪ ،‬ﻭﻧﻨـﺰﻩ ﺍﻟﻘﺮﺁﻥ‬ ‫ﺼﺪﻓﺔ‪ .‬ﺃﻣّﺎ ﺍﻟﻘﻮ ﹸﻝ ﺑﺄ ﹼﻥ ﻣﺎ ِﺟﺌﻨﺎ ﺑﻪ ﱂ ﻳﻘﻞ‬ ‫ﺍﻟﻜﺮﱘ ﺃﻥ ﻳﺮﺩ ﻓﻴﻪ ﺷﻲﺀ ﻋﻠﻰ ﻭﺟﻪ ﺍﻟ ّ‬ ‫ﺴﻠﻒ ﺍﻟﺼﺎﱀ‪ ،‬ﻓﻬﻮ ﻗﻮﻝ ﰲ ﺭﺃﻳﻨﺎ ﺻﺤﻴﺢ‪ ،‬ﻛﻴﻒ ﻻ‪ ،‬ﻭﺍﻟﻘﺮﺁﻥ‬ ‫ﺑﻪ ﺃﺣﺪ ﻣﻦ ﺍﻟ ّ‬ ‫ﺍﻟﻜﺮﱘ ﺃﻋﻈﻢ ﻭﺃﺟ ﹼﻞ ﻣﻦ ﺃﻥ ﳛﻴﻂ ﺑﻪ ﻋﻠﻢ ﺳﻠﻒ ﺃﻭ ﺧﻠﻒ ؟!‬ ‫ﻚ ﻣﻦ ﺃ ﹾﻥ ﻧﺸﺮﻙ ﺑﻚ ﺷﻴﺌﹰﺎ‪.‬‬ ‫ﺍﻟﻠﻬ ّﻢ ﺇﻧّﺎ ﻧﻌﻮﺫ ﺑ َ‬ ‫‪٣‬‬ ‫ﱂ ﻧﺬﻛﺮ ﺍﺳﻢ ﻫﺬﺍ ﺍﻟﻌﺎﱂ ﺍﳉﻠﻴﻞ ﻷ ﹼﻥ ﻗﺼﺪﻧﺎ ﻫﻨﺎ ﺇﺑﻼﻍ ﺍﻟﻔﻜﺮﺓ‪ .‬ﻭﺍﻟﻌﺠﻴﺐ ﺃ ﹼﻥ ﻫﻨﺎﻙ ﺃﻛﺜﺮ ﻣﻦ ﻛﺎﺗﺐ ﻣﺮﻣﻮﻕ ﺗﺒﻨّﻰ ﻫﺬﺍ‬ ‫ﺍﻟﺪﻟﻴﻞ‪.‬‬ ‫‪١٠‬‬ ‫ﻡﺪﺧﻞ‬ ‫‪٤‬‬ ‫ﻳﻄﻤﺢ ﺍﻟﺒﺸﺮ ﺑﻘﻮﺓ ﺇﱃ ﻣﻌﺮﻓﺔ ﺍﳌﺴﺘﻘﺒﻞ ﻭﻛﺸﻒ ﺃﺳﺘﺎﺭ ﺍﻟﻐﻴﺐ‪ ،‬ﻭﺷـﺎﺀ‬ ‫ﷲ ﺗﻌﺎﱃ ﺃﻥ ﻳُﻄﻠﻊ ﻋﺒﺎﺩﻩ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺑﻌﺾ ﺍﻟﻐﻴﺐ ﳊﻜﻤﺔ ﻳﺮﻳﺪﻫﺎ‪ ،‬ﻓﻜﺎﻧﺖ ﺍﻟﻨﺒﻮﺀﺍﺕ‬ ‫ﺍُ‬ ‫ﻼ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺻﺪﻕ ﺍﻟﻨﺒﻮﺓ ﻭﺍﻟﺮﺳﺎﻟﺔ‪ ،‬ﻭﺗﻜـﻮﻥ‬ ‫ﻳﺄﰐ ﻬﺑﺎ ﺍﻷﻧﺒﻴﺎﺀ ﻭﺍﻟﺮﺳﻞ‪ ،‬ﻓﺘﻜﻮﻥ ﺩﻟﻴ ﹰ‬ ‫ﻼ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺃ ﹼﻥ ﻋﻠﻢ ﺍﷲ ﺗﻌﺎﱃ ﻛﺎﻣﻞ‪ ،‬ﻓﻴﺪﺭﻙ ﺍﻟﻨﺎﺱُ ﺑﻌﺾ ﺃﺳﺮﺍﺭ ﺍﻟﻘﺪﺭ‪ .‬ﻭﳌـﺎ‬ ‫ﺩﻟﻴ ﹰ‬ ‫ﺷﺎﺀ ﺍﷲ ﺃﻥ ﲣﺘﻢ ﺍﻟﺮﺳﺎﻻﺕ‪ ،‬ﻭﺷﺎﺀ ﺃﻥ ﻳﺮﻓﻊ ﺻﻔﺎﺕ ﺍﻟﻨﺒـﻮﺓ‪ ،‬ﺃﺑﻘـﻰ ﺍﻟﺮﺅﻳـﺎ‬ ‫ﻉ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺍﻟﻐﻴﺐ ﻗﺒﻞ ﻭﻗﻮﻋﻪ‪ ،‬ﻟﻴﺪﺭﻙ ﺍﻟﻨﺎﺱ ﻣـﺎ ﻗـﺪ‬ ‫ﺍﻟﺼﺎﺩﻗﺔ‪ ،‬ﻭﺍﻟﱵ ﻫﻲ ﺍﻃﻼ ٌ‬ ‫ﻋﺠﺰﻭﺍ ﻋﻦ ﺗﺼﻮﺭﻩ ﻣﻦ ﻗﻀﺎﺀ ﺍﷲ‪ ،‬ﻭﻋﻠﻤﻪ ﺑﺎﻷﺷﻴﺎﺀ ﻗﺒﻞ ﻭﺟﻮﺩﻫﺎ‪ ،‬ﻭﻳﻌﻠﻤﻮﺍ ﺃ ﹼﻥ‬ ‫ﻋﺠﺰ ﺍﻹﻧﺴﺎﻥ ﻋﻦ ﺗﺼ ّﻮﺭ ﺍﻷﺷﻴﺎﺀ ﻻ ﻳﻨﻔﻲ ﻭﺟﻮﺩﻫﺎ‪.‬‬ ‫ﺍﻷﻣﺜﻠﺔ ﰲ ﺍﻟﻘﺮﺁﻥ ﻭﺍﻟﺴﻨﺔ ﻛﺜﲑﺓ‪ .‬ﻳﻘﻮﻝ ﺳﺒﺤﺎﻧﻪ ﻭﺗﻌـﺎﱃ ﰲ ﺳـﻮﺭﺓ‬ ‫ﺽ ﻭَﻫُﻢ ﻣِﻦ ﺑَﻌ ِﺪ ﹶﻏ ﹶﻠِﺒﻬِﻢ َﺳﻴَﻐ ِﻠﺒُﻮ ﹶﻥ‪ .‬ﻓِـﻲ‬ ‫ﺍﻟﺮﻭﻡ‪ ) :‬ﹸﻏﻠﺒﺖ ﺍﻟﺮﻭ ُﻡ ﰲ ﺃﺩﱏ ﺍﻷَﺭ ِ‬ ‫ﲔ ِﻟ ﹶﻠ ِﻪ ﺍﻷَﻣ ُﺮ ﻣِﻦ ﻗﹶﺒ ﹸﻞ َﻭﻣِﻦ ﺑَﻌ ُﺪ َﻭﻳﻮﻣﺌ ٍﺬ ﻳَﻔـ َﺮﺡُ ﺍﳌﹸﺆ ِﻣﻨُـﻮ ﹶﻥ ﺑِﻨَﺼـﺮِ‬ ‫ﺑِﻀ ِﻊ ِﺳِﻨ َ‬ ‫ﷲ ﺭَﺳﻮﹶﻟ ُﻪ ﺍﻟﺮﺅﻳﺎ ﺑﺎﳊ ﱢﻖ ﻟﺘﺪﺧ ﹸﻠ ﱠﻦ‬ ‫ﻕﺍ ُ‬ ‫ﺻ َﺪ َ‬ ‫ﺍﻟ ﹶﻠ ِﻪ‪٥(..‬ﻭﻳﻘﻮﻝ ﺳﺒﺤﺎﻧﻪ ﻭﺗﻌﺎﱃ‪) :‬ﹶﻟﻘﹶﺪ َ‬ ‫‪٤‬‬ ‫ﻼ ﻟﻠﻄﺒﻌﺔ ﺍﻷﻭﱃ‪ ،‬ﻓﺄﺿﻔﻨﺎ ﺇﻟﻴﻪ ﰲ ﻫﺬﻩ ﺍﻟﻄﺒﻌﺔ ﺍﻟﺸﻲﺀ ﺍﻟﻘﻠﻴﻞ‪ ،‬ﻣﻊ ﺑﻌﺾ ﺍﻟﺘﻌﺪﻳﻞ‪.‬‬ ‫ﻛﺎﻥ ﻫﺬﺍ ﻣﺪﺧ ﹰ‬ ‫‪ ٥‬ﺳﻮﺭﺓ ﺍﻟﺮﻭﻡ‪ ،‬ﺍﻵﻳﺎﺕ‪٥ -٢ :‬‬ ‫‪١١‬‬ ‫ﺼﺮﻳ َﻦ ﻻ ﲣـﺎﻓﻮﻥ‬ ‫ﲔ ﳏ ﱢﻠﻘﲔ ُﺭ َﺀﻭﺳﻜﻢ ﻭ ُﻣﻘ ﱢ‬ ‫ﷲ ﺀﺍﻣﻨ َ‬ ‫ﺍﳌﺴﺠ َﺪ ﺍﳊﺮﺍ َﻡ ﺇﻥ ﺷﺎ َﺀ ﺍ ُ‬ ‫ﻓﻌﻠ َﻢ ﻣﺎ ﱂ ﺗﻌﻠﻤﻮﺍ ﻓﺠﻌﻞ ﻣﻦ ﺩﻭ ِﻥ ﺫﻟﻚ ﻓﺘ ً‬ ‫ﺤﺎ ﻗﺮﻳﺒﹰﺎ( ‪٦‬ﻭﻳﻘﻮﻝ ﺍﻟﺮﺳﻮﻝ ﺻﻠﻰ‬ ‫ﺴﺎﻋ ﹸﺔ ﺣﱴ ﻳﻘﺎﺗـ ﹶﻞ ﺍﳌﺴـﻠﻤﻮ ﹶﻥ ﺍﻟﻴﻬـﻮﺩ‪(...‬‬ ‫ﺍﷲ ﻋﻠﻴﻪ ﻭﺳﻠﻢ ‪) :‬ﻻ ﺗﻘﻮ ُﻡ ﺍﻟ ّ‬ ‫ﻭﺍﻷﺣﺎﺩﻳﺚ ﰲ ﻫﺬﺍ ﺍﻟﺒﺎﺏ ﻛﺜﲑﺓ‪.‬‬ ‫ﻟﻴﺲ ﻫﺬﺍ ﻣﻘﺎﻡ ﺑﺴﻂ ﺍﳊﺪﻳﺚ ﰲ ﺣﻜﻤﺔ ﺍﻹﺧﺒﺎﺭ ﺑﺎﻟﻐﻴﺐ‪ ،‬ﻭﺩﻭﺭ ﺫﻟﻚ‬ ‫ﺙ ﺍﻟﺘﻮﺍﻛﻞ ﻭﺍﻟﺘﻘﺎﻋﺲ!!‬ ‫ﰲ ﺣﻴﺎﺓ ﺍﻟﻨﺎﺱ‪ .‬ﺇﻻ ﺃ ﹼﻥ ﺍﻟﺒﻌﺾ ﻳﺮﻯ ﺃﻥ ﺍﻟﻨﺒﻮﺀﺍﺕ ُﺗﻮﺭ ﹸ‬ ‫ﻱ ﻗﺪ ﳚ ُﺪ ﺻِﺪﻗِﻴّﺔ ﻋﻠﻲ ﺍﻟﺼّﻌﻴﺪ ﺍﻟﻨﻈﺮﻱ‪ ،‬ﺃﻭ ﺑﻌﺒﺎﺭﺓ ﺃﺧـﺮﻯ ﻋﻠـﻰ‬ ‫ﻭﻫﺬﺍ ﺍﻟﺮﺃ ُ‬ ‫ﺻﻌﻴﺪ ﺍﳉﺪﻝ ﺍﻟﻌﻘﻠﻲ ﺍﻟﺒﻌﻴﺪ ﻋﻦ ﳏﺎﻛﻤﺔ ﺍﻟﻮﺍﻗﻊ‪ .‬ﺃﻣﺎ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺍﻟﺼـﻌﻴﺪ ﺍﻟﻌﻤﻠـﻲ‬ ‫ﻭﺍﻟﻮﺍﻗﻌﻲ‪ ،‬ﻓﺎﻥ ﻟﻠﻨﺒﻮﺀﺍﺕ ﺍﻷﺛﺮ ﺍﻟﺒﺎﻟﻎ ﰲ ﺭﻓﻊ ﺍِﻟﻬﻤﻢ‪ ،‬ﻭﺍﺟﺘﺜﺎﺙ ﺍﻟﻴـﺄﺱ ﻣـﻦ‬ ‫ﺍﻟﻘﻠﻮﺏ‪ ،‬ﻭﺩﻓﻊ ﺍﻟﻨﺎﺱ ﻟﻠﻌﻤﻞ‪ .‬ﻭﺗﺎﺭﻳﺦ ﺍﻟﺼﺤﺎﺑﺔ ﺃﺻﺪﻕ ﺷﺎﻫﺪ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺫﻟﻚ‪.‬‬ ‫ﻫﻞ ﺟﻠﺲ ﺳﺮﺍ ﻗ ﹸﺔ ﰲ ﺑﻴﺘﻪ ﺣﱴ ﻳﺄﺗﻴﻪ ﺳﻮﺍﺭَﺍ ﻛﺴﺮﻯ؟ ﻭﻫﻞ ﺗﻘـﺎﻋﺲ‬ ‫ﺍﻟﺼﺤﺎﺑﺔ ﻋﻦ ﻓﺘﺢ ﺑﻼﺩ ﻓﺎﺭﺱ‪ ،‬ﻭﻗﺪ ﺃﺧﱪﻫﻢ ﺍﻟﺮﺳﻮﻝ ﲝﺼﻮﻝ ﺫﻟﻚ ؟ ﻭﻫﻞ‪...‬‬ ‫؟ ﻟﻴﺲ ﺑﺈﻣﻜﺎﻥ ﺍﳌﺴﻠﻢ ﺃﻥ ﻳﺘﺮﻙ ﻭﺍﺟﺒﺎﹰ‪ ،‬ﻭﺍﳌﺴﻠﻢ ﻳﻄﻠﺐ ﺭﺿـﻰ ﺍﷲ ﺑﺎﻟﺪﺭﺟـﺔ‬ ‫ﺍﻷﻭﱃ‪ ،‬ﺃﻣﺎ ﺍﻟﻨﺘﺎﺋﺞ ﻓﲑﺟﻮﻫﺎ‪ ،‬ﻭﻻ ﳚﻌﻠﻬﺎ ﻏﺎﻳﺔ ﰲ ﺳﻌﻴﻪ‪ .‬ﻫﺐ ﺃﻧﻨـﺎ ﺗﻘﺎﻋﺴـﻨﺎ‬ ‫ﻟﻌﻠﻤﻨﺎ ﲝﺼﻮﻝ ﺍﻟﻨﺘﻴﺠﺔ‪ ،‬ﻓﻤﺎ ﺍﻟﺬﻱ ﳝﻜﻦ ﺃ ﹾﻥ ﳒﻨﻴﻪ ﻭﻗﺪ ﺧﺴﺮﻧﺎ ﺃﻧﻔﺴﻨﺎ؟! ﻭﺍﻟﺪﻧﻴﺎ‬ ‫ﺩﺍﺭ ﺍﺑﺘﻼﺀ ﻭﺍﻣﺘﺤﺎﻥ‪ ،‬ﻭﻟﻴﺴﺖ ﺑﺪﺍﺭ ﻣﺜﻮﺑﺔ‪) :‬ﻭﺃﻟﹼﻮ ﺍﺳﺘﻘﺎﻣﻮﺍ ﻋﻠـﻰ ﺍﻟ ﹼﻄﺮﻳﻘـ ِﺔ‬ ‫ﻷﺳﻘﻴﻨﺎﻫﻢ ﻣﺎ ًﺀ ﻏﺪﻗﹰﺎ‪ ،‬ﻟﻨﻔﺘﻨﻬﻢ ﻓﻴﻪ‪( ....‬‬ ‫‪٧‬‬ ‫ﻑ ﻣﻦ ﺍﳌﺸﺮﻛﲔ ﻳُﺤﺎﺻﺮﻭﻥ ﺍﳌﺪﻳﻨﺔ ﺍﳌﻨـﻮﺭﺓ‪،‬ﺣﱴ ﺑﻠﻐـﺖ‬ ‫ﻋﺸﺮ ﹸﺓ ﺁﻻ ٍ‬ ‫‪ ٦‬ﺳﻮﺭﺓ ﺍﻟﻔﺘﺢ‪ ،‬ﺍﻵﻳﺔ ‪٢٧ :‬‬ ‫‪ ٧‬ﺳﻮﺭﺓ ﺍﳉﻦ‪ ،‬ﺍﻵﻳﺘﺎﻥ‪١٧ -١٦ :‬‬ ‫‪١٢‬‬ ‫ﺼﺤﺎﺑ ﹸﺔ ﺑﺎﷲ ﺍﻟﻈﻨﻮﻥ‪ .‬ﰲ ﻣﺜﻞ ﻫﺬﻩ ﺍﻷﺟﻮﺍﺀ ﺟـﺎﺀﺕ‬ ‫ﺍﻟﻘﻠﻮﺏ ﺍﳊﻨﺎﺟﺮ‪ ،‬ﻭﻇ ّﻦ ﺍﻟ ّ‬ ‫ﺖ ﻣﻔـﺎﺗﺢ‬ ‫ﷲ ﺃﻛﱪ ﺃﹸﻋﻄﻴ ُ‬ ‫ﺖ ﻣﻔﺎﺗﺢ ﻛﺴﺮﻯ‪ ...‬ﺍ ُ‬ ‫ﷲ ﺃﻛﱪ ﺃﹸﻋﻄﻴ ُ‬ ‫ﺍﻟﺒﺸﺮﻯ‪ ...) :‬ﺍ ُ‬ ‫ﻗﻴﺼﺮ‪ .(..‬ﻧﻌﻢ ﻓﻼ ﻳﺼ ّﺢ ﺃ ﹾﻥ ﻧﺘﺮﻙ ﺍﻟﻨﺎﺱ ﻳﺼﻠﻮﻥ ﻣﺮﺣﻠﺔ ﺍﻟﻴﺄﺱ ﺍﳌﻄﺒﻖ‪ ) :‬ﺇﻧ ُﻪ ﻻ‬ ‫ﺲ ﻣﻦ َﺭﻭ ِ‬ ‫ﻳﻴﺌ ُ‬ ‫ﺡ ﺍﷲ ﺇﻻ ﺍﻟﻘﻮ ُﻡ ﺍﻟﻜﺎﻓﺮﻭﻥ(‪ ٨‬ﳚﺐ ﺃ ﹾﻥ ﻳﺘﺤﺮﻙ ﺍﻹﻧﺴﺎﻥ ﺑﲔ ﻗﻄﱯ‬ ‫ﷲ ﺇﻻ‬ ‫ﺍﳋﻮﻑ ﻭﺍﻟﺮﺟﺎﺀ‪ ،‬ﻓﻼ ﻫﻮ ﺑﺎﻟﻴﺎﺋﺲ‪ ،‬ﻭﻻ ﻫﻮ ﺑﺎﻵﻣﻦ‪) :‬ﻓﻼ ﻳﺄﻣ ُﻦ ﻣﻜـ َﺮ ﺍ ِ‬ ‫ﺍﻟﻘﻮ ُﻡ ﺍﳋﺎﺳﺮﻭ ﹶﻥ(‪ .٩‬ﻭﺍﻟﻴﻮﻡ ﻭﻗﺪ ﺃﺣﺎﻁ ﺍﻟﻴﺄﺱ ﺑﺎﻟﻨﺎﺱ ﺣـﱴ ﺭﻓﻌـﻮﺍ ﺷـﻌﺎﺭﹰﺍ‬ ‫ﻳﻘﻮﻟﻮﻥ‪ :‬ﻣﺎ ﺍﻟﺒﺪﻳﻞ ؟ ﰲ ﻣﺜﻞ ﻫﺬﺍ ﺍﻟﻮﺍﻗﻊ ﻗﺪ ﳚﺪﺭ ﺑﻨﺎ ﺃﻥ ﻧﻔﺘﺢ ﻟﻠﻨﺎﺱ ﺃﺑـﻮﺍﺏ‬ ‫ﺍﻷﻣﻞ‪ ،‬ﻣﻊ ﺍﻟﺘﻨﺒﻪ ﺍﻟﺘﺎﻡ‪ ،‬ﺣﱴ ﻻ ﻧﱰﻟﻖ ﻓﻨﺼﺒﺢ ﻣﻦ ﺃﻫﻞ ﺍﻟﺸـﻌﻮﺫﺓ ﻭﺍﻟﻜﻬﺎﻧـﺔ؛‬ ‫ﺏ ﻋﻠﻰ ﻛ ِﻞ ﺿﺮﻭﺏ ﺍﻟﻌﺮﺍﻓﺔ ﻭﺍﻟﻜﻬﺎﻧﺔ ﻭﺍﻟﺸﻌﻮﺫﺓ‪.‬‬ ‫ﻓﺎﻹﺳﻼﻡ ﺣﺮ ٌ‬ ‫ﺴﺮ ﺍﻟﻨﺒﻮﺀﺓ ﺍﻟﻘﺮﺁﻧﻴﺔ ﺍﻟﻮﺍﺭﺩﺓ ﰲ ﺳـﻮﺭﺓ‬ ‫ﰲ ﻫﺬﺍ ﺍﻟﻜﺘﺎﺏ ﳓﺎﻭﻝ ﺃﻥ ﻧُﻔ ﱢ‬ ‫ﺍﻹﺳﺮﺍﺀ ﺗﻔﺴﲑﹰﺍ ﻳﻨﺴﺠﻢ ﻣﻊ ﻇﺎﻫﺮ ﺍﻟﻨﺺ ﺍﻟﻘﺮﺁﱐ‪ ،‬ﻭﻳﺘﻮﺍﻓﻖ ﻣﻊ ﺍﻟﻮﺍﻗﻊ ﺍﻟﺘﺎﺭﳜﻲ‪.‬‬ ‫ﺱ ﻣﻦ ﻋﺎﱂ ﺍﻷﻋـﺪﺍﺩ ﻳﺼـﺢ ﺃﻥ‬ ‫ﰒ ﻧُﺸ ِﻔﻊ ﺫﻟﻚ ﲟﺴﻠﻚٍ ﺟﺪﻳﺪ ﻳﻘﻮﻡ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺃﺳﺎ ٍ‬ ‫ﻧُﺴ ﱢﻤﻴﻪ ﺍﻟﺘﺄﻭﻳﻞ ﺍﻟ ّﺮﻳﺎﺿ ّﻲ‪ ،‬ﺃﻭ ﺍﻟﺘﺄﻭﻳﻞ ﺍﻟﻌﺪﺩﻱ‪ .‬ﻭﻳﻐﻠﺐ ﻋﻠﻰ ﻇﻨﻨﺎ ﺃ ﹼﻥ ﺍﻷﻋـﺪﺍﺩ‬ ‫ﺶ ﺍﻟﻘﺎﺭﺉ ﻛﻤﺎ ﺳﺒﻖ ﻭﺃﺩﻫﺸﺘﻨﺎ ﻭﺩﻓﻌﺘﻨﺎ ﰲ ﻃﺮﻳﻖ ﱂ ﻧﻜـﻦ ﻧﺘﻮﹼﻗﻌـﻪ‪.‬‬ ‫ﺳﺘُﺪﻫ ُ‬ ‫ﳉﻤﱠﻞ‪ ،‬ﻭﺍﻟﻌﺪﺩ ‪ ،١٩‬ﳘـﺎ ﺍﻷﺳـﺎﺱ ﰲ ﻫـﺬﺍ‬ ‫ﻭﺳﻴﺠﺪ ﺍﻟﻘﺎﺭِﺉ ﺃ ﹼﻥ ﺣﺴﺎﺏ ﺍ ﹸ‬ ‫ﳉﻤﱠﻞ ﻓﺴﻨﻔﺮﺩ ﻟﻪ ﺑﺎﺑﹰﺎ ﺧﺎﺻّﺎﹰ‪ ،‬ﻭﺃﻣّﺎ ﺍﻟﻌﺪﺩ ‪ ١٩‬ﻓﻨﻘﻮﻝ‪:‬‬ ‫ﺍﻟﺘﺄﻭﻳﻞ‪ .‬ﺃﻣّﺎ ﺍ ﹸ‬ ‫ﺼﺔ ﻃﻮﻳﻠﺔ‪ ،‬ﻭﺍﳊﺪﻳﺚ ﰲ ﻣﺴﺄﻟﺔ ﺍﻟﻌﺪﺩ ‪ ١٩‬ﻭﻣﺎ ﺛﺎﺭ ﺣﻮﻟﻪ ﻣﻦ ﺟﺪﻝ‬ ‫ﺍﻟﻘ ّ‬ ‫ﺕ ﳛﺘﺎﺝ ﺇﱃ ﺗﻔﺼﻴﻞ ﻭﺇﺳﻬﺎﺏ‪ ،‬ﻭﻫﺬﺍ ﻣﺎ ﻓﻌﻠﻨﺎﻩ ﰲ ﻛﺘـﺎﺏ‪) :‬ﻋﺠﻴﺒـﺔ‬ ‫ﻭﺷﺒﻬﺎ ٍ‬ ‫‪ ٨‬ﺳﻮﺭﺓ ﻳﻮﺳﻒ‪ ،‬ﺍﻵﻳﺔ ‪٨٧‬‬ ‫‪ ٩‬ﺳﻮﺭﺓ ﺍﻷﻋﺮﺍﻑ‪ ،‬ﺍﻵﻳﺔ ‪٩٩‬‬ ‫‪١٣‬‬ ‫ﺗﺴﻌﺔ ﻋﺸﺮ ﺑﲔ ﲣﹼﻠﻒ ﺍﳌﺴﻠﻤﲔ ﻭﺿﻼﻻﺕ ﺍﳌﺪﻋﲔ(‪ ١٠،‬ﰒ ﻭﻓﻘﻨﺎ ﺍﷲ ﺗﻌـﺎﱃ‪،‬‬ ‫ﻭﳓﻦ ﰲ ﻣﺮﺝ ﺍﻟﺰﻫﻮﺭ‪ ،‬ﺇﱃ ﺇﺧﺮﺍﺟﻪ ﰲ ﻃﺒﻌﺔ ﻣﺰﻳﺪﺓ ﻭﻣﻨﻘﹼﺤﺔ‪ ،‬ﺑﻌﻨﻮﺍﻥ‪) :‬ﺇﻋﺠﺎﺯ‬ ‫ﺍﻟﺮﻗﻢ ‪ ١٩‬ﰲ ﺍﻟﻘﺮﺁﻥ ﺍﻟﻜﺮﱘ‪ ،‬ﻣﻘﺪﻣﺎﺕ ﺗﻨﺘﻈﺮ ﺍﻟﻨﺘﺎﺋﺞ(‪ ١١.‬ﺑﻌﺪ ﺍﳊﺪﻳﺚ ﻋـﻦ‬ ‫ﺣﻘﻴﻘﺔ ﻣﺪّﻋﻲ ﺍﻟﻨﺒﻮّﺓ‪ ،‬ﺍﳌﺴﻤّﻰ ﺭﺷﺎﺩ ﺧﻠﻴﻔﺔ‪ ،‬ﻭﺑﻌﺪ ﻭﺿﻊ ﺍﻟﻴﺪ ﻋﻠـﻰ ﺗﺰﻭﻳـﺮﻩ‬ ‫ﻭﺗﻠﻔﻴﻘﺎﺗﻪ‪ ،‬ﻧﻘﻮﻡ ﺑﺘﻌﺮﻳﻒ ﺍﻟﻘﺎﺭﺉ ﲟﺴﺄﻟﺔ ﺍﻟﻌﺪﺩ ‪ ١٩‬ﰲ ﺍﻟﻘﺮﺁﻥ ﺍﻟﻜﺮﱘ‪ ،‬ﻭﺩﻻﻻﺗﻪ‬ ‫ﺍﻹﻋﺠﺎﺯﻳّﺔ‪ ،‬ﻭﳓﺮﺭﻩ ﳑﺎ ﻋﻠﻖ ﺑﻪ ﻣﻦ ﺷﺒﻬﺎﺕ‪.‬‬ ‫ﺑﻨﺎﺀ ﺭﻳﺎﺿﻲّ ﻣﺬﻫﻞ‪ ،‬ﻭﺇﻋﺠﺎ ٌﺯ ﺳﻴﻜﻮﻥ ﻟﻪ ﻣﺎ ﺑﻌﺪﻩُ‪ ،‬ﻭﻟﻦ ﻳﺴﺘﻄﻴﻊ ﺃﺣﺪ‬ ‫ﷲ‬ ‫ﺐﺍُ‬ ‫ﺃﻥ َﻳﺤُﻮﻝ ﺑﻴﻨﻨﺎ ﻭﺑﲔ ﻣﺎ ﻳﺮﻳ ُﺪ ﺍﷲ ﺃﻥ ﳚﹼﻠﻴﻪ ﻣﻦ ﺃﺳﺮﺍﺭ ﻛﺘﺎﺑﻪ ﺍﻟﻌﺰﻳﺰ‪) :‬ﻛﺘ َ‬ ‫ﱭ ﺃﻧﺎ ﻭﺭﺳﻠﻲ(‪ .‬ﻟﻘﺪ ﺑﺬﻟﻨﺎ ﻣﺎ ﰲ ﻭﺳﻌﻨﺎ ﻟﻨﻀ َﻊ ﻫﺬﻩ ﺍﻷﻣﺎﻧـﺔ ﰲ ﺃﻋﻨـﺎﻕ‬ ‫ﻷﻏﻠ ﱠ‬ ‫ﻋﻠﻤﺎﺀ ﺍﻷﻣﺔ‪ ،‬ﻟﻌﻠﻤﻨﺎ ﺃ ﹼﻥ ﻫﺬﺍ ﺍﻷﻣﺮ ﻻ ﻳﻄﻴﻘ ُﻪ ﻓﺮﺩٌ‪ ،‬ﻭﻻ ﺣﱴ ﲨﺎﻋﺔ‪ .‬ﻭﺃﻣﻠﻨﺎ ﻛﺒﲑ‬ ‫ﺃﻥ ﻳﻨﻬﺾ ﺃﻫﻞ ﺍﻟﻌﺰﻡ ﻬﺑﺬﻩ ﺍﳌﺴﺆﻭﻟﻴﺔ‪ ،‬ﻟﺘﺘﻢ ﺍﻟﻨﻌﻤﺔ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺍﳌﺴﻠﻤﲔ‪ ،‬ﻭﻋﻠﻰ ﺍﻟﻨﺎﺱ‬ ‫ﺃﲨﻌﲔ‪.‬‬ ‫ﻣﻦ ﻳﻘﺮﺃ ﺍﻟﻜﺘﺐ ﺍﳋﺎﺻﺔ ﺑﺎﻟﻌﺪﺩ ‪ ،١٩‬ﻭﺍﻟﺼﺎﺩﺭﺓ ﻋﻦ ﻣﺮﻛـﺰ ﻧـﻮﻥ‬ ‫ﻟﻠﺪﺭﺍﺳﺎﺕ ﺍﻟﻘﺮﺁﻧﻴّﺔ‪ ١٢،‬ﻳﺪﺭﻙ ﺑﺸﻜﻞ ﺟﻠﻲ ﻣﻌﲎ ﺃﻥ ﺗﻘﻮﻡ ﺍﳌﻌﺎﺩﻟﺔ ﺍﻟﺘﺎﺭﳜﻴـﺔ ﰲ‬ ‫ﻫﺬﺍ ﺍﻟﻜﺘﺎﺏ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺍﻟﻌﺪﺩ ‪ .١٩‬ﻭﻧﻘﻮﻝ ﻟﻠﺬﻱ ﱂ ﻳﻘﺮﺃ ﺍﻟﻜﺘﺎﺏ‪ :‬ﺇﻥ ﻫﻨﺎﻙ ﺑﻨـﺎﺀً‬ ‫ﺱ ﻣـﻦ‬ ‫ﺭﻳﺎﺿﻴﹰﺎ ﻣﺪﻫﺸﹰﺎ ﻳﺘﻌﻠﻖ ﺑﺎﻟﻜﻠﻤﺎﺕ ﻭﺍﻷﺣﺮﻑ ﺍﻟﻘﺮﺁﻧﻴﺔ‪ ،‬ﻭﻳﻘﻮﻡ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺃﺳﺎ ٍ‬ ‫‪١٠‬‬ ‫‪١١‬‬ ‫‪١٢‬‬ ‫ﻁ‪١٩٩١ ،١‬ﻡ‪ ،‬ﻣﺆﺳﺴﺔ ﺍﻻﻋﺘﺼﺎﻡ‪ ،‬ﺍﳋﻠﻴﻞ‪.‬‬ ‫ﻁ‪٢،١٩٩٤‬ﻡ‪ ،‬ﺍﳌﺆﺳﺴﺔ ﺍﻹﺳﻼﻣﻴﺔ‪ ،‬ﺑﲑﻭﺕ‪.‬‬ ‫ﻟﻠﻤﺆﻟﻒ‪ ):‬ﺇﻋﺠﺎﺯ ﺍﻟﻌﺪﺩ ‪ ١٩‬ﰲ ﺍﻟﻘﺮﺁﻥ ﺍﻟﻜﺮﱘ ﻣﻘﺪّﻣﺎﺕ ﺗﻨﺘﻈﺮ ﺍﻟﻨﺘﺎﺋﺞ(‪ ) ،‬ﺇﺭﻫﺎﺻﺎﺕ ﺍﻹﻋﺠﺎﺯ ﺍﻟﻌﺪﺩﻱ ﰲ ﺍﻟﻘﺮﺁﻥ‬ ‫ﺍﻟﻜﺮﱘ (‪) ،‬ﻭﻟﺘﻌﻠﻤﻮﺍ ﻋﺪﺩ ﺍﻟﺴﻨﲔ ﻭﺍﳊﺴﺎﺏ(‪ ) ،‬ﺍﳌﻴﺰﺍﻥ ‪ ٤٥٦‬ﲝﻮﺙ ﰲ ﺍﻟﻌﺪﺩ ﺍﻟﻘﺮﺁﱐ(‪ ) ،‬ﺍﻟﻜﻬﻒ ﻭﺻﺨﺮﺓ ﺑﻴﺖ ﺍﳌﻘﺪﺱ(‬ ‫– ﻣﺮﻛﺰ ﻧﻮﻥ ﻟﻠﺪﺭﺍﺳﺎﺕ ﺍﻟﻘﺮﺁﻧﻴّﺔ – ﺍﻟﺒﲑﺓ – ﺭﺍﻡ ﺍﷲ – ﻓﻠﺴﻄﲔ‪.‬‬ ‫‪١٤‬‬ ‫ﺍﻟﻌﺪﺩ ‪ .١٩‬ﻭﺗﺸﲑ ﺍﻷﲝﺎﺙ ﺇﱃ ﻋﻼﻗﺔ ﻫﺬﺍ ﺍﻟﻌﺪﺩ ﺑﻌﺎﱂ ﺍﻟﻔﻠﻚ‪ ،‬ﻭﻳﺪﻫﺸﻚ ﺃﻥ‬ ‫ﺗﻜﺘﺸﻒ ﺃ ﹼﻥ ﻟﻪ ﺃﻳﻀﹰﺎ ﻋﻼﻗﺔ ﺑﺎﻟﺘﺎﺭﻳﺦ‪ ،‬ﻭﻋﻠﻰ ﻭﺟﻪ ﺍﳋﺼﻮﺹ ﺗـﺎﺭﻳﺦ ﺍﻷﺭﺽ‬ ‫ﺍﳌﻘﺪّﺳﺔ‪.‬‬ ‫ﻳﺘﺄﻟﻒ ﻫﺬﺍ ﺍﻟﻜﺘﺎﺏ ﻣﻦ ﻓﺼﻠﲔ‪ :‬ﺍﻟﻔﺼﻞ ﺍﻷﻭﻝ ﻫﻮ ﺗﻔﺴـﲑ ﻟﻠﻨﺒـﻮﺀﺓ‬ ‫ﺍﻟﻘﺮﺁﻧﻴﺔ ﺍﻟﻮﺍﺭﺩﺓ ﰲ ﺳﻮﺭﺓ ﺍﻹﺳﺮﺍﺀ‪ ،‬ﻭﺍﳌﺘﻌﻠﻘﺔ ﺑﺰﻭﺍﻝ ﺩﻭﻟﺔ ﺇﺳﺮﺍﺋﻴﻞ ﻣﻦ ﺍﻷﺭﺽ‬ ‫ﺍﳌﻘﺪّﺳﺔ‪ .‬ﻭﺍﻟﻔﺼﻞ ﺍﻟﺜﺎﱐ ﻫﻮ ﺗﺄﻭﻳ ﹲﻞ ﺭﻳﺎﺿﻲﱞ ﳍﺬﻩ ﺍﻟﻨﺒﻮﺀﺓ ﻳﺄﰐ ﻣُﺼﺪّﻗﹰﺎ ﻟﻠﺘﻔﺴـﲑ‬ ‫ﺍﻟﻮﺍﺭﺩ ﰲ ﺍﻟﻔﺼﻞ ﺍﻷﻭﻝ‪ ،‬ﻭﻳﻀﻔﻲ ﻋﻠﻴﻪ ﺻِﺪﻗﻴﱠﺔ ﺭﻳﺎﺿﻴّﺔ‪ .‬ﻭﻫﻮ ﻣﺴﻠﻚٌ ﺟﺪﻳـﺪ‬ ‫ﻧﺄﻣﻞ ﺃﻥ ﻳﻜﻮﻥ ﻣﻔﺘﺎﺣﹰﺎ ﻟﻜﺜ ٍﲑ ﻣﻦ ﺃﺑﻮﺍﺏ ﺍﳋﲑ‪.‬‬ ‫ﺏ ﺍﺭﲪﻬﻤﺎ ﻛﻤﺎ ﺭﺑﻴﺎﱐ ﺻﻐﲑﹰﺍ‪.‬‬ ‫ﻱ‪ ،‬ﺭ ﱢ‬ ‫ﺏ ﺍﻏﻔﺮ ﱄ‪ ،‬ﻭﻟﻮﺍﻟﺪ ﱠ‬ ‫ﺭ ﱢ‬ ‫ﻭﺍﷲ ﺍﳌﻮﹼﻓﻖ‬ ‫ﺴﺎﻡ َﺟ ّﺮﺍﺭ‬ ‫ﺑّ‬ ‫‪١٩٩٣ / ٨ /٥‬ﻡ‬ ‫ﻣﺮﺝ ﺍﻟﺰﻫﻮﺭ ‪ -‬ﺍﳉﻨﻮﺏ ﺍﻟﻠﺒﻨﺎﱐ‬ ‫‪١٥‬‬ ‫اﻟﻔﺼﻞ اﻷول‬ ‫اﻟﺘﻔﺴﻴﺮ‬ ‫‪١٦‬‬ ‫ﱂ ﻳﻜﻦ ﰲ ﺍﻟﻘﺪْﺱ ﻳﻬﻮﺩ‬ ‫ﻗﺒﻞ ﺍﳍﺠﺮﺓ ﺑﺴﻨﺔ‪ ،‬ﻛﺎﻧﺖ ﺣﺎﺩﺛﺔ ﺍﻹﺳﺮﺍﺀ ﻭﺍﳌﻌﺮﺍﺝ‪ ،‬ﻓﻜﺎﻧﺖ ﺯﻳـﺎﺭﺓ‬ ‫ﺍﻟﺮﺳﻮﻝ‪ ،‬ﺻﻠﻰ ﺍﷲ ﻋﻠﻴﻪ ﻭﺳﻠﻢ‪ ،‬ﻟﻸﺭﺽ ﺍﳌﺒﺎﺭﻛﺔ‪ ،‬ﻟﻠﻤﺴﺠﺪ ﺍﻷﻗﺼﻰ ﺍﻟـﺬﻱ‬ ‫ﷲ ﺣﻮﻟﻪ‪ .‬ﻭﺍﻧﻄﻠﻖ ﻋﻠﻴﻪ ﺍﻟﺴﻼﻡ ﻣﻦ )ﻟﻠﺬﻱ ﺑﺒﻜﺔ ﻣﺒﺎﺭﻛﺎ(‪ ،‬ﺇﱃ ﺍﳌﺴﺠﺪ‬ ‫ﺑﺎﺭﻙ ﺍ ُ‬ ‫)ﺍﻟﺬﻱ ﺑﺎﺭﻛﻨﺎ ﺣﻮﻟﻪ(‪ .‬ﻣﻦ ﺃﻭﻝ ﺑﻴﺖ ﻭﺿﻊ ﻟﻠﻨﺎﺱ‪ ،‬ﺇﱃ ﺛﺎﱐ ﺑﻴﺖ ﻭﺿﻊ ﻟﻠﻨﺎﺱ‪.‬‬ ‫ﰲ ﺫﻟﻚ ﺍﻟﻮﻗﺖ ﻛﺎﻧﺖ ﺍﻟﻘﺪﺱ ﳏﺘﻠﺔ ﻣﻦ ﻗﺒﻞ ﺍﻟﺮﻭﻣﺎﻥ‪ ،‬ﻭﻛﺎﻥ ﺍﳌﺴﺠﺪ ﺍﻷﻗﺼﻰ‬ ‫ﳎﺮﺩ ﺁﺛﺎﺭ ﻗﺪﳝﺔ ﻭﻣﻬﺠﻮﺭﺓ‪ .‬ﻭﻋﻠﻰ ﺍﻟﺮﻏﻢ ﻣﻦ ﺫﻟﻚ ﻓﻘﺪ ﺑﻘﻴﺖ ﻟﻪ ﻣﺴﺠﺪﻳﺘﻪ ﺍﻟﱵ‬ ‫ﷲ ﺍﻷﺭﺽ ﻭﻣﻦ ﻋﻠﻴﻬﺎ‪.‬‬ ‫ﺙﺍ ُ‬ ‫ﺳﺘﺒﻘﻰ ﺇﱃ ﺃﻥ ﻳﺮ ﹶ‬ ‫ﱂ ﻳﻜﻦ ﻟﻠﻴﻬﻮﺩ ﻭﺟﻮﺩ ﻳُﺬﻛﺮ ﰲ ﻣﻜﺔ ﺍﳌﻜﺮﻣﺔ‪ ،‬ﻭﱂ ﻳﻜﻦ ﳍـﻢ ﺃﻳﻀـﹰﺎ‬ ‫ﻭﺟﻮﺩ ﰲ ﺍﻟﻘﺪﺱ ﻣﻨﺬ ﺍﻟﻌﺎﻡ ‪١٣٥‬ﻡ‪ ،‬ﻋﻨﺪﻣﺎ ﺩ ّﻣﺮ )ﻫﺪﺭﻳﺎﻥ( ﺍﻟﺮﻭﻣﺎﱐ ﺍﳍﻴﻜـﻞ‬ ‫ﺍﻟﺜﺎﱐ‪ ،‬ﻭﺣﺮﺙ ﺃﺭﺿﻪ ﺑﺎﶈﺮﺍﺙ‪ ،‬ﻭﺷﺮﺩ ﺍﻟﻴﻬﻮﺩ ﻭﺷﺘﺘﻬﻢ ﰲ ﺃﺭﺟﺎﺀ ﺍﻹﻣﱪﺍﻃﻮﺭﻳﺔ‬ ‫ﻱ‬ ‫ﺍﻟﺮﻭﻣﺎﻧﻴﺔ‪ ،‬ﻭﺣ ّﺮﻡ ﻋﻠﻴﻬﻢ ﺍﻟﻌﻮﺩﺓ ﺇﱃ ﺍﻟﻘﺪﺱ ﻭﺍﻟﺴﻜﲎ ﻓﻴﻬﺎ‪ .‬ﻭﻋﻨـﺪﻣﺎ ﺃﹸﺳـﺮ َ‬ ‫ﺑﺎﻟﺮﺳﻮﻝ ﺻﻠﻰ ﺍﷲ ﻋﻠﻴﻪ ﻭﺳﻠﻢ ﻛﺎﻥ ﻗﺪ ﻣﻀﻰ ﻋﻠﻰ ﻫﺬﺍ ﺍﻟﺘﺎﺭﻳﺦ ﻣﺎ ﻳﻘـﺎﺭﺏ‬ ‫ﺍﻟـ ‪ ٥٠٠‬ﻋﺎﻡ‪ ،‬ﻭﻫﻲ ﻣُﺪﺓ ﻛﺎﻓﻴﺔ ﻛﻲ ﻳﻨﺴﻰ ﺍﻟﻨﺎﺱ ﺃﻧﻪ ﻛﺎﻥ ﻫﻨـﺎﻙ ﻳﻬـﻮﺩ‬ ‫‪١٧‬‬ ‫ﺳﻜﻨﻮﺍ ﺍﻷﺭﺽ ﺍﳌﻘﺪّﺳﺔ‪.‬‬ ‫ﺑﻌﺪ ﺣﺎﺩﺛﺔ ﺍﻹﺳﺮﺍﺀ ﻧﺰﻟﺖ ﻓﻮﺍﺗﺢ ﺳﻮﺭﺓ ﺍﻹﺳﺮﺍﺀ‪،‬ﻭﺍﻟﱵ ﺗﺴﻤّﻰ ﺃﻳﻀـﹰﺎ‬ ‫ﺳﻮﺭﺓ ﺑﲏ ﺇﺳﺮﺍﺋﻴﻞ‪ .‬ﻭﺍﻟﻼﻓﺖ ﻟﻠﻨﻈﺮ ﺃﻥ ﺫﻛﺮ ﺍﳊﺎﺩﺛﺔ ﺟﺎﺀ ﰲ ﺁﻳـﺔ ﻭﺍﺣـﺪﺓ‪:‬‬ ‫ﺠ ِﺪ ﺍﳊﺮﺍ ِﻡ ﺇﱃ ﺍﳌﺴﺠ ِﺪ ﺍ َﻷﻗﹾﺼـﺎ‬ ‫ﺴِ‬ ‫ﻼ ِﻣ َﻦ ﺍ ﹶﳌ ْ‬ ‫)ﺳُﺒﺤﺎ ﹶﻥ ﺍﻟﺬﻱ ﺃﺳﺮﻯ ﺑﻌﺒﺪ ِﻩ ﻟﻴ ﹰ‬ ‫ﺍﻟﺬﻱ ﺑﺎﺭﻛﻨﺎ ﺣﻮﻟ ُﻪ ﻟﻨُ ِﺮَﻳﻪُ ِﻣ ْﻦ ﺁﻳﺎﺗِﻨﺎ ﺇّﻧ ُﻪ ﻫُ َﻮ ﺍﻟﺴﻤﻴ ُﻊ ﺍﻟﺒَﺼﲑ(‪ .‬ﰒ ﺟﺎﺀ ﺍﳊﺪﻳﺚ‬ ‫ﻋﻦ ﻣﻮﺳﻰ ﻋﻠﻴﻪ ﺍﻟﺴّﻼﻡ‪ ،‬ﻭﻧﺰﻭﻝ ﺍﻟﺘﻮﺭﺍﺓ‪ ،‬ﻭﺍﻹﻓﺴﺎﺩ ﺍﻹﺳﺮﺍﺋﻴﻠﻲ‪) :‬ﻭﺁﺗﻴﻨﺎ ﻣﻮﺳﻰ‬ ‫ﻯ ﻟﺒﲏ ﺇﺳﺮﺍﺋﻴ ﹶﻞ ﺃﻻ ﺗﺘﺨِﺬﻭﺍ ﻣِـ ْﻦ ﺩﻭﱐ ﻭَﻛـﻴﻼﹰ‪....‬‬ ‫ﺏ ﻭﺟﻌﻠﻨﺎ ُﻩ ُﻫﺪ ً‬ ‫ﺍﻟﻜﺘﺎ َ‬ ‫ﺽ ﻣَﺮَﺗ ْﻴ ِﻦ‪ ...‬ﻓﹶﺈﺫﺍ ﺟﺎ َﺀ‬ ‫ﺴﺪُﻥ ﰲ ﺍﻷﺭ ِ‬ ‫ﺏ ﻟﺘُ ﹾﻔ ِ‬ ‫ﻀ ْﻴﻨَﺎ ﺇﱃ ﺑﲏ ﺇﺳﺮﺍﺋﻴ ﹶﻞ ﰲ ﺍﻟﻜﺘﺎ ِ‬ ‫ﻭﻗ َ‬ ‫ﺴﻼﻡ‪،‬‬ ‫ﻭ ْﻋ ُﺪ ﺃﹸﻭﻻﻫُﻤﺎ‪ ...‬ﹶﻓﺈِﺫﺍ ﺟﺎ َﺀ َﻭ ْﻋﺪُ ﺍﻵ ِﺧ َﺮ ِﺓ‪ ( ...‬ﻓﻤﺎ ﻋﻼﻗﺔ ﻣﻮﺳﻰ ﻋﻠﻴﻪ ﺍﻟ ّ‬ ‫ﻭﻣﺎ ﻋﻼﻗﺔ ﺑﲏ ﺇﺳﺮﺍﺋﻴﻞ ﺑﺘﻠﻚ ﺍﳊﺎﺩﺛﺔ ﻭﺗﻠﻚ ﺍﻟﺰﻳﺎﺭﺓ‪ ،‬ﻭﻣﺎ ﻋﻼﻗﺔ ﺍﻟﻨﺒﻮﺀﺓ ﺍﻟـﱵ‬ ‫ﺟﺎﺀﺕ ﰲ ﺍﻟﺘﻮﺭﺍﺓ ﻗﺒﻞ ﺍﻹﺳﺮﺍﺀ ﲟﺎ ﻳﻘﺎﺭﺏ ﺍﻟـ ‪ ١٨٠٠‬ﺳﻨﺔ ﻬﺑﺬﻩ ﺍﳊﺎﺩﺛﺔ ؟!‬ ‫ﺴﺮﻳﻦ ﺍﻟﻘﺪﻣﺎﺀ ﺇﻣﻜﺎﻧﻴـﺔ ﺃﻥ ﻳﻌـﻮﺩ‬ ‫ﻫﻞ ﻳﺘﻮﻗﻊ ﺃﺣﺪ ﺃ ﹾﻥ ﳜﻄﺮ ﺑﺒﺎﻝ ﺍﳌﻔ ﱢ‬ ‫ﻟﻠﻴﻬﻮﺩ ﺩﻭﻟﺔ ﰲ ﺍﻷﺭﺽ ﺍﳌﻘﺪّﺳﺔ ؟! ﻧﻘﻮﻝ‪ :‬ﺍﻟﺪﻭﻟﺔ ﺍﻷﻣﻮﻳﺔ‪ ،‬ﻭﺍﻟﺪﻭﻟﺔ ﺍﻟﻌﺒﺎﺳـﻴﺔ‪،‬‬ ‫ﻱ ﻣﻔﺴﺮ‬ ‫ﻭﺍﻟﺪﻭﻟﺔ ﺍﻟﻌﺜﻤﺎﻧﻴﺔ‪ ،‬ﻛﻞ ﻭﺍﺣﺪﺓ ﻣﻨﻬﺎ ﻛﺎﻧﺖ ﺃﻋﻈﻢ ﺩﻭﻟﺔ ﰲ ﻋﺼﺮﻫﺎ‪ .‬ﻓﺄ ﱡ‬ ‫ﻫﻮ ﻫﺬﺍ ﺍﻟﺬﻱ ﺳﻴﺨﻄﺮ ﺑﺒﺎﻟﻪ ﺃ ﹼﻥ ﺍﳌ ّﺮﺓ ﺍﻟﺜﺎﻧﻴﺔ ﱂ ﺗﺄﺕ ﺑﻌﺪ‪ ،‬ﻭﺇﻥ ﺧﻄﺮ ﺫﻟﻚ ﺑﺒﺎﻟﻪ‬ ‫ﻂ ﻗﻠﻤﻪ ﻣﺜﻞ ﻫﺬﻩ ﺍﻟﻨﺒﻮﺀﺓ‪ ،‬ﺍﻟﱵ ﺗﺘﺤﺪﺙ ﻋﻦ ﺳﻘﻮﻁ‬ ‫ﻓﻬﻞ ﺳﺘﻘﺒﻞ ﻋﺎﻃﻔﺘﻪ ﺃﻥ ﳜ ﹼ‬ ‫ﺍﻟﻘﺪﺱ ﰲ ﺃﻳﺪﻱ ﺍﻟﻴﻬﻮﺩ ﺍﻟﻀﺎﺋﻌﲔ ﺍﳌﺸﺮﺩﻳﻦ ﺍﳌﺴﺘﻀﻌﻔﲔ ؟! ﻣﻦ ﻫﻨﺎ ﳒـﺪ ﺃ ﹼﻥ‬ ‫ﺍﳌﻔﺴﺮﻳﻦ ﺍﻟﻘﺪﻣﺎﺀ ﻗﺪ ﺫﻫﺒﻮﺍ ﺇﱃ ﺍﻟﻘﻮﻝ ﺑﺄ ﹼﻥ ﺍﻟﻨﺒﻮﺀﺓ ﺍﻟﺘﻮﺭﺍﺗّﻴﺔ ﻗﺪ ﲢﻘﻘﺖ ﺑﺸ ﹼﻘﻴْﻬﺎ‬ ‫ﻗﺒﻞ ﺍﻹﺳﻼﻡ ﺑﻘﺮﻭﻥ‪ .‬ﻭﳓﻦ ﺍﻟﻴﻮﻡ ﻧﻔﻬﻢ ﲤﺎﻣﹰﺎ ﺳﺒﺐ ﻫﺬﺍ ﺍﻟﺘﻮﺟﻪ ﰲ ﺍﻟﺘﻔﺴـﲑ‪،‬‬ ‫ﻟﻜﻨﻨﺎ ﺃﻳﻀﹰﺎ ﻧُﺪﺭﻙ ﺿﻌﻔﻪ ﻭﳎﺎﻓﺎﺗﻪ ﻟﻠﻮﺍﻗﻊ‪ ،‬ﻭﻣﻦ ﻫﻨﺎ ﳒﺪ ﺍﻟﻐﺎﻟﺒﻴﺔ ﻣﻦ ﺍﳌﻔﺴـﺮﻳﻦ‬ ‫‪١٨‬‬ ‫ﺍﳌﻌﺎﺻﺮﻳﻦ ﺗﺬﻫﺐ ﺇﱃ ﺍﻟﻘﻮﻝ ﺑﺄﻥ ﻭﻋﺪ ﺍﻹﻓﺴﺎﺩ ﺍﻟﺜﺎﱐ ﻗﺪ ﲢﻘﹼﻖ ﺑﻘﻴـﺎﻡ ﺩﻭﻟـﺔ‬ ‫ﺇﺳﺮﺍﺋﻴﻞ ﻋﺎﻡ ‪١٩٤٨‬ﻡ‪.‬‬ ‫ﺼﺎﺩﻗﺔ ﻻ‬ ‫ﺴﺮ ﺍﳊﻘﻴﻘﻲ ﻟﻠﻨﺒﻮﺀﺍﺕ ﺍﻟﺼﺎﺩﻗﺔ ﻫﻮ ﺍﻟﻮﺍﻗﻊ‪ ،‬ﻷﻥ ﺍﻟﻨﺒﻮﺀﺓ ﺍﻟ ّ‬ ‫ﺍﳌﻔ ﱢ‬ ‫ﺑﺪ ﺃﻥ ﺗﺘﺤﻘﻖ ﰲ ﺃﺭﺽ ﺍﻟﻮﺍﻗﻊ‪ .‬ﻭﻣﻦ ﻫﻨﺎ ﻻ ُﺑﺪّ ﻣﻦ ﺃﻥ ﻧﺴﺘﻌﲔ ﺑﺎﻟﺘﺎﺭﻳﺦ ﻗـﺪﺭ‬ ‫ﱐ‪ ،‬ﺣﱴ ﻻ ﻧﻠﺠـﺄ ﺇﱃ‬ ‫ﺍﻹﻣﻜﺎﻥ ﻟﻨﺼﻞ ﺇﱃ ﻓﻬﻤ ٍﻢ ﻳﻨﺴﺠﻢ ﻣﻊ ﻇﺎﻫﺮ ﺍﻟﻨﺺ ﺍﻟﻘﺮﺁ ﹼ‬ ‫ﺍﻟﺘﺄﻭﻳﻞ ﺍﻟﺬﻱ ﳉﺄ ﺇﻟﻴﻪ ﺍﻷﻗﺪﻣﻮﻥ ﻭﺑﻌﺾ ﺍﳌﻌﺎﺻﺮﻳﻦ‪ .‬ﻭﳓﻦ ﻫﻨﺎ ﻻ ﻧﻌﻄﻲ ﺍﻟﺘﺎﺭﻳﺦ‬ ‫ﺼ ْﺪﻗﻴﺔ ﺍﻟﺘﺎﻣﺔ‪ ،‬ﻓﻤﻌﻠﻮﻡ ﻟﺪﻳﻨﺎ ﺃ ﹼﻥ ﺍﻟﻈﻦّ ﻫﻮ ﺍﻟﻘﺎﻋﺪﺓ ﰲ ﻋﺎﱂ ﺍﻟﺘﺎﺭﻳﺦ‪ ،‬ﻟﻜﻨﻨﺎ ﰲ‬ ‫ﺍﻟ ﱢ‬ ‫ﺼﻮﺍﺏ‪ ،‬ﻓـﻨﺤﻦ‬ ‫ﺍﻟﻮﻗﺖ ﻧﻔﺴﻪ ﻻ ﳒ ُﺪ ﺍﻟﺒﺪﻳﻞ ﺍﻟﺬﻱ ﳚﻌﻞ ﺗﻔﺴﲑﻧﺎ ﺃﻗﺮﺏ ﺇﱃ ﺍﻟ ّ‬ ‫ﳓﺎﻭﻝ ﺑﻘﺪﺭ ﺍﻹﻣﻜﺎﻥ ﺃﻥ ﻧﻘﺘﺮﺏ ﻣﻦ ﺍﳊﻘﻴﻘﺔ‪.‬‬ ‫ﻗﻀﻰ ﺍﷲ ﰲ ﺍﻟﺘﻮﺭﺍﺓ ﺃ ﹼﻥ ﺑﲏ ﺇﺳﺮﺍﺋﻴﻞ ﺳـﻴﺪﺧﻠﻮﻥ ﺍﻷﺭﺽ ﺍﳌﻘﺪّﺳـﺔ‪،‬‬ ‫ﻭﻳﻘﻴﻤﻮﻥ ﻓﻴﻬﺎ ﳎﺘﻤﻌﹰﺎ )ﺩﻭﻟﺔ(‪ ،‬ﻭﻳُﻔﺴﺪﻭﻥ ﺇﻓﺴﺎﺩﹰﺍ ﻛﺒﲑﹰﺍ‪ ،‬ﺗﻜـﻮﻥ ﻋﻘﻮﺑﺘـﻪ ﺃﻥ‬ ‫ﻳﺒﻌﺚ ﺍﷲ ﻋﻠﻴﻬﻢ ﻋﺒﺎﺩﺍﹰ ﺃﻗﻮﻳﺎﺀ ﳚﺘﺎﺣﻮﻥ ﺩﻳﺎﺭَﻫﻢ‪ .‬ﻭﺑﻌﺪ ﺯﻣﻦ ﻳﺘﻜﺮﺭ ﺇﻓﺴﺎﺩ ﺑﲏ‬ ‫ﷲ ﺍﻟﻌﺒﺎﺩ ﻣ ّﺮﺓ ﺃﺧﺮﻯ‪ ،‬ﻓﻴﺪ ّﻣﺮﻭﻥ ﻭﻳﻬﻠﻜﻮﻥ‬ ‫ﺇﺳﺮﺍﺋﻴﻞ ﰲ ﺍﻷﺭﺽ ﺍﳌﻘﺪّﺳﺔ‪ ،‬ﻓﻴﺒﻌﺚ ﺍ ُ‬ ‫ﻛ ﹼﻞ ﻣﺎ ﻳﺴﻴﻄﺮﻭﻥ ﻋﻠﻴﻪ ﺇﻫﻼﻛﹰﺎ ﻭﺗﺪﻣﲑﹰﺍ‪.‬‬ ‫‪١٩‬‬ ‫ﻧﻈﺮﺓ ﺗﺎﺭﳜﻴّﺔ‬ ‫ﺑﻌﺪ ﻭﻓﺎﺓ ﻣﻮﺳﻰ ﻋﻠﻴﻪ ﺍﻟﺴﻼﻡ‪ ،‬ﺩﺧﻞ )ﻳﻮﺷﻊ ﺑﻦ ﻧﻮﻥ( ﺑﺒﲏ ﺇﺳـﺮﺍﺋﻴﻞ‬ ‫ﺽ‬ ‫ﷲ ﳍﻢ ﺃﻥ ﻳﺪﺧﻠﻮﻫﺎ‪) :‬ﻳﺎ ﹶﻗ ْﻮ ِﻡ ﺍﺩْﺧُﻠـﻮﺍ ﺍﻷﺭ َ‬ ‫ﺍﻷﺭﺽ ﺍﳌﻘ ّﺪﺳﺔ‪ ،‬ﺍﻟﱵ ﻛﺘﺐ ﺍ ُ‬ ‫ﺐﺍ ُ‬ ‫ﺍﳌﹸﻘ ّﺪ َﺳ ﹶﺔ ﺍﻟﱵ ﻛَﺘ َ‬ ‫ﷲ ﹶﻟ ﹸﻜ ْﻢ‪ ،١٣(...‬ﻭﺑﺬﻟﻚ ﲢﻘﻖ ﺍﻟﻮﻋـﺪ ﳍـﻢ ﺑﺎﻟـﺪﺧﻮﻝ‬ ‫ﻭﺑﺈﻗﺎﻣﺔ ﳎﺘﻤﻊ ﺇﺳﺮﺍﺋﻴﻠﻲ‪ .‬ﻭﺑﻌﺪ ﻣﺎ ﻳﻘﺎﺭﺏ ‪ ١٨٧‬ﺳﻨﺔ ﲤﻜﻦ ﺩﺍﻭﺩ ﻋﻠﻴﻪ ﺍﻟﺴﻼﻡ‬ ‫ﻣﻦ ﻓﺘﺢ ﺍﻟﻘﺪﺱ‪ ،‬ﻭﺇﻗﺎﻣﺔ ﳑﻠﻜﺔ‪ .‬ﻣﻦ ﻫﻨﺎ ﳒﺪ ﺃ ﹼﻥ )ﻛﺘﺎﺏ ﺍﳌﻠﻮﻙ ﺍﻷﻭﻝ( ﰲ ﺍﻟﻌﻬﺪ‬ ‫ﺍﻟﻘﺪﱘ‪ ،‬ﻳُﺴﺘﻬ ﹼﻞ ﺑﺎﳊﺪﻳﺚ ﻋﻦ ﺷﻴﺨﻮﺧﺔ ﺩﺍﻭﺩ ﻋﻠﻴﻪ ﺍﻟﺴﻼﻡ ﻭﻣﻮﺗﻪ‪ .‬ﻭﻣـﻊ ﺃ ﹼﻥ‬ ‫)ﺍﻟﻌﻬﺪ ﺍﻟﻘﺪﱘ( ﻗﺪ ﻧﺴﺐ ﺇﱃ ﺩﺍﻭﺩ‪ ،‬ﻋﻠﻴﻪ ﺍﻟﺴﻼﻡ‪ ،‬ﻣﺎ ﻻ ﻳﻠﻴﻖ ﲟﻘﺎﻣﻪ‪ ،‬ﺇﻻ ﺃﻧـﻪ‬ ‫ﺼﻼﺡ‪ ،‬ﻋﻠﻰ ﺧﻼﻑ ﺍﺑﻨﻪ ﻭﺧﻠﻴﻔﺘﻪ ﺳﻠﻴﻤﺎﻥ ﻋﻠﻴﻪ ﺍﻟﺴﻼﻡ‪ .‬ﺟـﺎﺀ ﰲ‬ ‫ﺣﻜﻢ ﻟﻪ ﺑﺎﻟ ّ‬ ‫ﺍﻹﺻﺤﺎﺡ ﺍﳊﺎﺩﻱ ﻋﺸﺮ‪ ،‬ﻣﻦ ﺳﻔﺮ ﺍﳌﻠﻮﻙ ﺍﻷﻭﻝ‪ ..." :‬ﻓﺎﺳـﺘﻄﻌ َﻦ ﰲ ﺯﻣـﻦ‬ ‫ﺷﻴﺨﻮﺧﺘﻪ ﺃﻥ ﻳﻐﻮﻳ َﻦ ﻗﻠﺒﻪ ﻭﺭﺍﺀ ﺁﳍﺔ ﺃﹸﺧﺮﻯ‪ ،‬ﻓﻠﻢ ﻳﻜﻦ ﻗﻠﺒﻪ ﻣﺴﺘﻘﻴﻤﹰﺎ ﻣﻊ ﺍﻟﺮﺏ‬ ‫ﺃﳍﻪ‪ ،‬ﻛﻘﻠﺐ ﺩﺍﻭﺩ ﺃﺑﻴﻪ‪ .‬ﻭﻣﺎ ﻟﺒﺚ ﺃﻥ ﻋﺒﺪ ﻋﺸﺘﺎﺭﻭﺕ‪ ...‬ﻭﺍﺭﺗﻜﺐ ﺍﻟﺸـ ّﺮ ﰲ‬ ‫ﻋﻴﲏ ﺍﻟﺮﺏ‪ ،‬ﻭﱂ ﻳﺘﺒﻊ ﺳﺒﻴﻞ ﺍﻟﺮﺏ ﺑﻜﻤﺎﻝ‪ ،‬ﻛﻤﺎ ﻓﻌﻞ ﺃﺑﻮﻩ ﺩﺍﻭﺩ"‪ .‬ﻧﻘﻮﻝ‪ :‬ﺇﻧﻨـﺎ‬ ‫‪ ١٣‬ﺳﻮﺭﺓ ﺍﳌﺎﺋﺪﺓ‪ ،‬ﺍﻵﻳﺔ‪٢١ :‬‬ ‫‪٢٠‬‬ ‫ﻧﺘﻔﻖ ﻣﻊ ﹶﻛَﺘﺒﺔ ﺍﻟﻌﻬﺪ ﺍﻟﻘﺪﱘ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺃ ﹼﻥ ﻟﺪﺍﻭﺩ ﻋﻠﻴﻪ ﺍﻟﺴﻼﻡ ﻭﻟﺪ ﺍﲰﻪ )ﺳـﻠﻴﻤﺎﻥ(‪،‬‬ ‫ﻭﺃّﻧﻪ ﻛﺎﻥ ﺣﻜﻴﻤﺎﹰ‪ ،‬ﻭﺃﹶﻧﻪ ﻣﻠﻚ ﺑﻌﺪ ﻭﻓﺎﺓ ﺃﺑﻴﻪ‪ .‬ﻭﻟﻜﻨﻨﺎ ﳔﺎﻟﻔﻬﻢ ﲤﺎﻣﺎ ﰲ ﺍﻟﻨﻈـﺮﺓ‬ ‫ﺇﻟﻴﻪ‪ ،‬ﻋﻠﻴﻪ ﺍﻟﺴﻼﻡ؛ ﻓﻬﻮ‪ ،‬ﻛﻤﺎ ﺟﺎﺀ ﰲ ﺍﻟﻘﺮﺁﻥ ﺍﻟﻜﺮﱘ‪َ ):‬ﻭ َﻭ َﻫﺒْﻨﺎ ِﻟﺪَﺍﻭ َﺩ ﺳُﻠﻴْﻤﺎ ﹶﻥ‬ ‫ِﻧ ْﻌ َﻢ ﺍﻟ َﻌ ْﺒﺪُ ﺇﻧ ُﻪ ﹶﺃ ّﻭﺍﺏ(‪ .١٤‬ﻣﻦ ﻫﻨﺎ ﻧﻌﺘﱪ ﺃﻥ ﺍﻹﻓﺴﺎﺩ ﺍﻹﺳﺮﺍﺋﻴﻠﻲ ﻗﺪ ﺑﺪﺃ ﺑﻌﺪ ﻭﻓﺎﺓ‬ ‫ﺳﻠﻴﻤﺎﻥ ﻋﻠﻴﻪ ﺍﻟﺴﻼﻡ؛ ﻋﻨﺪﻣﺎ ﺍﻧﻘﺴﻤﺖ ﺩﻭﻟﺔ ﺍﻟﻨﺒﻮﺓ ﺇﱃ ﺩﻭﻟـﺘﲔ ﻣﺘﻨـﺎﺯﻋﺘﲔ‪،‬‬ ‫ﻭﺍﻧﺘﺸﺮ ﺍﻟﻔﺴﺎﺩ‪ ،‬ﻭﺷﺎﻋﺖ ﺍﻟﺮﺫﻳﻠﺔ‪ .‬ﺟﺎﺀ ﰲ ﻣﻘﺪﻣﺔ )ﻛﺘﺎﺏ ﺍﳌﻠـﻮﻙ ﺍﻷﻭﻝ(‪:١٥‬‬ ‫"‪ ...‬ﻳﺒﲔ ﻛﺘﺎﺏ ﺍﳌﻠﻮﻙ ﺍﻷﻭﻝ‪ ،‬ﺑﺸﻜﻞ ﺧﺎﺹ‪ ،‬ﺗﺄﺛﲑ ﺍﳌﺴـﺎﻭﺉ ﺍﻻﺟﺘﻤﺎﻋﻴـﺔ‬ ‫ﺍﳌﹸﻔﺠِﻊ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺣﻴﺎﺓ ﺍﻷﻣﺔ ﺍﻟﺮﻭﺣﻴﺔ"‪.‬‬ ‫ﺗﻮﻓﹼﻲ ﺳﻠﻴﻤﺎﻥ ﻋﻠﻴﻪ ﺍﻟﺴﻼﻡ ﻋﺎﻡ )‪ ٩٣٥‬ﻕ‪.‬ﻡ(‪ ،١٦‬ﻓﺤﺼﻞ ﺃﻥ ﲤـ ّﺮﺩ‬ ‫ﻋﺸﺮﺓ ﺃﺳﺒﺄﻁ‪ ،‬ﻭﻧﺼﺒﻮﺍ )ﻳﺮﺑﻌﺎﻡ ﺑﻦ ﻧﺎﺑﻂ( ﻣﻠﻜﺎﹰ ﻋﻠـﻰ ﳑﻠﻜـﺔ ﺇﺳـﺮﺍﺋﻴﻞ ﰲ‬ ‫ﺍﻟﺸﻤﺎﻝ‪ .‬ﻭﱂ ﻳﺒﻖ ﲢﺖ ﺣﻜﻢ ﺭﺣﺒﻌﺎﻡ ﺑﻦ ﺳﻠﻴﻤﺎﻥ ﺳﻮﻯ ﺳـﺒﻂ )ﻳﻬـﻮﺫﺍ(‪.‬‬ ‫ﻭﻫﻜﺬﺍ ﻧﺸﺄﺕ ﳑﻠﻜﺔ )ﺇﺳﺮﺍﺋﻴﻞ( ﰲ ﺍﻟﺸﻤﺎﻝ‪ ،‬ﻭﳑﻠﻜﺔ )ﻳﻬـﻮﺫﺍ( ﰲ ﺍﳉﻨـﻮﺏ‪،‬‬ ‫ﻭﻋﺎﺻﻤﺘﻬﺎ ﺍﻟﻘﺪﺱ‪ .‬ﻭﻛﺎﻥ ﺍﻹﻓﺴﺎﺩ‪ ،‬ﻓﻜﺎﻥ ﺍﳉﻮﺱ ﻣﻦ ﻗﺒﻞ ﺍﻷﻋـﺪﺍﺀ‪ ،‬ﺍﻟـﺬﻳﻦ‬ ‫ﺍﺟﺘﺎﺣﻮﺍ ﺍﳌﻤﻠﻜﺘﲔ ﰲ ﻣﻮﺟﺎﺕ ﺑﺪﺃﻫﺎ ﺍﳌﺼﺮّﻳﻮﻥ‪ ،‬ﻭﺗﻮﱃ ﻛﱪﻫـﺎ ﺍﻷﺷـﻮﺭّﻳﻮﻥ‬ ‫ﻭﺍﻟﻜﻠﺪﺍﻧﻴﻮﻥ‪ ،‬ﺍﻟﻘﺎﺩﻣﻮﻥ ﻣﻦ ﺟﻬﺔ ﺍﻟﻔﺮﺍﺕ‪ .‬ﺟﺎﺀ ﰲ ﻣﻘﺪﻣﺔ )ﻛﺘـﺎﺏ ﺍﳌﻠـﻮﻙ‬ ‫ﺍﻟﺜﺎﱐ(‪" :‬ﻓﻔﻲ ﺳﻨﺔ ‪ ٧٢٢‬ﻕ‪.‬ﻡ ﻫﺎﺟﻢ ﺍﻷﺷﻮﺭّﻳﻮﻥ ﳑﻠﻜﺔ ﺇﺳﺮﺍﺋﻴﻞ ﰲ ﺍﻟﺸـﻤﺎﻝ‬ ‫ﻭﺩ ّﻣﺮﻭﻫﺎ‪ .‬ﻭﰲ ﺳﻨﺔ ‪ ٥٨٦‬ﻕ‪.‬ﻡ ﺯﺣﻒ ﺍﳉﻴﺶ ﺍﻟﺒﺎﺑﻠﻲ ﻋﻠﻰ ﳑﻠﻜﺔ ﻳﻬـﻮﺫﺍ ﰲ‬ ‫‪ ١٤‬ﺳﻮﺭﺓ ﺹ‪ ،‬ﺍﻵﻳﺔ‪٣٠ :‬‬ ‫‪ ١٥‬ﺍﻟﻜﺘﺎﺏ ﺍﳌﻘﺪﺱ ‪ -‬ﻛﺘﺎﺏ ﺍﳊﻴﺎﺓ ﺗﺮﲨﺔ ﺗﻔﺴﲑﻳﺔ ‪ -‬ﺟﻲ‪.‬ﺳﻲ‪ .‬ﺳﻨﺘﺮ ‪ -‬ﻣﺼﺮ ﺍﳉﺪﻳﺪﺓ‬ ‫‪ ١٦‬ﺃﺧﻄﺎﺀ ﳚﺐ ﺃﻥ ﺗُﺼﺤّﺢ ﰲ ﺍﻟﺘﺎﺭﻳﺦ‪ ،‬ﺩ‪ .‬ﲨﺎﻝ ﻣﺴﻌﻮﺩ‪ ،‬ﺩﺍﺭ ﻃﻴﺒﺔ‪ ،‬ﺍﳌﻤﻠﻜﺔ ﺍﻟﻌﺮﺑﻴﺔ ﺍﻟﺴﻌﻮﺩﻳﺔ‪ ،‬ﻁ‪ ،١٩٧٦ ،١‬ﺹ‪٦١‬‬ ‫ﻼ ﻋﻦ‪ :‬ﺳﻴﺎﺳﺔ ﺍﻹﺳﺘﻌﻤﺎﺭ ﻭﺍﻟﺼﻬﻴﻮﻧﻴﺔ ﲡﺎﻩ ﻓﻠﺴﻄﲔ‪ ،‬ﺣﺴﻦ ﺻﱪﻱ ﺍﳋﻮﱄ‪.‬‬ ‫ﻧﻘ ﹰ‬ ‫‪٢١‬‬ ‫ﺨﺮ ﺍﷲ ﺍﻷﺷﻮﺭﻳﲔ‪،‬‬ ‫ﺍﳉﻨﻮﺏ ﻭﻗﻀﻮﺍ ﻋﻠﻴﻬﺎ… ﻓﻔﻲ ﻫﺬﺍ ﺍﻟﻜﺘﺎﺏ ﻧﺮﻯ ﻛﻴﻒ ﺳ ّ‬ ‫ﻭﺍﻟﺒﺎﺑﻠﻴﲔ‪ ،‬ﻟﺘﻨﻔﻴﺬ ﻗﻀﺎﺋﻪ ﺑﺸﻌﱯ ﳑﻠﻜﺔ ﻳﻬﻮﺫﺍ ﻭﺇﺳﺮﺍﺋﻴﻞ ﺍﳌﻨﺤﺮﻓﲔ‪ .‬ﳚﺐ ﺍﻟﺘﻨﻮﻳﻪ‬ ‫ﻫﻨﺎ ﺃ ﹼﻥ ﺍﳋﻄﻴﺌﺔ ﲡﻠﺐ ﺍﻟﺪﻳﻨﻮﻳﺔ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺍﻷﻣﺔ‪ ،‬ﺃ ّﻣﺎ ﺍﻟ ّﱪ ﻓﻤﺪﻋﺎﺓ ﻟﱪﻛﺔ ﺍﷲ‪ .‬ﻳﻜﺸﻒ‬ ‫ﻟﻨﺎ ﻛﺘﺎﺏ ﺍﳌﻠﻮﻙ ﺍﻟﺜﺎﱐ ﺃ ﹼﻥ ﺍﷲ ﻻ ﻳُﺪﻳﻦ ﺃﺣﺪﹰﺍ ﻗﺒﻞ ﺇﻧﺬﺍﺭﻩ‪ ،‬ﻭﻗﺪ ﺑﻌﺚ ﺑﺄﻧﺒﻴﺎﺋـﻪ‬ ‫ﺃﻭ ﹰﻻ ﻟﻴُﺤ ﹼﺬﺭﻭﺍ ﺍﻷﻣﺔ ﻣﻦ ﺍﻟﻌﻘﺎﺏ ﺍﻹﻟﹶﻬﻲ"‪.١٧‬‬ ‫ُﻳﻠﺤﻆ ﺃ ﹼﻥ ﺩﻭﻟﺔ ﺇﺳﺮﺍﺋﻴﻞ ﺍﻟﺸﻤﺎﻟﻴﺔ ﻛﺎﻧﺖ ﺗﺸﻤﻞ ﻣﻌﻈﻢ ﺍﻟﺸﻌﺐ‪ ،‬ﺃﻱ‬ ‫ﻋﺸﺮﺓ ﺃﺳﺒﺎﻁ‪ ،‬ﻭﻛﺎﻧﺖ ﻫﻲ ﺳﺒﺐ ﲤ ّﺰﻕ ﺩﻭﻟﺔ ﺳﻠﻴﻤﺎﻥ‪ ،‬ﻋﻠﻴﻪ ﺍﻟﺴـﻼﻡ‪ ،‬ﺑﻌـﺪ‬ ‫ﺸﻘﺎﻕ ﰲ ﺍﻟﺸﻌﺐ ﺍﻟﻮﺍﺣﺪ‪ .‬ﻭﻗﺪ ﺯﺍﻟﺖ ﺇﺳﺮﺍﺋﻴﻞ ﻭ ُﺷ ﱢﺮﺩ ﺷﻌﺒﻬﺎ‬ ‫ﻭﻓﺎﺗﻪ‪ ،‬ﻭﺣﺼﻮﻝ ﺍﻟ ﱢ‬ ‫ﻗﺒﻞ ﳑﻠﻜﺔ ﻳﻬﻮﺫﺍ ﲟﺎ ﻳﻘﺎﺭﺏ ‪ ١٣٦‬ﺳﻨﺔ‪ .‬ﻭﺑﻌـﺪ ﻓﻨـﺎﺀ ﺍﻟـ ّﺪﻭﻟﺘﲔ ﺣـﺎﻭﻝ‬ ‫ﺴﺎﺑﻘﺔ ﻓﺄﺧﻔﻘﻮﺍ‪ .‬ﺃ ّﻣﺎ ﳒﺎﺡ ﺑﻌﺾ ﺍﻟﺜﻮﺭﺍﺕ ﻓﻠﻢ‬ ‫ﺍﻹﺳﺮﺍﺋﻴﻠّﻴﻮﻥ ﺃﻥ ﻳﻌﻴﺪﻭﺍ ﺍﻷﳎﺎﺩ ﺍﻟ ّ‬ ‫ﰐ‪ ،‬ﺃﻭ ﻣُﻠﻚ ﲢﺖ ﺍﻟﺘﺎﺝ ﺍﻟﺮﻭﻣﺎﱐ‪ ،‬ﻟـﺬﻟﻚ ﳒـ ُﺪ‬ ‫ﻳﺘﻌ ّﺪ ﺍﳊﺼﻮﻝ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺣﻜﻢ ﺫﺍ ﹼ‬ ‫ﻛﹸﺘﺐ ﺍﻟﺘﺎﺭﻳﺦ ﺗﺘﻮﺍﻃﺄ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺍﻟﻘﻮﻝ ﺇﻥ ﺯﻭﺍﻝ ﳑﻠﻜﺔ ﻳﻬﻮﺫﺍ ﻫـﻮ ﺯﻭﺍﻝ ﺍﻟﺪﻭﻟـﺔ‬ ‫ﺍﻹﺳﺮﺍﺋﻴﻠﻴﺔ ﺍﻷﻭﱃ‪ ،‬ﻓﻠﻢ ﺗﻮﻟﺪ ﻣ ّﺮﺓ ﺛﺎﻧﻴﺔ ﺇﻻ ﻋﺎﻡ ‪١٩٤٨‬ﻡ‪.‬‬ ‫‪ ١٧‬ﻛﺘﺎﺏ ﺍﳊﻴﺎﺓ‪ ،‬ﺍﳌﺮﺟﻊ ﺍﻟﺴﺎﺑﻖ‪ ،‬ﺹ ‪٤٧٨‬‬ ‫‪٢٢‬‬ ‫ﰲ ﺗﻔﺴﲑ ﺍﻟّﻨﺒﻮﺀﺓ‬ ‫ﳌﺎﺫﺍ ﹸﺃﻧﺰﻟﺖ ﺍﻟﻨﺒﻮﺀﺓ ﻣﺮﺓ ﺃﺧﺮﻯ ﺑﻌﺪ ﻧﺰﻭﳍﺎ ﺍﻷﻭﻝ ﰲ ﺍﻟﺘـﻮﺭﺍﺓ‪ ،‬ﻗﺒـﻞ‬ ‫ﺍﻹﺳﺮﺍﺀ ﲟﺎ ﻳﻘﺎﺭﺏ ‪ ١٨٠٠‬ﺳﻨﺔ ؟ ﻧﻘﻮﻝ‪ :‬ﻟﻮ ﻛﺎﻧﺖ ﺍﻟﻨﺒﻮﺀﺓ ﻗﺪ ﲢﻘﻘﺖ ﻛﺎﻣﻠﺔ‬ ‫ﻗﺒﻞ ﺍﻹﺳﻼﻡ‪ ،‬ﻟﻮﺟﺪﻧﺎ ﺻﻌﻮﺑﺔ ﰲ ﻓﻬﻢ ﺫﻟﻚ‪ .‬ﻭﻟﻜﻦ ﻋﻨﺪﻣﺎ ﺗﻜﻮﻥ ﺍﳌ ّﺮﺓ ﺍﻷﻭﱃ‬ ‫ﻗﺪ ﲢﻘﻘﺖ ﻗﺒﻞ ﺍﻹﺳﻼﻡ ‪ -‬ﻭﻫﺬﺍ ﻣﺎ ﺣﺼﻞ ﰲ ﺍﻟﻮﺍﻗﻊ ‪ -‬ﻭﺍﻟﺜﺎﻧﻴﺔ ﺗﺘﺤﻘـﻖ ﰲ‬ ‫ﻣﺴﺘﻘﺒﻞ ﺍﳌﺴﻠﻤﲔ‪ ،‬ﻓﺈﻥ ﺍﻷﻣﺮ ﻋﻨﺪﻫﺎ ﻳﻜﻮﻥ ﻣﻔﻬﻮﻣﺎ‪ ،‬ﺳّﻴﻤﺎ ﻭﺃﻧﻨﺎ ﻧﻌﻴﺶ ﺯﻣـﻦ‬ ‫ﲢﻘﻖ ﺍﻟﺜﺎﻧﻴﺔ‪ ،‬ﺑﻞ ﺇ ﹼﻥ ﺍﻟﺘﻔﺴﲑ ﺍﳌﻨﺴﺠﻢ ﻣﻊ ﻇﺎﻫﺮ ﺍﻟﻨﺺ ﺍﻟﻘﺮﺁﱐ ﻟﻴﺆﻛﹼﺪ ﺫﻟﻚ‪:‬‬ ‫ﲔ‬ ‫ﺽ ﻣﺮﺗ ِ‬ ‫ﺴﺪُ ﱠﻥ ﰲ ﺍﻷﺭ ِ‬ ‫ﺏ ﹶﻟﺘُ ﹾﻔ ِ‬ ‫ﻀﻴْﻨﺎ ﺇﱃ ﺑَﲏ ﺇﺳﺮﺍﺋﻴ ﹶﻞ ﰲ ﺍﻟﻜﺘﺎ ِ‬ ‫) َﻭ ﹶﻗ َ‬ ‫ﺱ‬ ‫َﻭﹶﻟَﺘﻌْﻠﹸ ﱠﻦ ﻋُﻠﻮﹰﺍ ﻛﺒﲑﹰﺍ‪ .‬ﹶﻓﺈِﺫﺍ ﺟَﺎ َﺀ َﻭ ْﻋﺪُ ﺃﹸﻭﻻﻫُﻤﺎ ﺑَﻌﺜﹾﻨﺎ َﻋ ﹶﻠ ْﻴﻜﹸﻢ ﻋِﺒﺎﺩﹰﺍ ﻟﻨﺎ ﺃﹸﻭﱄ َﺑ ﹾﺄ ٍ‬ ‫ﺷَﺪﻳﺪ ﹶﻓﺠَﺎﺳﻮﺍ ﺧِﻼﻝﹶ ﺍﻟ ِّﺪﻳﺎ ِﺭ ﻭَﻛﺎ ﹶﻥ َﻭﻋْﺪﹰﺍ َﻣﻔﹾﻌﻮ ﹰﻻ(‪.‬‬ ‫‪١٨‬‬ ‫)ﻭَﻗﹶﻀَﻴﻨﺎ ﺇﱃ َﺑﲏ ﺇﺳﺮﺍﺋﻴﻞ(‪ :‬ﻭﺇﺳﺮﺍﺋﻴﻞ ﻫﻮ )ﻳﻌﻘﻮﺏ( ﻋﻠﻴﻪ ﺍﻟﺴـﻼﻡ‪،‬‬ ‫ﻭﺃﺑﻨﺎﺀ ﺇﺳﺮﺍﺋﻴﻞ ﻫﻢ ﺍﻷﺳﺒﺎﻁ ﺍﻹﺛﻨﺎ ﻋﺸﺮ‪ ،‬ﻭﻣﺎ ﺗﻨﺎﺳﻞ ﻣﻨﻬﻢ‪ .‬ﻭﺍﻟﻘﻀـﺎﺀ ﻫﻨـﺎ‬ ‫ﳜﺼﻬﻢ ﺑﺼﻔﺘﻬﻢ ﳎﺘﻤﻌﺎﹰ‪ ،‬ﻭﻫﺬﺍ ﻳﺴﺘﻔﺎﺩ ﻣﻦ ﻗﻮﻟﻪ ﺗﻌﺎﱃ‪ " :‬ﺇﱃ ﺑﲏ ﺇﺳﺮﺍﺋﻴﻞ "‪.‬‬ ‫‪١٨‬‬ ‫ﺍﻹﺳﺮﺍﺀ‪٥،٤ :‬‬ ‫‪٢٣‬‬ ‫)ﰲ ﺍﻟﻜﺘﺎﺏ(‪ :‬ﺃﻱ ﺍﻟﺘﻮﺭﺍﺓ‪ ،‬ﻭﻳﺆ ﹼﻛﺪ ﻫﺬﺍ ﻗﻮﻟﻪ ﺗﻌﺎﱃ ﰲ ﺍﻵﻳﺔ ﺍﻟﺜﺎﻧﻴﺔ ﻣﻦ‬ ‫ﻯ ﻟِﺒﲏ ﺇﺳﺮﺍﺋﻴﻞ"‪ .‬ﻭﺍﳌﻌﺮﻭﻑ‬ ‫ﺏ ﻭﺟﻌﻠﻨﺎ ُﻩ ﻫُﺪ ً‬ ‫ﺴﻮﺭﺓ‪" :‬ﻭﺀﺍَﺗﻴْﻨﺎ ﻣﻮﺳﻰ ﺍﻟﻜﺘﺎ َ‬ ‫ﺍﻟ ّ‬ ‫ﺃ ﹼﻥ ﺍﻟﺘﻮﺭﺍﺓ ﻧﺰﻟﺖ ﻟﺒﲏ ﺇﺳﺮﺍﺋﻴﻞ‪ .‬ﻭﻛﺎﻥ ﻛﻞ ﺭﺳﻮ ٍﻝ ﻳُﺒﻌﺚ ﺇﱃ ﻗﻮﻣـﻪ ﺧﺎﺻّـﺔ‪،‬‬ ‫ﻭﺑُﻌﺚ ﳏﻤﺪ‪ ،‬ﺻﻠﻰ ﺍﷲ ﻋﻠﻴﻪ ﻭﺳﻠﻢ‪ ،‬ﺇﱃ ﺍﻟﻨﺎﺱ ﻛﺎﻓﺔ‪.‬‬ ‫ﺽ(‪ :‬ﻭﺍﺿﺢ ﺃ ﹼﻥ ﺍﻟﻜﻼﻡ ﻫﻮ ﺇﺧﺒﺎﺭ ﺑﺎﳌﺴﺘﻘﺒﻞ‪ .‬ﻭﲟﺎ‬ ‫ﺴﺪُ ﱠﻥ ﰲ ﺍﻷﺭ ِ‬ ‫)ﻟﺘُ ﹾﻔ ِ‬ ‫ﺃ ﹼﻥ ﺍﻟﻜﺘﺎﺏ ﻫﻮ ﺍﻟﺘﻮﺭﺍﺓ‪ ،‬ﻓﺎﻟﻨﺒﻮﺀﺓ ﺗﺘﺤﺪﺙ ﻋﻦ ﺍﳌﺴﺘﻘﺒﻞ ﺑﻌﺪ ﺯﻣـﻦ ﺍﻟﺘـﻮﺭﺍﺓ‪،‬‬ ‫ﻭﻟﻴﺲ ﺑﻌﺪ ﻧﺰﻭﻝ ﺍﻟﻘﺮﺍﻥ ﺍﻟﻜﺮﱘ‪ .‬ﻭﻭﺭﻭﺩ ﺍﻟﻨﺒﻮﺀﺓ ﰲ ﺍﻟﻘـﺮﺍﻥ ﺍﻟﻜـﺮﱘ ﺑﺼـﻴﻐﺔ‬ ‫ﺍﻻﺳﺘﻘﺒﺎﻝ‪ ،‬ﻻ ﹼﻥ ﺍﻟﻜﻼﻡ ﺣِﻜﺎﻳﺔ ﳌﺎ ﻭﺭﺩ ﰲ ﺍﻟﺘﻮﺭﺍﺓ‪ ،‬ﻛﻘﻮﻟﻪ ﺗﻌﺎﱃ ﰲ ﺣﻜﺎﻳﺔ ﻗﻮﻝ‬ ‫ﺍﺑﻦ ﺁﺩﻡ ﳐﺎﻃﺒﺎﹰ ﺃﺧﺎﻩ‪" :‬ﻗﺎ ﹶﻝ َﻷ ﹾﻗﺘُ ﹶﻠّﻨﻚ"‪.‬‬ ‫)ﰲ ﺍﻷﺭﺽ(‪ :‬ﺍﻹﻓﺴﺎﺩ ﰲ ﺟُﺰﺀ ﻣﻦ ﺍﻷﺭﺽ ﻫﻮ ﺇﻓﺴـﺎﺩ ﰲ ﺍﻷﺭﺽ‪.‬‬ ‫ﻭﺍﻟﻔﺴﺎﺩ ﻫﻮ ﺧﺮﻭﺝ ﺍﻟﺸﻲﺀ ﻋﻦ ﻭﻇﻴﻔﺘﻪ ﺍﻟﱵ ﺧُﻠﻖ ﳍﺎ‪ ،‬ﻭﻫﻮ ﺩﺭﺟـﺎﺕ؛ ﻣﻨـﻪ‬ ‫ﺍﻟﺼﻐﲑ‪ ،‬ﻭﻣﻨﻪ ﺍﻟﻜﺒﲑ‪.‬‬ ‫)ﻣﺮﺗﲔ(‪ :‬ﻫﺬﺍ ﻳﺆ ﹼﻛﺪ ﺃ ﹼﻥ ﺍﻹﻓﺴﺎﺩ ﻫﻮ ﺇﻓﺴﺎﺩ ﳎﺘﻤﻌـﻲ‪ ،‬ﻭﰲ ﺯﻣـﺎﻥ‬ ‫ﻭﻣﻜﺎﻥ ﻣﻌﻴﻨﲔ‪ .‬ﺃﻣﺎ ﺍﻹﻓﺴﺎﺩ ﺍﻟﻔﺮﺩﻱ ﻓﻬﻮ ﻣﺘﻜﺮﺭ ﰲ ﻛﻞ ﳊﻈﺔ‪.‬‬ ‫) َﻭﹶﻟَﺘﻌْﻠﹸ ﱠﻦ ﻋُﻠﻮﹰﺍ ﻛﹶﺒﲑﹰﺍ(‪ :‬ﻓﻬﻮ ﺇﻓﺴﺎﺩ ﻋﻦ ﻋﻠﻮ ﻭﲡﺒّـﺮ‪ .‬ﻭﻗـﺪ ﻳﻜـﻮﻥ‬ ‫ﻒ ﻭﺫِﻟﹼﺔ‪ .‬ﺃﻣﺎ ﺍﻹﻓﺴﺎﺩ ﺍﳌﻨﺒﺄ ﺑﻪ ﻓﻬﻮ ﻋﻦ ﻋﻠ ٍﻮ ﻛـﺒﲑ‪ .‬ﻭﺍﻟﻌﻠـﻮ‬ ‫ﺍﻹﻓﺴﺎﺩ ﻋﻦ ﺿﻌ ٍ‬ ‫ﺽ ﻭﺟﻌـ ﹶﻞ ﺃﻫْﻠـﻬﺎ ﺷِـﻴَﻌﹰﺎ‬ ‫ﻳﻔﺴﺮﻩ ﻗﻮﻝ ﺍﷲ ﺗﻌﺎﱃ‪) :‬ﺇﻥ ِﻓ ْﺮﻋَﻮ ﹶﻥ ﻋﻼ ﰲ ﺍﻷﺭ ِ‬ ‫ﺴﺘَﺤﻴﻲ ﻧِﺴﺎ َﺀﻫُﻢ ﺇﻧ ُﻪ ﻛـﺎ ﹶﻥ ﻣِـ َﻦ‬ ‫ﺢ ﺃﹶﺑﻨﺎ َﺀﻫُﻢ َﻭَﻳ ْ‬ ‫َﻳﺴَْﺘﻀْ ِﻌﻒُ ﻃﺎﺋِﻔ ﹰﺔ ِﻣ ْﻨﻬُﻢ ُﻳ ﹶﺬّﺑ ُ‬ ‫‪٢٤‬‬ ‫ﺍﳌﹸﻔﹾﺴِﺪﻳﻦ(‬ ‫‪١٩‬‬ ‫ﻓﺈﻓﺴﺎﺩ ﺍﺠﻤﻟﺘﻤﻊ ﺍﻹﺳﺮﺍﺋﻴﻠﻲ ﺳﻴﻜﻮﻥ ﻋﻦ ﻋﻠـﻮ‪ ،‬ﻭﺍﺳـﺘﻜﺒﺎﺭ‪،‬‬ ‫ﻭﻏﻄﺮﺳﺔ‪ ،‬ﻭﺇﺟﺮﺍﻡ‪.‬‬ ‫)ﻓﺈﺫﺍ ﺟﺎ َﺀ َﻭ ْﻋﺪُ ﺃﹸﻭﻻﻫُﻤﺎ(‪ :‬ﻓﺈﺫﺍ ﺣﺼﻞ ﺍﻹﻓﺴﺎﺩ ﻣﻦ ﻗﺒـﻞ ﺍﺠﻤﻟﺘﻤـﻊ‬ ‫ﺍﻹﺳﺮﺍﺋﻴﻠﻲ ﰲ ﺍﻷﺭﺽ ﺍﳌﻘﺪّﺳﺔ‪ ،‬ﻭﲢ ﹼﻘﻘﺖ ﺍﻟﻨﺒﻮﺀﺓ ﲝﺼﻮﻝ ﺫﻟﻚ‪ ،‬ﻋﻨﺪﻫﺎ ﺗﻜﻮﻥ‬ ‫ﺍﻟﻌﻘﻮﺑﺔ‪.‬‬ ‫ﻋﺒﺎﺩﹼﺍ ﻟﻨﺎ‬ ‫)ﺑﻌﺜﻨﺎ ﻋﻠﻴﻜﻢ ﻋﺒﺎﺩﹰﺍ ﻟﻨﺎ(‪ :‬ﺫﻫﺐ ﺑﻌﺾ ﺍﳌﻌﺎﺻﺮﻳﻦ ﺇﱃ ﺍﻟﻘـﻮﻝ ﺑـﺄ ﹼﻥ‬ ‫ﺍﻟﻌﺒﺎﺩ ﻫﻢ ﻣﻦ ﺍﳌﺆﻣﻨﲔ‪ ،‬ﺑﺪﻟﻴﻞ ﻗﻮﻟﻪ ﺗﻌﺎﱃ‪) :‬ﻋﺒﺎﺩﹰﺍ ﻟﻨﺎ(‪ .‬ﻭﻗﺪ ﺃﳉﺄﻫﻢ ﻫـﺬﺍ ﺇﱃ‬ ‫ﺍﻟﻘﻮﻝ ﺑﺄ ﹼﻥ ﺍﳌ ّﺮﺓ ﺍﻷﻭﱃ ﻫﻲ ﺍﻟﱵ ﰎ ﻓﻴﻬﺎ ﺇﺧﺮﺍﺝ ﺍﻟﻴﻬﻮﺩ ﻣﻦ ﺍﳌﺪﻳﻨﺔ ﺍﳌﻨـﻮﺭﺓ‪ ،‬ﰲ‬ ‫ﻋﺼﺮ ﺍﻟﺮﺳﻮﻝ ﺻﻠﻰ ﺍﷲ ﻋﻠﻴﻪ ﻭﺳﻠﻢ‪ ،‬ﻭﺩﺧﻮﻝ ﻋﻤﺮ ﺑﻦ ﺍﳋﻄﺎﺏ ﺍﻟﻘﺪﺱ ﻓﺎﲢﺎﹰ‪،‬‬ ‫ﻭﻫﺬﺍ ﺑﻌﻴﺪ ﻋﻦ ﻇﺎﻫﺮ ﺍﻟﻨﺺ ﺍﻟﻘﺮﺁﱐ‪ .‬ﻭﻻ ﺿﺮﻭﺭﺓ ﳌﺜﻞ ﻫﺬﺍ ﺍﻟﺘﺄﻭﻳﻞ ﻷ ﹼﻥ ﻋﺒﺎﺭﺓ‬ ‫)ﻋﺒﺎﺩﹰﺍ ﻟﻨﺎ( ﲢﺘﻤﻞ ﺍﳌﺆﻣﻨﲔ ﻭﻏﲑ ﺍﳌﺆﻣﻨﲔ‪ ،‬ﻣﻊ ﻭﺟﻮﺩ ﺍﻟﻘﺮﺍﺋﻦ ﺍﻟﻜﺜﲑﺓ ﺍﻟﱵ ﺗﺪﻝ‬ ‫ﻋﻠﻰ ﺃﻬﻧﻢ ﻣﻦ ﻏﲑ ﺍﳌﺆﻣﻨﲔ‪ .‬ﻭﺇﻟﻴﻚ ﺗﻮﺿﻴﺢ ﺫﻟﻚ ‪:‬‬ ‫‪ (١‬ﱂ ﻳﺮﺩ ﺗﻌﺒﲑ )ﻋﺒﺎﺩﹰﺍ ﻟﻨﺎ( ﰲ ﺍﻟﻘﺮﺁﻥ ﺍﻟﻜﺮﱘ ﺇﻻ ﰲ ﻫـﺬﺍ ﺍﳌﻮﺿـﻊ‬ ‫ﻓﻘﻂ‪ .‬ﻭﺃﻫﻞ ﺍﻟﻠﻐﺔ ﻣﻦ ﺍﳌﻔﺴﺮﻳﻦ ﺍﻟﻘﺪﻣﺎﺀ ﱂ ﻳﻘﻮﻟﻮﺍ ﺑﺄ ﹼﻥ ﻋﺒﺎﺩﺍﹰ ﻟﻨﺎ ﺗﻌﲏ ﻣﺆﻣﻨﲔ‪.‬‬ ‫ﺑﻞ ﺫﻫﺒﻮﺍ ﺇﱃ ﺍﻟﻘﻮﻝ ﺇﻬﻧﻢ ﻣﻦ ﺍﺠﻤﻟﻮﺱ‪.‬‬ ‫ﺤﺖ ﺭﺳﺎﻟﺔ ﻋﻤﺮ ﺑﻦ ﺍﳋﻄﺎﺏ ﺭﺿﻲ ﺍﷲ ﻋﻨـﻪ ﺇﱃ ﺍﳉﻨـﺪ‪،‬‬ ‫‪ (٢‬ﺇﺫﺍ ﺻ ّ‬ ‫ﻼ ﻋﻠﻰ ﻓﻬﻢ ﺍﻟﺼﺤﺎﺑﺔ ﻟﻶﻳﺔ‬ ‫ﻭﺍﻟﱵ ﺃﺧﺮﺟﻬﺎ ﺍﺑﻦ ﺳﻌﺪ ﰲ ﺍﻟ ﹼﻄﺒﻘﺎﺕ‪ ،‬ﻓﺴﺘﻜﻮﻥ ﺩﻟﻴ ﹰ‬ ‫‪ ١٩‬ﺳﻮﺭﺓ ﺍﻟﻘﺼﺺ‪ ،‬ﺍﻵﻳﺔ ‪٤ :‬‬ ‫‪٢٥‬‬ ‫ﺍﻟﻜﺮﳝﺔ‪ .‬ﻳﻘﻮﻝ ﺭﺿﻲ ﺍﷲ ﻋﻨﻪ‪" :‬ﻭﻻ ﺗﻘﻮﻟﻮﺍ ﺇ ﹼﻥ ﻋﺪ ّﻭﻧﺎ ﺷﺮٌ ﻣﻨﺎ ﻓﻠﻦ ُﻳﺴَـ ﹼﻠﻂ‬ ‫ﻋﻠﻴﻨﺎ ﻭﺇﻥ ﺃﺳﺄﻧﺎ‪ .‬ﻓﺮﺏ ﻗﻮ ٍﻡ ُﺳ ﹼﻠﻂ ﻋﻠﻴﻬﻢ ﺷﺮٌ ﻣﻨﻬﻢ‪ ،‬ﻛﻤﺎ ُﺳ ﹼﻠﻂ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺑـﲏ‬ ‫ﺇﺳﺮﺍﺋﻴﻞ ﳌﺎ ﺃﺗﻮﺍ ﻣﺴﺎﺧﻂ ﺍﷲ ﻛﻔﺮﺓ ﺍﺠﻤﻟﻮﺱ‪ ،‬ﻓﺠﺎﺳﻮﺍ ﺧﻼﻝ ﺍﻟﺪﻳﺎﺭ ﻭﻛـﺎﻥ‬ ‫ﻭﻋﺪﹰﺍ ﻣﻔﻌﻮ ﹰﻻ"‪ .‬ﻻﺣﻆ ﻗﻮﻟﻪ ﺭﺿﻲ ﺍﷲ ﻋﻨﻪ‪" :‬ﻛﻔﺮﺓ ﺍﺠﻤﻟﻮﺱ ﻓﺠﺎﺳﻮﺍ ﺧـﻼﻝ‬ ‫ﺍﻟﺪﻳﺎﺭ" ﻓﻬﻮ ﳚﺰﻡ ﺑﺄﻬﻧﻢ ﻛﻔﺮﺓ‪ ،‬ﻭﺍﺳﺘﺸﻬﺪ ﺑﺎﳌ ّﺮﺓ ﺍﻷﻭﱃ‪ ،‬ﻭﻫﺬﺍ ﻳﻮﺣﻲ ﺑﺄ ﹼﻥ ﺍﳌ ّﺮﺓ‬ ‫ﺍﻟﺜﺎﻧﻴﺔ ﱂ ﲢﺪﺙ ﺑﻌﺪ؛ ﺇﺫ ﻛﺎﻥ ﺍ َﻷﻭﱃ ﺃﻥ ﻳﺴﺘﺸﻬ َﺪ ﺑﺎﳌ ّﺮﺓ ﺍﻟﺜﺎﻧﻴﺔ‪ ،‬ﻷﻬﻧﺎ ﺃﻗﺮﺏ ﰲ‬ ‫ﺍﻟﺰﻣﺎﻥ‪ ،‬ﻭﺃ ْﺩﻋﻰ ﺇﱃ ﺍﻻﻋﺘﺒﺎﺭ‪.‬‬ ‫ﷲ ِﺑ ِﻪ ﻋِﺒﺎ َﺩﻩُ ﻳـﺎ ﻋِﺒـﺎ ِﺩ‬ ‫ﻑﺍُ‬ ‫ﺨ ّﻮ ُ‬ ‫ﻚ ُﻳ َ‬ ‫‪ (٣‬ﻧﻘﺮﺃ ﰲ ﺍﻟﻘﺮﺍﻥ ﺍﻟﻜﺮﱘ‪ " :‬ﹶﺫِﻟ َ‬ ‫ﻓﺎﺗﻘﻮ ِﻥ " ]ﺍﻟﺰﻣﺮ‪.[ ١٦:‬‬ ‫ﺨَﺘﻠِﻔﻮﻥ " ]ﺍﻟﺰﻣﺮ‪.[ ٤٦‬‬ ‫ﺤﻜﹸﻢُ َﺑ ْﻴ َﻦ ﻋِﺒﺎ ِﺩ َﻙ ﰲ ﻣﺎ ﻛﺎﻧُﻮﺍ ﻓﻴ ِﻪ َﻳ ْ‬ ‫ﺖ َﺗ ْ‬ ‫" ﺃﹶﻧ َ‬ ‫" َﻧ ْﻬﺪِﻱ ِﺑ ِﻪ َﻣ ْﻦ َﻧﺸَﺎ ُﺀ ِﻣ ْﻦ ِﻋﺒَﺎ ِﺩﻧَﺎ " ]ﺍﻟﺸﻮﺭﻯ ‪.[٤٢‬‬ ‫ﲑ ﺑَﺼﲑ " ]ﻓﺎﻃﺮ ‪.[ ٣١‬‬ ‫ﷲ ِﺑ ِﻌﺒَﺎ ِﺩ ِﻩ ﹶﻟﺨَﺒ ٌ‬ ‫" ﺇِﻥ ﺍ َ‬ ‫ﺴﺒﻴﻞ " ]ﺍﻟﻔﺮﻗﺎﻥ ‪[١٧‬‬ ‫ﺿ ﹼﻠﻮﺍ ﺍﻟ ّ‬ ‫" َﺀﹶﺃْﻧُﺘ ْﻢ ﺃﹶﺿْﻠﹶﻠﹾﺘُﻢ ﻋِﺒﺎﺩِﻱ ﻫﺆﻻ ِﺀ ﹶﺃ ْﻡ ﻫﻢ َ‬ ‫ﻻﺣﻆ ﺍﻟﻜﻠﻤﺎﺕ‪):‬ﻋﺒﺎﺩﻩ‪ ..‬ﻋﺒﺎﺩﻱ‪ ..‬ﻋﺒﺎﺩﻙ‪ ..‬ﻋﺒﺎﺩﻧﺎ( ﰲ ﺍﻵﻳﺎﺕ ﺍﻟﺴـﺎﺑﻘﺔ‬ ‫ﻭﺍﻟﱵ ﺗﺆﻛﺪ ﺃﻥ ﺍﳌﻘﺼﻮﺩ ﻋﻤﻮﻡ ﺍﻟﺒﺸﺮ‪.‬‬ ‫‪ (٤‬ﺍﻟﺘﺨﺼﻴﺺ ﰲ ﻗﻮﻟﻪ ﺗﻌﺎﱃ‪ " :‬ﻋﺒﺎﺩﹰﺍ ﻟﻨﺎ " ﻳﻘﺼﺪ ﺑﻪ ﺇﺑـﺮﺍﺯ ﺻـﻔﺔ‬ ‫ﺖ‪ :‬ﻭﻟﺪﻱ ﺫﻛ ّﻲ‪ ،‬ﻓﻬﻤﻨﺎ ﺃﻧﻚ‬ ‫ﺱ ﺷﺪﻳ ٍﺪ "‪ .‬ﻓﺈﺫﺍ ﻗﻠ َ‬ ‫ﻗﺎﺩﻣﺔ‪ ،‬ﻭﻫﻲ ﻫﻨﺎ‪ " :‬ﺃﹸﻭﱄ ﺑﺄ ٍ‬ ‫ﺗﻘﺼﺪ ﺍﳊﺪﻳﺚ ﻋﻦ ﻭﻟﺪﻙ‪ .‬ﺃﻣﺎ ﺇﺫﺍ ﻗﻠﺖ‪ :‬ﻭﻟ ٌﺪ ﱄ ﺫﻛ ّﻲ‪ ،‬ﻓﻬﻤﻨﺎ ﺃﻧـﻚ ﺗﻘﺼـﺪ‬ ‫ﺍﳊﺪﻳﺚ ﻋﻦ ﺫﻛﺎﺀ ﻭﻟﺪﻙ ﺑﺎﻟﺪﺭﺟﺔ ﺍﻷﻭﱃ‪.‬‬ ‫‪ (٥‬ﻭﺩﻟﻴﻞ ﺃﺧﺮ ﻣﻦ ﺣﺪﻳﺚ ﺭﺳﻮﻝ ﺍﷲ‪ ،‬ﺻﻠﻰ ﺍﷲ ﻋﻠﻴﻪ ﻭﺳﻠﻢ؛ ﻓﻘـﺪ‬ ‫‪٢٦‬‬ ‫ﺃﺧﺮﺝ ﻣﺴﻠﻢ ﰲ ﺻﺤﻴﺤﻪ‪ ،‬ﰲ ﻛﺘﺎﺏ ﺍﻟﻔﱳ ‪ -‬ﺑﺎﺏ ِﺫﻛﹾﺮ ﺍﻟـ ّﺪﺟّﺎﻝ ‪ -‬ﻋﻨـﺪ‬ ‫ﷲ ﺇﱃ‬ ‫ﺍﳊﺪﻳﺚ ﻋﻦ ﻳﺄﺟﻮﺝ ﻭﻣﺄﺟﻮﺝ‪ ..." :‬ﻓﺒﻴﻨﻤﺎ ﻫﻮ ﻛﺬﻟﻚ‪ ،‬ﺇﺫ ﺃﻭﺣـﻰ ﺍ ُ‬ ‫ﻋﻴﺴﻰ ﻋﻠﻴﻪ ﺍﻟﺴﻼﻡ‪ :‬ﺃﱐ ﻗﺪ ﺃﺧﺮﺟﺖُ ﻋﺒﺎﺩﹰﺍ ﱄ ﻻ ﻳﺪﺍﻥ ﻷﺣـﺪ ﺑﻘﺘـﺎﳍﻢ "‬ ‫ﻻﺣﻆ‪ " :‬ﻋﺒﺎﺩﹰﺍ ﱄ "‪.‬‬ ‫ﺱ ﺷﺪﻳﺪ (‪ :‬ﻻ ﻳﺘﻮﻫﻢ ﺃﺣﺪ ﺃ ﹼﻥ ﺍﻟﻮﺻﻒ ﺍﻟﺒـﺄﺱ‬ ‫) ﻋﺒﺎﺩﹰﺍ ﻟﻨﺎ ﺃﻭﱄ ﺑﺄ ٍ‬ ‫ﺍﻟﺸﺪﻳﺪ ﻻ ﻳﻜﻮﻥ ﺇﻻ ﰲ ﺍﳌﺴﻠﻤﲔ‪ ،‬ﻓﻘﺪ ﺟﺎﺀ ﰲ ﺳﻮﺭﺓﺍﻟﻔﺘﺢ‪َ …":‬ﺳُﺘﺪﻋﻮ ﹶﻥ ﺇﱃ‬ ‫ﺱ ﺷﺪﻳﺪ …"‬ ‫ﻗﻮ ٍﻡ ﺃﻭﱄ ﺑﺎ ٍ‬ ‫‪٢٠‬‬ ‫ﳉﻮْﺱ‬ ‫ﺍﹶ‬ ‫)ﻓﺠﺎﺳﻮﺍ ﺧﻼﻝ ﺍﻟﺪﻳﺎﺭ(‪ :‬ﺍﳉﻮﺱ ﻫﻮ ﺍﻟﺘﺮﺩﱡﺩ ﺫﻫﺎﺑﹰﺎ ﻭﺇﻳﺎﺑﺎﹰ‪ .‬ﻭﳓﻦ ﻧﻘﻮﻝ‬ ‫ﰲ ﺍﻟﻌﺎﻣّﻴﺔ‪" :‬ﺣﺎﺱ ﺍﻟﺪﺍﺭ" ﺇﺫﺍ ﺃﻛﺜﺮ ﻣﻦ ﺍﻟﺬﻫﺎﺏ ﻭﺍﻹﻳﺎﺏ ﺣﱴ ﻇﻬﺮﺕ ﺁﺛـﺎﺭ‬ ‫ﺫﻟﻚ ﰲ ﺃﺭﺟﺎﺀ ﺍﻟﺒﻴﺖ‪ ،‬ﰲ ﺻﻮﺭﺓ ﻣﻦ ﺍﻟﻔﻮﺿﻰ‪ .‬ﻭﻛﺬﻟﻚ ﻋﻨﺪﻣﺎ ﻧﻀﻊ ﺍﻟﺒﺼﻞ ﰲ‬ ‫ﺍﻟﺰﻳﺖ‪ ،‬ﻭﻧﻀﻌﻬﻤﺎ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺍﻟﻨﺎﺭِ‪ ،‬ﻭﻧﻜﺜﺮ ﻣﻦ ﺍﻟﺘﺤﺮﻳﻚ ﻭﺍﻟﺘﻘﻠﻴﺐ‪ ،‬ﻧﻘﻮﻝ‪ " :‬ﺇﻧﻨـﺎ‬ ‫ﳓﻮﺱ ﺍﻟﺒﺼﻞ "‪ .‬ﻭﺇﺫﺍ ﻭﻗﻊ ﺇﻧﺴﺎﻥﹲ ﰲ ﻣﺸﻜﻠﺔ ﺟﻌﻠﺘﻪ ﻳﻀﻄﺮﺏ ﻓﻼ ﻳﻌﺮﻑ ﳊﻠﻬﺎ‬ ‫ﻭﺟﻬﹰﺎ‪ ،‬ﻧﻘﻮﻝ‪ " :‬ﻭﻗﻊ ﰲ ﺣﻮﺳﺔ "‪ .‬ﻭﺍﳊﻮﺱ ﻭﺍﳉﻮﺱ ﻫﻨـﺎ ﲟﻌـﲎ ﻭﺍﺣـﺪ‪.‬‬ ‫ﻭﺍﻟﻌﻘﻮﺑﺔ ﻏﲑ ﻭﺍﺿﺤﺔ ﺍﳌﻌﺎﱂ ﻛﺎﳌﺮﺓ ﺍﻟﺜﺎﻧﻴﺔ‪ ،‬ﻭﻟﻜﻨﻚ ﺗﺴـﺘﻄﻴﻊ ﺃﻥ ﺗﺘﺼـﻮﺭﻫﺎ‬ ‫ﺱ ﺷﺪﻳﺪ‪ ،‬ﻟﻴﺲ ﰲ ﻗﻠﻮﻬﺑﻢ ﺇﳝﺎ ﹲﻥ ﻭﻻ ﺭﲪﺔ‪.‬‬ ‫ﻋﻨﺪﻣﺎ ﳚﻮﺱ ﻗﻮﻡ ﺃﻭﻟﻮﺍ ﺑﺎ ٍ‬ ‫ﺑﺪﺃ ﺍﻟﻔﺴﺎﺩ ﺑﺎﻧﻘﺴﺎﻡ ﺍﻟ ّﺪﻭﻟﺔ ﺑﻌﺪ ﻣﻮﺕ ﺳﻠﻴﻤﺎﻥ ﻋﻠﻴﻪ ﺍﻟﺴﻼﻡ ﻋﺎﻡ ‪٩٣٥‬‬ ‫ﻕ‪ .‬ﻡ‪ ،‬ﰒ ﻛﺎﻥ ﺟﻮﺱ ﺍﳌﺼﺮﻳﲔ‪ ،‬ﻓﺎﻵﺷﻮﺭﻳﲔ‪ ،‬ﻓﺎﻟﻜﻠﺪﺍﻧﻴﲔ‪ .‬ﻭﺑﺎﺭﺗﻔﺎﻉ ﻭﺗـﲑﺓ‬ ‫‪ ٢٠‬ﺍﻟﻔﺘﺢ‪١٦ :‬‬ ‫‪٢٧‬‬ ‫ﺍﻹﻓﺴﺎﺩ ﺍﺭﺗﻔﻌﺖ ﻭﺗﲑﺓ ﺍﳉﻮﺱ ﻭﺧﻄﻮﺭﺗﻪ‪ ،‬ﺣﱴ ﺑﻠﻎ ﺍﻟ ﹼﺬﺭﻭﺓ ﺑﺘـﺪﻣﲑ ﺍﻟ ّﺪﻭﻟـﺔ‬ ‫ﺍﻟﺸﻤﺎﻟﻴﺔ ﺇﺳﺮﺍﺋﻴﻞ ﻋﺎﻡ ‪ ٧٢٢‬ﻕ‪.‬ﻡ‪ .‬ﻭﺑﺬﻟﻚ ﰎ ﻗﺘﻞ ﻭﺳﱯ ﻋﺸﺮﺓ ﺃﺳﺒﺎﻁ ﻣـﻦ‬ ‫ﺍﻷﺳﺒﺎﻁ ﺍﻹﺛﲏ ﻋﺸﺮ‪ ،‬ﻭﺑﻘﻲ ﺍﳉﻮﺱ ﰲ ﺍﻟﺪﻭﻟﺔ ﺍﳉﻨﻮﺑﻴﺔ ﻳﻬﻮﺫﺍ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺍﻟﺮﻏﻢ ﻣﻦ‬ ‫ﺑﻌﺾ ﺍﻹﺻﻼﺣﺎﺕ‪ ،‬ﻭﺃﺑﺮﺯﻫﺎ ﺇﺻﻼﺣﺎﺕ )ﻳﻮﺷﻴﺎ( ﻋـﺎﻡ ‪ ٦٢١‬ﻕ‪.‬ﻡ‪ ٢١،‬ﺇﱃ ﺃﻥ‬ ‫ﰎ ﺗﺪﻣﲑﻫﺎ ﻣﻦ ﻗﺒﻞ ﺍﻟﻜﻠﺪﺍﻧﻴﲔ ﻋﺎﻡ ‪ ٥٨٦‬ﻕ‪.‬ﻡ‪ .‬ﻭﺑﺬﻟﻚ ﺗﻼﺷﺖ ﺁﺛﺎﺭ ﺍﳌﻤﻠﻜﺔ‬ ‫ﺍﻟﱵ ﺃﺳﺴﻬﺎ ﺩﺍﻭﺩ ﻭﺳﻠﻴﻤﺎﻥ‪ ،‬ﻋﻠﻴﻬﻤﺎ ﺍﻟﺴﻼﻡ‪.‬‬ ‫ﺱ ﺷﺪﻳﺪ ﹶﻓﺠﺎ ُﺳﻮﺍ ﺧﻼﻝ ﺍﻟ ّﺪﻳﺎﺭ(‪ :‬ﺍﻟﺪﺍﺭﺱ ﻟﻠﺘﺎﺭﻳﺦ‪،‬‬ ‫)ﻋﺒﺎﺩﹰﺍ ﻟﻨﺎ ﺃﻭﱃ ﺑﺄ ٍ‬ ‫ﻭﺍﳌﺘﺪﺑّﺮ ﻟﻶﻳﺎﺕ ﺍﻟﻜﺮﳝﺔ‪ ،‬ﻳﻼﺣﻆ‪:‬‬ ‫‪ (١‬ﺃ ﹼﻥ ﺍﳉﻮﺱ ﻗﺎﻡ ﺑﻪ ﺍﳌﺼﺮّﻳﻮﻥ‪ ،‬ﻭﺍﻵﺷﻮﺭّﻳﻮﻥ‪ ،‬ﻭﺍﻟﻜﻠﺪﺍﻧﻴّﻮﻥ –ﺍﻟﺒﺎﺑﻠﻴﻮﻥ‬ ‫‪ -‬ﻭﺑﺬﻟﻚ ﻧﻠﺤﻆ ﺩﻗﺔ ﺍﻟﺘﻌﺒﲑ ﺍﻟﻘﺮﺁﱐ‪ " :‬ﻋﺒﺎﺩﹰﺍ " ﻫﻜﺬﺍ ﺑﺎﻟﺘﻨﻜﲑ‪.‬‬ ‫‪ (٢‬ﻛﺎﻧﺖ ﺍﻷﻣﻢ ﺍﻟﺜﻼﺙ ﻗﻮﻳﺔ ﻭﺷﺪﻳﺪﺓ ﺍﻟﺒﺄﺱ‪ ،‬ﻭﲡﺪ ﺫﻟﻚ ﻭﺍﺿﺤﺎ ﰲ‬ ‫ﺍﻟﺮﻭﺍﻳﺎﺕ ﺍﻟﺘﺎﺭﳜﻴﺔ‪.‬‬ ‫‪ (٣‬ﺩﺧﻠﺖ ﺟﻴﻮﺵ ﻫﺬﻩ ﺍﻷﻣﻢ ﺧﻼﻝ ﺍﻟﺪﻳﺎﺭ ﻣﻦ ﻏﲑ ﺗـﺪﻣﲑ ﻟﻜﻴـﺎﻥ‬ ‫ﺍﺠﻤﻟﺘﻤﻊ‪ ،‬ﻭﺃﺑﻘﻮﺍ ﺍﳌﻠﻮﻙ ﰲ ﻋﺮﻭﺷﻬﻢ‪ ،‬ﺣﱴ ﻛﺎﻥ ﺍﳌﻠﻚ )ﻫﻮﺷﻊ(‪ ،‬ﺍﳌﻠﻚ ﺍﻟﺘﺎﺳﻊ‬ ‫ﻋﺸﺮ ﻋﻠﻰ ﳑﻠﻜﺔ ﺇﺳﺮﺍﺋﻴﻞ‪ ،‬ﻓﺰﺍﻟﺖ ﰲ ﻋﻬﺪﻩ ﻋﺎﻡ ‪ ٧٢٢‬ﻕ‪.‬ﻡ‪ .‬ﺃﻣﺎ ﳑﻠﻜﺔ ﻳﻬﻮﺫﺍ‬ ‫ﺻ ْﺪﻗّﻴﺎ(‪ ،‬ﺍﳌﻠﻚ ﺍﻟﺘﺎﺳﻊ ﻋﺸـﺮ ﻋﻠـﻰ‬ ‫ﻓﺰﺍﻟﺖ ﻋﺎﻡ ‪ ٥٨٦‬ﻕ‪.‬ﻡ‪ ،‬ﰲ ﻋﻬﺪ ﺍﳌﻠﻚ ) ِ‬ ‫ﳑﻠﻜﺔ ﻳﻬﻮﺫﺍ‪ ،‬ﻭﺑﺬﻟﻚ ﺍﻧﺘﻬﻰ ﺍﳉﻮﺱ‪ .‬ﻣﻦ ﻫﻨﺎ ﻧﻠﺤﻆ ﺩﻗﺔ ﺍﻟﺘﻌﺒﲑ ﺍﻟﻘﺮﺁﱐ ﰲ ﻗﻮﻟﻪ‬ ‫ﺗﻌﺎﱃ‪ " :‬ﺧﻼﻝ ﺍﻟﺪﻳﺎﺭ "‪.‬‬ ‫‪َ (٤‬ﺗﺼﺎﻋﺪﺕ ﻭﺗﲑﺓ ﺍﻹﻓﺴﺎﺩ ﻭﺗﺼﺎﻋﺪ ﻣﻌﻪ ﺍﳉﻮﺱ‪ ،‬ﺣﱴ ﻛـﺎﻥ ﺍﻷﻭﺝ‬ ‫‪ ٢١‬ﺗﺎﺭﻳﺦ ﺳﻮﺭﻳﺔ ﻭﻟﺒﻨﺎﻥ ﻭﻓﻠﺴﻄﲔ‪ ،‬ﺩ‪ .‬ﻓﻴﻠﻴﺐ ﺣﱵ‪ ،‬ﺗﺮﲨﺔ ﺩ‪ .‬ﺟﻮﺭﺝ ﺣﺪﺍﺩ‪ ،‬ﺩﺍﺭ ﺍﻟﺜﻘﺎﻓﺔ‪ ،‬ﺑﲑﻭﺕ‪ ،‬ﻁ‪ ،٣‬ﺝ‪ ،١‬ﺹ ‪٢١٨‬‬ ‫‪٢٨‬‬ ‫ﻋﺎﻡ ‪ ٧٢٢‬ﻕ‪.‬ﻡ‪ ،‬ﹼﰒ ﻋﺎﻡ ‪ ٥٨٦‬ﻕ‪.‬ﻡ‪ .‬ﻣﻦ ﻫﻨﺎ ﻧﺪﺭﻙ ﺩﹼﻗﺔ ﺍﻟﺘﻌﺒﲑ ﺍﻟﻘﺮﺁﱐ ﰲ ﻗﻮﻟﻪ‬ ‫ﺴﺪ ﱠﻥ ﰲ ﺍﻷﺭﺽ‪ ...‬ﻭﻟﺘﻌﻠ ﱠﻦ ُﻋﻠﻮﹰﺍ ﻛﺒﲑﹰﺍ "‪.‬‬ ‫ﺗﻌﺎﱃ‪ " :‬ﻟُﺘﻔ ِ‬ ‫ﺑﻌﺪ ﺯﻭﺍﻝ ﺍﳌﻤﻠﻜﺘﲔ ﺍﻧﺘﻬﺖ ﺍﳌﺮﺓ ﺍﻷﻭﱃ‪ ،‬ﻟﻜ ّﻦ ﺟﺰﺀﹰﺍ ﻣﻦ ﺍﻟﻴﻬﻮﺩ ﻋﺎﺩﻭﺍ‬ ‫ﺇﱃ ﺍﻷﺭﺽ ﺍﳌﻘﺪّﺳﺔ ﻋﻠﻰ ﻣﺮﺍﺣﻞ‪ ،‬ﻭﺑـﺪﺃﺕ ﻋـﻮﺩﻬﺗﻢ ﰲ ﻋﻬـﺪ )ﻛـﻮﺭﺵ(‬ ‫ﺍﻟﻔﺎﺭﺳﻲ‪ ،‬ﺍﻟﺬﻱ ﺣﺮﺹ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺃﻥ ﻻ ﻳﻘﻴﻢ ﳍﻢ ﺩﻭﻟﺔ‪ ،‬ﰒ ﻛﺎﻥ ﺍﻻﺣﺘﻼﻝ ﺍﻟﻴﻮﻧﺎﱐ‬ ‫ﻋﺎﻡ ‪ ٣٣٣‬ﻕ‪.‬ﻡ‪ ،‬ﰒ ﺍﻷﻧﺒﺎﻁ‪ ،‬ﻓﺎﻟﺮﻭﻣﺎﻥ ﺍﻟﺬﻳﻦ ﺍﺳﺘﻤﺮ ﺍﺣﺘﻼﳍﻢ ﻟﻸﺭﺽ ﺍﳌﻘﺪّﺳﺔ‬ ‫ﺣﱴ ﺍﻟﻌﺎﻡ ‪٦٣٦‬ﻡ‪ ،‬ﺃﻱ ﻋﺎﻡ ﻓﺘﺢ ﻋﻤﺮ ﺑﻦ ﺍﳋﻄﺎﺏ ﻟﻠﻘﺪﺱ‪.‬‬ ‫ﻗﺎﻡ ﺍﻟﻴﻬﻮﺩ ﺍﻟﻌﺎﺋﺪﻭﻥ ﻣﻦ ﺍﻟﺸـﺘﺎﺕ‪ ٢٢‬ﲟﺤـﺎﻭﻻﺕ ﻋـﺪﺓ ﻟﺘﺤﻘﻴـﻖ‬ ‫ﰐ‪ .‬ﻭﻗﺪ ﳒﺤﺖ ﺑﻌﺾ ﻫﺬﻩ ﺍﶈـﺎﻭﻻﺕ‬ ‫ﺍﻻﺳﺘﻘﻼﻝ‪ ،‬ﺃﻭ ﺍﳊﺼﻮﻝ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺣﻜﻢ ﺫﺍ ﹼ‬ ‫ﻟﻔﺘﺮﺓ ﳏﺪﻭﺩﺓ ﺣﱴ ﻛﺎﻥ ﺍﻟﺴﱯ ﻋﻠﻰ ﻳﺪ )ﺗﻴﻄﺲ( ﺍﻟ ّﺮﻭﻣﺎﱐ ﺳﻨﺔ‪٧٠‬ﻡ‪ ،‬ﰒ ﺍﻟﺴﱯ‬ ‫ﺍﻟﺮﻭﻣﺎﱐ ﺍﻷﺧﲑ ﰲ ﻋﻬﺪ )ﻫﺪﺭﻳﺎﻥ( ﻋﺎﻡ ‪١٣٥‬ﻡ‪ .‬ﻭﻗﺪ ﺍﻟﺘـﺒﺲ ﺍﻷﻣـﺮ ﻋﻠـﻰ‬ ‫ﺍﻟﺒﻌﺾ‪ ،‬ﻓﺬﻫﺒﻮﺍ ﺇﱃ ﺍﻟﻘﻮﻝ ﺑﺄ ﹼﻥ ﺍﳌﺮﺓ ﺍﻟﺜﺎﻧﻴﺔ ﻛﺎﻧﺖ ﻋـﺎﻡ ‪٧٠‬ﻡ ﻭ ‪١٣٥‬ﻡ ﻷﻥ‬ ‫ﺍﳍﻴﻜﻞ ﺍﻷﻭﻝ ﺩُﻣﺮ ﻋﺎﻡ ‪ ٥٨٦‬ﻕ‪.‬ﻡ‪ ،‬ﻭ ُﺩﻣّﺮ ﺍﳍﻴﻜﻞ ﺍﻟﺜﺎﱐ ﻋﺎﻡ ‪٧٠‬ﻡ‪ ،‬ﻭﻣُﺤﻴـﺖ‬ ‫ﺁﺛﺎﺭﻩ ﲤﺎﻣﺎ ﻋﺎﻡ ‪١٣٥‬ﻡ‪.‬‬ ‫ﺗﻮﺻﻴﻒ ﺍﻟﺜﺎﻧﻴﺔ‬ ‫ﻼ ﺑـﺎﳌ ّﺮﺓ‬ ‫ﺑﺎﻟﺮﺟﻮﻉ ﺇﱃ ﺍﻟﻨﺺ ﺍﻟﻘﺮﺁﱐ ﻧﻠﺤﻆ ﺃ ﹼﻥ ﻫﻨﺎﻙ ﺗﻌﺮﻳﻔﹰﺎ ﻣﻔﺼّـ ﹰ‬ ‫ﺍﻟﺜﺎﻧﻴﺔ ﻳﺮﻓﻊ ﻛﻞ ﺍﻟﺘﺒﺎﺱ‪ ،‬ﻭﺇﻟﻴﻚ ﺑﻴﺎﻥ ﺫﻟﻚ‪:‬‬ ‫‪٢٢‬‬ ‫ﻭﻫﻢ ﻗﻠﹼﺔ ﻋﻤﻠﺖ ﻋﻠﻰ ﻬﺗﻮﻳﺪ ﺑﻌﺾ ﺍﻟﺴﻜﺎﻥ ﰲ ﺍﻷﺭﺽ ﺍﳌﻘﺪّﺳﺔ ﻟﻴﺘﻜﱠﺜﺮﻭﺍ ﻬﺑﻢ‪ .‬ﻭﳚﺪﺭ ﺍﻟﺘﻨﺒﻴﻪ ﻫﻨﺎ ﺇﱃ ﺃ ﹼﻥ ﺍﻟﻐﺎﻟﺒﻴّﺔ ﺍﻟﻌﻈﻤﻰ‬ ‫ﻣﻦ ﺑﲏ ﺇﺳﺮﺍﺋﻞ ﺫﺍﺑﺖ ﰲ ﺍﻟﺸﻌﻮﺏ ﺍﳌﺨﺘﻠﻔﺔ‪ .‬ﻭﻋﻠﻴﻪ ﻓﺈ ﹼﻥ ﺍﻟﻐﺎﻟﺒﻴّﻪ ﺍﻟﻌﻈﻤﻰ ﻣﻦ ﺑﲏ ﺇﺳﺮﺍﺋﻞ ﺃﺻﺒﺤﻮﺍ ﻣﺴﻠﻤﲔ‪ ،‬ﻭﺍﻟﻨﺴﺒﺔ ﺍﻷﻗﻞ‬ ‫ﻧﺼﺎﺭﻯ‪ ،‬ﻭﺃﻗﻞ ﺍﻟﻘﻠﻴﻞ ﺑﻘﻮﺍ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺍﻟﻴﻬﻮﺩﻳّﺔ‪.‬‬ ‫‪٢٩‬‬ ‫)ﰒ(‪ :‬ﻭﻫﻲ ﻟﻠﺘﺮﺍﺧﻲ ﰲ ﺍﻟﺰﻣﻦ‪ :‬ﺳـﻨﺔ‪ ...‬ﻋﺸـﺮﺍﺕ ﺍﻟﺴـﻨﲔ‪...‬‬ ‫ﺁﻻﻑ‪ ...‬ﻻ ﻧﺪﺭﻱ‪.‬‬ ‫)ﰒ ﺭﺩﺩﻧﺎ ﻟﻜﻢ ﺍﻟﻜﺮﺓ ﻋﻠﻴﻬﻢ(‪ :‬ﺗﻌﺎﺩ ﺍﻟ ّﺪﻭﻟﺔ ﻟﻠﻴﻬﻮﺩ ﻋﻠﻰ ﻣـﻦ ﺃﺯﺍﻝ‬ ‫ﺍﻟﺪﻭﻟﺔ ﺍﻷﻭﱃ‪ ،‬ﻭﱂ ﳛﺼﻞ ﻫﺬﺍ ﰲ ﺍﻟﺘﺎﺭﻳﺦ ﺇﻻ ﻋﺎﻡ ‪١٩٤٨‬ﻡ‪ ،‬ﺇﺫ ُﺭ ّﺩﺕ ﺍﻟﻜـ ّﺮﺓ‬ ‫ﻟﻠﻴﻬﻮﺩ ﻋﻠﻰ ﻣﻦ ﺃﺯﺍﻝ ﺍﻟﺪﻭﻟﺔ ﺍﻷﻭﱃ‪ .‬ﻭﺍﻟﺬﻳﻦ ﺟﺎﺳـﻮﺍ ﰲ ﺍﳌـ ّﺮﺓ ﺍﻷﻭﱃ ﻫـﻢ‬ ‫ﺍﳌﺼﺮﻳﻮﻥ‪ ،‬ﻭﺍﻷﺷﻮﺭﻳﻮﻥ‪ ،‬ﻭﺍﻟﻜﻠﺪﺍﻧﻴﻮﻥ‪ .‬ﺃﻣﺎ ﺍﻟﺘـﺪﻣﲑ ﺍﻟﻨـﻬﺎﺋﻲ ﻓﻜـﺎﻥ ﺑﻴـﺪ‬ ‫ﺐ ﻫﻨﺎ ﺃﻥ ﻳﻌﻠﻢ ﺍﻟﻘﺎﺭﺉ ﺃﻥ ﺍﻵﺷﻮﺭﻳﲔ ﻭﺍﻟﻜﻠﺪﺍﻧﻴﲔ‬ ‫ﺍﻵﺷﻮﺭﻳﲔ ﻭﺍﻟﻜﻠﺪﺍﻧﻴﲔ‪ .‬ﻭﳓ ّ‬ ‫ﻫﻢ ﻗﺒﺎﺋﻞ ﻋﺮﺑﻴﺔ ﻫﺎﺟﺮﺕ ﻣﻦ ﺍﳉﺰﻳﺮﺓ ﺍﻟﻌﺮﺑﻴﺔ ﺇﱃ ﻣﻨﻄﻘﺔ ﺍﻟﻔﺮﺍﺕ‪ ،‬ﰒ ﺍﻧﺴﺎﺣﺖ‬ ‫ﰲ ﺍﻟﺒﻼﺩ‪ ،‬ﺣﱴ ﺳﻴﻄﺮﺕ ﻋﻠﻰ ﻣﺎ ﻳﺴﻤﻰ ﺍﻟﻴﻮﻡ ﺍﻟﻌﺮﺍﻕ ﻭﺳﻮﺭﻳﺎ ﺍﻟﻄﺒﻴﻌﻴﺔ‪ .‬ﻭﻗـﺪ‬ ‫ﺃﺳﻠﻢ ﻣﻌﻈﻢ ﻫﺆﻻﺀ ﻭﺃﺻﺒﺤﻮﺍ ﻣﻦ ﺍﻟﻌﺮﺏ ﺍﳌﺴﻠﻤﲔ‪ ،‬ﻭﻫﺬﺍ ﻣﺎ ﺣﺼـﻞ ﻷﻫـﻞ‬ ‫ﻣﺼﺮ ﺃﻳﻀﹰﺎ‪ .‬ﺃﻣﺎ ﺍﻟﻴﻮﻧﺎﻥ ﻭﺍﻟﺮﻭﻣﺎﻥ‪ ،‬ﻓﻠﻢ ﻳﻜﻦ ﳍﻢ ﻳﺪ ﰲ ﺯﻭﺍﻝ ﺍﻟﺪّﻭﻟـﺔ ﺍﻷﻭﱃ‪،‬‬ ‫ﻭﱂ ﺗُﺮ ّﺩ ﺍﻟﻜﺮﺓ ﻟﻠﻴﻬﻮﺩ ﻋﻠﻴﻬﻢ‪ ،‬ﻭﱂ ﻳﻜﻦ ﺍﻟﻴﻬﻮﺩ ﰲ ﻳﻮ ٍﻡ ﻣﻦ ﺍﻷﻳﺎﻡ ﺃﻛﺜﺮ ﻧﻔـﲑﹰﺍ‬ ‫ﻣﻨﻬﻢ‪ .‬ﺃﻣﺎ ﳒﺎﺡ ﺍﻟﻴﻬﻮﺩ ﰲ ﺍﳊﺼﻮﻝ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺷﻲﺀ ﻣـﻦ ﺍﻻﺳـﺘﻘﻼﻝ ﰲ ﺍﻟﻌﻬـﺪ‬ ‫ﺍﻟﻴﻮﻧﺎﱐ ﻭﺍﻟﺮﻭﻣﺎﱐ‪ ،‬ﻓﻼ ﳝﻜﻦ ﺍﻋﺘﺒﺎﺭﻩ ﺭﺩﹰﺍ ﻟﻠﻜﺮّﺓ‪ ،‬ﻷﻥ ﺍﻟﻴﻮﻧـﺎﻥ ﻭﺍﻟﺮﻭﻣـﺎﻥ ﻻ‬ ‫ﻋﻼﻗﺔ ﳍﻢ ﺑﺎﳉﻮﺱ ﺍﻷﻭﻝ‪ ،‬ﹼﰒ ﺇ ﹼﻥ ﺍﻟﻴﻬﻮﺩ ﺍﺳﺘﻄﺎﻋﻮﺍ ﺃﻥ ﳛﺼﻠﻮﺍ ﻓﻘﻂ ﻋﻠﻰ ﻣـﺎ‬ ‫ﻳﺴﻤﻰ ﺍﻟﻴﻮﻡ ﺑﺎﳊﻜﻢ ﺍﻟﺬﺍﰐ ﻻ ﺃﻛﺜﺮ‪.‬‬ ‫)ﻭﺃﻣﺪﺩﻧﺎﻛﻢ ﺑﺄﻣﻮﺍﻝ(‪ :‬ﻻﺣﻆ ﺇﳛﺎﺀﺍﺕ‪) :‬ﺃﻣﺪﺩﻧﺎﻛﻢ(‪ ،‬ﰒ ﺍﻧﻈﺮ ﻭﺍﻗـﻊ‬ ‫ﺩﻭﻟﺔ ﺇﺳﺮﺍﺋﻴﻞ ﻗﺒﻞ ﻗﻴﺎﻣﻬﺎ‪ ،‬ﻭﺑﻌﺪ ﻗﻴﺎﻣﻬﺎ ﺇﱃ ﻳﻮﻣﻨﺎ ﻫﺬﺍ‪ ،‬ﻓﻘﺪ ﻗﺎﻣﺖ ﻭﺍﺳﺘﻤﺮﺕ‬ ‫ﱄ ﻫﺎﺋﻞ ﻣﻦ ﻗﺒﻞ ﺍﻟﻐﺮﺏ‪ .‬ﻭﻻ ﻧﻈ ّﻦ ﺃﻧّﻨﺎ ﲝﺎﺟﺔ ﺇﱃ ﺍﻟﺘﻔﺼﻴﻞ ﰲ ﻫـﺬﻩ‬ ‫ﺑﺪﻋ ٍﻢ ﻣﺎ ﹼ‬ ‫ﺍﳌﺴﺄﻟﺔ‪ ،‬ﺍﻟﱵ ﻳﻌﺮﻓﻬﺎ ﺍﳉﻤﻴﻊ‪.‬‬ ‫‪٣٠‬‬ ‫)ﻭﺃﻣﺪﺩﻧﺎﻛﻢ ﺑﺄﻣﻮﺍ ٍﻝ ﻭﺑﻨﲔ(‪ :‬ﻗﻮﻟﻪ ﺗﻌﺎﱃ‪) :‬ﻭﺑﻨﲔ( ﻻ ﻳﻌﲏ ﺃﻬﻧـﻢ ﱂ‬ ‫ﻳُﻤ ّﺪﻭﺍ ﺑﺎﻟﺒﻨﺎﺕ‪ ،‬ﻭﻟﻜﻦ ﻻ ﺿﺮﻭﺭﺓ ﻟﻠﻜﻼﻡ ﻋﻦ ﺍﻟﺒﻨﺎﺕ ﰲ ﺍﻟﻮﻗﺖ ﺍﻟﺬﻱ ﻧـﺘﻜﻠﻢ‬ ‫ﻓﻴﻪ ﻋﻦ ﺭﺩ ﺍﻟﻜ ّﺮﺓ‪ ،‬ﻭﻗﻴﺎﻡ ﺍﻟﺪﻭﻟﺔ‪ ،‬ﻭﺣﺎﺟﺔ ﺫﻟﻚ ﺇﱃ ﺍﳉﻴﻮﺵ ﺍﻟﺸﺎﺑﺔ ﺍﳌﻘﺎﺗﻠـﺔ‪.‬‬ ‫ﻭﺭﺩ ﰲ ﻛﺘﺎﺏ )ﺿﺤﺎﻳﺎ ﺍﶈﺮﻗﺔ ﻳّﺘﻬﻤﻮﻥ(‪ ،‬ﻭﺍﻟﺬﻱ ﻗﺎﻡ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺗﺄﻟﻴﻔﻪ ﳎﻤﻮﻋﺔ ﻣـﻦ‬ ‫ﺍﳊﺎﺧﺎﻣﺎﺕ ﺍﻟﻴﻬﻮﺩ‪ ،‬ﺃﻥ ﺣﻜﻮﻣﺔ ﻫﺘﻠﺮ ﻋﺮﺿﺖ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺍﻟﻮﻛﺎﻟﺔ ﺍﻟﻴﻬﻮﺩﻳﺔ ﺃﻥ ﺗﺪﻓﻊ‬ ‫ﺍﻟﻮﻛﺎﻟﺔ ﲬﺴﲔ ﺃﻟﻒ ﺩﻭﻻﺭ ﻣﻘﺎﺑﻞ ﺇﻃﻼﻕ ﺳﺮﺍﺡ ﺛﻼﺛـﲔ ﺃﻟـﻒ ﻳﻬـﻮﺩﻱ‪،‬‬ ‫ﻓﺮﻓﻀﺖ ﺍﻟﻮﻛﺎﻟﺔ ﻫﺬﺍ ﺍﻟﻌﺮﺽ ﻣﻊ ﻋﻠﻤﻬﺎ ﺑﺄﻬﻧﻢ ﺳﻴﻘﺘﻠﻮﻥ‪ .‬ﻭﻳﺮﻯ ﻣﺆﻟﻔﻮ ﺍﻟﻜﺘﺎﺏ‬ ‫ﺃ ﹼﻥ ﺳﺒﺐ ﺍﻟ ّﺮﻓﺾ ﻫﻮ ﻛﻮﻥ ﺍﻟﺜﻼﺛﲔ ﺃﻟﻔﹰﺎ ﻫﻢ ﻣﻦ ﺍﻟﻨﺴﺎﺀ‪ ،‬ﻭﺍﻷﻃﻔﺎﻝ‪ ،‬ﻭﺍﻟﺸﻴﻮﺥ‪،‬‬ ‫ﺍﻟﺬﻳﻦ ﻻ ﻳﺼﻠﺤﻮﻥ ﻟﻠﻘﺘﺎﻝ ﰲ ﻓﻠﺴﻄﲔ؛ ﻓﻘﺪ ﻛﺎﻧﺖ ﺍﻟﻮﻛﺎﻟﺔ ﺍﻟﻴﻬﻮﺩﻳﺔ ﲢـﺮﺹ‬ ‫ﻋﻠﻰ ﻬﺗﺠﲑ ﺍﻟﻌﻨﺎﺻﺮ ﺍﻟﺸﺎﺑﺔ ﺍﻟﻘﺎﺩﺭﺓ ﻋﻠﻰ ﲪﻞ ﺍﻟﺴﻼﺡ‪ ،‬ﺃﻱ ﺍﻟﺒﻨﲔ‪.‬‬ ‫)ﻭﺟﻌﻠﻨﺎﻛﻢ ﺃﻛﺜﺮ ﻧﻔﲑﹰﺍ(‪ :‬ﻭﺍﻟّﻨﻔﲑ‪ ،‬ﻫﻢ ﺍﻟﺬﻳﻦ ﻳﻨﻔﺮﻭﻥ ﺇﱃ ﺃﺭﺽ ﺍﳌﻌﺮﻛﺔ‬ ‫ﻟﻠﻘﺘﺎﻝ‪ .‬ﻭﻋﻠﻰ ﺍﻟﺮﱡﻏﻢ ﻣﻦ ﺃ ﹼﻥ ﺍﻟﻌﺮﺏ ﻛﺎﻧﻮﺍ ﺃﻛﺜﺮ ﻋﺪﺩﹰﺍ ﻋـﺎﻡ ‪١٩٤٨‬ﻡ‪ ،‬ﺇﻻ ﺃ ﹼﻥ‬ ‫ﺍﻟﻴﻬﻮﺩ ﻛﺎﻧﻮﺍ ﺃﻛﺜﺮ ﻧﻔﲑﹰﺍ؛ ﻓﻔﻲ ﺍﻟﻮﻗﺖ ﺍﻟﺬﻱ ﺣﺸﺪ ﻓﻴﻪ ﺍﻟﻌـﺮﺏ )‪ (٢٠‬ﺃﻟﻔـﺎﹰ‪،‬‬ ‫ﺣﺸﺪ ﺍﻟﻴﻬﻮﺩ ﺃﻛﺜﺮ ﻣﻦ ﺛﻼﺛﺔ ﺃﺿﻌﺎﻑ )‪ (٦٧‬ﺃﻟﻔﺎ‪.‬‬ ‫ﺳﺘﺔ ﻋﻨﺎﺻﺮ‬ ‫ﻋﻠﻰ ﺿﻮﺀ ﻣﺎ ﺳﻠﻒ ﻳﻈﻬﺮ ﻟﻨﺎ ﺃ ﹼﻥ ﻫﻨﺎﻙ ﺳﺘﺔ ﻋﻨﺎﺻﺮ ﻟﻘﻴﺎﻡ ﺍﻟﺪﻭﻟﺔ ﺍﻟﺜﺎﻧﻴﺔ‬ ‫ﻭﺍﻷﺧﲑﺓ‪ ،‬ﳒﺪﻫﺎ ﰲ ﺍﻟﻘﺮﺁﻥ ﺍﻟﻜﺮﱘ‪ .‬ﻭﺍﻟﻼﻓﺖ ﺃ ﹼﻥ ﻫﺬﻩ ﺍﻟﻌﻨﺎﺻﺮ ﺗﻨﻄﺒـﻖ ﲤﺎﻣـﹰﺎ‬ ‫ﻋﻠﻰ ﺩﻭﻟﺔ ﺇﺳﺮﺍﺋﻴﻞ ﺍﳌﻌﺎﺻﺮﺓ‪:‬‬ ‫‪ (١‬ﺗﻌﺎﺩ ﺍﻟﻜ ّﺮﺓ ﻭﺍﻟﺪﻭﻟﺔ ﻟﻠﻴﻬﻮﺩ ﻋﻠﻰ ﻣﻦ ﺃﺯﺍﻝ ﺍﻟﺪﻭﻟﺔ ﺍﻷﻭﱃ‪ ،‬ﻭﻫﺬﺍ ﱂ‬ ‫ﳛﺼﻞ ﰲ ﺍﻟﺘﺎﺭﻳﺦ ﺇﻻ ﻋﺎﻡ ‪١٩٤٨‬ﻡ‪ ،‬ﻛﻤﺎ ﺃﺳﻠﻔﻨﺎ‪.‬‬ ‫‪٣١‬‬ ‫‪ُ (٢‬ﺗﻤ ﱡﺪ ﺇﺳﺮﺍﺋﻴﻞ ﺑﺎﳌـﺎﻝ ﺍﻟـﺬﻱ ﻳﺴـﺎﻋﺪﻫﺎ ﻋﻨـﺪ ﻗﻴﺎﻣﻬـﺎ‪ ،‬ﻭﰲ‬ ‫ﻭﺍﺳﺘﻤﺮﺍﺭﻫﺎ‪ ،‬ﻭﻳﻈﻬﺮ ﺫﻟﻚ ﺟﻠﻴﺎ ﺑﺸﻜﻞ ﻻ ﳒﺪ ﻟﻪ ﻣﺜﻴﻼ ﰲ ﺩﻭﻟﺔ ﻏﲑ ﺇﺳﺮﺍﺋﻴﻞ‪.‬‬ ‫‪ُ (٣‬ﺗﻤ ﱡﺪ ﺇﺳﺮﺍﺋﻴﻞ ﺑﺎﻟﻌﻨﺎﺻﺮ ﺍﻟﺸﺎﺑﺔ ﺍﻟﻘﺎﺩﺭﺓ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺑﻨﺎﺀ ﺍﻟﺪﻭﻟﺔ‪ ،‬ﻭﻳﺘﺠﻠﻰ‬ ‫ﺫﻟﻚ ﺑﺎﳍﺠﺮﺍﺕ ﺍﻟﱵ ﺳﺒﻘﺖ ﻗﻴﺎﻡ ﺇﺳﺮﺍﺋﻴﻞ‪ ،‬ﻭﺍﻟﱵ ﺍﺳﺘﻤﺮﺕ ﺣﱴ ﻳﻮﻣﻨﺎ ﻫﺬﺍ‪.‬‬ ‫‪ (٤‬ﻋﻨﺪ ﻗﻴﺎﻡ ﺍﻟ ّﺪﻭﻟﺔ ﺗﻜﻮﻥ ﺃﻋﺪﺍﺩ ﺍﳉﻴﻮﺵ ﺍﻟﱵ ﺗﻌﻤﻞ ﻋﻠﻰ ﻗﻴﺎﻣﻬﺎ ﺃﻛﺜﺮ‬ ‫ﻣﻦ ﺃﻋﺪﺍﺩ ﺍﳉﻴﻮﺵ ﺍﳌﻘﺎﺑﻠﺔ‪ .‬ﻭﻗﺪ ﻇﻬﺮ ﺫﻟﻚ ﺟﻠﻴﺎ ﻋﺎﻡ ‪١٩٤٨‬ﻡ‪ ،‬ﻋﻠﻰ ﺍﻟ ﱡﺮﻏﻢ ﻣﻦ‬ ‫ﺃ ﹼﻥ ﺃﻋﺪﺍﺩ ﺍﻟﺸﻌﻮﺏ ﺍﻟﻌﺮﺑﻴّﺔ ﺗﺘﻔﻮﻕ ﻛﺜﲑﹰﺍ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺃﻋﺪﺍﺩ ﺍﻟﻴﻬﻮﺩ‪ ،‬ﻭﻣﻦ ﺍﳌﻔﺘﺮﺽ ﻋﻠﻰ‬ ‫ﺿﻮﺀ ﺫﻟﻚ ﺃ ﹼﻥ ﺗﻜﻮﻥ ﺃﻋﺪﺍﺩ ﺍﳉﻴﻮﺵ ﺍﻟﻌﺮﺑﻴّﺔ ﺃﻛﺜﺮ ﻣﻦ ﺫﻟﻚ ﺑﻜﺜﲑ‪.‬‬ ‫‪ (٥‬ﻳُﺠ َﻤﻊ ﺍﻟﻴﻬﻮ ُﺩ ﻣﻦ ﺍﻟﺸﺘﺎﺕ ﻟﺘﺤﻘﻴﻖ ﻭﻋﺪ ﺍﻵﺧﺮﺓ‪ .‬ﻭﻫـﺬﺍ ﻇـﺎﻫﺮ‬ ‫ﻟﻠﺠﻤﻴﻊ‪ ،‬ﻭﻳﺴﺘﻔﺎﺩ ﺫﻟﻚ ﻣﻦ ﻗﻮﻟﻪ ﺗﻌﺎﱃ‪ِ ..." :‬ﺟﺌﻨﺎ ﺑﻜﻢ‪.٢٣"...‬‬ ‫ﱴ‪ ،‬ﻋﻠﻰ‬ ‫‪ (٦‬ﻋﻨﺪﻣﺎ ﻳُﺠ َﻤ ُﻊ ﺍﻟﻴﻬﻮﺩ ﻣﻦ ﺍﻟﺸﺘﺎﺕ ﻳﻜﻮﻧﻮﻥ ﻣﻦ ﺃﺻﻮ ٍﻝ ﺷ ّ‬ ‫ﺧﻼﻑ ﺍﳌ ّﺮﺓ ﺍﻷﻭﱃ؛ ﻓﻘﺪ ﻛﺎﻧﻮﺍ ﲨﻴﻌﺎ ﻳﻨﺘﻤﻮﻥ ﺇﱃ ﺃﺻﻞ ﻭﺍﺣـﺪ‪ ،‬ﺃﻻ ﻭﻫـﻮ‬ ‫ﻳﻌﻘﻮﺏ ﻋﻠﻴﻪ ﺍﻟﺴﻼﻡ‪ .‬ﺃ ّﻣﺎ ﺍﻟﻴﻮﻡ ﻓﺈﻧﻨﺎ ﳒﺪ ﺃ ﹼﻥ ﺍﻹﺳـﺮﺍﺋﻴﻠﻴﲔ ﻳﻨﺘﻤـﻮﻥ ﺇﱃ ‪٧٠‬‬ ‫ﻗﻮﻣّﻴﺔ‪ ،‬ﺑﻞ ﺃﻛﺜﺮ‪ .‬ﻭﻳﺴﺘﻔﺎﺩ ﺫﻟﻚ ﻣﻦ ﻗﻮﻟﻪ ﺗﻌﺎﱃ‪ " :‬ﺟﺌﻨﺎ ﺑﻜﻢ ﻟﻔﻴﻔﹰﺎ "‪.‬‬ ‫ﺍﻧﻈﺮ ﻫﺬﻩ ﺍﻟﻌﻨﺎﺻﺮ ﺍﻟﺴﺘﺔ‪ ،‬ﻫﻞ ﲡﺪ ﻫﻨﺎﻙ ﻋﻨﺼﺮﹰﺍ ﺳﺎﺑﻌﹰﺎ ﳝﻜﻦ ﺇﺿﺎﻓﺘﻪ‪،‬‬ ‫ﻭﻫﻞ ﻫﻨﺎﻙ ﻋﻨﺼﺮ ﺯﺍﺋﺪ ﳝﻜﻦ ﺇﺳﻘﺎﻃﻪ ؟! ﻭﺑﺬﻟﻚ ﻳﻜﻮﻥ ﺗﻌﺮﻳﻒ ﺍﳌﺮّﺓ ﺍﻟﺜﺎﻧﻴـﺔ‬ ‫ﺟﺎﻣﻌﺎﹰ ﻛﻤﺎ ﻳﻘﻮﻝ ﺃﻫﻞ ﺍﻷﺻﻮﻝ‪ .‬ﻭﻋﻠﻴﻪ ﻣﻦ ﺃﺭﺍﺩ ﺃﻥ ﻳﻘﻮﻝ ﺇ ﹼﻥ ﻭﻋﺪ ﺍﻵﺧﺮﺓ ﻗﺪ‬ ‫ﲢﻘﹼﻖ ﻗﺒﻞ ﺍﻹﺳﻼﻡ‪ ،‬ﻓﻌﻠﻴﻪ ﺃﻥ ﻳُﺒﻴّﻦ ﻟﻨﺎ ﻣﱴ ﺗﻮﺍﻓﺮﺕ ﻫﺬﻩ ﺍﻟﻌﻨﺎﺻﺮ ﻗﺒﻞ ﻫﺬﻩ ﺍﳌﺮﺓ‪.‬‬ ‫‪ ٢٣‬ﻳﺄﰐ ﺑﻴﺎﻥ ﺫﻟﻚ ﺑﻌﺪ ﺃﺳﻄﺮ‪.‬‬ ‫‪٣٢‬‬ ‫ﻭﻋﺪ ﺍﻵﺧﺮﺓ‬ ‫ﱂ ﻳﺮﺩ ﺗﻌﺒﲑ ‪ " :‬ﻭﻋﺪ ﺍﻵﺧﺮﺓ " ﰲ ﺍﻟﻘـﺮﺍﻥ ﺍﻟﻜـﺮﱘ ﺇﻻ ﰲ ﺳـﻮﺭﺓ‬ ‫ﺍﻹﺳﺮﺍﺀ‪ ،‬ﰲ ﺍﻵﻳﺔ ‪ ،٧‬ﻭﺍﻵﻳﺔ ‪ .١٠٤‬ﻭﺍﳊﺪﻳﺚ ﰲ ﺍﻵﻳﺘﲔ ﻋﻦ ﺑﲏ ﺇﺳـﺮﺍﺋﻴﻞ‪:‬‬ ‫"ﻓﺈﺫﺍ ﺟﺎﺀ ﻭﻋ ُﺪ ﺍﻵﺧﺮﺓِ ﻟُﻴﺴﻮﺀﻭﺍ ﻭﺟﻮﻫﻜﻢ"‪" ،‬ﻓﺈﺫﺍ ﺟﺎﺀ َﻭ ْﻋﺪُ ﺍﻵﺧﺮﺓِ ِﺟﺌﹾﻨﺎ‬ ‫ﺑِﻜﻢ ﻟﻔﻴﻔﺎ"‪ .‬ﰲ ﺑﺪﺍﻳﺔ ﺳﻮﺭﺓ ﺍﻹﺳﺮﺍﺀ ﹼﰎ ﺗﻔﺼﻴﻞ ﺍﳊﺪﻳﺚ ﺣﻮﻝ ﺍﻹﻓﺴﺎﺩﻳﻦ‪ .‬ﻭﰲ‬ ‫ﺧﻮﺍﺗﻴﻢ ﺳﻮﺭﺓ ﺍﻹﺳﺮﺍﺀ ﹼﰎ ﺇﲨﺎﻝ ﺍﳊﺪﻳﺚ ﻋﻦ ﺍﳌﺮﺗﲔ "ﻓﺄﺭﺍ َﺩ ﺃ ﹾﻥ َﻳﺴﺘ ِﻔ ﱠﺰﻫﻢ ﻣﻦ‬ ‫ﺍﻷﺭﺽ ﻓﺄﻏﺮﻗﻨﺎ ُﻩ ﻭﻣﻦ ﻣﻌﻪُ ﲨﻴﻌﹰﺎ‪ ،‬ﻭﻗﻠﻨﺎ ﻣﻦ ﺑﻌﺪﻩ ﻟﺒﲏ ﺇﺳـﺮﺍﺋﻴ ﹶﻞ ﺍﺳـﻜﻨﻮﺍ‬ ‫ﺍﻷﺭﺽ ﻓﺈﺫﺍ ﺟﺎ َﺀ َﻭﻋ ُﺪ ﺍﻵﺧﺮﺓِ ﺟﺌﻨﺎ ﺑﻜﻢ ﹶﻟﻔﻴﻔﺎ" ﺃﻱ ﻗﻠﻨﺎ‪ ،‬ﻣﻦ ﺑﻌـﺪ ﻏـﺮﻕ‬ ‫ﻓﺮﻋﻮﻥ‪ ،‬ﻟﺒﲏ ﺇﺳﺮﺍﺋﻴﻞ‪ :‬ﺍﺳﻜﻨﻮﺍ ﺍﻷﺭﺽ ﺍﳌﻘﺪّﺳﺔ‪ .‬ﻭﺑﺬﻟﻚ ﻳﺘﺤ ﹼﻘﻖ ﻭﻋ ُﺪ ﺍﻷﻭﱃ‪.‬‬ ‫ﻭﻗﺪ ﻛﺎﻥ ﺍﻟﻘﻀﺎ ُﺀ ﲝﺼﻮﻝ ﺍﳌ ّﺮﺗﲔ ﺑﻌﺪ ﺧﺮﻭﺝ ﺑﲏ ﺇﺳﺮﺍﺋﻴﻞ ﻣﻦ ﻣﺼﺮ‪ .‬ﻭﺃﻣّﺎ ﻗﻮﻟﻪ‬ ‫ﺗﻌﺎﱃ‪) :‬ﻓﺈﺫﺍ ﺟﺎ َﺀ ﻭﻋ ُﺪ ﺍﻵﺧﺮﺓِ ﺟﺌﻨﺎ ﺑﻜﻢ ﹶﻟﻔﻴﻔﹰﺎ(‪ ،‬ﻓﺈﻧّﻪ ﻳﺸﲑ ﺇﱃ ﺃﻥ ﺍﻟﻴﻬﻮﺩ ﺑﲔ‬ ‫ﺸﺘﺎﺕ‪ ،‬ﺑﺪﻟﻴﻞ‬ ‫ﻭﻗﻮﻉ ﺍﳌﺮّﺓ ﺍﻷﻭﱃ‪ ،‬ﻭﻭﻗﻮﻉ ﺍﳌﺮّﺓ ﺍﻟﺜﺎﻧﻴﺔ ﻭﺍﻵﺧﲑﺓ‪ ،‬ﻳﻜﻮﻧﻮﻥ ﰲ ﺍﻟ ّ‬ ‫ﻗﻮﻟﻪ ﺗﻌﺎﱃ‪) :‬ﺟﺌﻨﺎ ﺑﻜﻢ(‪ .‬ﻭﻣﻦ ﻫﺬﻩ ﺍﻵﻳﺔ ﹼﰎ ﺍﺳـﺘﻨﺒﺎﻁ ﺍﻟﻌﻨﺼـﺮ ﺍﳋـﺎﻣﺲ‬ ‫ﻭﺍﻟﺴﺎﺩﺱ‪ ،‬ﻭﺍﳌﻌﲎ‪ :‬ﻋﻨﺪﻣﺎ ﻳﺄﰐ ﺯﻣﻦ ﻭﻋﺪ ﺍﳌﺮّﺓ ﺍﻷﺧﲑﺓ ﳒﻤﻌﻜﻢ ﻣﻦ ﺍﻟﺸﺘﺎﺕ‪،‬‬ ‫ﱴ‪ .‬ﺃ ّﻣﺎ ﻗﻮﻟﻨﺎ ﺇﻥ ﺍﻷﺭﺽ ﻫـﻲ ﺍﻷﺭﺽ‬ ‫ﰲ ﺣﺎﻟﺔ ﻛﻮﻧﻜﻢ ﻣﻨﺘﻤﲔ ﺇﱃ ﺃﺻﻮﻝ َﺷ ّ‬ ‫ﺍﳌﻘﺪّﺳﺔ ﺍﳌﺒﺎﺭﻛﺔ‪ ،‬ﻓﻴﻈﻬﺮ ﺫﻟﻚ ﺟﻠﻴﺎ ﰲ ﺍﻵﻳﺘﲔ‪ (١٣٧،١٣٦) :‬ﻣـﻦ ﺳـﻮﺭﺓ‬ ‫ﺍﻷﻋﺮﺍﻑ‪ " :‬ﻓﺎﻧﺘﻘﻤﻨﺎ ﻣﻨﻬﻢ ﻓﺄﻏﺮﻗﻨﺎﻫﻢ ﰲ ﺍﻟﻴ ﱢﻢ ﺑﺄﻬﻧﻢ ﻛ ﱠﺬﺑﻮﺍ ﺑﺂﻳﺘﻨـﺎ ﻭﻛـﺎﻧﻮﺍ‬ ‫ﻕ ﺍﻷﺭﺽ‬ ‫ﻋﻨﻬﺎ ﻏﺎﻓﻠﲔ‪ ،‬ﻭﺃﻭﺭﺛﻨﺎ ﺍﻟﻘﻮ َﻡ ﺍﻟﺬﻳﻦ ﻛﺎﻧﻮﺍ ﻳُﺴﺘﻀـﻌﻔﻮﻥﹶ ﻣﺸـﺎﺭ َ‬ ‫‪٣٣‬‬ ‫ﻭﻣﻐﺎﺭﻬﺑﺎ ﺍﻟﱵ ﺑﺎﺭﻛﻨﺎ ﻓﻴﻬﺎ‪ (..‬ﻣﻦ ﻫﻨﺎ ﳝﻜﻦ ﺃﻥ ﻧﻮﻇﻒ ﺍﻟﺘﺎﺭﻳﺦ ﻟﺘﺤﺪﻳﺪ ﺍﻷﺭﺽ‬ ‫ﺍﳌﺒﺎﺭﻛﺔ ﺷﺮﻗﹰﺎ ﻭﻏﺮﺑﹰﺎ‪ .‬ﻭﺍﳌﻌﺮﻭﻑ ﺃ ﹼﻥ ﺑﲏ ﺇﺳﺮﺍﺋﻴﻞ ﻗـﺪ ﺳـﻜﻨﻮﺍ ﻭﺍﺳـﺘﻮﻃﻨﻮﺍ‬ ‫ﻓﻠﺴﻄﲔ‪ ،‬ﻭﺍﻟﱵ ﺑﻮﺭﻛﺖ ﰲ ﺍﻟﻘﺮﺁﻥ ﺍﻟﻜﺮﱘ ﲬﺲ ﻣﺮﺍﺕ‪ ،‬ﻭﹸﻗﺪﱢﺳﺖ ﻣ ّﺮﺓ ﻭﺍﺣﺪﺓ‪:‬‬ ‫‪ ..." (١‬ﻣﺸﺎﺭﻕ ﺍﻷﺭﺽ ﻭﻣﻐﺎﺭﻬﺑﺎ ﺍﻟﱵ ﺑﺎﺭﻛﻨﺎ ﻓﻴﻬﺎ‪] ."..‬ﺍﻷﻋﺮﺍﻑ‪[١٣٧ :‬‬ ‫‪ ..." (٢‬ﺇﱃ ﺍﳌﺴﺠ ِﺪ ﺍﻷﻗﺼﺎ ﺍﻟﺬﻱ ﺑﺎﺭﻛﻨﺎﺣﻮﻟ ُﻪ‪] . "...‬ﺍﻹﺳﺮﺍﺀ‪[ ١ :‬‬ ‫‪ " (٣‬ﻭﳒﻴﻨﺎﻩ ﻭﻟﻮﻃﹰﺎ ﺇﱃ ﺍﻷﺭﺽ ﺍﻟﱵ ﺑﺎﺭﻛﻨﺎ ﻓﻴﻬﺎ ﻟﻠﻌﺎﳌﲔ "‪] .‬ﺍﻷﻧﺒﻴﺎﺀ‪[٧١ :‬‬ ‫‪..." (٤‬ﲡﺮﻱ ﺑِﺄﻣﺮ ِﻩ ﺇﱃ ﺍﻷﺭﺽ ﺍﻟﱵ ﺑﺎﺭﻛﻨﺎ ﻓﻴﻬﺎ‪] ."...‬ﺍﻷﻧﺒﻴﺎﺀ‪[ ٨١ :‬‬ ‫ﻯ ﻇﺎﻫﺮ ﹰﺓ‪ ] ."...‬ﺳﺒﺄ‪[١٨:‬‬ ‫‪ .. " (٥‬ﺑﻴﻨﻬﻢ ﻭﺑﲔ ﺍﻟﻘﺮﻯ ﺍﻟﱵ ﺑﺎﺭﻛﻨﺎ ﻓﻴﻬﺎ ﻗﺮ ً‬ ‫‪ " (٦‬ﻳﺎ ﻗﻮﻡ ﺍﺩﺧﻠﻮﺍ ﺍﻷﺭﺽ ﺍﳌﻘﺪﺳ ﹶﺔ‪] ."...‬ﺍﳌﺎﺋﺪﺓ‪[٢١:‬‬ ‫ﺗﺘﺤﺪﺙ ﺍﻵﻳﺔ ﺍﻷﻭﱃ ﻋﻦ ﺍﻷﺭﺽ ﺍﻟﱵ ﺳﻜﻨﻬﺎ ﺑﻨـﻮ ﺇﺳـﺮﺍﺋﻴﻞ ﺑﻌـﺪ‬ ‫ﺇﺧﺮﺍﺟﻬﻢ ﻣﻦ ﻣﺼﺮ ﻭ ﹶﻏﺮَﻕ ﻓﺮﻋﻮﻥ‪ ،‬ﻭﻫﻲ ﺍﻷﺭﺽ ﺍﳌﻘ ّﺪﺳﺔ ﺍﻟﱵ ﻭُﻋِـﺪﻭﺍ ﺑـﺄﻥ‬ ‫ﻳﺪﺧﻠﻮﻫﺎ‪ ،‬ﻛﻤﺎ ﺟﺎﺀ ﰲ ﺍﻵﻳﺔ ‪ ٢١‬ﻣﻦ ﺳﻮﺭﺓ ﺍﳌﺎﺋﺪﺓ‪ .‬ﻭﻣﻌﻠـﻮﻡٌ ﺃ ﹼﻥ ﺍﳌﺴـﺠﺪ‬ ‫ﺍﻷﻗﺼﻰ ﺍﻟﺬﻱ ﺗﺘﺤﺪﺙ ﻋﻨﻪ ﺁﻳﺔ ﺳﻮﺭﺓ ﺍﻹﺳﺮﺍﺀ ﻣﻮﺟﻮﺩ ﰲ ﻓﻠﺴﻄﲔ‪ .‬ﺃﻣّﺎ ﺍﻵﻳﺔ‬ ‫‪ ٧١‬ﻣﻦ ﺳﻮﺭﺓ ﺍﻷﻧﺒﻴﺎﺀ ﻓﺘﺘﺤﺪﺙ ﻋﻦ ﳒﺎﺓ ﺇﺑﺮﺍﻫﻴﻢ ﻭﻟﻮﻁ‪ ،‬ﻋﻠﻴﻬﻤﺎ ﺍﻟﺴﻼﻡ‪ ،‬ﺇﱃ‬ ‫ﺍﻷﺭﺽ ﺍﳌﺒﺎﺭﻛﺔ‪ .‬ﻭﳚﺘﻤﻊ ﺃﻫﻞ ﺍﻟﺘﺎﺭﻳﺦ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺍﻟﻘﻮﻝ ﺑﺄ ﹼﻥ ﺇﺑﺮﺍﻫﻴﻢ ﻭﻟﻮﻃﹰﺎ‪ ،‬ﻋﻠﻴﻬﻤﺎ‬ ‫ﺴﻼﻡ‪ ،‬ﻗﺪ ﻫﺎﺟﺮﺍ ﺇﱃ ﻓﻠﺴﻄﲔ‪ ،‬ﺑﻞ ﺇ ﹼﻥ ﺇﺑﺮﺍﻫﻴﻢ‪ ،‬ﻋﻠﻴﻪ ﺍﻟﺴـﻼﻡ‪ ،‬ﻣـﺪﻓﻮﻥ ﰲ‬ ‫ﺍﻟ ّ‬ ‫ﻣﺪﻳﻨﺔ ﺍﳋﻠﻴﻞ‪ .‬ﻭﺍﻵﻳﺔ ‪ ٨١‬ﻣﻦ ﺳﻮﺭﺓ ﺍﻷﻧﺒﻴﺎﺀ ﺗﺘﺤﺪﺙ ﻋـﻦ ﺳـﻠﻴﻤﺎﻥ‪ ،‬ﻋﻠﻴـﻪ‬ ‫ﺍﻟﺴﻼﻡ‪ ،‬ﻭﻣﻌﻠﻮﻡ ﺃﻥ ﳑﻠﻜﺘﻪ ﻛﺎﻧﺖ ﺍﺑﺘﺪﺍ ًﺀ ﰲ ﻓﻠﺴﻄﲔ‪ .‬ﺃﻣّﺎ ﺍﻵﻳﺔ ‪ ١٨‬ﻣﻦ ﺳﻮﺭﺓ‬ ‫ﺳﺒﺄ ﻓﺘﺘﺤﺪﺙ ﻋﻦ ﺍﻟﻌﻼﻗﺔ ﺑﲔ ﳑﻠﻜﺔ ﺳﺒﺄ ﻭﳑﻠﻜﺔ ﺳﻠﻴﻤﺎﻥ‪ ،‬ﻋﻠﻴـﻪ ﺍﻟﺴـﻼﻡ‪،‬‬ ‫ﻭﻣﻌﻠﻮﻡ ﺃﻥ ﳑﻠﻜﺘﻪ‪ ،‬ﻋﻠﻴﻪ ﺍﻟﺴﻼﻡ‪ ،‬ﺗﻌ ّﺪﺕ ﰲ ﺍﺗﺴﺎﻋﻬﺎ ﺣﺪﻭﺩ ﻓﻠﺴﻄﲔ ﺍﳌﻌﺎﺻﺮﺓ‪.‬‬ ‫‪٣٤‬‬ ‫ﻭﺇﻥ ﻛﺎﻧﺖ ﻓﻠﺴﻄﲔ ﺗﺸﻜﹼﻞ ﺍﳉﺰﺀ ﺍﻷﺳﺎﺱ ﻭﺍﻟﺮﺋﻴﺲ ﰲ ﳑﻠﻜﺘﻪ‪.‬‬ ‫) ﺇﻥ ﺃﺣﺴﻨﺘﻢ ﺃﺣﺴﻨﺘﻢ ﻷﻧﻔﺴﻜﻢ ﻭﺇﻥ ﺃﺳﺄﺗُﻢ ﻓﻠﻬﺎ (‪َ :‬ﻭﻋْﻆ ﳛﻤـﻞ‬ ‫ﻣﻌﲎ ﺍﻟﺘﻬﺪﻳﺪ‪.‬‬ ‫) ﻓﺈﺫﺍ ﺟﺎﺀ ﻭﻋ ُﺪ ﺍﻵﺧﺮﺓ (‪ :‬ﺇﺫﺍ ﻭﻗﻊ ﺍﻹﻓﺴﺎﺩ ﺍﻟﺜﺎﱐ‪ ،‬ﻭﺣﺼﻞ ﻣـﻦ‬ ‫ﺍﻟﻴﻬﻮﺩ ﺍﻟﻌﻠﻮ ﻭﺍﻟﻄﻐﻴﺎﻥ‪ ،‬ﻋﻨﺪﻫﺎ ﺳﺘﻜﻮﻥ ﺍﻟﻌﻘﻮﺑﺔ‪ ) :‬ﻟﻴﺴﻮﺀﻭﺍ ﻭﺟﻮﻫﻜﻢ‪.( ...‬‬ ‫ﻭﰲ ﻭﻋﺪ ﺃﹸﻭﻻﳘﺎ ﻛﺎﻥ ﺟﻮﺍﺏ )ﺇﺫﺍ( ﻫﻮ )ﺑﻌﺜﻨﺎ(‪ ،‬ﻓﺄﻳﻦ ﺟﻮﺍﺏ )ﺇﺫﺍ( ﰲ ﻭﻋـﺪ‬ ‫ﺍﻵﺧﺮﺓ ؟ﻧﻘﻮﻝ‪ :‬ﻫﻮ ﺃﻳﻀﹰﺎ )ﺑﻌﺜﻨﺎ( ﻭﺍﳌﻌﲎ‪ :‬ﻓﺈﺫﺍ ﺟﺎﺀ ﻭﻋﺪ ﺍﻟﺜﺎﻧﻴـﺔ ﻭﺍﻷﺧـﲑﺓ‬ ‫ﺑﻌﺜﻨﺎﻫﻢ ﻟﺘﺤﻘﻴﻖ ﺃﻣﻮﺭ ﺛﻼﺛﺔ‪ :‬ﻟﻴﺴﻮﺀﻭﺍ‪ ...‬ﻭﻟﻴﺪﺧﻠﻮﺍ‪ ...‬ﻭﻟﻴﺘﱪﻭﺍ‪.‬‬ ‫) ﻟﻴﺴﻮﺀﻭﺍ ﻭﺟﻮﻫﻜﻢ (‪ :‬ﺃﻱ ﻳُﻠﺤﻘﻮﺍ ﺍﻟﻌﺎﺭ ﺑﻜﻢ‪ ،‬ﺃﻭ ﻳُﺴﻴﺌﻮﺍ ﺇﻟـﻴﻜﻢ‬ ‫ﺇﺳﺎﺀﺓ ﺗَﻈﹾﻬﺮ ﺁﺛﺎﺭﻫﺎ ﰲ ﻭﺟﻮﻫﻜﻢ‪ .‬ﻭﻗﺪ ﻳﻜﻮﻥ ﺍﳌﻘﺼﻮﺩ ﺗﺪﻣﲑ ﺻﻮﺭﻬﺗﻢ ﺍﻟـﱵ‬ ‫ﺻﻨﻌﻮﻫﺎ ﻋﱪ ﺍﻹﻋﻼﻡ ﺍﳌﺰّﻳﻒ‪ ،‬ﲝﻴﺚ ﺗﺘﺠﻠﻰ ﺻﻮﺭﻬﺗﻢ ﺍﳊﻘﻴﻘﻴﺔ‪ ،‬ﻭﻳﻠﺤﻘﻬﻢ ﺍﻟﻌﺎﺭ‪،‬‬ ‫ﻭﺗﻨﻜﺸﻒ ﻋﻮﺭﺍﻬﺗﻢ ﺃﻣﺎﻡ ﺍﻷﻣﻢ‪ ،‬ﺍﻟﱵ ﺧُﺪﻋﺖ ﻬﺑﻢ ﺳﻨﲔ ﻃﻮﻳﻠﺔ‪ .‬ﻭﻫﺬﺍ ﻳﻜـﻮﻥ‬ ‫ﺑﻔﻌﻞ ﺍﻟﻌﺒﺎﺩ ﺍﻟﺬﻳﻦ ﻳﺒﻌﺜﻬﻢ ﺍﷲ ﻟﺘﺤﻘﻴﻖ ﻭﻋﺪ ﺍﻵﺧﺮﺓ‪.‬‬ ‫) َﻭِﻟَﻴ ْﺪﺧُﻠﻮﺍ ﺍﳌﺴﺠ َﺪ (‪ :‬ﺍﳌﻘﺼﻮﺩ ﺍﳌﺴﺠﺪ ﺍﻷﻗﺼﻰ‪ ،‬ﻭﺍﻟﺬﻱ ﺑُﲏ ﺑﻌـﺪ‬ ‫ﺍﳌﺴﺠﺪ ﺍﳊﺮﺍﻡ ﺑﺄﺭﺑﻌﲔ ﺳﻨﺔ‪ ،‬ﻭﻓﻖ ﻣﺎ ﺟﺎﺀ ﰲ ﺍﳊﺪﻳﺚ ﺍﻟﺼﺤﻴﺢ‪.‬‬ ‫) ﻛﻤﺎ ﺩﺧﻠﻮ ُﻩ ﺃﻭ ﹶﻝ ﻣﺮ ٍﺓ (‪ :‬ﺗﻜﻮﻥ ﻬﻧﺎﻳﺔ ﻛﻞ ﻣ ّﺮﺓ ﺑﺪﺧﻮﻝ ﺍﳌﺴـﺠﺪ‬ ‫ﺍﻷﻗﺼﻰ‪ ،‬ﻭﺳﺒﻖ ﺃﻥ ﺑﻴﻨﺎ ﺃﻥ ﻬﻧﺎﻳﺔ ﺍﳌﺮﺓ ﺍﻷﻭﱃ ﻛﺎﻧﺖ ﻋﺎﻡ ‪ ٥٨٦‬ﻕ‪.‬ﻡ‪ ،‬ﺇﺫ ُﺩﻣّﺮﺕ‬ ‫ﺩﻭﻟﺔ ﻳﻬﻮﺫﺍ‪ ،‬ﻭﺳﻘﻄﺖ ﺍﻟﻘﺪﺱ ﰲ ﺃﻳﺪﻱ ﺍﻟﻜﻠﺪﺍﻧﻴﲔ‪ .‬ﺃﻣﺎ ﺍﻟﻴـﻮﻡ ﻓﻘـﺪ ﺍﲣـﺬ‬ ‫ﺍﻹﺳﺮﺍﺋﻴﻠﻴﻮﻥ ﺍﻟﻘﺪﺱ ﻋﺎﺻﻤﺔ ﳍﻢ‪ ،‬ﻭﻻ ﺷﻚ ﺃﻥ ﺳﻘﻮﻁ ﺍﻟﻌﺎﺻﻤﺔ‪ ،‬ﻭﺍﻟﱵ ﻫـﻲ‬ ‫ﺙ ﰲ ﺍﳌﺮﺓ ﺍﻟﺜﺎﻧﻴﺔ‪ ،‬ﻭﺍﻟﱵ ﻭﺻﻔﺘﻬﺎ ﺍﻵﻳﺘﺎﻥ ﺑـ‬ ‫ﺭﻣﺰ ﺍﻟﺼﺮﺍﻉ‪ ،‬ﺳﻴﻜﻮﻥ ﺃﻋﻈﻢ ﺣﺪ ٍ‬ ‫‪٣٥‬‬ ‫)ﺍﻵﺧﺮﺓ(‪ ،‬ﳑﺎ ﻳﺸﲑ ﺇﱃ ﺃﻧّﻬﺎ ﺍﻷﺧﲑﺓ‪ .‬ﻭﻫﺬﺍ ﳑﺎ ﻳﻌﺰﺯ ﻗﻮﻟﻨﺎ‪ :‬ﺇ ﹼﻥ ﻫﺬﻩ ﻫﻲ ﺍﳌـﺮّﺓ‬ ‫ﺍﻟﺜﺎﻧﻴﺔ‪ ،‬ﺇﺫ ﻻ ﺛﺎﻟﺜﺔ‪ ،‬ﻭﻗﺪ ﺳﺒﻘﺖ ﺍﻷﻭﱃ‪.‬‬ ‫) ﻭﻟﻴﺘﱪﻭﺍ ﻣﺎ ﻋﻠﻮﺍ ﺗﺘﺒﲑﺍ ً(‪ :‬ﻳُﺪ ّﻣﺮﻭﻥ‪ ،‬ﻭﻳُﻬﻠﻜﻮﻥ‪ ،‬ﻭُﻳﻔﹶﺘﺘﻮﻥ ﻛﻞ ﻣـﺎ‬ ‫ﻕ‪٤‬ﻳﺴﻴﻄﺮﻭﻥ ﻋﻠﻴﻪ‪ ،‬ﺇﻫﻼﻛﺎ‪ ،‬ﻭﺗﺪﻣﲑﺍ‪ ،‬ﻭﺗﻔﺘﻴﺘﹰﺎ‪ .‬ﻭﺫﻟﻚ ﻳﻮﺣﻲ ﺑـﺄ ﹼﻥ ﺍﳌﻘﺎﻭﻣـﺔ‬ ‫ﺳﺘﻜﻮﻥ ﺷﺪﻳﺪﺓ‪ ،‬ﺗﺆ ّﺩﻱ ﺇﱃ ﺭﺩ ﻓﻌﻞ ﺃﺷﺪ‪ .‬ﻭ )ﻣﺎ( ﺗﺪﻝ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺍﻟﺸﻤﻮﻝ‪ ،‬ﻭﻫـﻲ‬ ‫ﻫﻨﺎ ﲟﻌﲎ )ﻛﻞ(‪ .‬ﻭﺍﻟﻀﻤﲑ ﰲ ) َﻋ ﹶﻠﻮْﺍ( ﻳﺮﺟﻊ ﺇﱃ ﺃﻋﺪﺍﺀ ﺑﲏ ﺇﺳﺮﺍﺋﻴﻞ‪ .‬ﻭﳚﺐ ﺃ ﹾﻥ‬ ‫ﻻ ﻧﻨﺴﻰ ﳊﻈﺔ ﺃ ﹼﻥ ﺍﳌﺨﺎﻃﹶﺐ ﰲ ﻫﺬﻩ ﺍﻟﻨﺒﻮﺀﺓ ﻫﻢ ﺍﻟﻴﻬـﻮﺩ‪ ) :‬ﻟﺘﻔﺴـ ُﺪ ﹼﻥ‪...‬‬ ‫ﻭﻟﺘﻌﻠﹸ ّﻦ‪ ...‬ﻋﻠﻴﻜﻢ‪ ...‬ﺭﺩﺩﻧﺎ ﻟﻜـﻢ‪ ...‬ﻭﺃﻣـﺪﺩﻧﺎﻛﻢ‪ ...‬ﻭﺟﻌﻠﻨـﺎﻛﻢ‪...‬‬ ‫ﺃﺣﺴﻨﺘﻢ‪ ...‬ﺃﺳﺄﰎ‪ ...‬ﻭﺟﻮﻫﻜﻢ‪ ...‬ﻳﺮﲪﻜﻢ‪ ...‬ﻋﺪﰎ (‪ .‬ﻟـﺬﻟﻚ ﳚـﺐ ﺃﻥ‬ ‫ﺼﺮِﻑ ﺍﻟﻀﻤﺎﺋﺮ ﰲ ﺍﻟﻜﻠﻤﺎﺕ ﺍﻵﺗﻴﺔ ﺇﱃ ﺃﻋـﺪﺍﺀ ﺍﻟﻴﻬـﻮﺩ‪ ) :‬ﻓﺠﺎﺳـﻮﺍ‪...‬‬ ‫َﻧ ْ‬ ‫ﻋﻠﻴﻬﻢ‪ ...‬ﻟﻴﺴﻮﺀﻭﺍ‪ ...‬ﻭﻟﻴﺪﺧﻠﻮﺍ‪ ...‬ﺩﺧﻠﻮﻩ‪ ....‬ﻭﻟﻴﺘﱪﻭﺍ‪ ...‬ﻋﻠﻮﺍ‪.( ...‬‬ ‫ﻫﻞ ﻳﻜﻮﻥ ﺍﻟﺘﺪﻣﲑ ﰲ ﻛﻞ ﺍﻷﺭﺽ ﺍﳌﺒﺎﺭﻛﺔ‪ ،‬ﺃﻡ ﻳﻜﻮﻥ ﰲ ﺟﺰﺀ ﻣﻨﻬﺎ ؟‬ ‫ﺖ ﺍﺣﺘﻤﺎ ﹰﻻ ﻣﻦ ﺍﻻﺣﺘﻤﺎﻟﲔ‪ ،‬ﻭﻟﻜﻦ ﻳُﻼﺣﻆ ﺃ ﹼﻥ ﺍﳊﺪﻳﺚ ﻋﻦ ﺍﻟﺘﺘﺒﲑ‬ ‫ﺍﻟﻨﺺ ﻻ ﻳﺒ ّ‬ ‫ﺟﺎﺀ ﺑﻌﺪ ﺍﳊﺪﻳﺚ ﻋﻦ ﺩﺧﻮﻝ ﺍﳌﺴﺠﺪ ﺍﻷﻗﺼﻰ‪ ،‬ﳑﺎ ﳚﻌﻠﻨﺎ ﻧﺘﻮﻗـﻊ ﺃﻥ ﻳﻜـﻮﻥ‬ ‫ﺍﻟﺘﺪﻣﲑ ﰲ ﳏﻴﻂ ﻣﺪﻳﻨﺔ ﺍﻟﻘﺪﺱ‪ .‬ﻭﲡﹾﺪﺭ ﺍﻹﺷﺎﺭﺓ ﻫﻨﺎ ﺇﱃ ﺃ ﹼﻥ ﺍﻟﻮﺍﻭ ﻻ ﺗﻔﻴﺪ ﺗﺮﺗﻴﺒﺎﹰ‬ ‫ﻭﻻ ﺗﻌﻘﻴﺒﺎﹰ‪ ) :‬ﻟﻴﺴﻮﺀﻭﺍ ﻭﺟﻮﻫﻜﻢ ﻭﻟﻴﺪﺧﻠﻮﺍ ﺍﳌﺴـﺠﺪ ‪ ...‬ﻭﻟﻴﺘـﱪﻭﺍ‪(...‬‬ ‫ﺺ ﺑﺬﻟﻚ‪ ،‬ﻭﳝﻜﻦ ﺗﺼ ّﻮﺭ ﺗﺮﺍﺧﻲ ﺍﻟﺪﺧﻮﻝ ﻋـﻦ ﺇﺳـﺎﺀﺓ‬ ‫ﻭﻟﻜﻦ ﺍﻟﺘﺮﺗﻴﺐ ُﻳﺮ ِﻫ ُ‬ ‫ﺍﻟﻮﺟﻪ‪ .‬ﺃ ّﻣﺎ ﺍﻟﺪﺧﻮﻝ ﻭﺍﻟﺘﺘﺒﲑ ﻓﻘﺪ ﻳﺴﺒﻖ ﺃﺣﺪﳘﺎ ﺍﻵﺧﺮ‪ ،‬ﻭﻗﺪ ﻳﺘﻼﺯﻣﺎﻥ‪ ،‬ﻭﻗـﺪ‬ ‫ﻳﺄﰐ ﺍﻟﺘﺘﺒﲑ ﺑﻌﺪ ﺍﻟﺪﺧﻮﻝ ﻭﻫﺬﺍ ﺑﻌﻴﺪ ﺇﺫﺍ ﻛﺎﻥ ﻣﻦ َﺳﻴ ْﺪ ُﺧﻞ ﻫﻢ ﺃﻫﻞ ﺍﻹﳝﺎﻥ‪.‬‬ ‫)ﻋﺴﻰ ﺭﺑﻜﻢ ﺃﻥ ﻳﺮﲪﻜﻢ (‪ :‬ﺩﻋﻮﺓ ﺇﱃ ﺍﻟﺘﻮﺑﺔ ﻭﺍﻟﺮﺟﻮﻉ ﺇﱃ ﺍﷲ‪.‬‬ ‫‪٣٦‬‬ ‫)ﻭﺇﻥ ﻋُﺪﺗُﻢ ُﻋ ْﺪﻧﺎ(‪ :‬ﻭﺇﻥ ﻋﺪﰎ ﻳﺎ ﺑﲏ ﺇﺳﺮﺍﺋﻴﻞ ﺇﱃ ﺍﻹﻓﺴﺎﺩ‪ ،‬ﻋﺪﻧﺎ ﺇﱃ‬ ‫ﺍﻟﻌﻘﻮﺑﺔ‪ .‬ﺗﺮﻏﻴﺐ ﻭﺗﺮﻫﻴﺐ ﻳُﻨﺎﺳﺒﺎﻥ ﺍﳌﻘﺎﻡ‪ ،‬ﻓﻬﻞ ﻳّﺘﻌﻆ ﺍﻟﻴﻬﻮﺩ ﺑﻌﺪ ﻫﺬﺍ ﺍﳊﺪﺙ ؟‬ ‫ﺍﳌﺘﺪّﺑﺮ ﻟﻠﻘﺮﺁﻥ ﺍﻟﻜﺮﱘ ﻳُﺪﺭﻙ ﺃ ﹼﻥ ﻓِﺌﺔ ﻣﻨﻬﻢ ﺳﺘﺒﻘﻰ ﺗﺴﻌﻰ ﺑﺎﻟﻔﺴﺎﺩ ﺃﻳﻨﻤﺎ ﺣﻠﹼـﻮﺍ‪،‬‬ ‫ﻗﺎﻝ ﺳُﺒﺤﺎﻧ ُﻪ ﻭﺗﻌﺎﱃ ﰲ ﺳﻮﺭﺓ ﺍﻷﻋﺮﺍﻑ‪ ) :‬ﻭﺇﺫ ﺗﺄ ﹼﺫ ﹶﻥ َﺭﺑﻚ ﹶﻟﻴﺒﻌﺜ ﱠﻦ ﻋﻠﻴﻬﻢ ﺇﱃ‬ ‫ﻳﻮﻡ ﺍﻟﻘﻴﺎﻣﺔ َﻣ ْﻦ َﻳﺴﻮ ُﻣﻬﻢ ﺳﻮ َﺀ ﺍﻟﻌﺬﺍﺏ(‪ ٢٤.‬ﻭﻗﺎﻝ ﺳﺒﺤﺎﻧﻪ ﰲ ﺳﻮﺭﺓ ﺍﳌﺎﺋﺪﺓ‪:‬‬ ‫)‪...‬ﻭﺃﻟﻘﻴﻨﺎ ﺑﻴﻨﻬ ُﻢ ﺍﻟﻌﺪﺍﻭ ﹶﺓ ﻭﺍﻟﺒﻐﻀﺎ َﺀ ﺇﱃ ﻳﻮﻡ ﺍﻟﻘﻴﺎﻣﺔ‪ ٢٥(...‬ﻭﻫﺬﻩ ﻋﻘﻮﺑـﺎﺕ‬ ‫ﺩﻧﻴﻮّﻳﺔ ﲢ ﹼﻞ ﻬﺑﻢ ﻟﻔﺴﺎﺩﻫﻢ ﻭﺇﻓﺴﺎﺩﻫﻢ‪.‬‬ ‫ﺇﻧّﻬﺎ ُﺑﺸﺮﻯ‬ ‫ﲔ ﺍﻟـﺬﻳﻦ‬ ‫)ﺇ ﹼﻥ ﻫﺬﺍ ﺍﻟﻘﺮﺁ ﹶﻥ ﻳﻬﺪﻱ ﻟﻠﱵ ﻫﻲ ﺃﻗﻮ ُﻡ ﻭﻳُﺒﺸّـ ُﺮ ﺍﳌـﺆﻣﻨ َ‬ ‫ﺕ‪ :(...‬ﻓﻬﻲ ﺇﺫﻥ ﺑﺸﺮﻯ ﻗﺮﺁﻧﻴﺔ‪ ،‬ﻭﻫﻲ ﺑُﺸـﺮﻯ ﻟﻠﻤـﺆﻣﻨﲔ‬ ‫ﻳﻌﻤﻠﻮﻥ ﺍﻟﺼﺎﳊﺎ ِ‬ ‫ﺍﻟﺴﺎﻟﻜﲔ ﻃﺮﻳﻖ ﺍﳊﻖ‪ .‬ﻭﰲ ﻫﺬﻩ ﺍﻵﻳﺔ ﺇﺷﺎﺭﺓ ﻭﺍﺿﺤﺔ ﺇﱃ ﺃ ﹼﻥ ﺍﻟﻨﺒـﻮﺀﺓ ﺗﺘﻌﻠﹼـﻖ‬ ‫ﲟﺴﺘﻘﺒﻞ ﻳﺄﰐ ﺑﻌﺪ ﻧﺰﻭﻝ ﺍﻟﻘﺮﺁﻥ ﺍﻟﻜﺮﱘ‪.‬‬ ‫) ﻭَﺃﻥ ﺍﻟﺬﻳﻦَ ﻻ ﻳُﺆﻣﻨﻮﻥ ﺑﺎﻵﺧﺮﺓِ ﺍﻋﺘﺪﻧﺎ ﳍﻢ ﻋﺬﺍﺑﹰﺎ ﺃﻟﻴﻤـﹰﺎ (‪ :‬ﻫـﻲ‬ ‫ﺑُﺸﺮﻯ ﻟﻠﻤﺆﻣﻨﲔ‪ ،‬ﻭﺇﻧﺬﺍﺭ ﻟﺒﲏ ﺇﺳﺮﺍﺋﻴﻞ ﺍﻟﺬﻳﻦ ﻻ ﻳﺆﻣﻨﻮﻥ ﺑـﺎﻵﺧﺮﺓ؛ ﻓﺎﻟﻌﻬـﺪ‬ ‫ﺍﻟﻘﺪﱘ ﺗﺰﻳﺪ ﺻﻔﺤﺎﺗﻪ ﻋﻦ ﺃﻟﻒ ﺻﻔﺤﺔ‪ ،‬ﻭﻋﻠﻰ ﺍﻟ ﱡﺮﻏﻢ ﻣﻦ ﺫﻟﻚ ﻻ ﲡﺪ ﻓﻴﻪ ﻧﺼﹰﺎ‬ ‫ﺻﺮﳛﺎ ﻳﺬﻛﺮ ﺍﻟﻴﻮﻡ ﺍﻵﺧﺮ!!‬ ‫ُﺧﺘﻤﺖ ﺍﻟﻨﺒﻮﺀﺓ ﺑﻮﺻﻒ ﺍﻟﻘﺮﺁﻥ ﺍﻟﻜﺮﱘ ﺑﺄﻧّﻪ ﻳﻬﺪﻱ‪ ،‬ﻭﻳﺒﺸﺮ‪ ،‬ﻭﻳُﻨـﺬﺭ‪.‬‬ ‫ﻭﻗﺪ ﺗﻜﺮﺭ ﻫﺬﺍ ﺍﻟﻮﺻﻒ ﰲ ﺍﻟﺘﻌﻘﻴﺐ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺍﻟﻨﺒﻮﺀﺓ ﺍ ﹸﳌﺠﻤﻠﺔ ﺍﻟـﻮﺍﺭﺩﺓ ﰲ ﺍﻵﻳـﺔ‬ ‫‪ ٢٤‬ﺍﻷﻋﺮﺍﻑ‪.١٦٧ :‬‬ ‫‪ ٢٥‬ﺍﳌﺎﺋﺪﺓ‪.٦٤ :‬‬ ‫‪٣٧‬‬ ‫ﺽ‬ ‫‪ ١٠٤‬ﻣﻦ ﺳﻮﺭﺓ ﺍﻹﺳﺮﺍﺀ‪ ) :‬ﻭﻗﻠﻨﺎ ﻣﻦ ﺑﻌﺪ ِﻩ ﻟﺒﲏ ﺇﺳﺮﺍﺋﻴ ﹶﻞ ﺍﺳـﻜﻨﻮﺍ ﺍﻷﺭ َ‬ ‫ﻓﺈﺫﺍ ﺟﺎ َﺀ ﻭ ْﻋ ُﺪ ﺍﻵﺧﺮﺓِ ِﺟﺌﹾﻨﺎ ِﺑﻜﹸﻢ ﻟﻔﻴﻔﹰﺎ‪ .‬ﻭﺑﺎﳊ ﱢﻖ ﺃﻧﺰﻟﻨﺎ ُﻩ ﻭﺑﺎﳊ ﱢﻖ ﻧـﺰﻝ ﻭﻣـﺎ‬ ‫ﺼﻠﺔ ﰲ‬ ‫ﺃﺭﺳﻠﻨﺎ َﻙ ﺇﻻ ُﻣﺒﺸﺮﹰﺍ ﻭَﻧﺬﻳﺮﹰﺍ (‪ .٢٦.‬ﻭﺟﺎﺀ ﰲ ﺍﻟﺘﻌﻘﻴﺐ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺍﻟﻨﺒﻮﺀﺓ ﺍﳌﻔ ّ‬ ‫ﲑ ﻭﻛـﺎﻥ ﺍﻹﻧﺴـﺎ ﹸﻥ‬ ‫ﻉ ﺍﻹﻧﺴﺎ ﹸﻥ ﺑﺎﻟﺸ ﱢﺮ ُﺩﻋﺎ َﺀﻩُ ﺑـﺎﳋ ِ‬ ‫ﺴﻮﺭﺓ‪َ ) :‬ﻭﻳ ْﺪ ُ‬ ‫ﻓﻮﺍﺗﺢ ﺍﻟ ّ‬ ‫ﻋﺠﻮ ﹰﻻ(‪ ٢٧.‬ﻭﺟﺎﺀ ﰲ ﺍﻟﺘﻌﻘﻴﺐ ﻋﻠﻴﻬﺎ ُﻣﺠﻤﻠﺔ‪ ) :‬ﻭﻗﺮﺁﻧﹰﺎ ﹶﻓ َﺮﻗﹾﻨﺎﻩُ ﻟﺘﻘﺮﺃ ُﻩ ﻋَﻠـﻰ‬ ‫ﻼ(‪.‬‬ ‫ﺚ ﻭﻧﺰﻟﻨﺎ ُﻩ ﺗﱰﻳ ﹰ‬ ‫ﺍﻟﻨﺎﺱِ ﻋﻠﻰ ﻣُﻜ ٍ‬ ‫‪٢٨‬‬ ‫ﺍﻧﻌﻜﺎﺳﺎﺕ ﺍﳊﺪﺙ‬ ‫)ﻗﹸﻞ ﺁﻣﻨﻮﺍ ِﺑ ِﻪ ﺃ ْﻭ ﻻ ﺗُﺆْﻣِﻨﻮﺍ ﺇ ﱠﻥ ﺍﻟﺬﻳﻦ ﺃﹸﻭﺗﻮﺍ ﺍﻟﻌﻠ َﻢ ﻣﻦ ﻗﹶﺒ ِﻠ ِﻪ ﺇﺫﺍ ﻳُﺘْﻠﻰ‬ ‫ﺠﺪﹰﺍ‪ ،‬ﻭﻳﻘﻮﻟﻮﻥﹶ ﺳُﺒْﺤﺎ ﹶﻥ َﺭﱢﺑﻨﺎ ﺇ ﹾﻥ ﻛﺎ ﹶﻥ َﻭ ْﻋﺪُ ﺭَﺑﻨـﺎ‬ ‫ﺨ ﱡﺮﻭ ﹶﻥ ﻟﻸﺫﻗﺎ ِﻥ ُﺳ ﱠ‬ ‫ﻋَﻠﻴﻬﻢ َﻳ ِ‬ ‫ﺨ ﱡﺮﻭ ﹶﻥ ﻟ َ‬ ‫ﹶﻟ َﻤﻔﹾﻌﻮ ﹰﻻ‪َ ،‬ﻭَﻳ ِ‬ ‫ﻸﺫﹾﻗﺎ ِﻥ َﻳﺒْﻜﻮ ﹶﻥ ﻭَﻳَﺰﻳﺪُﻫُﻢ ﺧُﺸﻮﻋﺎﹰ(‪ ،٢٩‬ﻋﻨﺪ ﲢﻘﹼﻖ ﻭﻋـﺪ‬ ‫ﺍﻵﺧﺮﺓ ﺳﻴﻜﻮﻥ ﻟﻪ ﺍﻷﺛﺮ ﺍﻟﺒﺎﻟﻎ ﰲ ﻧﻔﻮﺱ ﺃﻭﻟﺌﻚ ﺍﻟﺬﻳﻦ ﺃﻭﺗﻮﺍ ﺍﻟﻌﻠﻢ ﺑﺎﻟﻮﻋﺪ ﻗﺒﻞ‬ ‫ﺣﺼﻮﻟﻪ‪ ،‬ﻭﺳﺘﻜﻮﻥ ﺍﻧﻌﻜﺎﺳﺎﺕ ﺍﳊﺪﺙ ﻋﻠﻴﻬﻢ ﺇﳚﺎﺑﻴ ﹰﺔ ﻭﻣﺒﻬﺮﺓ‪ ،‬ﳊﺼﻮﻝ ﺍﻟﻨﺒﻮﺀﺓ‬ ‫ﻭﻓﻖ ﻣﺎ ﺃﺧﱪ ﺍﻟﻘﺮﺁﻥ ﺍﻟﻜﺮﱘ‪ ،‬ﻭﻳﻘﻮﻟﻮﻥ‪ " :‬ﺳُﺒﺤﺎ ﹶﻥ َﺭّﺑﻨﺎ ﺇ ﹾﻥ ﻛﺎ ﹶﻥ َﻭﻋْﺪ ﺭّﺑﻨـﺎ‬ ‫ﳌﻔﻌﻮﻻ "‪ .‬ﻧﻌﻢ ﻻﺑﺪ ﻟﻮﻋﺪ ﺍﷲ ﺃ ﹾﻥ ﻳﺘﺤ ﹼﻘﻖ‪ ،‬ﺍﻧﻈﺮ ﻗﻮﻟﻪ ﺗﻌﺎﱃ‪ " :‬ﺇ ﹾﻥ ﻛﺎ ﹶﻥ ﻭﻋـ ُﺪ‬ ‫ﺭﱢﺑﻨﺎ ﳌﻔﻌﻮﻻ "‪ .‬ﰒ َﺗﺪّﺑﺮ ﺧﺎﲤﺔ ﺳﻮﺭﺓ ﺍﻹﺳﺮﺍﺀ ﻣﻦ ﺟﻬﺔ ﺍﳌﻌﲎ ﻭﺍﳌﻮﺳﻴﻘﻰ‪َ " :‬ﻭﻗﹸ ِﻞ‬ ‫ﻚ ﻭﱂ ﻳَﻜﻦ ﻟﹶـ ُﻪ ﻭﱄﹲ‬ ‫ﷲ ﺍﻟﺬﻱ ﱂ ﻳﱠﺘﺨ ﹾﺬ ﻭﻟﺪﹰﺍ ﻭﱂ ﻳَﻜﹸﻦ ﻟ ُﻪ ﺷﺮﻳﻚٌ ﰲ ﺍﳌﹸﻠ ِ‬ ‫ﺍﳊﻤ ُﺪ ِ‬ ‫‪ ٢٦‬ﺍﻹﺳﺮﺍﺀ‪.١٠٥ :‬‬ ‫‪ ٢٧‬ﺍﻹﺳﺮﺍﺀ‪.١١ :‬‬ ‫‪ ٢٨‬ﺍﻹﺳﺮﺍﺀ‪.١٠٦ :‬‬ ‫‪ ٢٩‬ﺍﻹﺳﺮﺍﺀ‪.١٠٩-١٠٧ :‬‬ ‫‪٣٨‬‬ ‫ﻣ َﻦ ﺍﻟ ﱡﺬ ﱢﻝ ﻭﻛّﺒﺮ ُﻩ ﺗﻜﺒﲑﹰﺍ "‬ ‫ﺃﻭّﻝ ﺍﳊﺸﺮ‬ ‫ﻧﻘﺮﺃ ﰲ ﺍﻟﺴﲑﺓ ﺍﻟﻨﺒﻮﻳﺔ ﺍﻟﺸﺮﻳﻔﺔ ﺃ ﹼﻥ ﺍﻟﺮﺳﻮﻝ ﺻﻠﻰ ﺍﷲ ﻋﻠﻴـﻪ ﻭﺳـﻠﻢ‬ ‫ﺃﺧﺮﺝ ﻳﻬﻮﺩ ﺑﲏ ﻗﻴﻨﻘﺎﻉ ﻣﻦ ﺍﳌﺪﻳﻨﺔ‪ ،‬ﰒ ﺃﺧﺮﺝ ﻳﻬﻮﺩ ﺑﲏ ﺍﻟﻨﻀﲑ‪ ،‬ﻓﱰﻟﺖ ﺳﻮﺭﺓ‬ ‫ﺕ‬ ‫ﷲ ﻣﺎ ﰲ ﺍﻟﺴﻤﻮﺍ ِ‬ ‫ﺢ ِ‬ ‫ﺍﳊﺸﺮ‪ ،‬ﻭﺍﻟﱵ ُﺗﺴﺘﻬ ﹼﻞ ﻛﺴﻮﺭﺓ ﺍﻹﺳﺮﺍﺀ ﺑﺎﻟﺘﺴﺒﻴﺢ‪َ " :‬ﺳﱠﺒ َ‬ ‫ﺝ ﺍﻟﺬﻳﻦَ ﻛﻔﺮﻭﺍ ﻣﻦ ﺃﻫﻞ‬ ‫ﺽ ﻭﻫﻮ ﺍﻟﻌﺰﻳ ُﺰ ﺍﳊﻜﻴﻢ‪ ،‬ﻫ َﻮ ﺍﻟﺬﻱ ﺃﺧﺮ َ‬ ‫ﻭﻣﺎ ﰲ ﺍﻷﺭ ِ‬ ‫ﺏ ﻣِﻦ ﺩِﻳﺎﺭِﻫﻢ ﻷ ّﻭ ِﻝ ﺍﳊﹶﺸﺮ " ﻗﺎﻝ ﺍﳌﻔﺴﺮﻭﻥ‪ " :‬ﻷﻭّﻝ ﺍﳊﺸﺮ‪ ،‬ﺃﻱ ﻷ ّﻭﻝ‬ ‫ﺍﻟﻜﺘﺎ ِ‬ ‫ﲨ ٍﻊ ﳍﻢ ﰲ ﺑﻼﺩ ﺍﻟﺸﺎﻡ "‪ .‬ﻭﺍﻟﺴﺆﺍﻝ‪ :‬ﻣﺎ ﺍﳊﻜﻤﺔ ﻣﻦ ﲨﻌﻬﻢ ﰲ ﺑﻼﺩ ﺍﻟﺸّـﺎﻡ‪،‬‬ ‫ﻭﳌﺎﺫﺍ ﺍﻋﺘُِﺒ َﺮ ﻫﺬﺍ ﺍﻹﺧﺮﺍﺝ ﺃﻭﻝ ﺍﳉﻤﻊ‪ ،‬ﻭﻣﺎﺫﺍ ﺳﻴﺤﺼﻞ ﰲ ﺁﺧﺮ ﺍﳉﻤﻊ ؟‬ ‫ﻭﺭﺩ ﰲ ﺗﻔﺴﲑ ﺍﻟﻨﺴﻔﻲ ﺃ ﹼﻥ ﺍﻟﺮﺳﻮﻝ‪ ،‬ﺻﻠﻰ ﺍﷲ ﻋﻠﻴﻪ ﻭﺳﻠﻢ‪ ،‬ﻗﺎﻝ ﻋﻨﺪﻣﺎ‬ ‫ﺃﺧﺮﺝ ﺑﲏ ﺍﻟﻨﻀﲑ ﻣﻦ ﺍﳌﺪﻳﻨﺔ ﺍﳌﻨﻮّﺭﺓ‪ " :‬ﺍﻣﻀﻮﺍ ﻷ ّﻭﻝ ﺍﳊﺸﺮ ﻭﺇﻧﺎ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺍﻷﺛﺮ "‬ ‫ﻓﻬﻞ ﻳُﺸﲑ ﺫﻟﻚ ﺇﱃ ﻭﻋﺪ ﺍﻵﺧﺮﺓ " ﻓﺈﺫﺍ ﺟﺎﺀ ﻭَﻋ ُﺪ ﺍﻵﺧﺮﺓِ ِﺟ ﹾﺌﻨَﺎ ِﺑﻜﹸﻢ ﻟﹶﻔﻴﻔﺎ "‬ ‫ﻓﺪﺧﻮﻝ ﺑﲏ ﺇﺳﺮﺍﺋﻴﻞ ﺍﻷﺭﺽ ﺍﳌﻘﺪّﺳﺔ ﺑﻌﺪ ﻣﻮﺳﻰ‪ ،‬ﻋﻠﻴﻪ ﺍﻟﺴﻼﻡ‪ ،‬ﻛﺎﻥ ﻣﻘ ّﺪﻣـﺔ‬ ‫ﻟﺘﺤﻘﻴﻖ ﻭﻋﺪ ﺍﻷﻭﱃ‪ ،‬ﻭﺩﺧﻮﳍﻢ ﺑﻌﺪ ﺃ ﹾﻥ ﺃﺧ َﺮ َﺟ ُﻬﻢ ﺍﻟﺮﺳﻮﻝ‪ ،‬ﺻـﻠﻰ ﺍﷲ ﻋﻠﻴـﻪ‬ ‫ﻭﺳﻠﻢ‪،‬ﻛﺎﻥ ﺃﻳﻀﹰﺎ ﻣﻘ ّﺪﻣﺔ ﻟﺘﺤﻘﻴﻖ ﻭﻋﺪ ﺍﻵﺧﺮﺓ‪ ،‬ﻭﻛﺎﻥ ﺑﺪﺍﻳﺔ ﺭﻣﺰﻳـﺔ ﺗُـﺮْ ِﻫﺺُ‬ ‫ﲟﻘﺪﻡ ﻭﻋﺪ ﺍﻵﺧﺮﺓ‪ .‬ﻭﻗﺪ ﺃﺧﺮﺝ ﺍﻟﻨﺴﻔﻲ ﺃ ﹼﻥ ﻗﺴﻤﹰﺎ ﻣﻦ ﺑﲏ ﺍﻟﻨﻀﲑ ﺳﻜﻨﻮﺍ ﺃﺭﳛﹰﺎ‪.‬‬ ‫ﳉﻤ ُﻊ ﰲ ﺑﺪﺍﻳﺘﻪ ﺣﺸﺮﺍﹰ‪ ،‬ﻭﺇﻥ ﻛـﺎﻥ ﻳﺼـ ّﺢ ﺃﻥ ﻧﻘـﻮﻝ ﺃﻭﻝ‬ ‫ﻧﻘﻮﻝ‪ :‬ﻻ ﻳﻜﻮﻥ ﺍ ﹶ‬ ‫ﺍﳊﺸﺮ‪ ،‬ﻷﻥ ﺍﳊﺸﺮ ﻫﻮ ﺍﳉﻤﻊ ﺍﻟﺬﻱ ﻳﻜﻮﻥ ﻣﻌﻪ ﺍﻟﻀﻴﻖ ﰲ ﺍﳌﻜـﺎﻥ‪ ،‬ﻭﺍﻟﻀـﻴﻖ‬ ‫ﺍﻟﻨﻔﺴ ّﻲ‪ .‬ﻭﻫﺬﺍ ﻳﻌﲏ ﺃ ﹼﻥ ﻭﻋﺪ ﺍﻵﺧﺮﺓ ﻳﺘﺤﻘﻖ ﻋﻨﺪﻣﺎ ﻳﺼﺒﺢ ﲨﻊ ﺑﲏ ﺇﺳﺮﺍﺋﻴﻞ ﰲ‬ ‫ﺍﻷﺭﺽ ﺍﳌﻘﺪّﺳﺔ ﺣﺸﺮﹰﺍ‪.‬‬ ‫‪٣٩‬‬ ‫ﺃﺳﺒﺎﻁ ﺿﺎﺋﻌﺔ‬ ‫ﻳﻘﻮﻝ ﻋﻠﻤﺎﺀ ﺍﻷﺟﻨﺎﺱ ﺇ ﹼﻥ ‪ %٩٠‬ﻣﻦ ﻳﻬﻮﺩ ﺍﻟﻌﺎﱂ ﻫﻢ ﻣﻦ ﺍﻷﻣﻢ ﺍﻟـﱵ‬ ‫ﻬﺗ ﱠﻮﺩﺕ‪ ،‬ﻭﻻ ﻳﺮﺟﻌﻮﻥ ﰲ ﺃﺻﻮﳍﻢ ﺇﱃ ﺑﲏ ﺇﺳﺮﺍﺋﻴﻞ‪ .‬ﻭﻳُﻘ ّﺮ ﺍﻟﻴﻬﻮﺩ ﺑـﺄﻥ ﻫﻨـﺎﻙ‬ ‫ﻋﺸﺮﺓ ﺃﺳﺒﺎﻁ ﺿﺎﺋﻌﺔ‪ ":‬ﺭﺃﻭﺑﲔ‪ ،‬ﻭﴰﻌﻮﻥ‪ ،‬ﻭﺯﺑﻮﻟﻮﻥ‪ ،‬ﻭﻳﺴﺎﻛﺮ‪ ،‬ﻭﺩﺍﻥ‪ ،‬ﻭﺟﺎﺩ‪،‬‬ ‫ﻭﺃﺷﲑ‪ ،‬ﻭﻧﻔﺘﺎﱄ‪ ،‬ﻭﺃﻓﺮﺍﱘ ﻭﻣﻨﺴﻲ‪ ٣٠".‬ﻋﻠﻰ ﺿﻮﺀ ﺫﻟﻚ‪ ،‬ﻛﻴﻒ ﻳَﺼ ﱡﺢ ﺃﻥ ﻧﻘﻮﻝ‬ ‫ﺇ ﹼﻥ ﺍﻟﻘﻀﺎﺀ ﺍﻹﳍﻲ ﻟﺒﲏ ﺇﺳﺮﺍﺋﻴﻞ ﻳﺘﻌﻠﹼﻖ ﺑﻴﻬﻮﺩ ﺍﻟﻴﻮﻡ ؟‪:‬‬ ‫‪ -١‬ﻳﻘﻮﻝ ﺍﷲ ﺗﻌﺎﱃ ﰲ ﺳﻮﺭﺓ ﺍﻹﺳﺮﺍﺀ‪ ..." :‬ﻓﺈﺫﺍ ﺟﺎ َﺀ َﻭ ْﻋﺪُ ﺍﻵﺧـﺮﺓِ ِﺟﺌﹾﻨـﺎ‬ ‫ِﺑﻜﹸﻢ ﻟﻔﻴﻔﹰﺎ "‪ ٣١‬ﻭﺍﳌﻘﺼﻮﺩ ﳒﻤﻌﻜﻢ ﻣﻦ ﺍﻟﺸﺘﺎﺕ ﰲ ﺣﺎﻟﺔ ﻛﻮﻧﻜﻢ ﻣﻨـﺘﻤﲔ ﺇﱃ‬ ‫ﺃﺻﻮ ٍﻝ ﺷﱴ‪ ،‬ﻋﻠﻰ ﺧﻼﻑ ﻭﺍﻗﻌﻜﻢ ﰲ ﺍﳌﺮّﺓ ﺍﻷﻭﱃ‪.‬‬ ‫‪ _٢‬ﺣﺮﺹ ﺍﻟﻴﻬﻮﺩ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺗﺴﻤﻴﺔ ﺍﻟﺪﻭﻟﺔ ﺍﻷﺧﲑﺓ ﻫﺬﻩ )ﺇﺳﺮﺍﺋﻴﻞ(‪ ،‬ﻓﺄﺻـﺒﺤﺖ‬ ‫ﺍﻟُﺒﻨ ّﻮﺓ ﻫﻲ ُﺑﻨ ّﻮﺓ ﺍﻧﺘﻤﺎﺀٍ ﻟﻠﺪﻭﻟﺔ‪ .‬ﻓﻼ ﺷﻚ ﺃﻬﻧﻢ ﺍﻟﻴﻮﻡ ﺃﺑﻨﺎﺀ ﺇﺳﺮﺍﺋﻴﻞ‪.‬‬ ‫‪ -٣‬ﺇ ﹼﻥ ﺍﳊﻜﻢ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺍﻟﻨﺎﺱ ﰲ ﺩﻳﻦ ﺍﷲ ﻻ ﻳﻜﻮﻥ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺃﺳﺎﺱ ﺍﻟﻌﺮﻕ ﻭﺍﳉـﻨﺲ‪،‬‬ ‫ﺑﻞ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺃﺳﺎﺱ ﺍﻟﻌﻘﻴﺪﺓ ﻭﺍﻟﺴﻠﻮﻙ‪ .‬ﻭﻗﺪ ﺁﻣﻦ ﺑﻨﻮ ﺇﺳﺮﺍﺋﻴﻞ ﺑﺎﻟﻴﻬﻮﺩﻳﺔ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺻﻮﺭﺓ‬ ‫ﻣﻨﺤﺮﻓﺔ‪ ،‬ﻓﻴُﻠﺤ ُﻖ ﻬﺑﻢ ﻛﻞ ﻣﻦ ﻳﺸﺎﺭﻛﻬﻢ ﰲ ﻋﻘﻴﺪﻬﺗﻢ ﻭﺷﺮﻋﻬﻢ‪.‬‬ ‫‪ ٣٠‬ﻣﻦ ﻫﻮ ﺍﻟﻴﻬﻮﺩﻱ ﰲ ﺩﻭﻟﺔ ﺍﻟﻴﻬﻮﺩ ‪ -‬ﻋﻜﻴﻔﺎ ﺃﻭﺭ ‪ -‬ﺩﺍﺭ ﺍﳊﻤﺮﺍﺀ ‪ -‬ﺑﲑﻭﺕ ‪ -‬ﻁ‪ ١٩٩٣ - ١‬ﺹ‪ .١٤٧‬ﻣﻦ ﻫﻨﺎ‬ ‫ﻧﺪﺭﻙ ﺃﻥ ﻣﺴﺄﻟﺔ ﺍﳊﻖ ﺍﻟﺘﺎﺭﳜﻲ ﻫﻲ ﺃﺳﻄﻮﺭﺓ ﺍﺧﺘﺮﻋﻬﺎ ﺍﻟﻴﻬﻮﺩ ﺍﻟﺼﻬﺎﻳﻨﺔ‪ ،‬ﻷﻥ ﺍﻟﻐﺎﻟﺒﻴﺔ ﺍﻟﻌﻈﻤﻰ ﻣﻦ ﺑﲏ ﺇﺳﺮﺍﺋﻴﻞ ﲢﻮﻟﻮﺍ ﺇﱃ‬ ‫ﺍﳌﺴﻴﺤﻴﺔ ﻭﺍﻹﺳﻼﻡ‪.‬‬ ‫‪٣١‬‬ ‫ﺍﻹﺳﺮﺍﺀ‪١٠٤ :‬‬ ‫‪٤٠‬‬ ‫‪ -٤‬ﺍﻻﻧﺘﻤﺎﺀ ﺍﳊﻘﻴﻘﻲ ﻫﻮ ﺍﻧﺘﻤﺎﺀ ﺍﻟﻮﻻﺀ‪ ،‬ﻳﻘﻮﻝ ﺳﺒﺤﺎﻧﻪ ﻭﺗﻌﺎﱃ‪ " :‬ﻭ َﻣ ْﻦ َﻳَﺘ َﻮﹼﻟﻬﻢ‬ ‫ﻣﻨﻜ ْﻢ ﻓﺈﻧ ُﻪ ﻣﻨﻬﻢ "‪.٣٢‬‬ ‫‪ -٥‬ﻻ ﻧﺴﺘﻄﻴﻊ ﺃﻥ ﻧﻨﻜﺮ ﺃﻥ ﺟﺰﺀﹰﺍ ﻣﻦ ﻳﻬﻮﺩ ﺍﻟﻴﻮﻡ ﻳﺮﺟﻌﻮﻥ ﰲ ﺃﺻﻮﳍﻢ ﺇﱃ ﺑﲏ‬ ‫ﺇﺳﺮﺍﺋﻴﻞ‪ ،‬ﻭﻋﻠﻰ ﻭﺟﻪ ﺍﳋﺼﻮﺹ ﺑﻌﺾ ﺍﻟﺸﺮﻗﻴﲔ ﻣﻨﻬﻢ‪.‬‬ ‫‪ -٦‬ﻗﻮﻟﻨﺎ ﺇ ﹼﻥ ﻫﻨﺎﻙ ﻗﺴﻤﹰﺎ ﻣﻦ ﻳﻬﻮﺩ ﺍﻟﻴﻮﻡ ﻳﺮﺟﻌﻮﻥ ﰲ ﺃﺻﻮﳍﻢ ﺇﱃ ﺑﲏ ﺇﺳﺮﺍﺋﻴﻞ‬ ‫ﻫﻮ ﻗﻮﻝ ﺻﺤﻴﺢ‪ ،‬ﻟﻜﻨﻨﺎ ﻻ ﻧﺴﺘﻄﻴﻊ ﺃﻥ ُﻧﻌّﻴﻨﻬﻢ ﻭُﻧﺴ ّﻤﻴﻬﻢ‪ .‬ﻭﻣﻦ ﻫﻨـﺎ ﺗﻌﺘـﱪ‬ ‫ﺍﻟﻘﻀﻴﺔ ﻗﻀﻴﺔ ﻏﻴﺒّﻴﺔ‪.‬‬ ‫ﻟﻴﺲ ﻣﻦ ﻋﻼﻣﺎﺕ ﺍﻟﻘﻴﺎﻣﺔ‬ ‫ﻳﻈﻦ ﺍﻟﺒﻌﺾ ﺃ ﹼﻥ ﻬﻧﺎﻳﺔ ﺍﻟﺪﻭﻟﺔ ﺍﻹﺳﺮﺍﺋﻴﻠﻴﺔ ﺗﻌﲏ ﺍﻗﺘﺮﺍﺏ ﺍﻟﻴـﻮﻡ ﺍﻵﺧـﺮ‪،‬‬ ‫ﻭﻫﺬﺍ ﻏﲑ ﺻﺤﻴﺢ‪ ،‬ﻭﻻ ﺃﺻﻞ ﻟﻪ‪ .‬ﺃ ّﻣﺎ ﻗﻮﻝ ﺍﻟﺮﺳﻮﻝ ﺻﻠﻰ ﺍﷲ ﻋﻠﻴﻪ ﻭﺳﻠﻢ ‪ " :‬ﻻ‬ ‫ﺴﺎﻋﺔ ﺣﱴ ﻳﻘﺎﺗﻞ ﺍﳌﺴﻠﻤﻮﻥ ﺍﻟﻴﻬﻮﺩ‪ "....‬ﻓﻘﺪ ﺫﻫﺐ ﺑﻌﺾ ﺍﻟﻌﻠﻤﺎﺀ ﺇﱃ‬ ‫ﺗﻘﻮﻡ ﺍﻟ ّ‬ ‫ﺍﻟﻘﻮﻝ ﺃ ﹼﻥ ﺍﳌﻘﺼﻮﺩ ﺑﺎﳊﺪﻳﺚ ﺣﺘﻤﻴّﺔ ﺍﻟﻮﻗﻮﻉ‪ ،‬ﻭﻟﻴﺲ ﺍﳌﻘﺼﻮﺩ ﺃ ﹼﻥ ﻗﺘـﺎﳍﻢ ﻣـﻦ‬ ‫ﻋﻼﻣﺎﺕ ﺍﻟﻘﻴﺎﻣﺔ‪ .‬ﻧﻘﻮﻝ‪ :‬ﺣﱴ ﻟﻮ ﻛﺎﻥ ﺍﳌﻘﺼﻮﺩ ﺃ ﹼﻥ ﻗﺘﺎﳍﻢ ﻫﻮ ﻣﻦ ﻋﻼﻣﺎﺕ ﻳﻮﻡ‬ ‫ﺍﻟﻘﻴﺎﻣﺔ‪ ،‬ﻓﻤﻦ ﻗﺎﻝ ﺇ ﹼﻥ ﺯﻭﺍﻝ ﺩﻭﻟﺘﻬﻢ ﻫﺬﻩ ﰲ ﻓﻠﺴﻄﲔ ﻫﻮ ﺁﺧﺮ ﻗﺘـﺎﻝ ﳍـﻢ ﰲ‬ ‫ﺍﻷﺭﺽ‪ ،‬ﻭﺇﻻ ﻓﻤﺎ ﻣﻌﲎ ﻗﻮﻝ ﺍﷲ ﺗﻌﺎﱃ ﰲ ﺧﻮﺍﺗﻴﻢ ﻧﺒﻮﺀﺓ ﺍﻹﺳﺮﺍﺀ‪ " :‬ﻭﺇﻥ ﻋُﺪﺗُﻢ‬ ‫ُﻋﺪْﻧﺎ "‪ ،‬ﻭﻫﻞ ﻧﺴﻴﻨﺎ ﺃ ﹼﻥ ﻋﺎﻣﺔ ﺃﺗﺒﺎﻉ ﺍﻟ ّﺪﺟﺎﻝ ﻫﻢ ﻣﻦ ﺍﻟﻴﻬﻮﺩ‪ ،‬ﻭﻓﻖ ﻣﺎ ﺟـﺎﺀ ﰲ‬ ‫ﺼﺤﻴﺢ؟ ﺑﻞ ﺇ ﹼﻥ ﺑﻌﺾ ﺭﻭﺍﻳﺎﺕ ﺍﳊﺪﻳﺚ ﺍﻟﺼﺤﻴﺤﺔ ُﺗﺼـﺮّﺡ ﺑـﺄ ﹼﻥ‬ ‫ﺍﳊﺪﻳﺚ ﺍﻟ ّ‬ ‫ﺴﻼﻡ‪ .‬ﻭﻻ ﻧﻨﺴﻰ ﺃ ﹼﻥ‬ ‫ﺍﳌﻘﺼﻮﺩ ﺑﺎﳊﺪﻳﺚ ﻗﺘﺎﻝ ﺍﳌﺴﻠﻤﲔ ﲢﺖ ﻟﻮﺍﺀ ﺍﳌﺴﻴﺢ ﻋﻠﻴﻪ ﺍﻟ ّ‬ ‫‪ ٣٢‬ﺳﻮﺭﺓ ﺍﳌﺎﺋﺪﺓ‪ ،‬ﺍﻵﻳﺔ‪٥١:‬‬ ‫‪٤١‬‬ ‫ﺯﺣﻒ ﺍﻟﺪﺟّﺎﻝ ﻳﻜﻮﻥ ﻣﻦ ﺍﻟﺸﺮﻕ ﺇﱃ ﺍﻟﻐﺮﺏ‪ ،‬ﻭﻫﺬﺍ ﻳﺸﲑ ﺇﱃ ﳏﺎﻭﻟـﺔ ﺛﺎﻟﺜـﺔ‬ ‫ﻟﻠﻌﻮﺩﺓ ﺇﱃ ﺍﻷﺭﺽ ﺍﳌﻘﺪّﺳﺔ‪ ،‬ﻭﻟﻜﻨّﻬﺎ ﲣﻔﻖ‪ ،‬ﻻ ﹼﻥ ﻗﻀﺎﺀ ﺍﷲ ﲟﺮّﺗﲔ‪ .‬ﻭﻋﻠﻰ ﺿﻮﺀ‬ ‫ﺫﻟﻚ ﳝﻜﻦ ﺃﻥ ﻧﻔﻬﻢ ﺑﻌﺾ ﺩﻻﻻﺕ ﻗﻮﻟﻪ ﺗﻌﺎﱃ‪ " :‬ﻭﺇ ﹾﻥ ﻋُﺪﰎ ﻋُﺪﻧﺎ "‪ ،‬ﻭﻳﺼﺒﺢ‬ ‫ﺍﻟﻘﻮﻝ ﺑﺄ ﹼﻥ ﺍﳊﺪﻳﺚ ﻳُﻔﻴﺪ ﻋﻼﻣ ﹰﺔ ﻣـﻦ ﻋﻼﻣـﺎﺕ ﻳـﻮﻡ ﺍﻟﻘﻴﺎﻣـﺔ ﺭﺍﺟﺤـﹰﺎ‪.‬‬ ‫ﺍﳋﻼﻓﺔ ﺗَﻨـﺰِﻝ‬ ‫ﺟﺎﺀ ﰲ ﺳﻨﻦ ﺃﰊ ﺩﺍﻭﺩ‪ ،‬ﰲ ﻛﺘﺎﺏ ﺍﳉﻬﺎﺩ‪ ..." :‬ﻳﺎ ﺍﺑﻦ ﺣﻮﺍﻟـﺔ‪ ،‬ﺇﺫﺍ‬ ‫ﺭﺃﻳﺖ ﺍﳋﻼﻓﺔ ﻗﺪ ﻧﺰﻟﺖ ﺍﻷﺭﺽ ﺍﳌﻘ ّﺪﺳﺔ‪ ،‬ﻓﻘﺪ ﺍﻗﺘﺮﺑﺖ ﺍﻟﺰﻻﺯﻝ ﻭﺍﻟﺒﻼﺑـﻞ‬ ‫ﻭﺍﻷﻣﻮﺭ ﺍﻟﻌﻈﺎﻡ‪ ،‬ﻭﺍﻟﺴﺎﻋﺔ ﻳﻮﻣﺌﺬ ﺃﻗﺮﺏ ﺇﱃ ﺍﻟﻨﺎﺱ ﻣﻦ ﻳـﺪﻱ ﻫـﺬﻩ ﻣـﻦ‬ ‫ﺭﺃﺳﻚ"‪ .‬ﺃﻭ ﻛﻤﺎ ﻗﺎﻝ ﺻﻠﻰ ﺍﷲ ﻋﻠﻴﻪ ﻭﺳﻠﻢ‪ .‬ﻗﻮﻝ ﺍﻟﺮﺳﻮﻝ ﺻـﻠﻰ ﺍﷲ ﻋﻠﻴـﻪ‬ ‫ﻭﺳﻠﻢ ‪..." :‬ﺍﳋﻼﻓﺔ ﻗﺪ ﻧﺰﻟﺖ‪ " ...‬ﺩﻟﻴﻞ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺃ ﹼﻥ ﺍﳋﻼﻓﺔ ﺳﺘﺴﺎﻓﺮ ﺣﱴ ﺗﱰﻝ‬ ‫ﰲ ﺑﻴﺖ ﺍﳌﻘﺪﺱ‪ ،‬ﻓﺘﻜﻮﻥ ﺁﺧﺮ ﺩﺍ ٍﺭ ﻟﻠﺨﻼﻓﺔ‪ .‬ﻭﺍﻟﺘـﺎﺭﻳﺦ ﳜﱪﻧـﺎ ﺃ ﹼﻥ ﺍﳋﻼﻓـﺔ‬ ‫ﺳﺎﻓﺮﺕ ﻣﻦ ﺍﳌﺪﻳﻨﺔ‪ ،‬ﺇﱃ ﺍﻟﻜﻮﻓﺔ‪ ،‬ﺇﱃ ﺩﻣﺸﻖ‪ ،‬ﺇﱃ ﺑﻐﺪﺍﺩ‪ ،‬ﰒ ﺇﱃ ﺍﺳـﻄﻨﺒﻮﻝ‪..‬‬ ‫ﰒ‪ ...‬ﰒ‪ ...‬ﺣﱴ ﺗﱰﻝ ﺑﻴﺖ ﺍﳌﻘﺪﺱ‪ .‬ﻭُﻳﺆّﻳﺪ ﻣﻌﲎ ﻫﺬﺍ ﺍﳊﺪﻳﺚ ﻗﻮﻝ ﺍﻟﺮﺳـﻮﻝ‬ ‫ﺻﻠﻰ ﺍﷲ ﻋﻠﻴﻪ ﻭﺳﻠﻢ‪ " :‬ﻫﻢ ﰲ ﺑﻴﺖ ﺍﳌﻘﺪﺱ ﻭﺃﻛﻨﺎﻑ ﺑﻴﺖ ﺍﳌﻘﺪﺱ " ﻓﻌﻨﺪﻣﺎ‬ ‫ﻳﺄﰐ ﺃﻣﺮ ﺍﷲ ﻳﻜﻮﻥ ﺁﺧﺮ ﻇﻬﻮﺭ ﻟﻠﻤﺴﻠﻤﲔ ﰲ ﺑﻴﺖ ﺍﳌﻘﺪﺱ ﻭﺍﻛﻨـﺎﻑ ﺑﻴـﺖ‬ ‫ﺍﳌﻘﺪﺱ‪ .‬ﻭﺍﻟﻼﻓﺖ ﻟﻼﻧﺘﺒﺎﻩ ﺃ ﹼﻥ ﺍﳌﺴﻠﻤﲔ ﱂ ﻳﺘﺨﺬﻭﺍ ﺑﻴﺖ ﺍﳌﻘﺪﺱ ﺩﺍﺭﹰﺍ ﻟﻠﺨﻼﻓﺔ‪،‬‬ ‫ﻣﻊ ﺃ ﹼﻥ ﺩﻭﺍﻋﻲ ﺫﻟﻚ ﻛﺜﲑﺓ‪ .‬ﻭﻻ ﻧﻈ ﱡﻦ ﺃ ﹼﻥ ﺍﻟﺬﻳﻦ ﺳﻴﺤﺮﺭﻭﻬﻧﺎ‪ ،‬ﺇﻥ ﺷـﺎﺀ ﺍﷲ‪ ،‬ﰲ‬ ‫ﻫﺬﺍ ﺍﻟﻌﺼﺮ ﺳﻴﺘﺨﺬﻭﻬﻧﺎ ﻋﺎﺻﻤﺔ ﻭﺩﺍﺭﹰﺍ ﻟﻠﺨﻼﻓﺔ‪ .‬ﻭﲟﻌﲎ ﺁﺧﺮ ﻻ ﻧﻈ ﱡﻦ ﺃﻥ ﺁﺧـﺮ‬ ‫ﻇﻬﻮﺭ ﻟﻠﻤﺴﻠﻤﲔ ﺳﻴﻜﻮﻥ ﻋﻨﺪ ﲢﺮﻳﺮ ﺑﻴﺖ ﺍﳌﻘﺪﺱ‪ ،‬ﺑﻞ ﺇ ﹼﻥ ﺁﺧ َﺮ ﹸﻇﻬﻮﺭ ﺳﻴﻜﻮﻥ‬ ‫ﻋﻠﻰ ﻳﺪ ﺍﳌﻬﺪﻱﱢ‪ ،‬ﺍﻟﺬﻱ ﺳﻴﺤﻜﻢ ﺍﻷﺭﺽ ﺑﺎﻟﻌﺪﻝ‪ ،‬ﻭﳛﻞ ﺍﻹﺷﻜﺎﻝ ﻣﻊ ﺍﻟﻐﺮﺏ‪،‬‬ ‫‪٤٢‬‬ ‫ﻭﻳﻨـﺰﻝ ﺍﳌﺴﻴﺢ‪ ،‬ﻋﻠﻴﻪ ﺍﻟﺴﻼﻡ‪ ،‬ﰲ ﺁﺧﺮ ﻋﻬﺪﻩ‪ ،‬ﻭﺗﻜﻮﻥ ﻋﺎﺻﻤﺔ ﺩﻭﻟﺘﻪ ﺍﻟﻘﺪﺱ‪.‬‬ ‫ﻛﺎﻧﺖ ﺍﻟﺒﺪﺍﻳﺔ ﰲ ﻣﻜﺔ‪ ،‬ﻭﺳﺘﻜﻮﻥ ﺍﳋﺎﲤﺔ‪ ،‬ﺇﻥ ﺷﺎﺀ ﺍﷲ‪ ،‬ﰲ ﺍﻟﻘﺪﺱ‪:‬‬ ‫ﻼ ﻣ َﻦ ﺍﳌﺴﺠ ِﺪ ﺍﳊﺮﺍ ِﻡ ﺇﱃ ﺍﳌﺴـﺠ ِﺪ‬ ‫)ﺳُﺒﺤﺎ ﹶﻥ ﺍﻟﺬﻱ ﹶﺃﺳﺮﻯ ِﺑ َﻌ ْﺒ ِﺪ ِﻩ ﻟﻴ ﹰ‬ ‫ﺴﻤﻴ ُﻊ ﺍﻟﺒﺼﲑُ(‬ ‫ﺍﻷﻗﺼﻰ ﺍﻟﺬﻱ ﺑﺎﺭﻛﻨﺎ ﺣﻮﻟ ُﻪ ِﻟُﻨﺮﻳ ُﻪ ﻣﻦ ﺀﺍﻳﺘﻨﺎ ﺇﻧ ُﻪ ﻫُ َﻮ ﺍﻟ ّ‬ ‫‪٣٣‬‬ ‫ﺍﻹﺳﺮﺍﺀ‪١ :‬‬ ‫‪٤٣‬‬ ‫‪٣٣‬‬ ‫ﺍﻟﻔﺼﻞ ﺍﻟﺜﺎﱐ‬ ‫ﻧﺒﻮﺀﺓ‬ ‫ﺃﻡ ﺻُﺪﻑ ﺭﻗﻤّﻴﺔ ؟‬ ‫‪٤٤‬‬ ‫ﻣﻦ ﻫﻨﺎ ﻛﺎﻧﺖ ﺍﻟﺒﺪﺍﻳﺔ‬ ‫ﺴﻤﺎﻭﻳﺔ ﺗُﺨﱪ ﻋﻦ ﺍﳌﺴﺘﻘﺒﻞ‪ ،‬ﻭﺗﻜﺸﻒ ﺑﻌﺾ ﻣُﻐَﻴﺒﺎﺗـﻪ‪،‬‬ ‫ﻛﻞ ﺍﻷﺩﻳﺎﻥ ﺍﻟ ّ‬ ‫ﻭﻣﺎ ﻣﻦ ﻧﱯ ﺇﻻ ﻭﺃﻧﺒﺄ ﺑﺎﻟﻐﻴﺐ‪ .‬ﻭﻟﻺﺧﺒﺎﺭ ﺑﺎﻟﻐﻴﺐ ﺻﻮﺭ ﻛﺜﲑﺓ‪ ،‬ﺑﻌﻀﻬﺎ ﻳﻜـﻮﻥ‬ ‫ﺑﺎﳋﱪ ﺍﳌﺒﺎﺷﺮ ﻭﺍﻟﻮﺣﻲ ﺍﻟﺼّﺮﻳﺢ‪ ،‬ﻭﺑﻌﻀﻬﺎ ﻳﻜﻮﻥ ﺑﺎﻟ ّﺮﻣﺰ ﺍﻟﺬﻱ ﳛﺘﺎﺝ ﺇﱃ ﲢﻠﻴﻞ‬ ‫ﺼﺎﺩﻗﺔ ﻟﻠﻨﱯ‪ ،‬ﺃﻭ ﺣـﱴ ﻟﻐـﲑ‬ ‫ﻭﺗﺄﻭﻳﻞ‪ .‬ﻭﻗﺪ ﻳُﻌﻠﻢ ﺍﻟﻐﻴﺐ ﻋﻦ ﻃﺮﻳﻖ ﺍﻟﺮﺅﻳﺎ ﺍﻟ ّ‬ ‫ﺍﻷﻧﺒﻴﺎﺀ‪ .‬ﻭﺑﻌﻀﻬﺎ ﻗﺪ ﻳﺘﺤ ﹼﻘﻖ ﰲ ﺯﻣﻦ ﻗﺮﻳﺐ‪ ،‬ﻭﺑﻌﻀﻬﺎ ﻳﺘﺮﺍﺧﻰ ﻓﻴﺘﺤﻘﻖ ﺑﻌـﺪ‬ ‫ﺳﻨﲔ ﻃﻮﻳﻠﺔ‪ ،‬ﺃﻭ ﺣﱴ ﺑﻌﺪ ﻗﺮﻭﻥ‪.‬‬ ‫ﻳﺆﻣﻦ ﺍﳌﺴﻠﻤﻮﻥ ﺑﺎﻟﺘﻮﺭﺍﺓ‪ ،‬ﻟﻜﻨﻬﻢ ﻳﻌﺘﻘﺪﻭﻥ ﺃﻬﻧﺎ ﳏ ّﺮﻓﺔ‪ ،‬ﺃﻱ ﺃﻬﻧﻢ ﳚﺰﻣﻮﻥ‬ ‫ﺑﻮﺟﻮﺩ ﻧﺴﺒﺔ ﻣﻦ ﺍﳊﻘﻴﻘﺔ‪ ،‬ﻭﻣﻦ ﻫﻨﺎ ﻻ ﻳﺒﻌﺪ ﺃﻥ ﺗﻜﻮﻥ ﻫﻨﺎﻙ ﻧﺒﻮﺀﺍﺕ ﺗﻮﺭﺍﺗﻴّـﺔ‬ ‫ﻣﺼﺪﺭﻫﺎ ﺍﻟﻮﺣﻲ‪ ،‬ﻭﺇﻥ ﻛﺎﻧﺖ ﲢﺘﺎﺝ ﺇﱃ ﺗﺄﻭﻳﻞ‪ ،‬ﺃﻭ ﻓﻚ ﺭﻣﻮﺯ‪ .‬ﻭﳓـﻦ ﻫﻨـﺎ‬ ‫ﺑﺼﺪﺩ ﺗﺄﻭﻳﻞ ﻧﺒﻮﺀﺓ ﻗﺮﺁﻧﻴﺔ ﺳﺒﻖ ﺃﻥ ﻛﺎﻧﺖ ﻧﺒﻮﺀﺓ ﰲ ﺍﻟﺘﻮﺭﺍﺓ‪ ،‬ﺣﻴـﺚ ﻳﻘـﻮﻝ‬ ‫ﺏ‬ ‫ﻀ ْﻴﻨَﺎ ﺇﱃ ﺑﲏ ﺇﺳـﺮﺍﺋﻴ ﹶﻞ ﰲ ﺍﻟﻜﺘـﺎ ِ‬ ‫ﺳﺒﺤﺎﻧﻪ ﻭﺗﻌﺎﱃ ﰲ ﺳﻮﺭﺓ ﺍﻹﺳﺮﺍﺀ‪َ ) :‬ﻭ ﹶﻗ َ‬ ‫ﺽ ﻣﺮﺗﲔ‪ ...‬ﹶﻓﺈِﺫﺍ ﺟﺎ َﺀ َﻭ ْﻋﺪُ ﺃﻭﹶﻟﺎﻫُﻤﺎ‪ ...‬ﻓﺈﺫﺍ ﺟﺎﺀ َﻭﻋْـ ُﺪ‬ ‫ﺴﺪُ ﹼﻥ ﰲ ﺍﻷﺭ ِ‬ ‫ﹶﻟﺘُ ﹾﻔ ِ‬ ‫ﺍﻵﺧﺮﺓِ‪.٣٤ ( ...‬‬ ‫‪ ٣٤‬ﺍﻹﺳﺮﺍﺀ ‪(٧ -٤) :‬‬ ‫‪٤٥‬‬ ‫ﰲ ﺳﺒﻌﻴﻨﻴّﺎﺕ ﺍﻟﻘﺮﻥ ﺍﳌﺎﺿﻲ‪ ،‬ﺧﺮﺝ ﻋﻠﻴﻨﺎ ﺍﳌﺪﻋﻮ ﺭﺷﺎﺩ ﺧﻠﻴﻔﺔ ﺑﺒﺤـﺚ‬ ‫ﻳﺘﻌﹼﻠﻖ ﺑﺎﻹﻋﺠﺎﺯ ﺍﻟﻌﺪﺩﻱ ﻟﻠﻘﺮﺍﻥ ﺍﻟﻜﺮﱘ‪ ،‬ﻳﻘﻮﻡ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺍﻟﻌﺪﺩ ‪ ١٩‬ﻭﻣﻀـﺎﻋﻔﺎﺗﻪ‪.‬‬ ‫ﻭﻗﺪ ﺗﻠ ﹼﻘﺎﻩ ﺍﻟﻨﺎﺱ ﰲ ﺍﻟﺒﺪﺍﻳﺔ ﺑﺎﻟﻘﺒﻮﻝ ﻭﺍﻹﻋﺠﺎﺏ‪ ،‬ﰒ ﻣﺎ ﻟﺒﺜﻮﺍ ﺃﻥ ﺷﻌﺮﻭﺍ ﺑﺎﳓﺮﺍﻑ‬ ‫ﺍﻟﺮﺟﻞ‪ ،‬ﳑﺎ ﺟﻌﻠﻬﻢ ﻳﻘﻔﻮﻥ ﻣﻮﻗﻒ ﺍﳌﻌﺎﺭﺽ ﻟﺒﺤﺜﻪ‪ ،‬ﻭﺯﺍﺩ ﻣﻦ ﺷﺪّﺓ ﺍﻟـ ّﺮﻓﺾ ﺃ ﹼﻥ‬ ‫ﺍﻟﻌﺪﺩ ‪ ١٩‬ﻣﻘﺪﺱ ﻋﻨﺪ ﺍﻟﺒﻬﺎﺋﻴﲔ‪.‬‬ ‫ﻟﻘﺪ ﺗﻴﺴﺮ ﻟﻨﺎ ﺑﻔﻀﻞ ﺍﷲ ﺗﻌﺎﱃ ﺃﻥ ﻧﺪﺭﺱ ﺍﻟﺒﺤﺚ ﺩﺭﺍﺳـﺔ ﻣﺴﺘﻔﻴﻀـﺔ‬ ‫ﻭﻣﺴﺘﻘﺼﻴﺔ‪ ٣٥،‬ﻓﻮﺟﺪﻧﺎ ﺃ ﹼﻥ ﺍﻟﺮﺟﻞ ﻳﻜﺬﺏ ﻭﻳﻠ ﱢﻔﻖ ﺍﻷﺭﻗﺎﻡ‪ ،‬ﳑﺎ ﺟﻌﻞ ﺭﻓﺾ ﺍﻟﻨﺎﺱ‬ ‫ﻟﺒﺤﺜﻪ ﻣﱪﺭﹰﺍ‪ .‬ﻭﻟﻜﻦ ﺍﻟﻼﻓﺖ ﻟﻼﻧﺘﺒﺎﻩ ﺃ ﹼﻥ ﻫﻨﺎﻙ ﻣﻘ ّﺪﻣﺎﺕ ﺗﺸﲑ ﺇﱃ ﻭﺟﻮﺩ ﺑﻨـﺎﺀ‬ ‫ﺭﻳﺎﺿﻲّ ﻳﻘﻮﻡ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺍﻟﻌﺪﺩ ‪ ،١٩‬ﻭﻫﺬﻩ ﺍﳌﻘ ّﺪﻣﺎﺕ ﻫﻲ ﺍﳉـﺰﺀ ﺍﻟﺼّـﺤﻴﺢ ﻣـﻦ‬ ‫ﺍﻟﺒﺤﺚ‪ .‬ﻭﻳﺒﺪﻭ ﺃ ﹼﻥ ﻋﺪﻡ ﺻﺪﻕ ﺍﻟﺮﺟﻞ ﺣﺎﻝ ﺑﻴﻨﻪ ﻭﺑﲔ ﻣﻌﺮﻓﺔ ﺣﻘﻴﻘﺔ ﻣﺎ ﺗﻌﻨﻴـﻪ‬ ‫ﻫﺬﻩ ﺍﳌﻘﺪﻣﺎﺕ‪.‬‬ ‫ﻭﺑﻌﺪ ﺇﻋﺎﺩﺓ ﺍﻟّﻨﻈﺮ ﻣﺮﺍﺕ ﻭﻣﺮﺍﺕ‪ ،‬ﻭﺟﺪﻧﺎ ﺃ ﹼﻥ ﻫﻨﺎﻙ ﺑﻨﺎ ًﺀ ﺭﻳﺎﺿﻴﹰﺎ ﻣﻌﺠﺰﹰﺍ‬ ‫ﻳﻘﻮﻡ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺃﺳﺎﺱ ﺍﻟﻌﺪﺩ ‪ ،١٩‬ﻭﻫﻮ ﺑﻨﺎﺀ ﰲ ﻏﺎﻳﺔ ﺍﻹﺑﺪﺍﻉ‪ .‬ﻭﻗﺪ ﺃﺻﺪﺭﻧﺎ ﻋـﺎﻡ‬ ‫‪١٩٩٠‬ﻡ ﻛﺘﺎﺑﺎ ﺑﻌﻨﻮﺍﻥ )ﻋﺠﻴﺒﺔ ﺗﺴﻌﺔ ﻋﺸﺮ ﺑﲔ ﲣﻠﻒ ﺍﳌﺴﻠﻤﲔ ﻭﺿـﻼﻻﺕ‬ ‫ﺼﻠﻨﺎ ﻓﻴﻪ ﻫﺬﺍ ﺍﻹﻋﺠﺎﺯ ﺍﳌﺪﻫﺶ‪ ،‬ﺍﻟﺬﻱ ﻳﻔﺮﺽ ﻧﻔﺴﻪ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺍﻟﻨﺎﺱ‪،‬‬ ‫ﺍﳌ ّﺪﻋﲔ(‪ ،٣٦‬ﻓ ّ‬ ‫ﻻ ﹼﻥ ﻋﺎﱂ ﺍﻟﻌﺪﺩ ﻳﻘﻮﻡ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺑﺪﻫّﻴﺎﺕ ﺍﻟﻌﻘﻞ‪ ،‬ﻭﻻ ﳎـﺎﻝ ﻓﻴـﻪ ﻟﻼﺟﺘـﻬﺎﺩ‪ ،‬ﺃﻭ‬ ‫ﻭﺟﻬﺎﺕ ﺍﻟﻨﻈﺮ ﺍﻟﺸﺨﺼﻴﺔ‪ ٣٧.‬ﻭﻛﺎﻥ ﳑﺎ ﻭﺟﺪﻧﺎﻩ ﺃ ﹼﻥ ﺍﻟﻌﺪﺩ ‪ ١٩‬ﻳﺘﻜﺮﺭ ﺑﺸﻜﻞ‬ ‫‪ ٣٥‬ﺭﺍﺟﻊ ﻛﺘﺎﺑﻨﺎ‪ ) :‬ﺇﻋﺠﺎﺯ ﺍﻟﺮﻗﻢ ‪ ١٩‬ﰲ ﺍﻟﻘﺮﺁﻥ ﺍﻟﻜﺮﱘ‪ ،‬ﻣﻘﺪﻣﺎﺕ ﺗﻨﺘﻈﺮ ﺍﻟﻨﺘﺎﺋﺞ( – ‪١٩٩٤‬ﻡ ‪ -‬ﺍﳌﺆﺳﺴﺔ ﺍﻹﺳﻼﻣﻴّﺔ‬ ‫ ﺑﲑﻭﺕ‪.‬‬‫‪ ،١٩٩٠ ٣٦‬ﻣﺆﺳﺴﺔ ﺍﻻﻋﺘﺼﺎﻡ ‪ ،‬ﺍﳋﻠﻴﻞ – ﻓﻠﺴﻄﲔ‪.‬‬ ‫‪ ٣٧‬ﺭﺍﺟﻊ ﻛﺘﺎﺑﻨﺎ‪) :‬ﺇﺭﻫﺎﺻﺎﺕ ﺍﻹﻋﺠﺎﺯ ﺍﻟﻌﺪﺩﻱ(‪ ،‬ﻭﻛﺘﺎﺏ )ﺇﻋﺠﺎﺯ ﺍﻟﺮﻗﻢ ‪ ١٩‬ﰲ ﺍﻟﻘﺮﺁﻥ ﺍﻟﻜﺮﱘ ﻣﻘﺪﻣﺎﺕ ﺗﻨﺘﻈﺮ ﺍﻟﻨﺘﺎﺋﺞ(‪.‬‬ ‫‪٤٦‬‬ ‫ﻻﻓﺖ ﻟﻠﻨﻈﺮ ﰲ ﺍﻟﻌﻼﻗﺔ ﺍﻟﻘﺎﺋﻤﺔ ﺑﲔ ﺍﻟﺸﻤﺲ ﻭﺍﻷﺭﺽ ﻭﺍﻟﻘﻤﺮ‪ ،‬ﳑﺎ ﻗﺪ ﻳﺸﲑ ﺇﱃ‬ ‫ﻭﺟﻮﺩ ﻗﺎﻧﻮﻥ ﻛﻮﱐ ﻭﻗﺮﺁﱐﹼ‪ ،‬ﻛﻴﻒ ﻻ‪ ،‬ﻭﺍﷲ ﺳﺒﺤﺎﻧﻪ ﺧﻠﻖ ﻭﻫﻮ ﺍﻟﺬﻱ ﺃﻧﺰﻝ ؟!‬ ‫ﱂ ﻧﻜﻦ ﻧﺘﺼ ّﻮﺭ ﺃﻥ ﻳﻜﻮﻥ ﻫﺬﺍ ﺍﻟﻌﺪﺩ ﻫﻮ ﺍﻷﺳﺎﺱ ﳌﻌﺎﺩﻟﺔ ﺗﺎﺭﳜﻴﺔ ﺗﺴﺘﻨﺪ‬ ‫ﺇﱃ ﺍﻟﻌﺪﺩ ﺍﻟﻘﺮﺁﱐ‪ ،‬ﻭﺗﻨﺴﺠﻢ ﻣﻊ ﺍﻟﻘﻮﺍﻧﲔ ﺍﻟﻔﻠﻜﻴّﺔ‪ ،‬ﺣﱴ ﻭﻗﻌﻨﺎ ﻋﻠﻰ ﳏﺎﺿـﺮﺓ‬ ‫ﻟﻠﻜﺎﺗﺐ ﺍﳌﻌﺮﻭﻑ )ﳏﻤﺪ ﺃﲪﺪ ﺍﻟ ّﺮﺍﺷﺪ( ﺣﻮﻝ ﺍﻟﻨﻈﺎﻡ ﺍﻟﻌﺎﳌﻲ ﺍﳉﺪﻳﺪ‪ .‬ﻓﻜﺎﻧـﺖ‬ ‫ﻫﻲ ﺍﳌﻔﺘﺎﺡ ﳍﺬﻩ ﺍﳌﻼﺣﻈﺎﺕ ﺍﻟﱵ ﻧﻀﻌﻬﺎ ﺑﲔ ﻳﺪﻱ ﺍﻟﻘﺎﺭﺉ ﺍﻟﻜـﺮﱘ‪ ،‬ﻭﺍﻟـﺬﻱ‬ ‫ﺻﻔﺤﺎﺕ ﺍﳌﺮﺍﺟﻊ‪ ،‬ﺇﺫ ﺃﻧﲏ ﺃﻛﺘﺐ ﻣـﻦ‬ ‫ﻧﺮﺟﻮ ﺃﻥ ﻳﻌﺬﺭﻧﺎ ﺇﻥ ﱂ ﻧﺬﻛﺮ ﻟﻪ ﺃﺭﻗﺎﻡ ّ‬ ‫ﺧﻴﻤﱵ ﰲ ﻣﺮﺝ ﺍﻟﺰﻫﻮﺭ‪ ،‬ﻭﻗﺪ ﺧﹼﻠﻔﺖ ﺃﻭﺭﺍﻗﻲ ﻭﺭﺍﺋﻲ ﰲ ﻭﻃﲏ‪ .٣٨‬ﻭﻋﻠﻰ ﺃﻳـﺔ‬ ‫ﺣﺎﻝ ﺳﻮﻑ ﻻ ﳓﺘﺎﺝ ﺇﱃ ﻣﺮﺍﺟﻊ ﻛﺜﲑﺓ‪ ،‬ﻭﺳﻴﻜﻮﻥ ﻣﻦ ﺍﻟﺴّﻬﻞ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺍﻟﻘﺎﺭﺉ ﺃﻥ‬ ‫ﻳﺘﺤﻘﻖ ﻣﻦ ﻛﻞ ﻣﺎ ﺫﻛﺮﻧﺎﻩ‪ ،‬ﺑﺎﻟﺮﺟﻮﻉ ﺇﱃ ﺍﻟﻘﺮﺍﻥ ﺍﻟﻜﺮﱘ‪ ،‬ﹼﰒ ﻣﺎ ﻳﺴﻤّﻰ ﺑﺎﻟﻌﻬﺪ‬ ‫ﺍﻟﻘﺪﱘ‪ ،‬ﻭﺑﻌﺾ ﺍﳌﺼﺎﺩﺭ ﺍﻟﺘﺎﺭﳜﻴﺔ ﻭﺍﻟﻔﻠﻜﻴﺔ‪.‬‬ ‫ﻻ ﻧﻘﻮﻝ ﺇﻬﻧﺎ ﻧﺒﻮﺀﺓ‪ ،‬ﻭﻻ ﻧﺰﻋﻢ ﺃﻬﻧﺎ ﺳﺘﺤﺪُﺙ ﺣﺘﻤـﹰﺎ‪ ،‬ﻭﺇﳕﹼـﺎ ﻫـﻲ‬ ‫ﻣﻼﺣﻈﺎﺕ ﺭﺃﻳﻨﺎ ﺃﻧّﻪ ﻣﻦ ﻭﺍﺟﺒﻨﺎ ﺃﻥ ﻧﻀﻌﻬﺎ ﺑﲔ ﻳﺪﻱ ﺍﻟﻘﺎﺭﺉ‪ ،‬ﰒ ﻧﺘﺮﻙ ﺍﳊﻜﻢ ﻟﻪ‬ ‫ﻋﻠﻰ ﺿﻮﺀ ﺍﻟﻘﻨﺎﻋﺎﺕ ﺍﻟﱵ ﻳﺼﻞ ﺇﻟﻴﻬﺎ‪.‬‬ ‫ﻛﺎﻧﺖ ﺍﻟﺒﺪﺍﻳﺔ‪ ،‬ﻛﻤﺎ ﺃﺷﺮﻧﺎ‪ ،‬ﳏﺎﺿﺮﺓﻣﺪﻭّﻧﺔ ﻟﻠﻜﺎﺗـﺐ )ﳏﻤـﺪ ﺃﲪـﺪ‬ ‫ﺍﻟ ّﺮﺍﺷﺪ(‪ ،‬ﺗﺘﻌﻠﻖ ﺑﺎﻟﻨﻈﺎﻡ ﺍﻟﻌﺎﳌﻲ ﺍﳉﺪﻳﺪ‪ .‬ﻭﻗﺪ ﻳﺴﺘﻐﺮﺏ ﺍﻟﻘﺎﺭﺉ ﺃﻥ ﺗﺘﻀﻤﻦ ﻫﺬﻩ‬ ‫ﺍﶈﺎﺿﺮﺓ ﺍﳉﺎ ّﺩﺓ ﺍﻟﻜﻼﻡ ﺍﻵﰐ‪ ،‬ﻭﺍﻟﺬﻱ ﻧﻨﻘﻠﻪ ﺑﺎﳌﻌﲎ‪ " :‬ﻋﻨﺪﻣﺎ ﺃﹸﻋﻠﻦ ﻋـﻦ ﻗﻴـﺎﻡ‬ ‫ﺩﻭﻟﺔ ﺇﺳﺮﺍﺋﻴﻞ ﻋﺎﻡ ‪١٩٤٨‬ﻡ‪ ،‬ﺟﺎﺀﺕ ﺟﺎﺭﺓ‪ ،‬ﻭﻫﻲ ﻋﺠﻮﺯ ﻳﻬﻮﺩﻳّﺔ‪ ،‬ﺇﱃ ﺃ ّﻡ ﳏ ّﻤﺪ‬ ‫ﺍﻟﺮﺍﺷﺪ‪ ،‬ﻭﻫﻲ ﺗﺒﻜﻲ‪ .‬ﻓﻠ ّﻤﺎ ﺳﺄﻟﺘﻬﺎ ﺃ ّﻡ ﺍﻟﺮﺍﺷﺪ ﻋﻦ ﺳﺒﺐ ﺑﻜﺎﺋﻬﺎ‪ ،‬ﻭﻗـﺪ ﻓـﺮﺡ‬ ‫‪ ٣٨‬ﻛﺎﻥ ﺫﻟﻚ ﻋﻨﺪ ﺗﺪﻭﻳﻦ ﺍﻟﻄﺒﻌﺔ ﺍﻷﻭﱃ ﻋﺎﻡ ‪١٩٩٣‬ﻡ‪.‬‬ ‫‪٤٧‬‬ ‫ﺍﻟﻴﻬﻮﺩ‪ ،‬ﻗﺎﻟﺖ‪ :‬ﺇ ﹼﻥ ﻗﻴﺎﻡ ﻫﺬﻩ ﺍﻟ ّﺪﻭﻟﺔ ﺳﻴﻜﻮﻥ ﺳﺒﺒﹰﺎ ﰲ ﺫﺑﺢ ﺍﻟﻴﻬـﻮﺩ‪ .‬ﰒ ﻳﻘـﻮﻝ‬ ‫ﺍﻟﺮﺍﺷﺪ ﺇﻧﻪ ﲰﻌﻬﺎ ﺗﻘﻮﻝ ﺇ ﹼﻥ ﻫﺬﻩ ﺍﻟﺪﻭﻟﺔ ﺳﺘﺪﻭﻡ ‪ ٧٦‬ﺳﻨﺔ‪ .‬ﻛﺎﻥ ﺍﻟﺮﺍﺷﺪ ﻋﻨﺪﻫﺎ‬ ‫ﺻﻐﲑﺍﹰ‪ ،‬ﻭﻋﻨﺪﻣﺎ ﻛﱪ ﺭﺃﻯ ﺃ ﹼﻥ ﺍﻷﻣﺮ ﻗﺪ ﻳﺘﻌﻠﻖ ﺑﺪﻭﺭﺓ ﺍ ﹸﳌﺬّﻧﺐ ﻫﺎﱄ‪ ،‬ﻷ ﹼﻥ ﻣﺬّﻧﺐ‬ ‫ﻫﺎﱄ‪ ،‬ﻛﻤﺎ ﻳﻘﻮﻝ ﺍﻟﺮﺍﺷﺪ‪ ،‬ﻣﺮﺗﺒﻂ ﺑﻌﻘﺎﺋﺪ ﺍﻟﻴﻬﻮﺩ‪.‬‬ ‫ﰲ ﺍﻟﺒﺪﺍﻳﺔﱂ ﻳﻌﺠﺒﻨﺎ ﺍﻟﻜﻼﻡ‪ ،‬ﻷﻥ ﺍﶈﺎﺿﺮﺓ ﺭﲟﺎ ﺗﻜﻮﻥ ﺃﻓﻀﻞ ﻟﻮ ﱂ ﺗُﺬﻛﺮ‬ ‫ﻫﺬﻩ ﺍﳊﺎﺩﺛﺔ‪ ،‬ﺇﺫ ﺃﻥ ﺍﻟﻨﺎﺱ ﻗﺪ ﺍﻋﺘﺎﺩﻭﺍ ﺃﻥ ﻳﺴﻤﻌﻮﺍ ﻣﻦ ﺃﻓﻮﺍﻩ ﺍﻟﻌﺠﺎﺋﺰ ﺍﻟّﻨﺒـﻮﺀﺍﺕ‬ ‫ﺍﳌﺨﺘﻠﻘﺔ‪ ،‬ﻓﺄﺻﺒﺤﻮﺍ‪ ،‬ﻭﻋﻠﻰ ﻭﺟﻪ ﺍﳋﺼﻮﺹ ﺍﳌﺜﻘﻔﻮﻥ ﻣﻨﻬﻢ‪ ،‬ﻳﻨﻔﺮﻭﻥ ﻣﻦ ﻣﺜـﻞ‬ ‫ﻫﺬﺍ ﺍﳊﺪﻳﺚ‪ .‬ﹼﰒ ﻣﺎ ﻟﺒﺜﻨﺎ ﺃﻥ ﺗﻨﺒّﻬﻨﺎ ﺇﱃ ﺍﺣﺘﻤﺎﻝ ﺃﻥ ﺗﻜﻮﻥ ﻫﺬﻩ ﺍﻟﻌﺠـﻮﺯ ﻗـﺪ‬ ‫ﲰﻌﺖ ﻣﻦ ﺍﳊﺎﺧﺎﻣﺎﺕ‪ ،‬ﻷ ﹼﻥ ﺍﻟﻌﻘﻞ ﻳﺴﺘﺒﻌﺪ ﺍﺣﺘﻤﺎﻝ ﺃﻥ ﻳﻜﻮﻥ ﻫﺬﺍ ﺍﻟﻜﻼﻡ ﻣﻦ‬ ‫ﺻﺔ‪ .‬ﻭﻟﻴﺲ ﻫﻨﺎﻙ ﻣﺎ ﳝﻨﻊ‪ ،‬ﻭﻓﻖ ﺍﻟﻌﻘﻴﺪﺓ ﺍﻹﺳﻼﻣﻴّﺔ‪ ،‬ﺃﻥ‬ ‫ﺗﻮﹼﻗﻌﺎﻬﺗﺎ‪ ،‬ﺃﻭﲢﻠﻴﻼﻬﺗﺎ ﺍﳋﺎ ّ‬ ‫ﻳﻜﻮﻥ ﻟﺪﻯ ﺍﳊﺎﺧﺎﻣﺎﺕ ﺑﻘﻴﺔ ﻣﻦ ﺍﻟﻮﺣﻲ‪ ،‬ﲣﺘﻠﻂ ﺑﺎﻟﻜﺜﲑ ﻣﻦ ﺃﻭﻫـﺎﻡ ﺍﻟﺒﺸـﺮ‬ ‫ﻭﺃﺳﺎﻃﲑﻫﻢ‪ ...‬ﻭﻫﻜﺬﺍ ﻛﺎﻧﺖ ﺍﻟﺒﺪﺍﻳﺔ‪.‬‬ ‫‪٤٨‬‬ ‫ﺟﺎﺀ ﰲ ﻛﺘﺎﺏ ﺍﻷﺻﻮﻟّﻴﺔ ﺍﻟﻴﻬﻮﺩﻳﺔ ﰲ ﺇﺳﺮﺍﺋﻴﻞ‪ ..." :‬ﻭﻫﺬﺍ ﺑﺎﻟﻀﺒﻂ ﻫﻮ‬ ‫ﻧﻮﻉ ﺍﻟﺴّﻼﻡ ﺍﻟﺬﻱ ﺗﻨﺒﺄ ﺑﻪ ﻣﻨﺎﺣﻢ ﺑﻴﻐﻦ‪ ،‬ﻋﻨﺪﻣﺎ ﺃﻋﻠـﻦ ﰲ ﺫﺭﻭﺓ ﺍﻟﻨﺠـﺎﺡ‬ ‫ﺍﻹﺳﺮﺍﺋﻴﻠﻲ ﺍﻟﻈﺎﻫﺮﻱ ﰲ ﺍﳊﺮﺏ ﻋﻠﻰ ﻟﺒﻨﺎﻥ‪ ،‬ﻋﻨﺪﻣﺎ ﻗﺎﻝ‪ :‬ﺇ ﹼﻥ ﺇﺳﺮﺍﺋﻴﻞ ﺳﺘﻨﻌﻢ‬ ‫ﲟﺎ ﻧﺼّﺖ ﺍﻟﺘﻮﺭﺍﺓ ﻋﻠﻴﻪ ﻣﻦ ﺳﻨﻮﺍﺕ ﺍﻟﺴّﻼﻡ ﺍﻷﺭﺑﻌﲔ "‪ .٣٩‬ﻓﻬﻞ ﻳﺸﲑ ﺑـﻴﻐﻦ‬ ‫ﻫﻨﺎ ﺇﱃ ﺍﻟﻨﺒﻮﺀﺓ ﺍﻟﱵ ﺑﺪﺃﻧﺎ ﻬﺑﺎ ﻫﺬﺍ ﺍﻟﺒﺤﺚ ؟! ﻓـﺎﳌﻌﺮﻭﻑ ﺃ ﹼﻥ ﺇﺳـﺮﺍﺋﻴﻞ ﻗـﺪ‬ ‫ﺍﺟﺘﺎﺣﺖ ﻟﺒﻨﺎﻥ ﻋﺎﻡ ‪١٩٨٢‬ﻡ‪ ،‬ﻭﻋﻠﻴﻪ ﺗﻜﻮﻥ ﻬﻧﺎﻳﺔ ﺍﻷﺭﺑﻌـﲔ ﺳـﻨﺔ ﺑﺘـﺎﺭﻳﺦ‪:‬‬ ‫)‪٢٠٢٢ = (٤٠+١٩٨٢‬ﻡ‪.٤٠‬‬ ‫‪ ٣٩‬ﺍﻷﺻﻮﻟﻴّﺔ ﺍﻟﻴﻬﻮﺩﻳﺔ ﰲ ﺇﺳﺮﺍﺋﻴﻞ‪،‬ﺇﻳﺎﻥ ﻟﻮﺳﺘﻚ‪ ،‬ﺗﺮﲨﺔ ﺣﺴﲏ ﺯﻳﻨﺔ‪ ،‬ﺇﺻﺪﺍﺭ ﻣﺆﺳﺴﺔ ﺍﻟﺪﺭﺍﺳﺎﺕ ﺍﻟﻔﻠﺴﻄﻴﻨﻴّﺔ‪ ،‬ﻁ‪،١‬‬ ‫‪١٩٩١‬ﻡ‪ ،‬ﺻﻔﺤﺔ ‪ ،٩٥‬ﺑﲑﻭﺕ‪.‬‬ ‫‪ ٤٠‬ﻻ ﻧﺘﻮﻗﻊ ﺃﻥ ﳛﺪّﺙ ﺑﻴﻐﻦ ﺍﻟﺼﺤﺎﻓﺔ ﺑﺎﻟﺴﻨﲔ ﺍﻟﻘﻤﺮﻳﺔ‪ .‬ﻭﻻ ﻧﺪﺭﻱ ﻣﺎﺫﺍ ﻳﻘﺼﺪ ﺑﺴﻨﻮﺍﺕ ﺍﻟﺴﻼﻡ‪ .‬ﻭﱂ ﻳﻘﻞ ﻣﺎﺫﺍ ﺳﻴﺤﺼﻞ‬ ‫ﺑﻌﺪ ﺍﻧﺘﻬﺎﺋﻬﺎ‪.‬‬ ‫‪٤٩‬‬ ‫ﺍﻟﻨﺒﻮﺀﺓ ﺍﻟﻐﺎﻣﻀﺔ‬ ‫ﺗﺪﻭﻡ ﺇﺳﺮﺍﺋﻴﻞ ﻭﻓﻖ ﺍﻟﻨﺒـﻮﺀﺓ ﺍﻟﻐﺎﻣﻀـﺔ ‪ ٧٦‬ﺳـﻨﺔ‪ ،‬ﺃﻱ )‪.(٤×١٩‬‬ ‫ﻭﻳُﻔﺘﺮﺽ ﺃﻥ ﺗﻜﻮﻥ ﺳﻨﲔ ﻗﻤﺮّﻳﺔ‪ ،‬ﻷﻥ ﺍﻟﻴﻬﻮﺩ ﻳﺘﻌﺎﻣﻠﻮﻥ ﺩﻳﻨﻴﹰﺎ ﺑﺎﻟﺸﻬﺮ ﺍﻟﻘﻤﺮﻱ‪،‬‬ ‫ﻭﻳﻀﻴﻔﻮﻥ ﻛﻞ ﺛﻼﺙ ﺳﻨﻮﺍﺕ ﺷﻬﺮﹰﺍ ﻟﻠﺘﻮﻓﻴﻖ ﺑﲔ ﺍﻟﺴﻨﺔ ﺍﻟﻘﻤﺮّﻳﺔ ﻭﺍﻟﺸﻤﺴـّﻴﺔ‪.‬‬ ‫ﻭﻣﻌﻠﻮﻡ ﺃ ﹼﻥ ﺍﻟﻌﺎﻡ ‪١٩٤٨‬ﻡ ﻫﻮ ﺍﻟﻌﺎﻡ ‪١٣٦٧‬ﻫـ‪ .‬ﻭﻋﻠﻰ ﺿﻮﺀ ﺫﻟـﻚ‪ ،‬ﻭﺇﺫﺍ‬ ‫ﺤﺖ ﺍﻟﻨﺒﻮﺀﺓ‪ ،‬ﻓﺈﻥ ﺇﺳﺮﺍﺋﻴﻞ ﺗﺪﻭﻡ ﺣﱴ‪١٤٤٣ = ( ٧٦ + ١٣٦٧ ) :‬‬ ‫ﺻّ‬ ‫ﻫﺠﺮﻱ‪ ،‬ﻭﻫﺬﺍ ﻳﻮﺍﻓﻖ ‪ ٢٠٢٢‬ﻣﻴﻼﺩﻱ‪.‬‬ ‫ﺗﺴﻤّﻰ ﺳﻮﺭﺓ ﺍﻹﺳﺮﺍﺀ ﺃﻳﻀﺎ ﺳﻮﺭﺓ ﺑﲏ ﺇﺳﺮﺍﺋﻴﻞ‪ .‬ﻭﻫﻲ ﺗﺘﺤـﺪﺙ ﰲ‬ ‫ﺺ ﻫﺬﻩ ﺍﻟﻨﺒﻮﺀﺓ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺇﻓﺴﺎﺩﻳﻦ‬ ‫ﻣﻄﻠﻌﻬﺎ ﻋﻦ ﻧﺒﻮﺀﺓ ﺃﻧﺰﳍﺎ ﺍﷲ ﺗﻌﺎﱃ ﰲ ﺍﻟﺘﻮﺭﺍﺓ‪ ،‬ﻭﺗﻨ ّ‬ ‫ﻟﺒﲏ ﺇﺳﺮﺍﺋﻴﻞ ﰲ ﺍﻷﺭﺽ ﺍﺍﳌﻘﺪّﺳﺔ‪ ،‬ﻭﻳﻜﻮﻥ ﻫﺬﺍ ﺍﻹﻓﺴﺎﺩ ﰲ ﺻﻮﺭﺓ ﳎﺘﻤﻌّﻴﺔ‪ ،‬ﺃﻭ‬ ‫ﻣﺎ ﻳﺴ ّﻤﻰ ﺍﻟﻴﻮﻡ ﺑﺎﻟﺪﻭﻟﺔ‪ ٤١،‬ﻓﻴﻜﻮﻥ ﺫﻟﻚ ﻋﻦ ﻋﻠﻮ ﻭﺍﺳﺘﻜﺒﺎﺭ‪ .‬ﻳﻘﻮﻝ ﺳـﺒﺤﺎﻧﻪ‬ ‫ﻯ ﻟﺒﲏ ﺇﺳﺮﺍﺋﻴ ﹶﻞ ﺃﹶﻻ ﺗَﺘﺨﺬﻭﺍ‬ ‫ﺏ ﻭﺟﻌﻠﻨﺎ ُﻩ ﻫﺪ ً‬ ‫ﻭﺗﻌﺎﱃ ‪َ " :‬ﻭﺀَﺍﺗَﻴﻨﺎ ﻣُﻮﺳَﻰ ﺍﻟﻜﺘﺎ َ‬ ‫ﺡ ﺇّﻧ ُﻪ ﻛﺎ ﹶﻥ َﻋ ْﺒ َﺪﹰﺍ َﺷﻜﹸﻮﺭﹰﺍ‪َ .‬ﻭ ﹶﻗﻀَـ ْﻴﻨَﺎ‬ ‫ﻣﻦ ﺩﻭﱐ ﻭَﻛﻴﻼ‪ ،‬ﹸﺫ ّﺭﻳ ﹶﺔ َﻣ ْﻦ َﺣ َﻤ ﹾﻠﻨَﺎ َﻣ َﻊ ﻧُﻮ ٍ‬ ‫‪ ٤١‬ﺭﺍﺟﻊ ﺍﻟﺼﻔﺤﺎﺕ‪.(٢٤،٢٣) :‬‬ ‫‪٥٠‬‬ ‫ﺽ ﻣـ ّﺮﺗﲔ َﻭﻟﹶـَﺘ ْﻌ ﹸﻠ ّﻦ ﻋُﻠـﻮﹰﺍ‬ ‫ﺴﺪُ ﹼﻥ ﰲ ﺍﻷﺭ ِ‬ ‫ﺏ ﹶﻟﺘُ ﹾﻔ ِ‬ ‫ﺇﱃ ﺑﲏ ﺇﺳﺮﺍﺋﻴ ﹶﻞ ﰲ ﺍﻟﻜﺘﺎ ِ‬ ‫ﻛﺒﲑﹰﺍ‪ ...،‬ﻓﺈﺫﺍ ﺟﺎﺀ َﻭْﻋ ُﺪ ﺃﻭﻻﻫُﻤﺎ‪ ...‬ﻓﺈﺫﺍ ﺟﺎ َﺀ َﻭ ْﻋﺪُ ﺍﻵﺧﺮﺓ ِ"‪ ٤٢‬ﺃ ّﻣﺎ ﺍﻹﻓﺴﺎﺩ‬ ‫ﺍﻷﻭﻝ ﻓﻘﺪ ﻣﻀﻰ ﻗﺒﻞ ﺍﻹﺳﻼﻡ‪ ،‬ﻭﺃ ّﻣﺎ ﺍﻟﺜﺎﱐ ﻭﺍﻷﺧﲑ ﻓﺈﻥ ﺍﳌﻌﻄﻴﺎﺕ ﺗﻘﻮﻝ ﺇﻧـﻪ‬ ‫ﺍﻟ ّﺪﻭﻟﺔ ﺍﻟﱵ ﻗﺎﻣﺖ ﰲ ﻓﻠﺴﻄﲔ ﻋﺎﻡ ‪١٩٤٨‬ﻡ‪ ٤٣،‬ﻭﺍﳌﻼﺣﻆ ﺃﻥ ﺗﻌﺒﲑ " ﻭﻋـﺪ‬ ‫ﺍﻵﺧﺮﺓ "‪،‬ﱂ ﻳﺮﺩ ﰲ ﺍﻟﻘﺮﺁﻥ ﺍﻟﻜﺮﱘ ﺇﻻ ﻣ ّﺮﺗﲔ‪ :‬ﺍﻷﻭﱃﻋﻨﺪ ﺍﻟﻜﻼﻡ ﻋﻦ ﺍﻹﻓﺴـﺎﺩ‬ ‫ﺍﻟﺜﺎﱐ‪ ،‬ﰲ ﺑﺪﺍﻳﺔ ﺳﻮﺭﺓ ﺍﻹﺳﺮﺍﺀ‪ ،‬ﻭﺍﻟﺜﺎﻧﻴﺔ ﻋﻨﺪ ﺍﻟﻜﻼﻡ ﻋﻦ ﺍﻹﻓﺴﺎﺩ ﻧﻔﺴﻪ‪ ،‬ﻗﺒـﻞ‬ ‫ﻬﻧﺎﻳﺔ ﺳﻮﺭﺓ ﺍﻹﺳﺮﺍﺀ ﰲ ﺍﻵﻳﺔ ‪ .١٠٤‬ﻭﻋﻠﻰ ﺿﻮﺀ ﺫﻟﻚ ﻧﻘﻮﻝ‪:‬‬ ‫ﺇﺫﺍ ﻗﻤﻨﺎ ِﺑﻌ ّﺪ ﺍﻟﻜﻠﻤﺎﺕ ﻣﻦ ﺑﺪﺍﻳﺔ ﺍﻟﻜﻼﻡ ﻋﻦ ﺍﻟﻨﺒﻮﺀﺓ‪" :‬ﻭﺁﺗﻴﻨﺎ ﻣﻮﺳـﻰ‬ ‫ﺍﻟﻜﺘﺎﺏ" ﺇﱃ ﺁﺧﺮ ﻛﻼﻡ ﰲ ﺍﻟّﻨﺒﻮﺀﺓ‪" :‬ﻓﺈﺫﺍ ﺟﺎﺀ ﻭﻋﺪ ﺍﻵﺧـﺮﺓ ﺟﺌﻨـﺎ ﺑﻜـﻢ‬ ‫ﻟﻔﻴﻔﺎ"‪ ٤٤‬ﻓﺴﻮﻑ ﳒﺪ ﺃ ﹼﻥ ﻋﺪﺩ ﺍﻟﻜﻠﻤﺎﺕ ﻫﻮ ‪ ١٤٤٣‬ﻛﻠﻤﺔ‪ ،‬ﻭﻫﻮ ﺭﻗﻢ ﻳﻄﺎﺑﻖ‬ ‫ﻣﺎ ﺧﻠﺼﻨﺎ ﺇﻟﻴﻪ ﰲ ﺍﻟﺒﻨﺪ )‪ (١‬ﺃﻱ‪ ١٣٦٧) :‬ﻫـ ‪١٤٤٣ = (٧٦ +‬ﻫـ‬ ‫ﻫﺎﺟﺮ ﺍﻟﺮﺳﻮﻝ‪ ،‬ﺻﻠﻰ ﺍﷲ ﻋﻠﻴﻪ ﻭﺳﻠﻢ‪ ،‬ﺑﺘﺎﺭﻳﺦ ‪٦٢٢/٩/٢٠‬ﻡ‪ ،‬ﻭﻳﺬﻫﺐ‬ ‫ﺍﺑﻦ ﺣﺰﻡ ﺍﻟ ﹼﻈﺎﻫﺮﻱ ﺇﱃ ﺃ ﹼﻥ ﺍﻟﻌﻠﻤﺎﺀ ﻗﺪ ﺃﲨﻌﻮﺍ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺃ ﹼﻥ ﺣﺎﺩﺛﺔ ﺍﻹﺳﺮﺍﺀ ﻛﺎﻧـﺖ‬ ‫ﺤﺔ ﺍﻟﻘﻮﻝ ﺑﺎﻹﲨـﺎﻉ‪،‬‬ ‫ﻗﺒﻞ ﺍﳍﺠﺮﺓ ﺑﺴﻨﺔ‪ ،‬ﺃﻱ ﻋﺎﻡ ‪ ٦٢١‬ﻡ‪ .‬ﻭﻣﻊ ﺷ ﹼﻜﻨﺎ ﰲ ﺻ ّ‬ ‫ﺇﻻ ﺃ ﹼﻥ ﺍﻷﻗﻮﺍﻝ ﺍﻟ ّﺮﺍﺟﺤﺔ ﻻ ﲣﺮﺝ ﻋﻦ ﻫﺬﺍ ﺍﻟﻌﺎﻡ‪ ،‬ﻭﻻ ُﻳﺘﺼ ّﻮﺭ ﺗﺮﺍﺧـﻲ ﻧـﺰﻭﻝ‬ ‫ﻓﻮﺍﺗﺢ ﺳﻮﺭﺓ ﺍﻹﺳﺮﺍﺀ ﻋﻦ ﺣﺎﺩﺛﺔ ﺍﻹﺳﺮﺍﺀ ﻧﻔﺴﻬﺎ‪ .‬ﻋﻠـﻰ ﺿـﻮﺀ ﺫﻟـﻚ‪ ،‬ﻭﺇﺫﺍ‬ ‫ﺤﺖ ﺍﻟﻨﺒﻮﺀﺓ‪ ،‬ﻭﻛﺎﻧﺖ ﻬﻧﺎﻳﺔ ﺇﺳﺮﺍﺋﻴﻞ ﻋﺎﻡ ‪ ١٤٤٣‬ﻫﺠﺮﻱ‪ ،‬ﻓﺈﻥ ﻋﺪﺩ ﺍﻟﺴﻨﲔ‬ ‫ﺻّ‬ ‫‪ ٤٢‬ﺍﻹﺳﺮﺍﺀ‪( ٧ - ٢ ):‬‬ ‫‪ ٤٣‬ﺭﺍﺟﻊ ﺍﻟﺘﻔﺴﲑ‪.‬‬ ‫‪٤٤‬‬ ‫ﺍﻹﺳﺮﺍﺀ ‪١٠٤‬‬ ‫‪٥١‬‬ ‫ﺍﻟﻘﻤﺮّﻳﺔ ﻣﻦ ﺳﻨﺔ ﻧﺰﻭﻝ ﺍﻟﻨﺒﻮﺀﺓ‪ ٤٥‬ﺇﱃ ﺳﻨﺔ ﺯﻭﺍﻝ ﺇﺳـﺮﺍﺋﻴﻞ ﻫـﻮ ‪ ١٤٤٤‬ﻷﻥ‬ ‫ﺍﻹﺳﺮﺍﺀ ﻛﺎﻥ ﻗﺒﻞ ﺍﳍﺠﺮﺓ ﺑﺴﻨﺔ‪ .‬ﻭﺇﻟﻴﻚ ﻫﺬﻩ ﺍﳌﻼﺣﻈﺔ‪:‬‬ ‫)‪ .١٤٤٤ = (٧٦ × ١٩‬ﻻﺣﻆ ﺃﻥ ‪ ٧٦‬ﻫﻮ ﻋﺪﺩ ﺍﻟﺴﻨﲔ ﺍﻟﻘﻤﺮّﻳﺔ ﻟﻌﻤﺮ ﺩﻭﻟﺔ‬ ‫ﺇﺳﺮﺍﺋﻴﻞ‪ ،‬ﺃﻱ ﺃ ﹼﻥ ﺍﳌ ّﺪﺓ ﺍﻟﺰﻣﻨّﻴﺔ ﻣﻦ ﻭﻗﺖ ﻧﺰﻭﻝ ﺍﻟﻨﺒﻮﺀﺓ ﺇﱃ ﺯﻭﺍﻝ ﺇﺳﺮﺍﺋﻴﻞ ﻫـﻲ‬ ‫‪ ١٩‬ﺿﻌﻔﹰﺎ ﻟﻌﻤﺮ ﺇﺳﺮﺍﺋﻴﻞ ﺍﳌﺘﻮﻗﹼﻊ‪.‬‬ ‫ﺴﻼﻡ ﺳﻨﺔ ‪ ٩٣٥‬ﻕ‪.‬ﻡ‪ ،‬ﻓﺎﻧﺸﻘﹼﺖ ﺍﻟﺪﻭﻟـﺔ ﺑﻌـﺪ‬ ‫ﺗﻮﰲ ﺳﻠﻴﻤﺎﻥ ﻋﻠﻴﻪ ﺍﻟ ّ‬ ‫ﻭﻓﺎﺗﻪ ﺑﻮﻗﺖ ﻗﺼﲑ‪ ،‬ﻭﻛﺎﻥ ﻫﺬﺍ ﺍﻻﻧﺸﻘﺎﻕ‪ ،‬ﻓﻴﻤﺎ ﻧﺮﺍﻩ‪ ،‬ﺑﺪﺍﻳـﺔ ﺍﻹﻓﺴـﺎﺩ ﺍﻷﻭﻝ‬ ‫ﺍﳌﺸﺎﺭ ﺇﻟﻴﻪ ﰲ ﻓﻮﺍﺗﺢ ﺳﻮﺭﺓ ﺍﻹﺳﺮﺍﺀ‪ .‬ﺃﻣّﺎ ﻬﻧﺎﻳﺔ ﺍﻹﻓﺴﺎﺩ ﺍﻟﺜﺎﱐ ﻭﺍﻷﺧﲑ ﻓﻴﺘﻮﻗﹼﻊ ﺃﻥ‬ ‫ﻳﻜﻮﻥ ﻋﺎﻡ ‪٢٠٢٢‬ﻡ ﺍﳌﻮﺍﻓﻖ ‪١٤٤٣‬ﻫـ‪ .‬ﻭﻋﻠﻴﻪ ﻳﻜﻮﻥ ﻋﺪﺩ ﺍﻟﺴّـﻨﲔ ﻣـﻦ‬ ‫ﺑﺪﺍﻳﺔ ﺍﻹﻓﺴﺎﺩ ﺍﻷﻭﻝ ﺇﱃ ﺣﺎﺩﺛﺔ ﺍﻹﺳﺮﺍﺀ ﻫﻮ‪١٥٥٦ = (٦٢١+٩٣٥) :‬ﺳـﻨﺔ‬ ‫ﴰﺴّﻴﺔ‪ .‬ﻭﺍﳌﻔﺎﺟﺄﺓ ﻫﻨﺎ ﺃ ﹼﻥ ﻫﺬﺍ ﻫﻮ ﻋﺪﺩ ﻛﻠﻤﺎﺕ ﺳﻮﺭﺓ ﺍﻹﺳﺮﺍﺀ‪ .‬ﺃﻣّـﺎ ﻋـﺪﺩ‬ ‫ﺴﻨﲔ ﻣﻦ ﺑﺪﺍﻳﺔ ﺍﻹﺳﺮﺍﺀ ﺣﱴ ﻬﻧﺎﻳﺔ ﺍﻹﻓﺴﺎﺩ ﺍﻟﺜﺎﱐ ﻓﻬﻮ ‪ ١٤٤٤‬ﺳﻨﺔ ﻗﻤﺮﻳّـﺔ‪،‬‬ ‫ﺍﻟ ّ‬ ‫ﻭﻫﻮ‪ ،‬ﻛﻤﺎ ﻗﻠﻨﺎ‪ ١٩ ،‬ﺿﻌﻔﹰﺎ ﻟﻌﻤﺮ ﺇﺳﺮﺍﺋﻴﻞ ﺍﳌﺘﻮﻗﹼﻊ‪ .‬ﻭﻳُﻼ ِﺣﻆ ﺍﻟﻘـﺎﺭﺉ ﺃﻧّﻨـﺎ‬ ‫ﺃﺣﺼﻴﻨﺎ ﻗﺒﻞ ﻋﺎﻡ ﺍﻹﺳﺮﺍﺀ ﺳﻨﲔ ﴰﺴﻴّﺔ‪ ،‬ﻭﺑﻌﺪﻩ ﺳﻨﲔ ﻗﻤﺮﻳّﺔ‪.‬‬ ‫ﻭﺟﺪﻧﺎ ﺃ ﹼﻥ ﻛﻞ ﻛﻠﻤﺔ ﻣﻦ ﻛﻠﻤﺎﺕ ﺳﻮﺭﺓ ﺍﻹﺳﺮﺍﺀ ﺗﻘﺎﺑﻞ ﺳﻨﺔ؛ ﻓﻌـﺪﺩ‬ ‫ﻛﻠﻤﺎﺕ ﺍﻟﺴّﻮﺭﺓ ‪ -١٥٥٦ -‬ﻗﺎﺑﻞ ﻋﺪﺩ ﺍﻟﺴﻨﲔ ﻣﻦ ﺳﻨﺔ ﻭﻓﺎﺓ ﺳﻠﻴﻤﺎﻥ ﻋﻠﻴـﻪ‬ ‫ﺍﻟﺴﻼﻡ‪ ،‬ﺇﱃ ﺳﻨﺔ ﺍﻹﺳﺮﺍﺀ‪ .‬ﻭﺗﺮﺗﻴﺐ ﻛﻠﻤﺔ ﻟﻔﻴﻔﺎ‪ ،‬ﰲ ﻧﺒﻮﺀﺓ ﺳﻮﺭﺓ ﺍﻹﺳﺮﺍﺀ‪ ،‬ﻗﺎﺑﻞ‬ ‫ﺍﻟﻌﺎﻡ ‪١٤٤٣‬ﻫـ ﺍﳌﻮﺍﻓﻖ ‪٢٠٢٢‬ﻡ‪ .‬ﻭﺳﻨﺠﺪ ﻣﺼﺪﺍﻕ ﺫﻟﻚ ﰲ ﺃﻣﺜﻠﺔ ﺃﺧﺮﻯ ﻣﻦ‬ ‫ﻫﺬﺍ ﺍﻟﻜﺘﺎﺏ‪ ،‬ﺑﻞ ﺇ ﹼﻥ ﻫﻨﺎﻙ ﺃﻣﺜﻠﺔ ﻛﺜﲑﺓ ﰲ ﺳﻮﺭ ﻣﺘﻌﺪﺩﺓ ﺗﺆﻛﹼﺪ ﺻِـﺪِﻗّﻴﺔ ﻫـﺬﺍ‬ ‫‪ ٤٥‬ﺃﻱ ﺯﻣﻦ ﺣﺎﺩﺛﺔ ﺍﻹﺳﺮﺍﺀ‪ ،‬ﻭﺯﻳﺎﺭﺓ ﺍﻟﺮﺳﻮﻝ ﺻﻠﻰ ﺍﷲ ﻋﻠﻴﻪ ﻭﺳﻠﻢ ﻟﻠﻤﺴﺠﺪ ﺍﻷﻗﺼﻰ‪.‬‬ ‫‪٥٢‬‬ ‫ﺍﳌﺴﻠﻚ ﺍﻟﺮﻳﺎﺿﻲّ‪ .‬ﻭﺇﻟﻴﻚ ﻫﺬﺍ ﺍﳌﺜﺎﻝ ﻣﻦ ﺳﻮﺭﺓ ﺍﻟﻜﻬﻒ‪ :‬ﺗﺒﺪﺃ ﻗﺼﺔ ﺍﻟﻜﻬـﻒ‬ ‫ﻒ ﻭﺍﻟـ ّﺮﻗﻴﻢ‪ ."...‬ﹼﰒ ﻳﻜـﻮﻥ‬ ‫ﺖ ﺃ ﹼﻥ ﺃﺻﺤﺎﺏ ﺍﻟﻜﻬ ِ‬ ‫ﺑﻘﻮﻟﻪ ﺗﻌﺎﱃ‪ " :‬ﺃﻡ َﺣﺴﺒ َ‬ ‫ﺍﻟﻜﻼﻡ ﻋﻦ ﻣﺪّﺓ ﻟﺒﺚ ﺍﻟﻔﺘﻴﺔ ﰲ ﺍﻵﻳﺔ )‪ " :(٢٥‬ﻭﻟﺒﺜﻮﺍ ﰲ ﻛﻬﻔﻬﻢ ﺛﻼﺙ ﻣﺎﺋـ ٍﺔ‬ ‫ﲔ ﻭﺍﺯﺩﺍﺩﻭﺍ ﺗﺴﻌﺎ "‪ .‬ﻭﳝﻜﻦ ﺃﻥ ﻧﻘﻮﻝ ﺑﻠﻐﺔ ﺍﻷﺭﻗﺎﻡ‪" :‬ﻭﻟﺒﺜﻮﺍ ﰲ ﻛﻬﻔﻬـﻢ‬ ‫ﺳﻨ َ‬ ‫‪ ." ٣٠٩‬ﻋﻠﻰ ﺿﻮﺀ ﺫﻟﻚ ﻧﻘﻮﻝ‪ :‬ﺇﺫﺍ ﺑﺪﺃﻧﺎ ﺍﻟﻌ ّﺪ ﻣﻦ ﺑﺪﺍﻳﺔ ﺍﻟﻘﺼّﺔ‪ " :‬ﺃﻡ ﺣﺴﺒﺖ‬ ‫ﺃ ﹼﻥ‪ "...‬ﻓﺴﻨﺠﺪ ﺃ ﹼﻥ ﺗﺮﺗﻴﺐ ﺍﻟﻜﻠﻤﺔ ﺍﻟﱵ ﺗـﺄﰐ ﺑﻌـﺪ ﻋﺒـﺎﺭﺓ‪ " :‬ﻭﻟﺒﺜـﻮﺍ ﰲ‬ ‫ﻛﻬﻔﻬﻢ‪ "...‬ﻫﻮ )‪ ،(٣٠٩‬ﻭﻫﺬﺍ ﻳﻌﲏ ﺃ ﹼﻥ ﻛﻞ ﻛﻠﻤﺔ ﻗﺎﺑﻠﺖ ﺳﻨﺔ‪ .‬ﰲ ﺍﳌﻘﺎﺑـﻞ‬ ‫ﻻﺣﻈﻨﺎ ﺳﺎﺑﻘﹰﺎ ﺃ ﹼﻥ ﻛﻞ ﺣﺮﻑ ﻣﻦ ﺣﺮﻭﻑ ﺳﻮﺭﺓ ﺳﺒﺄ ﻗﺎﺑﻠﺖ ﺳﻨﺔ‪.‬‬ ‫‪٥٣‬‬ ‫‪٦٢١‬ﻡ‬ ‫ﻱ‬ ‫ﺍﻟﺸﻤﺴ ّﻲ ﻭ ﺍﻟﻘﻤﺮ ّ‬ ‫ﻋﻨﺪﻣﺎ ﺗﺪﻭﺭ ﺍﻷﺭﺽ ﺣﻮﻝ ﺍﻟﺸﻤﺲ ﺩﻭﺭﺓ ﻭﺍﺣﺪﺓ ﺗﻜﻮﻥ ﻗﺪ ﺩﺍﺭﺕ ﺣﻮﻝ‬ ‫ﻧﻔﺴﻬﺎ ‪ ٣٦٥‬ﻣﺮﺓ‪ ،‬ﻭﻳﻜﻮﻥ ﺍﻟﻘﻤﺮ ﻋﻨﺪﻫﺎ ﻗﺪ ﺩﺍﺭ ﺣـﻮﻝ ﺍﻷﺭﺽ ‪ ١٢‬ﻣـﺮﺓ‪.‬‬ ‫ﻭﺍﻟﻼﻓﺖ ﺃ ﹼﻥ ﻛﻠﻤﺔ ﻳﻮﻡ ﻣﻔﺮﺩﺓ ﻭﺭﺩﺕ ﰲ ﺍﻟﻘﺮﺍﻥ ﺍﻟﻜﺮﱘ ‪ ٣٦٥‬ﻣﺮﺓ‪ ،‬ﻭﺃ ﹼﻥ ﻛﻠﻤﺔ‬ ‫ﺷﻬﺮ ﻣﻔﺮﺩﺓ ﻭﺭﺩﺕ ‪ ١٢‬ﻣﺮﺓ‪ .‬ﻳﺒﻘﻲ ﺃﻥ ﻧﺴﺄﻝ‪ :‬ﻛﻢ ﻣﺮﺓ ﻭﺭﺩﺕ ﻛﻠﻤﺔ ﺳـﻨﺔ؟‬ ‫ﻭﺣﱴ ﻧﻌﺮﻑ ﺍﳉﻮﺍﺏ‪ ،‬ﻻﺑ ّﺪ ﻣﻦ ﺍﻹﳌﺎﻡ ﺑﺎﻷﻣﻮﺭ ﺍﻟﻔﻠﻜﻴّﺔ ﺍﻵﺗﻴﺔ‪:‬‬ ‫ﻗﻠﻨﺎ ﺇﻧّﻪ ﻋﻨﺪﻣﺎ ﺗﻌﻮﺩ ﺍﻷﺭﺽ ﺇﱃ ﺍﻟﻨﻘﻄﺔ ﻧﻔﺴﻬﺎ ﺍﻟﱵ ﻛﺎﻧﺖ ﻓﻴﻬﺎ ﻭﳌـ ّﺮﺓ‬ ‫ﻭﺍﺣﺪﺓ ﺗﻜﻮﻥ ﻗﺪ ﺩﺍﺭﺕ ﺣﻮﻝ ﻧﻔﺴﻬﺎ ‪ ٣٦٥‬ﻣﺮﺓ‪ ،‬ﻭﻳﻜﻮﻥ ﺍﻟﻘﻤﺮ ﻋﻨﺪﻫﺎ ﻗﺪ ﺩﺍﺭ‬ ‫ﺣﻮﻝ ﺍﻷﺭﺽ ‪ ١٢‬ﻣﺮﺓ‪ .‬ﻭﻟﻜﻦ ﺣﱴ ﻳﻌﻮﺩ ﺍﻟﻘﻤﺮ ﻭﺍﻷﺭﺽ ﻣﻌﺎ ﺇﱃ ﺍﻹﺣﺪﺍﺛﻴّـﺔ‬ ‫ﻧﻔﺴﻬﺎ ﻓﻼ ﺑ ّﺪ ﺃﻥ ﺗﺪﻭﺭ ﺍﻷﺭﺽ ﺣﻮﻝ ﺍﻟﺸﻤﺲ ‪ ١٩‬ﻣﺮّﺓ‪ ،‬ﻭﻫﺬﺍ ﻳﻌﲏ ﻓﻠﻜﻴﹰﺎ ﺃ ﹼﻥ‬ ‫ﺍﻷﺭﺽ ﻭﺍﻟﻘﻤﺮ ﻳﻌﻮﺩﺍﻥ ﻣﻌﹰﺎ ﺇﱃ ﺍﻹﺣﺪﺍﺛﻴّﺔ ﻧﻔﺴﻬﺎ ﻛﻞ ‪ ١٩‬ﺳﻨﺔ ﻣﺮّﺓ‪ .‬ﻭﻋﻠﻴﻪ ﻓﺈ ﹼﻥ‬ ‫ﺍﻟﻌﺪﺩ ‪ُ ١٩‬ﻳﺴﺘﺨﺪﻡ ﻋﻨﺪ ﺍﻟﻔﻠﻜﻴﲔ ﰲ ﺍﳌﻌﺎﺩﻻﺕ ﺍﻟﱵ ﺗﺒﻴّﻦ ﺍﻟﻌﻼﻗﺔ ﺑﲔ ﺍﻟﺴّـﻨﺔ‬ ‫ﺍﻟﺸﻤﺴﻴّﺔ ﻭﺍﻟﻘﻤﺮﻳّﺔ‪.‬‬ ‫‪٥٤‬‬ ‫ﻋﻠﻰ ﺿﻮﺀ ﻣﺎ ﺳﻠﻒ‪ ،‬ﻭﻷ ﹼﻥ ﻫﻨﺎﻙ ﺃﻛﺜﺮ ﻣﻦ ﺩﻭﺭﺓ ﻷﻛﺜﺮ ﻣﻦ ُﺟﺮﻡ‪ ،‬ﻓﻘﺪ ﻗﻤﻨـﺎ‬ ‫ﺑﺈﺣﺼﺎﺀ ﻛﻠﻤﺎﺕ‪) :‬ﺳﻨﺔ ﻭﺳﻨﲔ(‪ ،‬ﺃﻱ ﺍﳌﻔﺮﺩ ﻭﺍﳉﻤﻊ‪ ،٤٦‬ﻓﻮﺟـﺪﻧﺎ ﺃ ﹼﻥ ﻛﻠﻤـﺔ‬ ‫)ﺳﻨﺔ( ﻗﺪ ﺗﻜﺮﺭﺕ ﰲ ﺍﻟﻘﺮﺁﻥ ﺍﻟﻜﺮﱘ ‪ ٧‬ﻣﺮّﺍﺕ‪ ،‬ﻭﻛﻠﻤﺔ )ﺳﻨﲔ( ﺗﻜﺮﺭﺕ ‪١٢‬‬ ‫ﻣﺮّﺓ‪ ،‬ﻭﻋﻠﻴﻪ ﻳﻜﻮﻥ ﺍﺠﻤﻟﻤﻮﻉ‪ ٤٧١٩ = (١٢+٧) :‬ﻭﻣﻦ ﺍﳉﺪﻳﺮ ﺑﺎﻟ ﹼﺬﻛﺮ ﺃﻥ ﻛﻞ‬ ‫‪ ١٩‬ﺳﻨﺔ ﻗﻤﺮﻳﺔ ﻓﻴﻬﺎ ‪ ٧‬ﺳﻨﻮﺍﺕ ﻛﺒﻴﺴﺔ ‪ ٣٥٥‬ﻳﻮﻣﺎﹰ‪ ،‬ﻭ ‪ ١٢‬ﺳﻨﺔ ﺑﺴﻴﻄﺔ ‪٣٥٤‬‬ ‫ﻳﻮﻣﹰﺎ‪.‬‬ ‫ﺇﺫﺍ ﹼﰎ ﲢﻮﻳﻞ ﺍﻟﻌﺎﻡ ‪٦٢١‬ﻡ ‪ -‬ﻭﻫﻮ ﻋﺎﻡ ﺍﻹﺳﺮﺍﺀ ‪ -‬ﺇﱃ ﺳﻨﻮﺍﺕ ﻗﻤﺮﻳﺔ‪،‬‬ ‫ﻓﺴﻴﻜﻮﻥ ﺍﻟﻨﺎﺗﺞ‪:‬‬ ‫)‪ ٦٤٠,٠٥ = (٣٥٤,٣٦٧) ÷ (٣٦٥,٢٤٢٢×٦٢١‬ﺳــﻨﺔ ﻗﻤﺮﻳــﺔ‪،‬‬ ‫‪٤٨‬‬ ‫ﻭﻋﻠﻴﻪ ﻓﺈ ﹼﻥ ﺍﻟﻔﺎﺭﻕ ﻫﻮ‪ ١٩ = (٦٢١ -٦٤٠) :‬ﻭﲟﺎ ﺃﻥ ﺍﻟﻌﺪﺩ ‪ ١٩‬ﻳﺸﲑ ﻓﻠﻜﻴﹰﺎ‬ ‫ﺇﱃ ﺍﻟﺘﻘﺎﺀ ﺍﻟﺸﻤﺴﻲ ﺑﺎﻟﻘﻤﺮﻱ‪ ،‬ﻓﺎﻧﻪ ﻳﺼ ّﺢ ﺍﻋﺘﺒﺎﺭ ﺍﻟﻌﺎﻡ ‪٦٢١‬ﻡ ﺭﻣـﺰﹰﺍ ﻟﻠﺘﻘـﺎﺀ‬ ‫ﺍﻟﺸﻤﺴﻲ ﺑﺎﻟﻘﻤﺮﻱ ﺃﻳﻀﹰﺎ‪ .‬ﻟﺬﻟﻚ ﺳﻴﺠﺪ ﺍﻟﻘﺎﺭﺉ ﺃﻧﻨﺎ ﻧﺘﻌﺎﻣﻞ ﻗﺒﻞ ﻋﺎﻡ ‪٦٢١‬ﻡ ‪-‬‬ ‫ﻭﺍﻟﺬﻱ ﻫﻮ ﻗﺒﻞ ﺍﳍﺠﺮﺓ ﺑﻌﺎﻡ ‪ -‬ﺑﺎﻟﺴﻨﺔ ﺍﻟﺸﻤﺴﻴﺔ‪ ،‬ﻭﺑﻌﺪﻩ ﺳـﻨﺘﻌﺎﻣﻞ ﺑﺎﻟﺴـﻨﺔ‬ ‫ﺍﻟﻘﻤﺮّﻳﺔ‪ ،‬ﻭﺑﺬﻟﻚ ﺗﺘﻤﻴّﺰ ﻣﺮﺣﻠﺔ ﻣﺎ ﺑﻌﺪ ﻇﻬﻮﺭ ﺍﻹﺳﻼﻡ ﻋﻤّﺎ ﻗﺒﻠﻬﺎ‪ .‬ﻭﻏﲏ ﻋـﻦ‬ ‫ﺴﻨﺔ ﺍﳌﻴﻼﺩّﻳﺔ ﻫﻲ ﴰﺴّﻴﺔ‪ ،‬ﻭﺃ ﹼﻥ ﺍﻟﺴﻨﺔ ﺍﳍﺠﺮﻳﺔ ﻫﻲ ﻗﻤﺮّﻳﺔ‪.‬‬ ‫ﺍﻟﺒﻴﺎﻥ ﺃ ﹼﻥ ﺍﻟ ّ‬ ‫‪ ٤٦‬ﱂ ﺗﺮﺩ ﻛﻠﻤﺔ )ﺳﻨﺔ( ﻣﺜﻨّﺎﺓ‪..‬‬ ‫‪ ٤٧‬ﻧﻼﺣﻆ ﻫﻨﺎ ﺃ ﹼﻥ ﺍﻷﺭﺽ ﻗﺪ ﺩﺍﺭﺕ ﺃﻛﺜﺮ ﻣﻦ ﺩﻭﺭﺓ‪ ،‬ﻟﺬﺍ ﻓﺈﻧﻨﺎ ﳓﺼﻲ ﺍﳌﻔﺮﺩ ﻭﺍﳉﻤﻊ‪ ،‬ﺃﻱ‪) :‬ﺳﻨﺔ ﻭﺳﻨﲔ(‪.‬‬ ‫‪ ٤٨‬ﺍﻟﻜﺴﺮ‪ (،٠٥) :‬ﺟﺎﺀ ﻧﺘﻴﺠﺔ ﻻﻋﺘﺒﺎﺭ ﺃ ﹼﻥ ﺍﻟﻌﺎﻡ ‪ ٦٢١‬ﻛﺎﻣﻼﹼ‪ ،‬ﺃﻱ ﺣﱴ ﺗﺎﺭﻳﺦ ‪ ٣٠‬ﺫﻭﺍﳊﺠّﺔ‪ ،‬ﻭﻋﻠﻴﻪ ﻳﺼﺎﺩﻑ ﺍﻟﻔﺮﻕ‬ ‫‪ ١٩‬ﺩﻭﻥ ﺯﻳﺎﺩﺓ ﰲ ﺍﻟﻌﺎﻡ ‪٦٢١‬ﻡ‪.‬‬ ‫‪٥٥‬‬ ‫ﺍﻟﺘﺎﺭﻳﺦ ﰲ ﻣﻌﺎﺩﻟﺔ‬ ‫ﺃﻋﻠﻦ ﺍﻟﻴﻬﻮﺩ ﻋﻦ ﺇﻗﺎﻣﺔ ﺩﻭﻟﺘﻬﻢ ﰲ ﻓﻠﺴﻄﲔ ﺑﺘـﺎﺭﻳﺦ ‪١٩٤٨/٥/١٥‬ﻡ‪،‬‬ ‫ﻭﻻ ﻧﺴﺘﻄﻴﻊ ﺃﻥ ﻧﻌﺘﱪ ﺃ ﹼﻥ ﻫﺬﺍ ﺍﻟﺘﺎﺭﻳﺦ ﻫﻮ ﺗﺎﺭﻳﺦ ﻗﻴﺎﻡ ﺩﻭﻟﺔ ﺇﺳﺮﺍﺋﻴﻞ‪ ،‬ﻷﻬﻧـﺎ ﱂ‬ ‫ﺗﻘﻢ ﻋﻨﺪﻫﺎ ﺑﺎﻟﻔﻌﻞ‪ ،‬ﻭﺍﻟﻌﱪﺓ ﺑﺎﻟﻮﺟﻮﺩ ﺍﻟﻮﺍﻗﻌﻲّ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺍﻷﺭﺽ‪ .‬ﺑﻌﺪ ﻫﺬﺍ ﺍﻹﻋﻼﻥ‬ ‫ﺩﺧﻠﺖ ﺍﳉﻴﻮﺵ ﺍﻟﻌﺮﺑﻴﺔ ﰲ ﺣﺮﺏ ﻣﻊ ﺍﻟﻴﻬﻮﺩ‪ ،‬ﺣﱴ ﺃﺻﺪﺭﺕ ﺍﻷﻣـﻢ ﺍﳌﺘﺤـﺪﺓ‬ ‫ﻗﺮﺍﺭﹰﺍ ﺑﻮﻗﻒ ﺇﻃﻼﻕ ﺍﻟﻨﺎﺭ‪ ،‬ﻭﺍﻓﻘﺖ ﻋﻠﻴﻪ ﺟﺎﻣﻌـﺔ ﺍﻟـ ّﺪﻭﻝ ﺍﻟﻌﺮﺑﻴـﺔ ﺑﺘـﺎﺭﻳﺦ‬ ‫‪١٩٤٨/٦/١٠‬ﻡ‪ ،٤٩‬ﻓﻴﻤﺎ ﲰﻲ‪) :‬ﺍﳍﺪﻧﺔ ﺍﻷﻭﱃ(‪ ،‬ﻭﻫﻮ ﺍﻟﺘﺎﺭﻳﺦ ﺍﻟﻔﻌﻠﻲ ﻟﺒﺪﺍﻳـﺔ‬ ‫ﻗﻴﺎﻡ ﺩﻭﻟﺔ ﺇﺳﺮﺍﺋﻴﻞ‪ .‬ﻭﺑﻌﺪ ﺃﺭﺑﻌﺔ ﺃﺳﺎﺑﻴﻊ ﻣﻦ ﻫﺬﺍ ﺍﻟﺘﺎﺭﻳﺦ ﺛﺎﺭ ﺍﻟﻘﺘﺎﻝ ﻣﺮﺓ ﺃﺧﺮﻯ‪،‬‬ ‫ﻭﺃﺻﺪﺭﺕ ﺍﻷﻣﻢ ﺍﳌﺘﺤﺪﺓ ﻗﺮﺍﺭﹰﺍ ﺑﻮﻗﻒ ﺇﻃﻼﻕ ﺍﻟﻨﺎﺭ‪ ،‬ﻭﺍﻓﻘﺖ ﻋﻠﻴﻪ ﺟﺎﻣﻌﺔ ﺍﻟﺪﻭﻝ‬ ‫ﺍﻟﻌﺮﺑﻴﺔ ﺑﺘﺎﺭﻳﺦ ‪١٩٤٨/٧/١٨‬ﻡ ﻓﻴﻤﺎ ﲰﻲ )ﺍﳍﺪﻧﺔ ﺍﻟﺜﺎﻧﻴﺔ(‪ ،‬ﻭﺑﺬﻟﻚ ﺍﻛﺘﻤﻞ ﻗﻴﺎﻡ‬ ‫‪٥٠‬‬ ‫ﺩﻭﻟﺔ ﺇﺳﺮﺍﺋﻴﻞ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺃﺭﺽ ﺍﻟﻮﺍﻗﻊ‪.‬‬ ‫‪ ٦|١٠ ٤٩‬ﻫﻮ ﺃﻳﻀﹰﺎ ﺗﺎﺭﻳﺦ ﺍﻧﺘﻬﺎﺀ ﺣﺮﺏ ﺍﻷﻳﺎﻡ ﺍﻟﺴﺘﺔ ﻋﺎﻡ ‪١٩٦٧‬ﻡ‪ ،‬ﻭﺑﺬﻟﻚ ﻳﻜﻮﻥ ﻋﺪﺩ ﺍﻟﺴﻨﲔ ﻣﻦ ﺍﳍﺪﻧﺔ ﺍﻷﻭﱃ ﻋﺎﻡ‬ ‫‪١٩٤٨‬ﻡ ﺇﱃ ﻫﺪﻧﺔ ‪١٩٦٧‬ﻡ ﻫﻮ )‪ (١٩‬ﺳﻨﺔ ﴰﺴﻴﺔ ﲤﺎﻣﹰﺎ‪.‬‬ ‫‪ ٥٠‬ﻭﻳُﻠﺤﻆ ﺃ ﹼﻥ ﻋﺪﺩ ﺍﻷﻳﺎﻡ ﻣﻦ ﺍﳍﺪﻧﺔ ﺍﻷﻭﱃ ﺇﱃ ﺍﳍﺪﻧﺔ ﺍﻟﺜﺎﻧﻴﺔ ﻫﻮ ‪ ٣٨‬ﻳﻮﻣﺎ‪ ،‬ﺃﻱ )‪ .(٢×١٩‬ﻭﻳُﻠﺤﻆ ﺃﻳﻀـﹰﺎ ﺃﻥ ﳎﻤـﻮﻉ‬ ‫ﺃﺭﻗﺎﻡ ﺗﺎﺭﻳﺦ ﺍﳍﺪﻧﺔ ﺍﻟﺜﺎﻧﻴﺔ ‪١٩٤٨/٧/١٨‬ﻡ ﻫﻮ ﺃﻳﻀﹰﺎ ‪٣٨‬‬ ‫‪٥٦‬‬ ‫ﺑﻌﺪ ﺍﻋﺘﻤـﺎﺩ ﺍﻟـﺮﺍﺟﺢ ﰲ ﺗـﺎﺭﻳﺦ ﺍﻹﺳـﺮﺍﺀ‪ ٥١‬ﺗـﺒﲔ ﻟﻨـﺎ ﺃﻧّـﻪ‬ ‫ﺗﺎﺭﻳﺦ‪٦٢١/١٠/١٠‬ﻡ ﻭﺑﻨﺎﺀ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺫﻟﻚ ﺃﺻﺒﺤﺖ ﺍﳌﻌﺎﺩﻟﺔ‪:‬‬ ‫‪ ٩٣٥‬ﻕ‪ .‬ﻡ‬ ‫‪ ٦٢١‬ﻡ‬ ‫‪١٩٤٨‬ﻡ‬ ‫‪٢٠٢٢‬ﻡ‬ ‫_______________________________________‬ ‫‪١٠/١٠‬‬ ‫‪١٠/١٠‬‬ ‫‪٦/١٠‬‬ ‫‪٣ /٥‬‬ ‫ﻋﺮﻓﻨﺎ ﺃ ﹼﻥ ﺍﻟﺒﺪﺍﻳﺔ ﺍﻟﻌﻤﻠّﻴﺔ ﻟﻘﻴﺎﻡ ﺇﺳﺮﺍﺋﻴﻞ ﻫﻲ ﺍﳍﺪﻧـﺔ ﺍﻷﻭﱃ‪ ،‬ﻭﺫﻟـﻚ‬ ‫ﺑﺘﺎﺭﻳﺦ ‪١٩٤٨/٦/١٠‬ﻡ‪ .‬ﻭﺇﺫﺍ ﺃﺿﻔﻨﺎ ‪ ٧٦‬ﺳﻨﺔ ﻗﻤﺮﻳﺔ ﻛﺎﻣﻠﺔ ﻓﺴﻴﻜﻮﻥ ﺍﻛﺘﻤﺎﳍﺎ‬ ‫ﺑﺘﺎﺭﻳﺦ ‪٢٠٢٢/٣/٥‬ﻡ‪ .‬ﻭﲟﺎ ﺃﻧﻨﺎ ﻻ ﻧﺪﺭﻱ ﻣﺎ ﺇﺫﺍ ﻛﺎﻧﺖ ﺃﻟـ ‪ ١٥٥٦‬ﺳﻨﺔ ﺗﺰﻳﺪ‬ ‫ﺴﻼﻡ ﻛﺎﻧـﺖ‬ ‫ﺃﺷﻬﺮﹰﺍ ﺃﻭ ﺗﻨﻘﺺ‪ ،‬ﻓﻼ ﻣﻨﺎﺹ ﻣﻦ ﺍﻋﺘﺒﺎﺭ ﺃ ﹼﻥ ﻭﻓﺎﺓ ﺳﻠﻴﻤﺎﻥ ﻋﻠﻴﻪ ﺍﻟ ّ‬ ‫ﺑﺘﺎﺭﻳﺦ ‪٩٣٥/١٠/١٠‬ﻕ‪.‬ﻡ‪.‬‬ ‫ﻋﺪﺩ ﺍﻟﺴﻨﲔ ﻣﻦ ﺑﺪﺍﻳﺔ ﺍﻹﻓﺴﺎﺩ ﺍﻷﻭﻝ‪ ،‬ﻭﺣﱴ ﺍﻹﺳﺮﺍﺀ‪ ،‬ﻫﻮ‪+ ٩٣٥) :‬‬ ‫ـﺮﺍﺀ‪ ،‬ﺃﻱ‬ ‫ـﻦ ﺍﻹﺳـ‬ ‫ﺴـﻨﲔ ﻣـ‬ ‫ـﺪﺩ ﺍﻟ ّ‬ ‫ـﻴﺔ‪ .‬ﻭﻋـ‬ ‫‪ ١٥٥٦ = (٦٢١‬ﺳـﻨﺔ ﴰﺴـ‬ ‫‪٦٢١/١٠/١٠‬ﻡ‪ ،‬ﻭﺣﱴ ﺯﻭﺍﻝ ﺍﻹﻓﺴﺎﺩ ﺍﻟﺜـﺎﱐ‪ ،‬ﺃﻱ ‪٢٠٢٢/٣/٥‬ﻡ‪ ،‬ﻫـﻮ‪:‬‬ ‫)‪ (١٤٠٠,٤‬ﺳﻨﺔ ﴰﺴﻴﺔ‪ ،‬ﻓﻜﻢ ﺗﺰﻳﺪ ﺍﻟﻔﺘﺮﺓ ﺍﻟﱵ ﻗﺒﻞ ﺍﻹﺳﺮﺍﺀ‪ ،‬ﻋﻦ ﺍﻟﺜﺎﻧﻴﺔ‪ ،‬ﺃﻱ‬ ‫ﻣﺎ ﺑﻌﺪ ﺍﻹﺳﺮﺍﺀ ؟ ﺇﻧّﻬﺎ‪ ١٥٥,٦ = (١٤٠٠,٤-١٥٥٦ ) :‬ﺳﻨﺔ‪ .‬ﻓﻤﺎ ﻫـﻮ‬ ‫ﻫﺬﺍ ﺍﻟﻌﺪﺩ؟‬ ‫‪ ٥١‬ﺍﻋﺘﻤﺪﻧﺎ ﺗﺮﺟﻴﺢ ﺍﻷﺳﺘﺎﺫ )ﳏﻤﺪ ﺃﺑﻮ ﺷﻬﺒﺔ( ﰲ ﻛﺘﺎﺑﻪ ﰲ ﺍﻟﺴﲑﺓ ﺍﻟﻨﺒﻮﻳﺔ‪ ،‬ﰒ ﻗﻤﻨﺎ ﺑﺘﺤﻮﻳﻞ ﺍﻟﻘﻤﺮﻱ ﺇﱃ ﴰﺴﻲ ﻓﻜﺎﻥ‬ ‫)‪ .(١٠|١٠‬ﻭﻛﺎﻧﺖ ﺍﳌﻔﺎﺟﺄﺓ ﺃﻥ ﻫﺬﺍ ﻫﻮ ﻳﻮﻡ )ﺍﻟﻜﻔﺎﺭﺓ( ﺍﳌﻨﺼﻮﺹ ﻋﻠﻴﻪ ﰲ ﺍﻹﺻﺤﺎﺡ )‪ (٢٣‬ﻣﻦ ﺳﻔﺮ ﺍﻟﻼﻭﻳﲔ‪.‬‬ ‫‪٥٧‬‬ ‫ﻋﺪﺩ ﺍﻟﺴﻨﲔ ﻣﻦ ﺑﺪﺍﻳﺔ ﺍﻹﻓﺴﺎﺩ ﺍﻷﻭﻝ‪ ،‬ﺇﱃ ﻬﻧﺎﻳﺔ ﺍﻹﻓﺴﺎﺩ ﺍﻟﺜﺎﱐ‪ ،‬ﻫـﻮ‪:‬‬ ‫)‪ .٢٩٥٦,٤ = (١٤٠٠,٤+١٥٥٦‬ﻭﺇﺫﺍ ﻗﺴﻤﻨﺎ ﻫﺬﺍ ﺍﻟﻌﺪﺩ ﻋﻠـﻰ )‪،(١٩‬‬ ‫ﻳﻜﻮﻥ ﺍﻟﻨﺎﺗﺞ‪.١٥٥,٦ = (١٩÷٢٩٥٦,٤) :‬‬ ‫ﻭﲟﺎ ﺃ ﹼﻥ ﺍﻟﻌﺪﺩ ‪ ١٩‬ﻫﻮ )‪ (٩+١٠‬ﻓﺈ ﹼﻥ‪١٥٥٦ = (١٠×١٥٥,٦) :‬‬ ‫ﻭﻫﻮ ﻋﺪﺩ ﺍﻟﺴﻨﲔ ﻣﻦ ﺑﺪﺍﻳﺔ ﺍﻹﻓﺴﺎﺩ ﺍﻷﻭﻝ ﺇﱃ ﻋﺎﻡ ﺍﻹﺳﺮﺍﺀ‪ .‬ﺃﻣّﺎ ﻋﺪﺩ ﺍﻟﺴـﻨﲔ‬ ‫ﻣﻦ ﺍﻹﺳﺮﺍﺀ ﺇﱃ ﻬﻧﺎﻳﺔ ﺍﻹﻓﺴﺎﺩ ﺍﻟﺜﺎﱐ‪ ،‬ﻓﺈﻧّـﻪ‪.١٤٠٠,٤ = (٩ × ١٥٥,٦) :‬‬ ‫ﻭﻋﻠﻴﻪ ﻳﻜﻮﻥ ﳎﻤﻮﻉ ﺍﻟﻔﺘﺮﺗﲔ ‪ ١٩‬ﺟﺰﺀﹰﺍ؛ ﻋﺸﺮﺓ ﻣﻨﻬﺎ ﺍﻧﻘﻀﺖ ﻗﺒﻞ ﺍﻹﺳـﺮﺍﺀ‪،‬‬ ‫ﻭﺗﺴﻌﺔ ﺗﺄﰐ ﺑﻌﺪ ﺍﻹﺳﺮﺍﺀ‪ ،‬ﻭﻭﺣﺪﺓ ﺍﻟﺒﻨﺎﺀ ﻫﻨﺎ ﻫﻲ ‪ ،١٥٥,٦‬ﺃﻱ ﺍﻟﻔﺮﻕ ﺍﻟﺰﻣﲏ‬ ‫ﺑﲔ ﺍﻟﻔﺘﺮﺗﲔ‪ .‬ﻭﻫﺬﻩ ﺍﻟﻨﺘﻴﺠﺔ ﺗﺴﺎﻫﻢ ﰲ ﺗﺮﺟﻴﺢ ﺍﺣﺘﻤﺎﻝ ﺃﻥ ﺗﻜﻮﻥ ﻭﻓﺎﺓ ﺳﻠﻴﻤﺎﻥ‬ ‫ﺴﻼﻡ ﺳﻨﺔ ‪٩٣٥‬ﻕ‪.‬ﻡ‪.‬‬ ‫ﻋﻠﻴﻪ ﺍﻟ ّ‬ ‫‪٥٨‬‬ ‫‪َ ١٩‬ﻣ ِﻠﻜﹰﺎ‬ ‫ﺴﻼﻡ ﻋﺎﻡ ‪ ٩٣٥‬ﻕ‪.‬ﻡ ﺍﻧﺸﻘﹼﺖ ﺍﻟﺪﻭﻟـﺔ ﺇﱃ‬ ‫ﻋﻨﺪﻣﺎ ﺗﻮﰲ ﺳﻠﻴﻤﺎﻥ ﻋﻠﻴﻪ ﺍﻟ ّ‬ ‫ﻗﺴﻤﲔ؛ ﺇﺳﺮﺍﺋﻴﻞ ﰲ ﺍﻟﺸﻤﺎﻝ‪ ،‬ﻭ َﺩ ّﻣﺮﻫﺎ ﺍﻷﺷﻮﺭﻳّﻮﻥ ﻋﺎﻡ ‪ ٧٢٢‬ﻕ‪.‬ﻡ‪ ،‬ﻭﻳﻬﻮﺫﺍ‬ ‫ﰲ ﺍﳉﻨﻮﺏ‪ ،‬ﻭﺩَﻣّﺮﻫﺎ ﺍﻟﺒﺎﺑﻠﻴّﻮﻥ ﻋﺎﻡ ‪ ٥٨٦‬ﻕ‪.‬ﻡ‪ .‬ﻭﺑﺬﻟﻚ ﺗﻜﻮﻥ ﻳﻬـﻮﺫﺍ ﻗـﺪ‬ ‫ُﻋ ّﻤﺮﺕ )‪ (١٣٦‬ﺳﻨﺔ ﺃﻛﺜﺮ ﻣﻦ ﺇﺳﺮﺍﺋﻴﻞ‪ .‬ﻭﻋﻠﻰ ﺍﻟ ﱡﺮﻏﻢ ﻣﻦ ﺫﻟﻚ ﳒﺪ ﺃ ﹼﻥ ﻋﺪﺩ‬ ‫ﺍﳌﻠﻮﻙ ﺍﻟﺬﻳﻦ ﺗﻌﺎﻗﺒﻮﺍ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺣﻜﻢ ﻛﻞ ﻭﺍﺣﺪﺓ ﻣﻦ ﺍﻟﺪﻭﻟﺘﲔ ﻫﻮ )‪ (١٩‬ﻣﻠﻜـﹰﺎ‪.‬‬ ‫ﱵ ﰲ ﻛﺘﺎﺑﻪ‪) :‬ﺗﺎﺭﻳﺦ ﺳﻮﺭﻳﺎ ﻭﻟﺒﻨﺎﻥ ﻭﻓﻠﺴﻄﲔ(‪ " :‬ﺇﻥ ﺇﺳﺮﺍﺋﻴﻞ‬ ‫ﻳﻘﻮﻝ ﻓﻴﻠﻴﺐ ِﺣ ّ‬ ‫ﻋﻨﺪﻣﺎ ﻓﻨﻴﺖ ﻛﺎﻥ ﻗﺪ ﺗﻌﺎﻗﺐ ﻋﻠﻰ ﻋﺮﺷﻬﺎ ‪ ١٩‬ﻣﻠﻜﺎﹰ "‪ .‬ﰒ ﻳﻘﻮﻝ‪ " :‬ﺇ ﹼﻥ ﻳﻬﻮﺫﺍ‬ ‫ﻛﺬﻟﻚ ﺗﻌﺎﻗﺐ ﻋﻠﻰ ﻋﺮﺷﻬﺎ ‪ ١٩‬ﻣﻠﻜﺎﹰ " ‪ ،٥٢‬ﻭﻫﺬﺍ ﺃﻣﺮ ﻻﻓـﺖ ﻟﻠﻨﻈـﺮ؛ ﻷ ﹼﻥ‬ ‫ﺩﻭﻟﺔ ﻳﻬﻮﺫﺍ‪ ،‬ﻛﻤﺎ ﻗﻠﻨﺎ‪ُ ،‬ﻋ ّﻤﺮﺕ ‪ ١٣٦‬ﺳﻨﺔ ﺃﻛﺜﺮ ﻣﻦ ﺩﻭﻟﺔ‬ ‫‪٥٨٦‬‬ ‫‪٩٣٥‬ﻕ‪.‬ﻡ‬ ‫‪١‬ﻡ‬ ‫ﺇﺳﺮﺍﺋﻴﻞ!!‬ ‫‪٢٠٢٢‬ﻡ‬ ‫*______*______*_________*_________________________*‬ ‫‪٧٢٢‬‬ ‫‪ ٥٢‬ﺗﺎﺭﻳﺦ ﺳﻮﺭﻳﺎ ﻭﻟﺒﻨﺎﻥ ﻭﻓﻠﺴﻄﲔ‪ ،‬ﺩ‪ .‬ﻓﻴﻠﻴﺐ ﺣﱵ‪ ،‬ﺗﺮﲨﺔ ﺩ‪ .‬ﺟﻮﺭﺝ ﺣﺪﺍﺩ‪ .‬ﺩﺍﺭ ﺍﻟﺜﻘﺎﻓﺔ‪ ،‬ﺑﲑﻭﺕ‪ ،‬ﻁ‪ ٣‬ﺝ‪ ،١‬ﺹ‪،٢٠٨‬‬ ‫‪.٢١٥‬‬ ‫‪٥٩‬‬ ‫‪٥٨٦‬ﻕ‪.‬ﻡ ﻫﻮ ﺗﺎﺭﻳﺦ ﺩﻣﺎﺭ ﺩﻭﻟﺔ ﻳﻬﻮﺫﺍ‪ ،‬ﻭﻫﻮ ﺗﺎﺭﻳﺦ ﻬﻧﺎﻳﺔ ﺍﻹﻓﺴـﺎﺩ‬ ‫ﺍﻷﻭﻝ‪ .‬ﺃﻣﺎ ﺯﻭﺍﻝ ﺍﻹﻓﺴﺎﺩ ﺍﻟﺜﺎﱐ ﺍﳌﺘﻮﻗﹼﻊ ﻓﻬـﻮ ‪٢٠٢٢‬ﻡ‪ .‬ﻭﻋﻠﻴـﻪ‪+٥٨٦) :‬‬ ‫‪ ٢٦٠٨ = (٢٠٢٢‬ﺳﻨﺔ‪ ،‬ﻭﻣﻦ ﺍﻟﻠﻄﻴﻒ ﺃ ﹼﻥ ﻫﺬﻩ ﺍﳌﺪﺓ ﺗﺸﻜﹼﻞ ‪ ١٩‬ﺿـﻌﻔﹰﺎ‬ ‫ﻟﻠﻔﺘﺮﺓ ﺍﻟﺰﻣﻨﻴﺔ ﻣﻦ ﺯﻭﺍﻝ ﺩﻭﻟﺔ ﺇﺳﺮﺍﺋﻴﻞ‪ ،‬ﺇﱃ ﺯﻭﺍﻝ ﺩﻭﻟﺔ ﻳﻬﻮﺫﺍ‪ ٥٣.‬ﻭﻗﺪ ﺫﻛـﺮ‬ ‫ﺍﻟﻌﻬﺪ ﺍﻟﻘﺪﱘ ﺃ ﹼﻥ ﻬﻧﺎﻳﺔ ﺩﻭﻟﺔ ﻳﻬﻮﺫﺍ ﻛﺎﻧﺖ ﰲ ﺍﻟﺴﻨﺔ ‪ ١٩‬ﻟﻠﻤﻠﻚ ﻧﺒﻮﺧﺬ ﻧﺼﺮ‪.٥٤‬‬ ‫ﻭﻧﻼﺣﻆ ﺃ ﹼﻥ ﺍﻟﻌﺎﻡ ‪٧٢٢‬ﻕ‪.‬ﻡ ﺍﻟﺬﻱ ُﺩﻣّﺮﺕ ﻓﻴﻪ ﺩﻭﻟﺔ ﺇﺳﺮﺍﺋﻴﻞ ﻫﻮ ﻋﺪﺩ‬ ‫ﻣﻦ ﻣﻀﺎﻋﻔﺎﺕ ‪ ١٩‬ﺃﻱ‪ .(٣٨×١٩ ) :‬ﻭﺇﺫﺍ ﺿﺎﻋﻔﻨﺎ ﻫﺬﺍ ﺍﻟﻌﺪﺩ ﳒﺪ ﺃﻧﻪ‪:‬‬ ‫ﺴﻨﲔ ﺍﻟﻘﻤﺮّﻳﺔ ﻣﻦ ﺳﻨﺔ ﺍﻹﺳﺮﺍﺀ‪،‬‬ ‫)‪ ،١٤٤٤ = ( ٢× ٧٢٢‬ﻭﻫﺬﺍ ﻫﻮ ﻋﺪﺩ ﺍﻟ ّ‬ ‫ﻭﺣﱴ ﺍﻟﻌﺎﻡ ‪٢٠٢٢‬ﻡ‪ .‬ﻭﻫﻮ ﺃﻳﻀﹰﺎ ﺍﳌﻀﺎﻋﻒ ‪ ١٩‬ﻟﻠﻌﺪﺩ ‪ ،٧٦‬ﻭﺍﻟﺬﻱ ﻫﻮ ﻋﻤﺮ‬ ‫ﺴﻨﲔ ﺍﻟﻘﻤﺮﻳّﺔ‪.‬‬ ‫ﺇﺳﺮﺍﺋﻴﻞ ﺍﳌﺘﻮﻗﹼﻊ ﺑﺎﻟ ّ‬ ‫‪١٩،١٧ = (١٣٦ ÷ ٢٦٠٨) ٥٣‬‬ ‫‪ ٥٤‬ﺳﻔﺮ ﺍﳌﻠﻮﻙ ﺍﻟﺜﺎﱐ‪ ،‬ﺍﻹﺻﺤﺎﺡ ﺍﳋﺎﻣﺲ ﻭﺍﻟﻌﺸﺮﻭﻥ‪ ..." :‬ﻭﰲ ﺍﻟﺸﻬﺮ ﺍﳋﺎﻣﺲ ﻣﻦ ﺳﺎﺑﻊ ﺍﻟﺸﻬﺮ ﻭﻫﻲ ﺍﻟﺴﻨﺔ ﺍﻟﺘﺎﺳﻌﺔ‬ ‫ﻋﺸﺮﺓ ﻟﻠﻤﻠﻚ ﻧﺒﻮﺧﺬﻧﺼﺮ‪ "...‬ﻭﻛﺬﻟﻚ ﺳﻔﺮ ﺃﺭﻣﻴﺎ ﺍﻹﺻﺤﺎﺡ ‪" :٥٢‬ﰲ ﺍﻟﻴﻮﻡ ﺍﻟﻌﺎﺷﺮ‪."..‬ﺍﻟﻼﻓﺖ ﻫﻨﺎ ﺍﻻﺧﺘﻼﻑ ﺑﲔ‬ ‫ﺍﻟﺴّﻔﺮﻳﻦ ﰲ ﲢﺪﻳﺪ ﺍﻟﻴﻮﻡ‪ ،‬ﻭﺍﳌﺸﻬﻮﺭ ﻋﻨﺪ ﺍﻟﻴﻬﻮﺩ ﺃ ﹼﻥ ﺇﺣﻴﺎﺀ ﻫﺬﻩ ﺍﻟﺬﻛﺮﻯ ﻳﻜﻮﻥ ﺑﺘﺎﺭﻳﺦ ‪٨‬ﻭ‪ ٩‬ﺁﺏ‪ .‬ﻭﺍﻟﺸﻬﺮ ﺍﳋﺎﻣﺲ ﰲ‬ ‫ﺍﻟﻌﻬﺪ ﺍﻟﻘﺪﱘ ﻳﻘﺼﺪ ﺑﻪ ﺍﻟﺜﺎﻣﻦ ﻣﻴﻼﺩﻱ‪ .‬ﻭﺍﳌﻠﺤﻮﻅ ﻫﻨﺎ ﺃ ﹼﻥ ﳎﻤﻮﻉ ﺃﺭﻗﺎﻡ ‪ ٥٨٦‬ﻫﻮ ‪.١٩‬‬ ‫‪٦٠‬‬ ‫ﺍﻟﻌﺪﺩ ‪ ٧٦‬ﻭﺳﻮﺭﺓ ﺍﻹﺳﺮﺍﺀ‬ ‫ﺗﻨﺘﻬﻲ ﻛﻞ ﺁﻳﺔ ﻣﻦ ﺁﻳﺎﺕ ﺳﻮﺭﺓ ﺍﻹﺳﺮﺍﺀ ﺑﻜﻠﻤﺔ ﻭﺗﺴـﻤﻰ )ﻓﺎﺻِـﻠﺔ(‬ ‫ﻣﺜﻞ‪) :‬ﻭﻛﻴﻼﹰ‪ ،‬ﺷﻜﻮﺭﺍﹰ‪ ،‬ﻧﻔﲑﺍﹰ‪ ،‬ﻟﻔﻴﻔﺎﹰ‪ ...‬ﺍﱁ( ﺃﻱ ﺃﻥ ﻫﻨﺎﻙ )‪ (١١١‬ﻓﺎﺻـﻠﺔ‪.‬‬ ‫ﻭﻋﻨﺪﻣﺎ ﳓﺬﻑ ﺍﻟﻔﻮﺍﺻﻞ ﺍﳌﺘﻜﺮﺭﺓ‪ ،‬ﳒﺪ ﺃ ﹼﻥ ﻋﺪﺩﺍﻟﻔﻮﺍﺻﻞ ﻫﻮ ‪ ٧٦‬ﻓﺎﺻـﻠﺔ‪،‬‬ ‫‪٥٥‬‬ ‫ﻭﻻ ﻧﻨﺴﻰ ﺃ ﹼﻥ ﻫﺬﺍ ﺍﻟﻌﺪﺩ ﻳﺸﲑ ﺇﱃ ﻋﻤﺮ ﺇﺳﺮﺍﺋﻴﻞ ﺍﳌﺘﻮﻗﹼﻊ ﺑﺎﻟﺴﻨﲔ ﺍﻟﻘﻤﺮﻳّﺔ‪ ،‬ﻭﻗﺪ‬ ‫ﻋﺮﻓﻨﺎ ﺳﺎﺑﻘﹰﺎ ﺃ ﹼﻥ ﻛﻞ ﻛﻠﻤﺔ ﻣﻦ ﻛﻠﻤﺎﺕ ﺳﻮﺭﺓ ﺍﻹﺳﺮﺍﺀ ﺗﻘﺎﺑﻞ ﺳﻨﺔ‪ .‬ﻭﺍﻟﻼﻓـﺖ‬ ‫ﺃﻳﻀﹰﺎ ﰲ ﺳﻮﺭﺓ ﺍﻹﺳﺮﺍﺀ ﺃ ﹼﻥ ﻫﻨﺎﻙ ﻓﻘﻂ )‪ (٤‬ﺁﻳﺎﺕ ﻋﺪﺩ ﻛﻠﻤﺎﺕ ﻛـ ٍّﻞ ﻣﻨـﻬﺎ‬ ‫)‪ (١٩‬ﻛﻠﻤﺔ‪ .‬ﻭﻋﻠﻴﻪ ﻳﻜﻮﻥ ﺍﺠﻤﻟﻤﻮﻉ‪٧٦ = (٤×١٩) :‬‬ ‫ﺍﻵﻳﺔ ‪ ٧٦‬ﻭﺍﳉﺬﺭ ﻓﺰﺯ‬ ‫ﳜﻄﺮ ﺑﺎﻟﺒﺎﻝ ﻫﻨﺎ ﺍﻟﺮﺟﻮﻉ ﺇﱃ ﺍﻵﻳﺔ ‪ ٧٦‬ﻣﻦ ﺳﻮﺭﺓ ﺍﻹﺳﺮﺍﺀ‪ .‬ﻭﺇﻟﻴـﻚ‬ ‫ﺽ ِﻟﻴُﺨﺮﺟﻮ َﻙ ﻣﻨـﻬﺎ‬ ‫ﻧﺺ ﺍﻵﻳﺔ ﺍﻟﻜﺮﳝﺔ‪ " :‬ﻭﺇ ﹾﻥ ﻛﹶﺎﺩُﻭﺍ ﹶﻟﻴﺴﺘ ِﻔ ّﺰﻭﻧﻚ ِﻣ َﻦ ﺍﻷﺭ ِ‬ ‫ﻼ( ﺭﻗـﻢ‬ ‫ﻼ " ﻭﺍﺿﺢ ﺃﻧّﻪ ﻳﺄﰐ ﺑﻌﺪ ﻛﻠﻤﺔ )ﻗﻠﻴ ﹰ‬ ‫ﻭﺇﺫﹰﺍ ﻻ ﻳﻠﺒﺜﻮ ﹶﻥ ﺧِﻼﻓﻚ ﺇﻻ ﻗﻠﻴ ﹰ‬ ‫ﺍﻵﻳﺔ‪ ،‬ﻭﻫﻮ )‪ .(٧٦‬ﻭﻗﺪ ﻳﺮﻣﺰ ﻫﺬﺍ ﺍﻟ ّﺮﻗﻢ ﺇﱃ ﻋﺪﺩ ﺍﻟﺴﻨﲔ؛ ﻓﺎﻟﻨﺒﻮﺀﺍﺕ ﺃﺣﻴﺎﻧـﹰﺎ‬ ‫ﺗﺄﰐ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺻﻮﺭﺓ ﺭﻣﺰ ﳛﺘﺎﺝ ﺇﱃ ﺗﺄﻭﻳﻞ‪ ،‬ﻛﻤﺎ ﳛﺼﻞ ﰲ ﺍﻟﺮﺅﻳﺎ ﺍﻟﺼﺎﺩﻗﺔ؛ ﻛﺮﺅﻳﺎ‬ ‫‪ ٥٥‬ﻣﻊ ﻣﻼﺣﻈﺔ ﺃ ﹼﻥ ﻓﺎﺻﻠﺔ‪ ):‬ﻣﻔﻌﻮﻻ( ﻭﻓﺎﺻﻠﺔ‪ ) :‬ﳌﻔﻌﻮﻻ( ﻫﻲ ﻓﺎﺻﻠﺔ ﻭﺍﺣﺪﺓ‪.‬‬ ‫‪٦١‬‬ ‫ﻳﻮﺳﻒ ﻋﻠﻴﻪ ﺍﻟﺴﻼﻡ‪ ،‬ﺃﻭ ﺭﺅﻳﺎ ﺍﳌﻠﻚ ﰲ ﺳﻮﺭﺓ ﻳﻮﺳﻒ‪ .‬ﻭﺇﻟﻴﻚ ﺍﳌﺆﺷﱢﺮﺍﺕ ﻋﻠﻰ‬ ‫ﺍﺣﺘﻤﺎﻝ ﺫﻟﻚ ﺍﺣﺘﻤﺎ ﹰﻻ ﺭﺍﺟﺤﹰﺎ‪:‬‬ ‫ﺃ( ﺍﻵﻳﺔ ‪ ٧٦‬ﺗﺘﺤﺪﺙ ﻋﻦ ﺍﻹﺧﺮﺍﺝ ﻣﻦ ﺍﻟ ّﺪﻳﺎﺭ‪ ،‬ﻭﻋﻦ ﻣـﺪّﺓ ﻟﺒـﺚ‬ ‫ﺍﻟﻜﻔﺎﺭ ﺑﻌﺪ ﻫﺬﺍ ﺍﻹﺧﺮﺍﺝ‪ .‬ﻭﻣﺎ ﳓﻦ ﺑﺼﺪﺩﻩ ﻫﻨﺎ ﻫﻮ ﺍﻟﺒﺤﺚ ﻋﻦ ﻋﺪﺩ ﺍﻟﺴـﻨﲔ‬ ‫ﺍﻟﱵ ﺗﻠﺒﺜﻬﺎ ﺇﺳﺮﺍﺋﻴﻞ ﺑﻌﺪ ﻗﻴﺎﻣﻬﺎ ﰲ ﺍﻷﺭﺽ ﺍﳌﻘﺪّﺳﺔ‪ ،‬ﻭﺑﻌﺪ ﺇﺧﺮﺍﺝ ﺃﻫﻠﻬﺎ ﻣﻨﻬﺎ‪.‬‬ ‫ﺏ( ﻗﺪ ﻳﻘﻮﻝ ﺍﻟﺒﻌﺾ ﺇ ﹼﻥ ﺍﻵﻳﺔ ﺗﺘﺤﺪﺙ ﻋﻦ ﺇﺧﺮﺍﺝ ﺍﻟﺮﺳﻮﻝ ﺻﻠﻰ ﺍﷲ‬ ‫ﻋﻠﻴﻪ ﻭﺳﻠﻢ ‪ -‬ﻭﻫﺬﺍ ﺻﺤﻴﺢ ‪ -‬ﻭﻟﻜ ّﻦ ﺍﻵﻳﺔ ﺍﻟﱵ ﺗﻠﻴﻬﺎ ﻫﻲ‪ُ " :‬ﺳّﻨ ﹶﺔ ﻣَﻦ ﻗﹶـ ْﺪ‬ ‫ﻼ "‪ .‬ﻓﺎﻵﻳﺔ ﺗﺘﺤﺪّﺙ ﻋﻦ ُﺳّﻨﺔ‬ ‫ﺴّﻨِﺘﻨَﺎ َﺗﺤْﻮﻳ ﹰ‬ ‫ﺠﺪُ ِﻟ ُ‬ ‫ﻚ ﻣِﻦ ﺭُﺳُ ِﻠَﻨﺎ ﻭَﻻ َﺗ ِ‬ ‫ﺃﹶﺭْﺳَﻠﹾﻨَﺎ ﹶﻗ ْﺒ ﹶﻠ َ‬ ‫ﰲ ﺍﳌﺎﺿﻲ‪ ،‬ﻭﺍﳊﺎﺿﺮ‪ ،‬ﻭﺍﳌﺴﺘﻘﺒﻞ‪.‬‬ ‫ﺝ( ﺍﺷﺘ ّﻖ ﰲ ﺍﻟﻘﺮﺁﻥ ﺍﻟﻜﺮﱘ ﻣﻦ ﺍﳉﺬﺭ ﺍﻟﺜﻼﺛﻲ )ﻓﺰﺯ( ﻓﻘـﻂ ﺛـﻼﺙ‬ ‫ﻛﻠﻤﺎﺕ‪ ،٥٦‬ﻭﺍﻟﻼﻓﺖ ﻟﻼﻧﺘﺒﺎﻩ ﺃﻥ ﻫﺬﻩ ﺍﻟﻜﻠﻤﺎﺕ ﺍﻟﺜﻼﺙ ﻣﻮﺟﻮﺩﺓ ﰲ ﺳـﻮﺭﺓ‬ ‫ﺍﻹﺳﺮﺍﺀ‪ ،‬ﺍﻵﻳﺎﺕ‪ .(١٠٣ ،٧٦ ،٦٤) :‬ﺃ ّﻣﺎ ﺍﻵﻳـﺔ ‪ " :٦٤‬ﻭَﺍﺳْـَﺘ ﹾﻔ ِﺰ ْﺯ ﻣَـ ِﻦ‬ ‫ﺖ ِﻣ ْﻨﻬُﻢ‪ "...‬ﻓﻬﻲ ‪ ١٩‬ﻛﻠﻤﺔ‪ ،‬ﻭﺑﺎﻟﺘﺎﱄ ﺗﻘﺎﺑﻞ ‪ -‬ﻛﻤﺎ ﺃﺳـﻠﻔﻨﺎ ‪١٩ -‬‬ ‫ﺍ ْﺳَﺘ ﹶﻄ ْﻌ َ‬ ‫ﺳﻨﺔ‪ .‬ﻭﺃ ّﻣﺎ ﺍﻵﻳﺔ ﺍﻟﺜﺎﻧﻴﺔ ﻓﻬﻲ ﺍﻵﻳﺔ ‪ ،٧٦‬ﻭﺍﻟﱵ ﳓﻦ ﺑﺼﺪﺩ ﺗﺮﺟﻴﺢ ﺍﺣﺘﻤـﺎﻝ ﺃ ﹼﻥ‬ ‫ﻳﻜﻮﻥ ﺭﻗﻤﻬﺎ ﻳﺸﲑ ﺇﱃ ﻋﺪﺩ ﺍﻟﺴﻨﲔ ﺍﻟﱵ ﺳﺘﻠﺒﺜﻬﺎ ﺇﺳﺮﺍﺋﻴﻞ ﰲ ﺍﻷﺭﺽ ﺍﳌﺒﺎﺭﻛﺔ؛‬ ‫ﺴَﺘ ِﻔ ّﺰﻫُﻢ‬ ‫ﻓﻬﻮ ﺗﻔﺴﲑ ﺭﻣﺰﻱ ﻟﻜﻠﻤﺔ )ﻗﻠﻴﻼ(‪ .‬ﺃ ّﻣﺎ ﺍﻵﻳﺔ ﺍﻟﺜﺎﻟﺜﺔ ﻓﻬﻲ‪ " :‬ﻓﹶﺄﺭﺍ َﺩ ﺃﹶﻥ َﻳ ْ‬ ‫ﺽ ﻓﹶﺄ ﹾﻏ َﺮ ﹾﻗﻨَﺎﻩُ َﻭﻣَﻦ َﻣ َﻌﻪُ ﺟَﻤﻴﻌﹰﺎ " ﻭﺗﻠﻴﻬﺎ ﺍﻵﻳﺔ )‪َ " :(١٠٤‬ﻭ ﹸﻗ ﹾﻠﻨَﺎ ﻣِـ ْﻦ‬ ‫ِﻣ َﻦ ﺍﻷﺭ ِ‬ ‫ﺽ ﹶﻓِﺈﺫﹶﺍ ﺟَﺎ َﺀ َﻭ ْﻋﺪُ ﺍﻵ ِﺧ َﺮ ِﺓ ِﺟﺌﹾﻨﹶﺎ ِﺑ ﹸﻜ ْﻢ ﹶﻟﻔِﻴﻔﹰﺎ "‬ ‫َﺑ ْﻌ ِﺪ ِﻩ ِﻟَﺒﻨِﻲ ﺇﺳْﺮﺍﺋﻴ ﹶﻞ ﺍ ْﺳ ﹸﻜﻨُﻮﺍ ﺍﻷﺭ َ‬ ‫‪ ٥٦‬ﺍﻻﺳﺘﻔﺰﺍﺯ ﻫﻨﺎ ﺍﻹﺯﻋﺎﺝ ﻭﺍﻹﻳﺬﺍﺀ ﻣﻦ ﺃﺟﻞ ﺍﻹﺧﺮﺍﺝ ﺃﻭ ﺍﻻﺳﺘﻨﻬﺎﺽ‪ .‬ﻭﻣﻦ ﻫﻨﺎ ﰎ ﺍﺧﺘﻴﺎﺭ ﻛﻠﻤﺔ )ﻟﻴﺴﺘﻔﺰّﻭﻧﻚ( ﺩﻭﻥ‬ ‫ﻏﲑﻫﺎ ﻣﻦ ﺍﻟﻜﻠﻤﺎﺕ ﰲ ﺍﻵﻳﺔ ‪٧٦‬‬ ‫‪٦٢‬‬ ‫ﺃﻱ ﻗﻠﻨﺎ ﻟﺒﲏ ﺇﺳﺮﺍﺋﻴﻞ ﺑﻌﺪ ﻏﺮﻕ ﻓﺮﻋﻮﻥ ﺍﺳﻜﻨﻮﺍ ﺍﻷﺭﺽ ﺍﳌﻘﺪّﺳﺔ‪ ٥٧،‬ﻓﻜﺎﻧـﺖ‬ ‫ﺴﻜﲎ ﺍﳌﻘﺪّﻣﺔ ﺍﻟﱵ ﻻﺑ ّﺪ ﻣﻨﻬﺎ ﻟﻴﺘﺤﻘﹼﻖ ﻭﻋﺪ ﺍﻹﻓﺴﺎﺩ ﺍﻷﻭﻝ‪ ،‬ﺍﻟﺬﻱ ﳛﺼﻞ‬ ‫ﻫﺬﻩ ﺍﻟ ّ‬ ‫ﺑﺴﺒﺒﻪ ﺍﻟﺸﺘﺎﺕ ﺍﻷﻭﻝ‪ .‬ﻓﺈﺫﺍ ﺟﺎﺀ ﻭﻋﺪ ﺍﳌ ّﺮﺓ ﺍﻟﺜﺎﻧﻴﺔ ﻭﺍﻷﺧﲑﺓ ﲨﻌﻨـﺎﻛﻢ ﻣـﻦ‬ ‫ﱴ‪ ،‬ﻋﻠـﻰ ﺧـﻼﻑ ﺍﳌـ ّﺮﺓ‬ ‫ﺸﺘﺎﺕ‪ ،‬ﻭﺍﳊﺎﻝ ﺃﻧّﻜﻢ ﺗﻨﺘﻤﻮﻥ ﺇﱃ ﺃﺻـﻮ ٍﻝ ﺷـ ّ‬ ‫ﺍﻟ ّ‬ ‫ﺍﻷﻭﱃ‪،‬ﺣﻴﺚ ﻛﻨﺘﻢ ﺗﻨﺘﻤﻮﻥ ﺇﱃ ﺃﺻ ٍﻞ ﻭﺍﺣﺪ‪ ،‬ﻭﻫﻮ ﻳﻌﻘﻮﺏ ﻋﻠﻴﻪ ﺍﻟﺴﻼﻡ‪ " :‬ﻓﹶﺈﺫﺍ‬ ‫ﺟَﺎ َﺀ َﻭ ْﻋﺪُ ﺍﻵ ِﺧ َﺮ ِﺓ ِﺟ ﹾﺌﻨَﺎ ِﺑﻜﹸﻢ ﹶﻟﻔِﻴ ﹶﻔﹰﺎ "‪ .‬ﻭﺍﻟﻼﻓـﺖ ﻫﻨـﺎ ﺃ ﹼﻥ ﺍﻟﻜﻠﻤـﺔ ﺍﻟﺜﺎﻟﺜـﺔ‬ ‫)َﻳﺴﺘ ِﻔ ّﺰﻫﻢ( ﺗﺘﻌﻠﻖ ﺑﺎﻟﻜﻼﻡ ﻋﻦ ﺍﻹﻓﺴﺎﺩﻳﻦ‪ ،‬ﻭﻋﻠﻰ ﻭﺟﻪ ﺍﳋﺼﻮﺹ ﺍﻹﻓﺴـﺎﺩ‬ ‫ﺍﻷﺧﲑ‪ ،‬ﻭﺍﻟﺬﻱ ﻫﻮ ﻣﻮﺿﻮﻉ ﻫﺬﺍ ﺍﻟﺒﺤﺚ‪ .‬ﻭﻻ ﻧﻨﺴﻰ ﻫﻨﺎ ﺃ ﹼﻥ ﻋﺪﺩ ﺍﻟﻜﻠﻤـﺎﺕ‬ ‫ﺚ‬ ‫ﻣﻦ ﺑﺪﺍﻳﺔ ﺍﳊﺪﻳﺚ ﻋﻦ ﺍﻟﻨﺒّﻮﺀﺓ‪ " :‬ﻭﺁﺗﻴﻨﺎ ﻣﻮﺳﻰ ﺍﻟﻜﺘﺎﺏ‪ "...‬ﺇﱃ ﺁﺧﺮ ﺣﺪﻳ ٍ‬ ‫ﺻﺮﻳﺢ ﻋﻨﻬﺎ‪ " :‬ﹶﻓِﺈﺫﹶﺍ ﺟَﺎ َﺀ َﻭ ْﻋﺪُ ﺍﻵ ِﺧ َﺮ ِﺓ ِﺟ ﹾﺌﻨَﺎ ِﺑﻜﹸﻢ ﹶﻟﻔِﻴ ﹶﻔﺎﹸ "‪ ،‬ﻫﻮ ‪١٤٤٣‬ﻛﻠﻤﺔ‪،‬‬ ‫ﻭﻳﺘﻄﺎﺑﻖ ﻫﺬﺍ ﺍﻟﻌﺪﺩ ﻣﻊ ﺍﻟﻌﺎﻡ ‪١٤٤٣‬ﻫـ‪ ،‬ﻭﳚﺪﺭ ﺍﻟﺘﺬﻛﲑ ﻫﻨﺎ ﺃ ﹼﻥ ﻋﺪﺩ ﺍﻟﺴﻨﲔ‬ ‫ﻣﻦ ﻋﺎﻡ ﺍﻹﺳﺮﺍﺀ‪ ،‬ﺇﱃ ﻫﺬﺍ ﺍﻟﻌﺎﻡ‪ ،‬ﻫﻮ ‪ ١٤٤٤‬ﺳﻨﺔ ﻗﻤﺮﻳّﺔ‪ ،‬ﺃﻱ )‪.(٧٦×١٩‬‬ ‫ﻋﻠﻰ ﺿﻮﺀ ﻣﺎ ﺳﺒﻖ‪ ،‬ﻭﻋﻠﻰ ﺿﻮﺀ ﺃ ﹼﻥ ﻛﻞ ﻛﻠﻤﺔ ﰲ ﺳـﻮﺭﺓ ﺍﻹﺳـﺮﺍﺀ‬ ‫ﺼﻠﺖ ﻣﻦ ﻣﺘﻌﹼﻠﻘﺎﺕ ﺍﻟﻜﻠﻤـﺎﺕ‬ ‫ﺗﻘﺎﺑﻞ ﺳﻨﺔ‪ ،‬ﺇﻟﻴﻚ ﻫﺬﻩ ﺍﳌﻌﺎﺩﻟﺔ ﺍﻟﻌﺪﺩﻳّﺔ ﺍﻟﱵ ﲢ ّ‬ ‫ﺍﻟﱵ ﺍﺷﺘﻘﹼﺖ ﻣﻦ )ﻓﺰﺯ(‪ :‬ﻓﺎﻟﻜﻠﻤﺔ ﺍﻷﻭﱃ )ﻭﺍﺳﺘﻔﺰﺯ( ﺗﻘﻊ ﰲ ﺍﻵﻳﺔ ‪ ،٦٤‬ﻭﺍﻟـﱵ‬ ‫ﻋﺪﺩ ﻛﻠﻤﺎﻬﺗﺎ )‪ (١٩‬ﻛﻠﻤﺔ‪ .‬ﻭﺍﻟﻜﻠﻤﺔ ﺍﻟﺜﺎﻧﻴﺔ )ﻟﻴﺴﺘﻔ ّﺰﻭﻧﻚ( ﺗﻘﻊ ﰲ ﺍﻵﻳﺔ ‪٧٦‬‬ ‫ﻭﺍﻟﱵ ﻳﺮﺍﺩ ﺗﺮﺟﻴﺢ ﺍﺣﺘﻤﺎﻝ ﺃﻬﻧﺎ ﺗﺮﻣﺰ ﺇﱃ ﻋـﺪﺩ ﺳـﻨﲔ‪ .‬ﻭﺍﻟﻜﻠﻤـﺔ ﺍﻟﺜﺎﻟﺜـﺔ‬ ‫)ﻳﺴﺘﻔﺰﻫﻢ( ﺗﻘﻊ ﰲ ﺍﻵﻳﺔ ‪ ١٠٣‬ﺍﻟﱵ ﺗﺘﺤﺪّﺙ ﻋﻦ ﻏﺮﻕ ﻓﺮﻋﻮﻥ‪ ،‬ﹼﰒ ﺗﻠﻴﻬﺎ ﺍﻵﻳﺔ‬ ‫ﺍﻟﱵ ﺗﺘﺤﺪّﺙ ﻋﻦ ﻭﻋﺪ ﺍﻵﺧﺮﺓ‪ .‬ﻭﻋﻠﻴﻪ ﻧﻘﻮﻝ‪ :‬ﲟﺎ ﺃ ﹼﻥ ﻋﺪﺩ ﻛﻠﻤﺎﺕ ﺍﻵﻳﺔ ﺍﻷﻭﱃ‬ ‫‪٥٧‬‬ ‫ﺭﺍﺟﻊ ﺍﻟﺘﻔﺴﲑ‪.‬‬ ‫‪٦٣‬‬ ‫‪ ١٩‬ﻛﻠﻤﺔ‪ ،‬ﻭﻛﻞ ﻛﻠﻤﺔ ﰲ ﺳﻮﺭﺓ ﺍﻹﺳﺮﺍﺀ ﺗﻘﺎﺑﻞ ﺳﻨﺔ‪ ،‬ﻭﲟﺎ ﺃﻧّﻨﺎ ﻧﻔﺘـﺮﺽ ﺃ ﹼﻥ‬ ‫ﺭﻗﻢ ﺍﻵﻳﺔ ‪ ٧٦‬ﻳﺸﲑ ﺇﱃ ﻋﺪﺩ ﺳﻨﲔ‪ ،‬ﻓﺈ ﹼﻥ ﺍﳌﻌﺎﺩﻟﺔ ﻫﻲ‪:‬‬ ‫) ‪ ١٤٤٤ = ( ٧٦×١٩‬ﻭﺍﳌﻔﺎﺟﺄﺓ ﻫﻨﺎ ﺃ ﹼﻥ ﺗﺮﺗﻴـﺐ ﺍﻟﻜﻠﻤـﺔ ﺍﻟﺜﺎﻟﺜـﺔ‪ ،‬ﺃﻱ‬ ‫ﻳﺴﺘﻔﺰﻫﻢ‪ ،‬ﰲ ﺳﻮﺭﺓ ﺍﻹﺳﺮﺍﺀ ﻫﻮ )‪ .(١٤٤٤‬ﻓﺘﺄﻣّﻞ!!‬ ‫‪٦٤‬‬ ‫ﺍﻟﻮﻋﺪ‬ ‫ﺑﻌﺪ ﻭﻓﺎﺓ ﺳﻠﻴﻤﺎﻥ ﻋﻠﻴﻪ ﺍﻟﺴﻼﻡ‪ ،‬ﺍﻧﺸﻘﹼﺖ ﺍﻟﺪﻭﻟﺔ ﻭﺑﺪﺃ ﺍﻹﻓﺴﺎﺩ‪ ،‬ﻓﻜـﺎﻥ‬ ‫ﺃﻥ ﺟﺎﺀ ﺍﳌﺼﺮّﻳﻮﻥ‪ ،‬ﻭﺍﻷﺷﻮﺭّﻳﻮﻥ‪ ،‬ﻭﺍﻟﻜﻠﺪﺍﻧﻴّﻮﻥ‪ ،‬ﻓﺎﺣﺘﻠﻮﺍ ﺍﻟﺪﻭﻟﺘﲔ ﻣﻦ ﻏـﲑ ﺃﻥ‬ ‫ﻳﺰﻳﻠﻮﺍ ﺍﳌﻠﻮﻙ‪ ،‬ﺑﻞ ﺃﺑﻘﻮﻫﻢ ﻋﻠـﻰ ﻋﺮﻭﺷـﻬﻢ‪ .‬ﻭﰲ ﺍﻟﻌـﺎﻡ ‪ ٧٢٢‬ﻕ‪.‬ﻡ ﻗـﺎﻡ‬ ‫ﺍﻷﺷﻮﺭّﻳﻮﻥ ﺑﺘﺪﻣﲑ ﺍﻟﺪﻭﻟﺔ ﺍﻟﺸﻤﺎﻟﻴﺔ ﺇﺳﺮﺍﺋﻴﻞ‪ ٥٨.‬ﻭﺍﺳﺘﻤﺮ ﺍﳉﻮﺱ ‪ -‬ﻭﻫﻮ ﻛﺜﺮﺓ‬ ‫ﺍﻟﺘﺮﺩﱡﺩ ‪ -‬ﰲ ﺍﻟﺪﻭﻟﺔ ﺍﳉﻨﻮﺑﻴﺔ ﻳﻬﻮﺫﺍ‪ ،‬ﺣﱴ ﺟﺎﺀ )ﻧﺒﻮﺧﺬ ﻧﺼﺮ( ﻭﺃﻟﻘﻰ ﺍﻟﻘـﺒﺾ‬ ‫ﺻﺪﻗﻴﺎ( ﻭﻗﺘﻞ ﺍﻟﻜﺜﲑﻳﻦ‪ ،‬ﻭﺩ ّﻣﺮ ﺩﻭﻟﺔ ﻳﻬﻮﺫﺍ‪،‬‬ ‫ﻋﻠﻰ ﺍﳌﻠﻚ ﺍﻟﺘﺎﺳﻊ ﻋﺸﺮ ﺍﳌﺴﻤﻰ ) ِ‬ ‫ﻭﺫﻟﻚ ﻋﺎﻡ ‪ ٥٨٦‬ﻕ‪.‬ﻡ‪ .‬ﻭﺑﺬﻟﻚ ﺍﻧﺘﻬﻰ ﺍﳉﻮﺱ ﰲ ﺍﳌ ّﺮﺓ ﺍﻷﻭﱃ‪ .‬ﻭﺍﻟﻼﻓﺖ ﻟﻠﻨﻈﺮ‬ ‫ﺃ ﹼﻥ ﺍﳉﻮﺱ ﺍﺳﺘﻤﺮ ﺑﺎﺳﺘﻤﺮﺍﺭ ﺍﻹﻓﺴﺎﺩ‪ ،‬ﻭﺍﻧﺘﻬﻰ ﺑﺘﺪﻣﲑ ﺍﻟـﺪﻭﻟﺘﲔ‪ .‬ﻭﻳُﻠﺤـﻆ ﺃ ﹼﻥ‬ ‫ﺍﻹﻓﺴﺎﺩ ﻭﺍﳉﻮﺱ ﻛﺎﻧﺎ ﻣﺘﻼﺯﻣﲔ‪ .‬ﺃ ّﻣﺎ ﰲ ﺍﳌﺮﺓ ﺍﻟﺜﺎﻧﻴﺔ ﻭﺍﻷﺧﲑﺓ ﻓﻘﺪ ﺑﺪﺃ ﺍﻹﻓﺴﺎﺩ‬ ‫ﻋﺎﻡ ‪١٩٤٨‬ﻡ ﰲ ﺟﺰ ٍﺀ ﻣﻦ ﺍﻷﺭﺽ ﺍﳌﻘﺪّﺳﺔ‪ ،‬ﰒ ﺍﻛﺘﻤﻞ ﻓﻴﻬﺎ ﺑﻌﺪ ‪ ١٩‬ﻋﺎﻣﺎ‪ ،‬ﰲ‬ ‫ﺍﻟﻌﺎﻡ ‪١٩٦٧‬ﻡ‪ .‬ﺃﻱ ﺃ ﹼﻥ ﺍﻹﻓﺴﺎﺩ ﴰﻞ ﺍﻷﺭﺽ ﺍﳌﻘ ّﺪﺳﺔ ﻋﻠﻰ ﻣﺮﺣﻠﺘﲔ‪ .‬ﺃﻣﺎ ﺍﻟﻮﻋﺪ‬ ‫ﺍﻷﻭﻝ ﻓﻘﺪ ﺗﻼﺯﻡ ﻓﻴﻪ ﺍﻹﻓﺴﺎﺩ ﻭﺍﻟﻌﻘﻮﺑﺔ‪ .‬ﻭﻫﺬﺍ ﺍﻟﻔﺎﺭﻕ ﺑﲔ ﺍﳌ ّﺮﺓ ﺍﻷﻭﱃ ﻭﺍﻷﺧﲑﺓ‬ ‫‪٥٨‬‬ ‫ﻭﺷﻌﺒﻬﺎ ﻳﻨﺘﺴﺐ ﺇﱃ ﻋﺸﺮﺓ‪ ،‬ﺃﺳﺒﺎﻁ ﻭﻫﻢ ﺍﻟﺬﻳﻦ ﻗﺎﻣﻮﺍ ﺑﺎﻻﻧﻔﺼﺎﻝ‪ ،‬ﻭﺳﺎﺭﻭﺍ ﰲ ﻃﺮﻳﻖ ﺍﻟﻔﺴﺎﺩ‪.‬‬ ‫‪٦٥‬‬ ‫ﳒﺪﻩ ﻳﻨﻌﻜﺲ ﰲ ﻋﺎﱂ ﺍﻷﺭﻗﺎﻡ‪:‬‬ ‫ﺍﻟﻌﺎﻡ ‪ ٧٢٢‬ﻕ‪.‬ﻡ ﻫﻮ ﻋﺎﻡ ﺗﺪﻣﲑ ﺇﺳﺮﺍﺋﻴﻞ ﺍﻷﻭﱃ‪ ،‬ﻭﺍﻟـﱵ ﻫـﻲ ﺃﻭﱃ‬ ‫ﺍﻟﺪﻭﻟﺘﲔ ﺇﻓﺴﺎﺩﹰﺍ؛ ﻓﻬﻲ ﺍﻟﱵ ﺑﺪﺃﺕ ﺍﻻﻧﻔﺼﺎﻝ‪ ،‬ﻭﻫﻲ ﺍﻟﱵ ﺯﺍﻟﺖ ﺃﻭﻻﹰ‪ ،‬ﻭﺑﺎﻟﺘـﺎﱄ‬ ‫ﻳﻨﻄﺒﻖ ﻋﻠﻴﻬﺎ ﻟﻔﻆ ﺃﻭﻻﳘﺎ‪.‬‬ ‫ﺍﻟﻌﺎﻡ ‪١٩٤٨‬ﻡ ﻳﻮﺍﻓﻖ ﺍﻟﻌﺎﻡ ‪١٣٦٧‬ﻫـ‪ ،‬ﻭﻋﻨﺪﻫﺎ ﻳﻜﻮﻥ ﻗﺪ ﻣﻀﻰ ﻋﻠﻰ‬ ‫ﺍﻹﺳﺮﺍﺀ ‪ ١٣٦٨‬ﺳﻨﺔ ﻗﻤﺮﻳّﺔ‪ .‬ﻭﰲ ﺍﻟﻌﺎﻡ ‪١٩٦٧‬ﻡ ﻳﻜﻮﻥ ﻗﺪ ﻣﻀـﻰ ﻋﻠـﻰ‬ ‫ﺍﻹﺳﺮﺍﺀ ‪ ١٣٨٧‬ﺳﻨﺔ ﻗﻤﺮﻳّﺔ‪ .‬ﻭﰲ ﺍﻟﻌﺎﻡ ‪٢٠٢٢‬ﻡ ﻳﻜﻮﻥ ﻗـﺪ ﻣﻀـﻰ ﻋﻠـﻰ‬ ‫ﺍﻹﺳﺮﺍﺀ ‪ ١٤٤٤‬ﺳﻨﺔ ﻗﻤﺮﻳّﺔ‪ .‬ﻭﺑﻨﺎ ًﺀ ﻋﻠﻴﻪ ﺇﻟﻴﻚ ﻫﺬﻩ ﺍﳌﻼﺣﻈﺎﺕ ﺍﻟﻌﺪﺩﻳّﺔ‪:‬‬ ‫ﺇﺫﺍ ﺑﺪﺃﻧﺎ ﻋ ّﺪ ﺍﻟﻜﻠﻤﺎﺕ ﻣﻦ ﺑﺪﺍﻳﺔ ﺍﳊﺪﻳﺚ ﻋﻦ ﺍﻟﻨﺒﻮﺀﺓ‪ ،‬ﺃﻱ ﻣﻦ ﻗﻮﻟـﻪ ﺗﻌـﺎﱃ‪:‬‬ ‫ﺏ"‪ ،‬ﻓﺴﻴﻜﻮﻥ ﺗﺮﺗﻴﺐ ﻛﻠﻤﺔ )ﺃﻭﻻﳘﺎ( ﰲ ﻗﻮﻟﻪ ﺗﻌـﺎﱃ‪:‬‬ ‫"ﻭﺁﺗَﻴﻨَﺎ ﻣُﻮﺳَﻰ ﺍﻟ ِﻜﺘَﺎ َ‬ ‫" ﻓﺈﺫﺍ ﺟﺎﺀ ﻭﻋ ُﺪ ﹸﺃﻭﻻﳘﺎ ﺑﻌﺜﻨﺎ ﻋﻠﻴﻜﻢ ﻋﺒﺎﺩﹰﺍ‪ "...‬ﻫﻮ ‪٥٩٣٨‬ﻭﻳﻜﻮﻥ ﺗﺮﺗﻴـﺐ‬ ‫ﻛﻠﻤﺔ )ﻭﻋﺪ( ﻫﻮ ‪ ،٧٢‬ﻭﺗﺮﺗﻴﺐ ﻛﻠﻤﺔ )ﺍﻵﺧﺮﺓ( ﻫﻮ ‪ ،٧٣‬ﻭﺫﻟﻚ ﰲ ﻗﻮﻟـﻪ‬ ‫ﺠ َﺪ‪." ...‬‬ ‫ﺴِ‬ ‫ﺗﻌﺎﱃ‪ " :‬ﻓﹶﺈﺫﺍ ﺟَﺎ َﺀ َﻭ ْﻋﺪُ ﺍﻵ ِﺧ َﺮ ِﺓ ﻟِﻴﺴُﻮﺀﻭﺍ ﻭﺟﻮﻫَﻜﻢ ﻭﻟﻴ ْﺪﺧُﻠﻮﺍ ﺍﳌ ْ‬ ‫ﺃﻣّﺎ ﺗﺮﺗﻴﺐ ﻛﻠﻤﺔ )ﻭﻟﻴﺪﺧﻠﻮﺍ( ﻓﻬﻮ ‪ ،٧٦‬ﻭﻫﺬﺍ ﻳﻨﺴﺠﻢ ﻣﻊ ﺍﻟﻘﻮﻝ ﺑﺄ ﹼﻥ ﻋُﻤـﺮ‬ ‫ﺴﻮﺭﺓ ﺗُﻘﺎﺑـﻞ ﺳـﻨﺔ‪،‬‬ ‫ﺩﻭﻟﺔ ﺇﺳﺮﺍﺋﻴﻞ ﺍﻟﺜﺎﻧﻴﺔ ﻫﻮ ‪ ٧٦‬ﺳﻨﺔ؛ ﻷ ﹼﻥ ﻛﻞ ﻛﻠﻤﺔ ﰲ ﺍﻟ ّ‬ ‫ﻭﺍﻟ ّﺪﺧﻮﻝ ﻳﻜﻮﻥ ﻋﻨﺪ ﺣﺼﻮﻝ ﻭﻋﺪ ﺍﻟﻌﻘﻮﺑﺔ‪.‬‬ ‫ﺇﺫﺍ ﺿﺮﺑﻨﺎ ﺗﺮﺗﻴﺐ ﻛﻠﻤﺔ )ﺃﹸﻭﻻﳘﺎ( ﰲ ‪ ١٩‬ﻳﻜﻮﻥ ﺍﻟﻨﺎﺗﺞ‪:‬‬ ‫)‪ ٧٢٢ = (٣٨×١٩‬ﻭﻫﺬﺍ ﻫﻮ ﺗﺎﺭﻳﺦ ﺳﻘﻮﻁ ﺩﻭﻟﺔ ﺇﺳﺮﺍﺋﻴﻞ ﺍﻷﻭﱃ‪ ،‬ﺃﻱ ﻋﺪﺩ‬ ‫‪٥٩‬‬ ‫ﺍﻟﻌﺪﺩ ‪ ٣٨‬ﻫﻮ ‪٢×١٩‬‬ ‫‪٦٦‬‬ ‫ﺍﻟﺴﻨﲔ ﺍﻟﺸﻤﺴﻴّﺔ ﻗﺒﻞ ﺍﳌﻴﻼﺩ‪.‬‬ ‫‪٦٠‬‬ ‫ﺇﺫﺍ ﺿﺮﺑﻨﺎ ﺗﺮﺗﻴﺐ ﻛﻠﻤﺔ )ﻭﻋﺪ( ﰲ ‪ ١٩‬ﻳﻜﻮﻥ ﺍﻟﻨﺎﺗﺞ‪:‬‬ ‫ﺴﻨﲔ ﺍﳍﺠﺮّﻳﺔ ﻣﻦ ﺍﻹﺳﺮﺍﺀ ﺇﱃ ﺍﻟﻌﺎﻡ‬ ‫)‪ ،١٣٦٨ = (٧٢×١٩‬ﻭﻫﺬﺍ ﻫﻮ ﻋﺪﺩ ﺍﻟ ّ‬ ‫‪١٩٤٨‬ﻡ‪ ،‬ﺃﻱ ﺇﱃ ﺯﻣﻦ ﺑﺪﺍﻳﺔ ﺍﻹﻓﺴﺎﺩ ﺍﳉﺰﺋﻲ ﰲ ﺍﻷﺭﺽ ﺍﳌﺒﺎﺭﻛﺔ‪.‬‬ ‫ﻭﺇﺫﺍ ﺿﺮﺑﻨﺎ ﺗﺮﺗﻴﺐ ﻛﻠﻤﺔ )ﺍﻵﺧﺮﺓ( ﰲ ‪ ١٩‬ﻳﻜﻮﻥ ﺍﻟﻨﺎﺗﺞ‪:‬‬ ‫) ‪ ١٣٨٧ = ( ٧٣×١٩‬ﻭﻫﺬﺍ ﻫﻮ ﻋﺪﺩ ﺍﻟﺴﻨﲔ ﺍﳍﺠﺮّﻳﺔ ﻣﻦ ﺍﻹﺳـﺮﺍﺀ ﺇﱃ‬ ‫ﺍﻟﻌﺎﻡ ‪١٩٦٧‬ﻡ‪ ،‬ﺃﻱ ﻋﺎﻡ ﺍﻛﺘﻤﺎﻝ ﺍﻹﻓﺴﺎﺩ ﰲ ﺍﻷﺭﺽ ﺍﳌﻘﺪّﺳﺔ‪.‬‬ ‫ﻭﺇﺫﺍ ﺿﺮﺑﻨﺎ ﺗﺮﺗﻴﺐ ﻛﻠﻤﺔ )ﻭﻟﻴﺪﺧﻠﻮﺍ( ﰲ ‪ ١٩‬ﻳﻜﻮﻥ ﺍﻟﻨﺎﺗﺞ‪:‬‬ ‫ﺴﻨﲔ ﺍﳍﺠﺮﻳﺔ‪ ،‬ﻣﻦ ﺍﻹﺳﺮﺍﺀ ﺇﱃ ﺍﻟﻌﺎﻡ‬ ‫) ‪ ١٤٤٤ = (٧٦×١٩‬ﻭﻫﺬﺍ ﻫﻮ ﻋﺪﺩ ﺍﻟ ّ‬ ‫‪٢٠٢٢‬ﻡ‬ ‫ﺇ ﹼﻥ ﺇﺳﺎﺀﺓ ﺍﻟﻮﺟﻪ ﰲ ﻗﻮﻟﻪ ﺗﻌﺎﱃ‪ِ ..) :‬ﻟَﻴﺴُﻮﺅﺍ ُﻭﺟُﻮ َﻫﻜﹸﻢ‪ ( ...‬ﳝﻜﻦ ﺃﻥ‬ ‫ﺗﺘﻤﺜﻞ ﰲ ﲡﺮﻳﺪ ﺇﺳﺮﺍﺋﻴﻞ ﻣﻦ ﺻﻮﺭﻬﺗﺎ ﺍﻹﳚﺎﺑﻴﺔ ﺍﳌﺰﻋﻮﻣﺔ ﻭﺍﳌﺼﻄﻨﻌﺔ‪ ،‬ﻭﻏﲏ ﻋﻦ‬ ‫ﺍﻟﺒﻴﺎﻥ ﺃ ﹼﻥ ﻭﺟﻮﺩ ﺇﺳﺮﺍﺋﻴﻞ ﻣﺮﻫﻮﻥ ﺑﺎﻟ ّﺪﻋﻢ ﺍﳋﺎﺭﺟﻲ‪ ،‬ﳑﺎ ﻳﻌﲏ ﺃ ﹼﻥ ﺳﻼﺡ ﺇﺳﺮﺍﺋﻴﻞ‬ ‫ﺍﻷﻭﻝ ﻫﻮ ﺍﻹﻋﻼﻡ‪ ،‬ﻭﺑﺎﻟﺘﺎﱄ ﻓﺈ ﹼﻥ ﺇﺳﺎﺀﺓ ﺍﻟﻮﺟﻪ ﺳﻴﻜﻮﻥ ﳍﺎ ﺁﺛﺎﺭ ﻣﺪ ّﻣﺮﺓ ﻋﻠـﻰ‬ ‫ﺴﺎﺑﻖ‪ ،‬ﻓﺴﻨﺼﻞ ﺇﱃ ﻧﺘﻴﺠـﺔ‬ ‫ﻭﺟﻮﺩ ﺇﺳﺮﺍﺋﻴﻞ‪ .‬ﻭﺇﺫﺍ ﺍﺳﺘﺨﺪﻣﻨﺎ ﺍﳌﻨﻄﻖ ﺍﻟﺮّﻳﺎﺿ ّﻲ ﺍﻟ ّ‬ ‫ﺗﻘﻮﻝ ﺑﺎﺣﺘﻤﺎﻝ ﺃﻥ ﲤﺘﺪ ﻣﺮﺣﻠﺔ ﺇﺳﺎﺀﺓ ﺍﻟﻮﺟﻪ ﻣﻦ ﻋﺎﻡ ‪١٩٨٥‬ﻡ‪ ،‬ﺇﱃ ﺃﻭﺍﺧﺮ ﻋﺎﻡ‬ ‫‪٢٠٠٣‬ﻡ‪.‬‬ ‫ﺗﻜﺮﺭﺕ ﻋﺒﺎﺭﺓ " ﻭﻋﺪ ﺍﻵﺧﺮﺓ " ﰲ ﺍﻟﻘﺮﺁﻥ ﺍﻟﻜﺮﱘ ﻣـﺮﺗﲔ ﻓﻘـﻂ؛‬ ‫‪ ٦٠‬ﻧﺬﻛﹼﺮ ﻫﻨﺎ ﺃﻧّﻨﺎ ﻧﺘﻌﺎﻣﻞ ﻗﺒﻞ ﺍﻹﺳﺮﺍﺀ ﺑﺎﻟﺴﻨﲔ ﺍﻟﺸﻤﺴﻴّﺔ‪ ،‬ﻭﺑﻌﺪﻩ ﺑﺎﻟﺴﻨﲔ ﺍﻟﻘﻤﺮﻳّﺔ‪.‬‬ ‫‪٦٧‬‬ ‫ﺍﻷﻭﱃ ﰲ ﻓﻮﺍﺗﺢ ﺳﻮﺭﺓ ﺍﻹﺳﺮﺍﺀ‪ ،‬ﻭﺍﻟﺜﺎﻧﻴﺔ ﰲ ﺧﻮﺍﺗﻴﻤﻬﺎ‪ ،‬ﻭﺍﻟﻜـﻼﻡ ﰲ ﺍﳌـﺮّﺗﲔ‬ ‫ﻳﺘﻌﻠﹼﻖ ﺑﺎﻹﻓﺴﺎﺩ ﺍﻹﺳﺮﺍﺋﻴﻠﻲ ﰲ ﺍﻷﺭﺽ ﺍﳌﻘﺪّﺳﺔ‪ ،‬ﺑﻞ ﺟﺎﺀﺕ ﺍﻟﻌﺒﺎﺭﺓ ﰲ ﺍﻟﻔﻮﺍﺗﺢ‪:‬‬ ‫" ﻓﹶﺈﺫﺍ ﺟَﺎ َﺀ َﻭ ْﻋﺪُ ﺍﻵ ِﺧ َﺮ ِﺓ‪ " .....‬ﻭﰲ ﺍﳋﻮﺍﺗﻴﻢ " ﻓﹶﺈﺫﺍ ﺟَﺎ َﺀ َﻭ ْﻋﺪُ ﺍﻵﺧِـ َﺮ ِﺓ‪"...‬‬ ‫ﻭﻫﺬﺍ ﻳﺸﲑ ﺇﱃ ﺃ ﹼﻥ ﺳﻮﺭﺓ ﺍﻹﺳﺮﺍﺀ ﲟﺠﻤﻠﻬﺎ ﺗﺘﺤﺪﺙ ﺣﻮﻝ ﻭﻋﺪ ﺍﻵﺧﺮﺓ‪ ،‬ﻭﻳﺪ ﹼﻝ‬ ‫ﻋﻠﻰ ﺃﳘﹼﻴﺔ ﻫﺬﺍ ﺍﻟﻮﻋﺪ‪ .‬ﻭﺳﺒﻖ ﻟﻨﺎ ﺃﻥ ﻗﺮﺃﻧﺎ ﻣﻘﺎ ﹰﻻ ﻟﻸﺳﺘﺎﺫ ﺍﳌﻮﺩﻭﺩﻱ ﻳﺴﺘﻨﺒﻂ ﻓﻴﻪ‬ ‫ﺕ ﻣﻦ ﺳﻮﺭﺓ ﺍﻹﺳﺮﺍﺀ‪.‬‬ ‫ﻋﻨﺎﺻﺮ ﻗﻴﺎﻡ ﺍﻟﺪﻭﻟﺔ ﺍﻹﺳﻼﻣﻴﺔ ﻣﻦ ﺁﻳﺎ ٍ‬ ‫ﺩﻻﻻﺕ ﺍﳋﻮﺍﺗﻴﻢ‬ ‫ﺟﺎﺀ ﰲ ﺧﻮﺍﺗﻴﻢ ﺳﻮﺭﺓ ﺍﻹﺳﺮﺍﺀ‪ " :‬ﻗﹸﻞ ﺁﻣﻨﻮﺍ ﺑـ ِﻪ ﹶﺃ ْﻭ ﻻ ُﺗ ْﺆﻣِﻨـﻮﺍ‪ ،‬ﺇ ﹼﻥ‬ ‫ﺠﺪﺍﹰ‪،‬‬ ‫ﺍﻟﺬﻳﻦ ﺃﹸﻭﺗُﻮﺍ ﺍﻟﻌِﻠ َﻢ ﻣِﻦ ﹶﻗ ْﺒ ِﻠ ِﻪ ﺇِﺫﹶﺍ ﻳُﺘﻠﻰ َﻋ ﹶﻠ ْﻴﻬِﻢ َﻳﺨِـ ّﺮﻭ ﹶﻥ ِﻟﻸَﺫﻗـﺎ ِﻥ ﺳُـ ّ‬ ‫ﻭَﻳَﻘﹸﻮﻟﻮﻥﹶ ﺳُﺒْﺤَﺎﻥﹶ ﺭَﺑﻨﺎ ﺇ ﹾﻥ ﻛﹶﺎ ﹶﻥ َﻭ ْﻋﺪُ َﺭّﺑﻨﺎ ﹶﻟ َﻤ ﹾﻔﻌُﻮ ﹰﻻ "‪.٦١‬‬ ‫)ﻗﹸﻞ ﺁﻣِﻨﻮﺍ ِﺑ ِﻪ(‪ :‬ﺃﻱ ﺑﺎﻟﻘﺮﺁﻥ‪ ،‬ﻭﻻ ﻧﻨﺴﻰ ﺃﻧﻨﺎ ﰲ ﺳﻴﺎﻕ ﺍﳊﺪﻳﺚ ﻋـﻦ‬ ‫ﻭﻋﺪ ﺍﻵﺧﺮﺓ‪ ،‬ﻭﻋﻠﻴﻪ ﻓﻘﺪ ﻳﺮﺟﻊ ﺍﻟﻀّﻤﲑ ﰲ )ﺑﻪ( ﺇﱃ ﺍﻟﻮﻋﺪ ﺍﻟﻘﺮﺁﱐ‪ ،‬ﻭُﻳﻘﹶـ ّﻮﻱ‬ ‫ﻫﺬﺍ ﻣﻼﺣﻈﺔ ﺃ ﹼﻥ )ﻭﻋﺪ ﻣﻔﻌﻮﻝ( ﱂ ﻳﺮﺩ ﰲ ﺍﻟﻘﺮﺁﻥ ﺍﻟﻜﺮﱘ ﺇﻻ ﺛﻼﺙ ﻣـﺮﺍﺕ‪:‬‬ ‫"ﻛﺎﻥ ﻭﻋﺪﻩ ﻣﻔﻌﻮ ﹰﻻ" ﻣﻦ ﺳﻮﺭﺓ ﺍﳌﺰ ّﻣﻞ‪ .٦٢‬ﻭﻭﺭﺩﺕ ﺍﳌﺮﺗﺎﻥ ﺍﻷﺧﺮﻳﺎﻥ ﰲ ﺳﻮﺭﺓ‬ ‫ﺍﻹﺳﺮﺍﺀ؛ ﺍﻷﻭﱃ ﺑﻌﺪ ﺍﳊﺪﻳﺚ ﻋﻦ ﲢﻘﹼﻖ ﺍﻟﻮﻋﺪ ﺍﻷﻭﻝ ﻗﺒﻞ ﺍﻹﺳﻼﻡ‪ " :‬ﻭﻛـﺎﻥ‬ ‫ﻭﻋﺪﹰﺍ ﻣﻔﻌﻮ ﹰﻻ "‪ .‬ﻭﺍﻟﺜﺎﻧﻴﺔ ﺟﺎﺀﺕ ﺑﻌﺪ ﺍﳊﺪﻳﺚ ﻋﻦ ﻭﻋﺪ ﺍﻵﺧﺮﺓ‪ ،‬ﻋﻨﺪ ﺍﻟﻜـﻼﻡ‬ ‫ﻋﻦ ﺗﻌ ّ‬ ‫ﺠﺐ ﺍﻟﺬﻳﻦ ﺃﻭﺗﻮﺍ ﺍﻟﻌﻠﻢ‪ ٦٣‬ﻣﻦ ﺻﺪﻕ ﺍﻟﻮﻋﺪ ﺍﻹﳍﻲ‪ ،‬ﻭﻗﻮﳍﻢ‪" :‬ﺳُـﺒﺤﺎﻥ‬ ‫‪ ٦١‬ﺍﻹﺳﺮﺍﺀ‪.١٠٨ ،١٠٧ :‬‬ ‫‪ ٦٢‬ﺍﳌﺰّﻣﻞ‪.١٨ :‬‬ ‫‪ ٦٣‬ﻻ ﻳﺒﻌﺪ ﺃﻥ ﻳﻜﻮﻥ ﺍﳌﻘﺼﻮﺩ ﺑﺎﻟﺬﻳﻦ ﺃﻭﺗﻮﺍ ﺍﻟﻌﻠﻢ ﻫﻨﺎ ﺃﻭﻟﺌﻚ ﺍﻟﺬﻳﻦ ﻋﻠﻤﻮﺍ ﺑﺎﻟﻮﻋﺪ ﻗﺒﻞ ﺣﺼﻮﻟﻪ‪.‬‬ ‫‪٦٨‬‬ ‫ﺭّﺑﻨﺎ ﺇ ﹾﻥ ﻛﺎ ﹶﻥ ﻭ ْﻋ ُﺪ َﺭّﺑﻨﺎ ﹶﻟﻤﻔﻌﻮﻻ"‪ .‬ﻭﺍﻟﻼﻓﺖ ﻟﻼﻧﺘﺒﺎﻩ ﺃ ﹼﻥ ﺳﻮﺭﺓ ﺍﻹﺳﺮﺍﺀ ُﺗﺨـﺘﻢ‬ ‫ﱪﻩُ َﺗﻜﹾﺒﲑﺍ"‪ .‬ﻭﺗُﺸﲑ ﺧﻮﺍﺗﻴﻢ ﺍﻟﺴﻮﺭﺓ ﺇﱃ ﻧﺼـ ٍﺮ ﳎﻠﺠـﻞ‪،‬‬ ‫ﺑﻘﻮﻟﻪ ﺗﻌﺎﱃ‪َ " :‬ﻭ ﹶﻛ ﱢ‬ ‫ﻭﺗﻔﺎﻋﻞ ﺷﺪﻳﺪ ﻋﻨﺪ ﲢﻘﹼﻖ ﺍﻟﻮﻋﺪ‪ ،‬ﻭﻳﺒﺪﻭ ﺃﻧّﻪ ﺳﻴﻜﻮﻥ ﻧﻘﻄﺔ ﲢـﻮّﻝ ﻫﺎﻣّـﺔ ﰲ‬ ‫ﷲ‬ ‫ﺗﺎﺭﻳﺦ ﺍﻟﺒﺸﺮﻳّﺔ‪ .‬ﻭﻗﺪ ﺟﺎﺀ ﰲ ﺍﳊﺪﻳﺚ ﺍﻟﺸﺮﻳﻒ‪ " :‬ﺁﻳﺔ ﺍﻟﻌﺰ‪َ :‬ﻭﻗﹸﻞ ﺍﳊﻤـ ُﺪ ِ‬ ‫ﺍﻟﺬﻱ ﱂ ﻳَﺘﺨِﺬ ﻭَﻟﹶﺪَﺍﹰ‪َ ،‬ﻭﻟﹶﻢ َﻳ ﹸﻜ ْﻦ ﹶﻟﻪُ ﺷَﺮﻳﻚٌ ﰲ ﺍﳌﹸﻠﻚ‪َ ،‬ﻭﻟﹶﻢ ﻳَﻜﹸﻦ ﹶﻟﻪُ ﻭَﱄﹲ ﻣِـ َﻦ‬ ‫ﺍﻟﺬﹼﻝ ﻭَﻛﹶﺒّﺮﻩُ َﺗﻜﹾﺒﲑﺍ "‪.‬‬ ‫ﺍﳌﺘﺪﺑّﺮ ﻟﺴﻮﺭﺓ ﺍﻹﺳﺮﺍﺀ‪ ،‬ﻭﻋﻠﻰ ﻭﺟﻪ ﺍﳋﺼﻮﺹ ﺧﻮﺍﺗﻴﻤﻬﺎ‪ ،‬ﻳﺪﺭﻙ ﺃﻧّﻬﺎ‬ ‫ﺗﺘﺤﺪﺙ ﺣﻮﻝ ﺍﻧﺘﺼﺎﺭ ﺻﺮﺍﻁ ﺍﻟﺬﻳﻦ ﺃﻧﻌﻢ ﺍﷲ ﻋﻠﻴﻬﻢ‪ ،‬ﰲ ﻣﻮﺍﺟﻬـﺔ ﻣﻨـﺎﻫﺞ‬ ‫ﻀﺎﻟﲔ‪ ،‬ﻭﻳﺒﺪﻭ ﺃﻧّﻪ ﺍﻧﺘﺼﺎﺭ ﻳﺆ ّﺩﻱ ﺇﱃ ﲢ ّﻮﻻﺕ ﻋﺎﳌﻴﺔ ﺗﺘﻼﺀﻡ‬ ‫ﺍﳌﻐﻀﻮﺏ ﻋﻠﻴﻬﻢ ﻭﺍﻟ ّ‬ ‫ﻣﻊ ﻣﻜﺎﻧﺔ " ﺍﻷﺭﺽ ﺍﻟﱵ ﺑﺎﺭﻛﻨﺎ ﻓﻴﻬﺎ ﻟﻠﻌﺎﳌﲔ "‪ ،٦٤‬ﻭﻫﺬﺍ ﺍﻹﺩﺭﺍﻙ ﺩﻓﻌﻨـﺎ ﺇﱃ‬ ‫ﺇﺣﺼﺎﺀ ﺍﻵﻳﺎﺕ ﻣﻦ ﻬﻧﺎﻳﺔ ﺍﻟﻔﺎﲢﺔ‪ ،‬ﺣﻴﺚ ﺍﻟﻜﻼﻡ ﻋﻦ‪ " :‬ﺻﺮﺍﻁ ﺍﻟﺬﻳﻦ ﺃﻧﻌﻤﺖ‬ ‫ﻋﻠﻴﻬﻢ‪ ،‬ﻏﲑ ﺍﳌﻐﻀﻮﺏ ﻋﻠﻴﻬﻢ‪ ،‬ﻭﻻ ﺍﻟﻀﺎﻟﲔ "‪ ،‬ﺇﱃ ﺑﺪﺍﻳﺔ ﺳﻮﺭﺓ ﺍﻹﺳﺮﺍﺀ‪ ،‬ﺍﻟﱵ‬ ‫ﺼﺮﺍﻁ ﺍﳊﻖ‪ ،‬ﻓﻜﺎﻥ ﻋﺪﺩ ﺍﻵﻳﺎﺕ ﻣﻦ ﺑﺪﺍﻳﺔ ﺳﻮﺭﺓ ﺍﻟﺒﻘﺮﺓ‪،‬‬ ‫ﻣﻮﺿﻮﻋﻬﺎ ﺍﻧﺘﺼﺎﺭ ﺍﻟ ّ‬ ‫ﺇﱃ ﻬﻧﺎﻳﺔ ﺳﻮﺭﺓ ﺍﻟﻨﺤﻞ‪ ،‬ﺃﻱ ﺑﺪﺍﻳﺔ ﺳﻮﺭﺓ ﺍﻹﺳﺮﺍﺀ‪ ،‬ﻫﻮ ‪ ٢٠٢٢‬ﺁﻳﺔ‪ .‬ﻓﺘﺄ ّﻣﻞ!!‬ ‫ﺟﺎﺀ ﰲ ﺳﻮﺭﺓ ﺍﳌﺎﺋﺪﺓ‪ ،‬ﺍﻵﻳﺔ )‪ (٢١‬ﻋﻠﻰ ﻟﺴﺎﻥ ﻣﻮﺳﻰ ﻋﻠﻴﻪ ﺍﻟﺴـﻼﻡ‬ ‫ﷲ ﻟﻜـﻢ‪ ،‬ﻭﻻ‬ ‫ﺐﺍُ‬ ‫ﺽ ﺍﳌﻘﺪّﺳ ﹶﺔ ﺍﻟﱵ ﻛﺘ َ‬ ‫ﳜﺎﻃﺐ ﻗﻮﻣﻪ ‪ " :‬ﻳﺎ ﻗﻮ ِﻡ ﺍﺩﺧﻠﻮﺍ ﺍﻷﺭ َ‬ ‫ﺗﺮﺗﺪﱡﻭﺍ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺃﺩﺑﺎﺭﻛﹸﻢ ﻓﺘﻨﻘﻠﺒﻮﺍ ﺧﺎﺳﺮﻳﻦ"‬ ‫ﰲ ﻫﺬﻩ ﺍﻵﻳﺔ ﻳﻄﻠﺐ ﻣﻮﺳﻰ ﻋﻠﻴﻪ ﺍﻟﺴﻼﻡ ﻣﻦ ﻗﻮﻣﻪ ﺃﻥ ﻳﺪﺧﻠﻮﺍ ﻓﻠﺴﻄﲔ‬ ‫‪ ٦٤‬ﺍﻷﻧﺒﻴﺎﺀ‪.٧١ :‬‬ ‫‪٦٩‬‬ ‫ﺍﻷﺭﺽ ﺍﳌﻘﺪﺳﺔ‪ ،‬ﺍﻟﱵ ﺃﺧﱪ ﺍﻟﻮﺣﻲ ﺃﻬﻧﻢ ﺳﻴﺪﺧﻠﻮﻬﻧﺎ‪ .‬ﻭﻣﻌﻠـﻮﻡ ﺃﻬﻧـﻢ ﺟﺒﻨـﻮﺍ‬ ‫ﺤﺮّﻣﺖ ﻋﻠﻴﻬﻢ ﺃﺭﺑﻌﲔ ﺳﻨﺔ‪ ،‬ﻳﺘﻴﻬﻮﻥ ﰲ ﺍﻷﺭﺽ‪ .‬ﻭﻛﺎﻥ ﺩﺧـﻮﳍﻢ‬ ‫ﻭﺗﻘﺎﻋﺴﻮﺍ ﹶﻓ ُ‬ ‫ﺍﻷﺭﺽ ﺍﳌﻘﺪّﺳﺔ ﺑﻌﺪ ﺫﻟﻚ ﻣﻘ ﱢﺪﻣﺔ ‪ -‬ﺑﻐﺾ ﺍﻟﻨﻈﺮ ﻋﻦ ﻃﻮﻝ ﺍﻟﺰﻣﻦ‪ -‬ﳊﺼـﻮﻝ‬ ‫ﻭﻋﺪ ﺍﻟﻔﺴﺎﺩ ﺍﻷﻭﻝ‪ ،‬ﺍﻟﺬﻱ ﻭﻗﻊ ﻗﺒﻞ ﺍﻹﺳﻼﻡ‪ .‬ﻭﺍﳌﺘﺪﺑّﺮ ﻟﻶﻳﺔ ‪ ١٠٤‬ﻣﻦ ﺳﻮﺭﺓ‬ ‫ﺍﻹﺳﺮﺍﺀ ﳚﺪ ﺃﻧّﻬﺎ ﺗﺘﺤﺪﺙ ﻋﻦ ﺑﺪﺍﻳﺔ ﺍﻟﻮﺟﻮﺩ ﺍﻹﺳﺮﺍﺋﻴﻠﻲ ﺍﻟﻴﻬـﻮﺩﻱ ﰲ ﺍﻷﺭﺽ‬ ‫ﺍﳌﻘﺪﺳﺔ‪ ،‬ﻭﻋﻦ ﻬﻧﺎﻳﺘﻪ ﺃﻳﻀﺎﹰ‪ ،‬ﺃﻱ ﺃﻬﻧﺎ ﺗﻠﺨّﺺ ﺍﻟﻨﺒﻮﺀﺓ ﺍﻟﻮﺍﺭﺩﺓ ﰲ ﺍﻟﺘﻮﺭﺍﺓ ﺣـﻮﻝ‬ ‫ﺽ ﹶﻓِﺈﺫﹶﺍ ﺟَﺎ َﺀ َﻭ ْﻋﺪُ‬ ‫ﺍﻹﻓﺴﺎﺩﻳﻦ ‪َ " :‬ﻭ ﹸﻗ ﹾﻠﻨَﺎ ِﻣ ْﻦ َﺑ ْﻌ ِﺪ ِﻩ ِﻟَﺒﻨِﻲ ِﺇﺳْﺮﺍﺋﻴ ﹶﻞ ﺍ ْﺳ ﹸﻜﻨُﻮﺍ ﺍﻷ ْﺭ َ‬ ‫ﺍﻵ ِﺧ َﺮ ِﺓ ِﺟ ﹾﺌﻨَﺎ ِﺑ ﹸﻜ ْﻢ ﹶﻟ ِﻔﻴﻔﹰﺎ "‪.‬‬ ‫ﺍﻹﺳﺮﺍﺀ ‪١٠٤‬‬ ‫ﺍﻟﻼﻓﺖ ﻟﻼﻧﺘﺒﺎﻩ ﺃ ﹼﻥ ﻋﺪﺩ ﺍﻵﻳﺎﺕ ﻣﻦ ﺍﻵﻳﺔ ‪ ٢١‬ﻣﻦ ﺳﻮﺭﺓ ﺍﳌﺎﺋـﺪﺓ‪ ،‬ﺇﱃ‬ ‫ﺍﻵﻳﺔ ‪ ١٠٤‬ﻣﻦ ﺳﻮﺭﺓ ﺍﻹﺳﺮﺍﺀ ﻫﻮ ‪ ١٤٤٣‬ﺁﻳﺔ‪ .‬ﻭﺳﺒﻖ ﺃﻥ ﻟﻔﺘﻨﺎ ﺍﻻﻧﺘﺒﺎﻩ ﺇﱃ ﺃ ﹼﻥ‬ ‫ﻋﺪﺩ ﺍﻟﻜﻠﻤﺎﺕ ﻣﻦ ﺑﺪﺍﻳﺔ ﺍﻟﻜﻼﻡ ﻋﻦ ﻧﺒﻮﺀﺓ ﺍﻹﻓﺴﺎﺩ ﺃﻭﻝ ﺳﻮﺭﺓ ﺍﻹﺳـﺮﺍﺀ ﺇﱃ‬ ‫ﻗﻮﻟﻪ ﺗﻌﺎﱃ " ﻟﻔﻴﻔﺎ" ﻫﻮ ﺃﻳﻀﹰﺎ ‪ ١٤٤٣‬ﻛﻠﻤﺔ‪ ،‬ﻭﻫﺬﺍ ﺍﻟﻌﺪﺩ ﻳﻮﺍﻓﻖ ﺍﻟﻌﺎﻡ ‪١٤٤٣‬‬ ‫ﻫـ‪٢٠٢٢ /‬ﻡ‪.‬‬ ‫ﺳﻮﺭﺓ ﺍﻹﺳﺮﺍﺀ ﻫﻲ ﺍﻟﺴﻮﺭﺓ ‪ ١٧‬ﰲ ﺗﺮﺗﻴﺐ ﺍﳌﺼﺤﻒ‪ ،‬ﻭﻭﺍﺿﺢ ﺃﻧّﻬﺎ‬ ‫ﺍﻟﺴّﻮﺭﺓ ﺍﻟﱵ ﺗﺘﺤﺪﺙ ﻋﻦ ﺯﻭﺍﻝ ﺍﻹﻓﺴﺎﺩ ﺍﻟﻴﻬﻮﺩﻱ ﰲ ﺍﻷﺭﺽ ﺍﳌﻘﺪﺳﺔ‪ .‬ﻭﺍﻟﻼﻓﺖ‬ ‫ﻟﻼﻧﺘﺒﺎﻩ ﺃ ﹼﻥ ﺍﻟﺴﻮﺭﺓ ‪ ،١٨‬ﻭﻫﻲ ﺳﻮﺭﺓ ﺍﻟﻜﻬﻒ‪ ،‬ﺗﺮﺩ ﻓﻴﻬﺎ ﻗﺼﺔ ﻣﻮﺳﻰ ﻋﻠﻴـﻪ‬ ‫ﺴﻼﻡ ﻣﻊ ﺍﳋﻀﺮ‪ ،‬ﻭﻻ ﺫﻛﺮ ﻓﻴﻬﺎ ﻟﻠﻴﻬﻮﺩﻳّﺔ‪ ،‬ﻭﻻ ﻟﺒﲏ ﺇﺳﺮﺍﺋﻴﻞ‪ ،‬ﻭﻷﻭﻝ ﻣﺮّﺓ ﳒﺪ‬ ‫ﺍﻟ ّ‬ ‫ﺭﺳﻮ ﹰﻻ ﻳﻜﻮﻥ ﺗﺎﺑﻌﹰﺎ‪ .‬ﻭﻗﺪ ﻳﺸﲑ ﻫﺬﺍ ﺇﱃ ﺗﺬﻛﲑ ﺍﻟﻴﻬﻮﺩ‪ ،‬ﻭﺑﻌﺪ ﺯﻭﺍﻝ ﺩﻭﻟﺘـﻬﻢ‬ ‫ﻭﺯﻭﺍﻝ ﺇﻓﺴﺎﺩﻫﻢ ﻣﻦ ﺍﻷﺭﺽ ﺍﳌﻘﺪّﺳﺔ‪ ،‬ﺃ ﹾﻥ ﺗﻮﺍﺿﻌﻮﺍ ﻛﻤﺎ ﺗﻮﺍﺿﻊ ﻣﻮﺳﻰ ﻋﻠﻴـﻪ‬ ‫ﺍﻟﺴﻼﻡ‪ ،‬ﻭﺧﺬﻭﺍ ﺍﳊﻖ ﳑﻦ ﳝﻠﻜﻪ‪ ،‬ﻭﻣﺎ ﻳﻀﺮ ﺍﻹﻧﺴﺎﻥ ﺃﻥ ﻳﻜﻮﻥ ﺗﺎﺑﻌﹰﺎ ﻟﻠﺤـﻖ‪،‬‬ ‫‪٧٠‬‬ ‫ﻭﳌﻦ ﺍﺻﻄﻔﺎﻩ ﺍﷲ ﺑﻌﻠﻤﻪ ﻭﻭﺣﻴﻪ؟! ﻭﻫﺬﺍ ﻭﺟﻪ ﻟﻄﻴﻒ ﻣﻦ ﻭﺟﻮﻩ ﺍﻟﺘﻨﺎﺳﺐ ﺑـﲔ‬ ‫ﺳﻮﺭﺓ ﺍﻹﺳﺮﺍﺀ ﻭﺳﻮﺭﺓ ﺍﻟﻜﻬﻒ‪.‬‬ ‫ﻋﺪﺩ ﺁﻳﺎﺕ ﺳﻮﺭﺓ ﺍﻹﺳﺮﺍﺀ‪ ،‬ﻭﺍﻟﱵ ﺗﺴﻤﻰ ﺃﻳﻀﹰﺎ ﺳﻮﺭﺓ ﺑﲏ ﺇﺳﺮﺍﺋﻴﻞ‪ ،‬ﻫﻮ‬ ‫‪ ١١١‬ﺁﻳﺔ‪ .‬ﻭﻳُﻼﺣﻆ ﺃ ﹼﻥ ﺳﻮﺭﺓ ﻳﻮﺳﻒ ﻫﻲ ﺃﻳﻀﹰﺎ ‪ ١١١‬ﺁﻳﺔ‪ .‬ﻭﻻ ﻳﻮﺟﺪ ﻏﲑﳘﺎ‬ ‫ﻣﻦ ﺍﻟﺴّﻮﺭ ﺍﻟﻘﺮﺁﻧﻴّﺔ ﻣﺎ ﻟﻪ ﺍﻟﻌﺪﺩ ﻧﻔﺴﻪ ﻣﻦ ﺍﻵﻳﺎﺕ‪ .‬ﻭﺍﳌﻼﺣﻆ ﻫﻨـﺎ ﺃ ﹼﻥ ﺳـﻮﺭﺓ‬ ‫ﻳﻮﺳﻒ ﺗﺘﺤﺪﺙ ﻋﻦ ﻧﺸﺄﺓ ﻣﺴﺄﻟﺔ ﺑﲏ ﺇﺳﺮﺍﺋﻴﻞ‪ ،‬ﻭﻋﻦ ﺧﺮﻭﺟﻬﻢ ﻣـﻦ ﺍﻷﺭﺽ‬ ‫ﺍﳌﻘﺪّﺳﺔ ﺇﱃ ﻣﺼﺮ‪ ،‬ﻭﺃ ﹼﻥ ﺳﻮﺭﺓ ﺍﻹﺳﺮﺍﺀ ﺗﺘﺤﺪﺙ ﻋﻦ ﺍﻹﻓﺴﺎﺩ ﺍﻟﺜﺎﱐ ﻭﺍﻷﺧـﲑ‬ ‫ﻟﺒﲏ ﺇﺳﺮﺍﺋﻴﻞ ﰲ ﺍﻷﺭﺽ ﺍﳌﻘﺪّﺳﺔ‪ ،‬ﻭﺑﺎﻟﺘﺎﱄ ﺧﺮﻭﺟﻬﻢ ﻣﻨﻬﺎ ﺍﳋﺮﻭﺝ ﺍﻷﺧـﲑ‪،‬‬ ‫ﺍﻟﺬﻱ ﻟﻦ ﻳﻜﻮﻥ ﺑﻌﺪﻩ ﻟﺒﲏ ﺇﺳﺮﺍﺋﻴﻞ ﻭﺟﻮﺩ ﳎﺘﻤﻌﻲ ﰲ ﺍﻷﺭﺽ ﺍﳌﻘﺪّﺳﺔ‪.‬‬ ‫‪٧١‬‬ ‫ﻋﻼﻣﺎﺕ ﻓﻠﻜﻴّﺔ‬ ‫‪ ١‬ﳏﺮﻡ ‪١٤٤٣‬ﻫـ ﻳُﻮﺍﻓﻖ ‪ ٨‬ﺃﻭ ‪ ٩‬ﺁﺏ ‪٢٠٢١‬ﻡ‪ ،‬ﻭﺍﻟﻼﻓﺖ ﻫﻨـﺎ ﺃ ﹼﻥ‬ ‫ﻫﺬﺍ ﻫﻮ ﺗﺎﺭﻳﺦ ﺗﺪﻣﲑ ﺍﳍﻴﻜﻞ ﺍﻷ ّﻭﻝ‪ ،‬ﻭﺍﳍﻴﻜﻞ ﺍﻟﺜﺎﱐ‪ .‬ﻭﻣﻦ ﻫﺬﺍ ﺍﻟﺘﺎﺭﻳﺦ ﺣـﱴ‬ ‫‪٢٠٢٢/٣/٥‬ﻡ‪ ،‬ﻭﺍﻟﺬﻱ ﻫﻮ ﺗﺎﺭﻳﺦ ﺍﻛﺘﻤﺎﻝ ﺍﻟـ‪ ٧٦‬ﺳﻨﺔ‪ ،‬ﻭﺍﻟﱵ ﻫﻲ ﻋُﻤﺮ ﺩﻭﻟﺔ‬ ‫ﺇﺳﺮﺍﺋﻞ ﺍﳌﺘﻮﻗﹼﻊ‪ ،‬ﻫﻨﺎﻙ )‪ (٢٠٩‬ﻣﻦ ﺍﻷﻳﺎﻡ‪ ،‬ﻭﻫﺬﺍ ﻫﻮ ﺃﻳﻀﹰﺎ ﻋﺪﺩ ﺍﻷﻳّـﺎﻡ ﻣـﻦ‬ ‫‪٢٠٢٢/١/١‬ﻡ‪ ،‬ﺇﱃ ﻬﻧﺎﻳﺔ ﺍﻟﻌﺎﻡ ‪ ١٤٤٣‬ﻫـ‪ ،‬ﻭﺍﻟﺬﻱ ﻳﺘﻮﻗﹼﻊ ﺃﻥ ﻳﻜﻮﻥ ﺑﺘـﺎﺭﻳﺦ‬ ‫‪٢٨‬ﺃﻭ‪٢٠٢٢/٧/٢٩‬ﻡ‪٦٥.‬ﻭﻫﺬﺍ ﻳﻌﲏ ﺃ ﹼﻥ ﺃﻭّﻝ ‪ ٢٠٩‬ﺃﻳّﺎﻡ ﻣﻦ ﺍﻟﺴﻨﺔ ﺍﳍﺠﺮﻳّﺔ ﻫﻲ‬ ‫ﺁﺧﺮ ‪ ٢٠٩‬ﺃﻳّﺎﻡ ﰲ ﻋُﻤﺮ ﺇﺳﺮﺍﺋﻴﻞ ﺍﳌﺘﻮﻗﹼﻊ‪ .‬ﻭﺃ ﹼﻥ ﺁﺧﺮ ‪ ٢٠٩‬ﺃﻳّﺎﻡ ﻣـﻦ ﺍﻟﺴـﻨﺔ‬ ‫ﺍﳍﺠﺮﻳّﺔ ﻫﻲ ﺃﻭّﻝ ‪ ٢٠٩‬ﺃﻳّﺎﻡ ﻣﻦ ﺍﻟﻌﺎﻡ ‪٢٠٢٢‬ﻡ‪ .‬ﻭﻳﺒﺪﺃ ﺍﻟﻌﺎﻡ ‪١٤٤٣‬ﻫـ ﻳـﻮﻡ‬ ‫ﺍﻻﺛﻨﲔ‪ ،‬ﻭﻳﻨﺘﻬﻲ ﻳﻮﻡ ﺍﳋﻤﻴﺲ‪ .‬ﺃﻣﺎ ﺍﻟﻌﺎﻡ ‪٢٠٢٢‬ﻡ ﻓﺎﻟﻼﻓﺖ ﺃﻧّﻪ ﻳﺒﺪﺃ ﻳﻮﻡ ﺳﺒﺖ‬ ‫ﻭﻳﻨﺘﻬﻲ ﻳﻮﻡ ﺳﺒﺖ ﺃﻳﻀﹰﺎ‪.‬‬ ‫ﻳﻘﻮﻝ ﺍﻷﺳﺘﺎﺫ ﺍﻟﺮﺍﺷﺪ‪ ،‬ﺑﻌﺪ ﺃﻥ ﺫﻛﺮ ﻗﻮﻝ ﺍﻟﻌﺠﻮﺯ ﺍﻟﻴﻬﻮﺩﻳّﺔ ﺑﺄ ﹼﻥ ﺇﺳﺮﺍﺋﻴﻞ‬ ‫ﺗﻌﻴﺶ ‪ ٧٦‬ﺳﻨﺔ‪ :‬ﺇّﻧﻪ ﻳﺘﻮﹼﻗﻊ ﺃ ﹼﻥ ﺍﻷﻣﺮ ﻳﺘﻌﻠﻖ ﲟُﺬّﻧﺐ َﻫﺎﱄ‪ ،‬ﻷ ﹼﻥ ﻣـﺬّﻧﺐ ﻫـﺎﱄ‬ ‫‪ ٦٥‬ﺍﻟﻌﺪﺩ ‪ ٢٠٩‬ﻫﻮ )‪.(١١×١٩‬‬ ‫‪٧٢‬‬ ‫ﻣﺮﺗﺒﻂ ﺑﻌﻘﺎﺋﺪ ﺍﻟﻴﻬﻮﺩ‪ .‬ﻭﻋﻠﻰ ﺍﻟﺮّﻏﻢ ﻣﻦ ﺃﻧّﻨﺎ ﻻ ﻧﻌﻠﻢ ﺣﻘﻴﻘﺔ ﻫﺬﺍ ﺍﻻﺭﺗﺒﺎﻁ‪ ،‬ﻓﻘﺪ‬ ‫ﺑﺎﺩﺭﻧﺎ ﺇﱃ ﺩﺭﺍﺳﺔ ﻣﺬّﻧﺐ َﻫﺎﱄ‪ ،‬ﻓﻮﺟﺪﻧﺎﻩ ﻳُﻜﻤﻞ ﺩﻭﺭﺗﻪ ﰲ ﻛﻞ ‪ ٧٦‬ﺳﻨﺔ ﴰﺴﻴﺔ‬ ‫ﻣﺮّﺓ‪ ،‬ﻭﺃﺣﻴﺎﻧﹰﺎ ﰲ ‪ ٧٥‬ﺳﻨﺔ‪ .‬ﻭﻭﺟﺪﻧﺎ ﻋﻠﻤﺎﺀ ﺍﻟﻔﻠﻚ ﻳﻌﺘﱪﻭﻥ ﺃ ﹼﻥ ﺑﺪﺍﻳﺔ ﺍﻟـ ّﺪﻭﺭﺓ‬ ‫ﻟﻠﻤﺬﻧﺐ ﻫﺎﱄ ﻋﻨﺪﻣﺎ ﻳﻜﻮﻥ ﰲ ﺃﺑﻌﺪ ﻧﻘﻄﺔ ﻟﻪ ﻋﻦ ﺍﻟﺸﻤﺲ‪ ،‬ﻭﺗﺴـﻤّﻰ ﻧﻘﻄـﺔ‬ ‫ﺍﻷﻭﺝ‪ .‬ﻭﻳﺮﻯ ﺃﻫﻞ ﺍﻷﺭﺽ ﺍ ﹸﳌ ﹶﺬّﻧﺐ ﻋﻨﺪﻣﺎ ﻳﻜﻮﻥ ﰲ ﺃﻗﺮﺏ ﻧﻘﻄـﺔ ﻟـﻪ ﻣـﻦ‬ ‫ﺍﻟﺸﻤﺲ‪ ،‬ﻭﺗﺴﻤّﻰ ﻧﻘﻄﺔ ﺍﳊﻀﻴﺾ‪.‬‬ ‫ﻭﺍﻟﻼﻓﺖ ﻫﻨﺎ ﺃ ﹼﻥ ﻫﺎﱄ ﺑﺪﺃ ﺩﻭﺭﺗﻪ ﺍﻷﺧﲑﺓ ﻋﺎﻡ ‪١٩٤٨‬ﻡ‪ ،‬ﻭﳒﺪ ﺫﻟﻚ‬ ‫ﰲ ﻛﺘﺐ ﺍﻟﻔﻠﻚ‪ .‬ﻭﻗﺪ ﲝﺜﻨﺎ ﰲ ﻣﺮﺍﺟﻊ ﻓﻠﻜﻴّﺔ ﻛﺜﲑﺓ ﻟﻨﻌﺮﻑ ﻣﱴ ﻳﺮﺟﻊ ﻫﺎﱄ ﺇﱃ‬ ‫ﻧﻘﻄﺔ ﺍﻷﻭﺝ‪ ،‬ﻟﻴﻜﻤﻞ ﺩﻭﺭﺗﻪ ﺍﻷﺧﲑﺓ‪ ،‬ﻓﻠﻢ ﳒﺪ ﻣﻦ ﻳﺘﻌ ّﺮﺽ ﻟﺬﻟﻚ‪ .‬ﻭﻟﻜﻦ ﳝﻜﻨﻨﺎ‬ ‫ﺃ ﹾﻥ ﻧﻘ ّﺪﺭ ﺫﻟﻚ؛ ﻓﺈﺫﺍ ﻛﺎﻧﺖ ﺩﻭﺭﺗﻪ ‪ ٧٦‬ﺳﻨﺔ‪ ،‬ﻓﺴﻴﻜﻮﻥ ﰲ ﻧﻘﻄﺔ ﺍﻷﻭﺝ ﻋـﺎﻡ‬ ‫‪٢٠٢٤‬ﻡ‪ .‬ﻭﺇﺫﺍ ﻛﺎﻧﺖ ﺩﻭﺭﺗﻪ ‪ ٧٥‬ﺳﻨﺔ‪ ،‬ﻓﺴﻴﻜﻮﻥ ﰲ ﺍﻷﻭﺝ ﻋـﺎﻡ ‪٢٠٢٣‬ﻡ‪.‬‬ ‫ﻭﻛﺎﻥ ﺃ ﹾﻥ ﻭﻗﻌﻨﺎ ﻋﻠﻰ ﻛﺘﺎﺏ ُﻳﻘﺪّﻡ ﺗﻄﺒﻴﻘﺎﺕ ﻋﻤﻠﻴّﺔ ﻻﺳﺘﺨﺪﺍﻡ ﺍﻟﻜﻤﺒﻴـﻮﺗﺮ ﰲ‬ ‫ﻋﻠﻢ ﺍﻟﻔﻠﻚ‪ ،‬ﺍﲰﻪ‪) :‬ﻣﻴﻜﺮﻭﻛﻤﺒﻴﻮﺗﺮ ﻭﻋﻠﻢ ﺍﻟﻔﻠﻚ(‪ ،‬ﻭﺟﺪﻧﺎ ﻓﻴﻪ ﺃﻧّﻪ ﺑﻌﺪ ﺗﺰﻭﻳﺪ‬ ‫ﺍﻟﻜﻤﺒﻴﻮﺗﺮ ﺑﺎﳌﻌﻠﻮﻣﺎﺕ ﺍﻟﻼﺯﻣﺔ ﻛﺎﻧﺖ ﺍﳌﻔﺎﺟﺄﺓ ﺃ ﹼﻥ ﻫﺎﱄ ﺳﻴﻌﻮﺩ ﺇﱃ ﺍﻷﻭﺝ ﻋﺎﻡ‬ ‫‪٢٠٢٢‬ﻡ‪ .‬ﻭﺑﺬﻟﻚ ﻳﻜﻮﻥ ﻫﻨﺎﻙ ﺗﻄﺎﺑﻖ ﺑﲔ ﺍﻟﻨﺒﻮﺀﺓ ﻭﺩﻭﺭﺓ ﺍﳌﺬﻧﺐ ﻫـﺎﱄ‪ ،‬ﻭﻻ‬ ‫ﻳﻌﲏ ﺫﻟﻚ ﻣﺎ ﻗﺪ ﻳﺘﻮﻫّﻤ ُﻪ ﺍﻟﺒﻌﺾ ﻣﻦ ﺍﺣﺘﻤﺎﻝ ﺛﺄﺛﲑ ﺍﻷﻓﻼﻙ ﰲ ﺣﻴﺎﺓ ﺍﻟﺒﺸﺮ‪ ،‬ﺑﻞ‬ ‫ﻻ ﻳﺰﻳﺪ ﺍﻷﻣﺮ ﻋﻦ ﻛﻮﻧﻪ ﻋﻼﻣﺔ ﻭﺭﺩﺕ ﰲ ﻧﺒﻮﺀﺓ‪ ،‬ﻓﻼ ﻓﺮﻕ ﺑـﲔ ﺃﻥ ﻧﻘـﻮﻝ‪":‬‬ ‫ﻋﻨﺪﻣﺎ ﺗﺰﻭﻝ ﺇﺳﺮﺍﺋﻴﻞ ﻳﻜﻮﻥ ﺍﻟﻌﺎﻡ ‪٢٠٢٢‬ﻡ " ﺃﻭ ﻧﻘﻮﻝ‪ ":‬ﻋﻨﺪﻣﺎ ﺗﺰﻭﻝ ﺇﺳﺮﺍﺋﻴﻞ‬ ‫ﻳﻜﻮﻥ ﺍﳌﺬﻧّﺐ ﰲ ﺃﺑﻌﺪ ﻧﻘﻄﺔ ﻟﻪ ﻋﻦ ﺍﻟﺸﻤﺲ "‪ .‬ﺃﻭ ﻧﻘـﻮﻝ‪ ":‬ﻋﻨـﺪﻣﺎ ﺗﻘـﻮﻡ‬ ‫ﺇﺳﺮﺍﺋﻴﻞ ﺗﺪﻭﻡ ﲟﻘﺪﺍﺭ ﺩﻭﺭﺓ ﻛﺎﻣﻠﺔ ﻟﻠﻤﺬﻧّﺐ "‪.‬‬ ‫‪٧٣‬‬ ‫ﺭﺃﻯ ﺍﻟﻨﺎﺱ ﻣﺬﻧﺐ ﻫﺎﱄ ﺑﺘﺎﺭﻳﺦ ‪١٩٨٦/٢/١٠‬ﻡ‪ ،‬ﺃﻱ ﻋﻨﺪﻣﺎ ﻛﺎﻥ ﰲ‬ ‫ﺍﳊﻀﻴﺾ‪ ،‬ﻭﻛﺎﻥ ﻗﺪ ﻗﻄﻊ ﻧﺼﻒ ﺍﻟﺪّﻭﺭﺓ ﰲ ﻣ ّﺪﺓ ﻣﻘﺪﺍﺭﻫﺎ ‪ ٣٨‬ﺳﻨﺔ ﴰﺴـّﻴﺔ‪،‬‬ ‫ﺃﻱ ) ‪ ،(٢×١٩‬ﻭﺇﺫﺍ ﺑﻘﻲ ﻳﺴﲑ ﺑﺎﻟﺴﺮﻋﺔ ﻧﻔﺴﻬﺎ ﻓﺴﻮﻑ ﻳﻜﻤﻞ ﺩﻭﺭﺗﻪ ﰲ ‪٧٦‬‬ ‫ﺳﻨﺔ‪ .‬ﻭﻟﻜﻦ ﻭﻓﻖ ﻣﻌﻄﻴﺎﺕ ﺍﻟﻜﻤﺒﻴﻮﺗﺮ ﺳﻴﻜﻤﻞ ﺁﺧﺮ ﺩﻭﺭﺓ ﻟـﻪ ﰲ ‪ ٧٥‬ﺳـﻨﺔ‬ ‫ﴰﺴّﻴﺔ؛ ﺇﺫ ﺑﺪﺃ ﺩﻭﺭﺗﻪ ﰲ ﺑﺪﺍﻳﺔ ﺍﻟﻌﺎﻡ ‪١٩٤٨‬ﻡ‪ ،‬ﻭﺳﻴﻜﻤﻠﻬﺎ ﰲ ﺃﻭﺍﺧـﺮ ﺍﻟﻌـﺎﻡ‬ ‫‪٢٠٢٢‬ﻡ‪ .‬ﻭﻳُﻼﺣَﻆ ﺃﻥ ﺍﳌﺪﺓ ﻣﻦ ‪١٩٨٦/٢/١٠‬ﻡ ﺇﱃ ﺃﻭﺍﺧﺮ ‪٢٠٢٢‬ﻡ ﻫـﻲ‬ ‫‪ ٣٨‬ﺳﻨﺔ ﻗﻤﺮﻳﺔ‪ ،‬ﺃﻱ) ‪ .(٢×١٩‬ﻭﺃ ﹼﻥ ﺍﳌﺪّﺓ ﻣﻦ ﺑﺪﺍﻳﺎﺕ ﻋـﺎﻡ ‪١٩٤٨‬ﻡ‪ ،‬ﺇﱃ‬ ‫‪١٩٨٦/٢/١٠‬ﻡ ﻫﻲ ‪ ٣٨‬ﺳﻨﺔ ﴰﺴﻴّﺔ‪ .‬ﻭﺑﺬﻟﻚ ﻳﻜﻮﻥ ﺍﺠﻤﻟﻤـﻮﻉ ‪ ٧٥‬ﺳـﻨﺔ‬ ‫ﴰﺴﻴﺔ‪ ،‬ﻭﻫﺬﺍ ﻳﻌﲏ ﺃ ﹼﻥ ﺳﺮﻋﺔ ﺍﳌﺬﻧّﺐ ﻗﺪ ﺍﺯﺩﺍﺩﺕ ﺑﻌﺪ ﻋـﺎﻡ ‪١٩٨٦‬ﻡ‪ .‬ﻓﻬـﻞ‬ ‫ﻟﺬﻟﻚ ﺩﻻﻟﺔ ﺗﺘﻌﻠﻖ ﺑﺎﻟﻨﺒﻮﺀﺓ؟!‬ ‫‪ ١٩٤٨‬ﻡ‬ ‫‪ ١٩٨٦- ٢-١٠‬ﻡ‬ ‫ﺳﺒﻖ ﺃﻥ ﺫﻛﺮﻧﺎ ﺃ ﹼﻥ ﺍﳊﺴﺎﺏ ﻗﺒﻞ ‪٦٢١‬ﻡ ﻫﻮ ﺑﺎﻟﺴﻨﺔ ﺍﻟﺸﻤﺴـﻴّﺔ‪ ،‬ﻭﺃ ﹼﻥ‬ ‫ﺍﳊﺴﺎﺏ ﺑﻌﺪﻫﺎ ﺑﺎﻟﺴﻨﺔ ﺍﻟﻘﻤﺮّﻳﺔ‪ .‬ﻭﲟﻌﲎ ﺁﺧﺮ‪ :‬ﻣﺎ ﻗﺒﻞ ﺍﳍﺠﺮﺓ ﺑﺎﻟﺸﻤﺴ ّﻲ‪ ،‬ﻭﻣـﺎ‬ ‫ﻱ ﺧﺎﺹ ﺑﺎﻹﺳﻼﻡ‪ .‬ﻓ ِﻤﻦ ﺃﻭﺝ ﺇﺳﺮﺍﺋﻴﻞ ﺇﱃ‬ ‫ﻱ‪ ،‬ﻭﻛﺄﻥ ﺍﻟﻘﻤﺮ ّ‬ ‫ﺑﻌﺪ ﺍﳍﺠﺮﺓ ﺑﺎﻟﻘﻤﺮ ّ‬ ‫ﺑﺪﺍﻳﺔ ﺣﻀﻴﻀﻬﺎ ‪ ٣٨‬ﺳﻨﺔ ﴰﺴّﻴﺔ‪ .‬ﻭﻣﻦ ﺑﺪﺍﻳﺔ ﺻﻌﻮﺩ ﺍﳌﺴﻠﻤﲔ ﻣﻦ ﺍﳊﻀﻴﺾ‬ ‫ﺇﱃ ﺃﻭﺟﻬﻢ ‪ ٣٨‬ﺳﻨﺔ ﻗﻤﺮّﻳﺔ‪ ،‬ﻭﺻﻌﻮﺩ ﺍﳌﺴﻠﻤﲔ ﻣﻦ ﺍﳊﻀﻴﺾ ﻳﻌـﲏ ﺑﺪﺍﻳـﺔ‬ ‫ﺣﻀﻴﺾ ﺇﺳﺮﺍﺋﻴﻞ‪ .‬ﻳُﻼﺣﻆ ﺃ ﹼﻥ ﻫﺎﱄ ﻳُﺴﺮﻉ ﰲ ﺣﺮﻛﺘﻪ ﺑﻌـﺪ ﻋـﺎﻡ ‪١٩٨٦‬ﻡ‪،‬‬ ‫‪٧٤‬‬ ‫‪٦٦‬‬ ‫ﻭﻳﻼﺣﻆ ﰲ ﺍﳌﻘﺎﺑﻞ ﺃ ﹼﻥ ﺍﳌﺘﻐﻴّﺮﺍﺕ ﰲ ﺍﻟﻌﺎﱂ ﺃﺳﺮﻉ ﻣﻦ ﻛﻞ ﺍﻟﺘﻮﻗﹼﻌﺎﺕ‪.‬‬ ‫ﺟﺎﺀ ﰲ ﺍﻵﻳﺔ ‪ ١٢‬ﻣﻦ ﺳﻮﺭﺓ ﺍﻹﺳﺮﺍﺀ‪ ،‬ﻭﺍﻟﱵ ﺗﺄﺗﻰ ﺗﻌﻘﻴﺒﺎﹰ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺍﻟﻨﺒﻮﺀﺓ‪:‬‬ ‫) َﻭ َﺟ َﻌ ﹾﻠﻨَﺎ ﺍﻟﻠﻴﻞﹶ ﻭَﺍﻟﻨﻬﺎ َﺭ َﺀﺍﹶﻳَﺘ ْﻴ ِﻦ ﻓﹶﻤَﺤَﻮْﻧَﺎ ﺀَﺍَﻳ ﹶﺔ ﺍﻟﻠﻴﻞِ َﻭ َﺟ َﻌ ﹾﻠﻨَـﺎ ﺀَﺍﻳَـ ﹶﺔ ﺍﻟﻨـﻬﺎ ِﺭ‬ ‫ﳊﺴَﺎﺏ َﻭﻛﹸﻞ َﺷ ٍﺊ‬ ‫ﻼ ِﻣ ْﻦ ﺭَﺑﻜﹸﻢ َﻭِﻟَﺘﻌْ ﹶﻠﻤُﻮﺍ َﻋ َﺪ َﺩ ﺍﻟﺴﻨﲔَ ﻭَﺍ ِ‬ ‫ﺼ َﺮ ﹰﺓ ِﻟَﺘﺒَْﺘﻐُﻮﺍ ﻓﻀ ﹰ‬ ‫ﻣُﺒْ ِ‬ ‫ﳊﺴَﺎﺏ‪( ..‬‬ ‫ﻼ(‪ .‬ﻻﺣﻆ ﻗﻮﻟﻪ ﺗﻌﺎﱃ‪َ ) :‬ﻭِﻟَﺘ ْﻌﻠﹶﻤﻮﺍ َﻋ َﺪ َﺩ ﺍﻟﺴﻨﲔَ ﻭَﺍ ِ‬ ‫ﺼﻠﻨَﺎ ُﻩ َﺗﻔﹾﺼﻴ ﹰ‬ ‫ﹶﻓ ّ‬ ‫ﻭﲝﺜﹸﻨﺎ ﻫﺬﺍ ﰲ ﻋﺪﺩ ﺍﻟﺴﻨﲔ ﻭﺍﳊﺴﺎﺏ‪ .‬ﻭﺍﻟﻼﻓﺖ ﻟﻠﻨﻈﺮ ﻫﻨﺎ ﺃ ﹼﻥ ﺗﺮﺗﻴﺐ ﻛﻠﻤـﺔ‬ ‫ﺴﻮﺭﺓ ﺗﻘﺎﺑـﻞ‬ ‫ﻭﺍﳊﺴﺎﺏ ﰲ ﺍﻵﻳﺔ ﻫﻮ ‪ ١٩‬ﻭﺳﺒﻖ ﺃﻥ ﻗﻠﻨﺎ ﺇ ﹼﻥ ﻛ ﹼﻞ ﻛﻠﻤﺔ ﰲ ﺍﻟ ّ‬ ‫ﺳﻨﺔ‪ .‬ﻭﲝﺜﹸﻨﺎ ﻫﺬﺍ ﻳﺘَﻌﺎﻣﻞ ﻣﻊ ﺍﻟﺴﻨﲔ ﻭﺍﳊﺴﺎﺏ ﻭﻓﻖ ﺍﻟﻌﺪﺩ ‪ .١٩‬ﻓﺘﺄﻣّﻞ!!‬ ‫‪ ٦٦‬ﻻ ﻋﻼﻗﺔ ﳌﺎ ﻧﻘﻮﻟﻪ ﲟﺰﺍﻋﻢ ﺍﻟﻘﺎﺋﻠﲔ ﺑﺘﺄﺛﲑ ﺍﻷﻓﻼﻙ‪ ،‬ﻭﻻ ﻳﺰﻳﺪ ﺍﻷﻣﺮ ﻋﻦ ﺍﺣﺘﻤﺎﻝ ﺃﻥ ﻳﻜﻮﻥ ﺇﺭﻫﺎﺻﺎ ﻣﻠﻤﻮﺳﺎ ﻳﺘﻌﻠﻖ ﺑﻐﻴﺐ‬ ‫ﻏﲑ ﳏﺴﻮﺱ‪.‬‬ ‫‪٧٥‬‬ ‫ﻓﻠﻤّﺎ ﻗﻀﻴﻨﺎ ﻋﻠﻴﻪ ﺍﳌﻮﺕ‬ ‫ﻫﻞ ﺍﺗّﻔﻖ ﺍﳌﺆﺭﺧﻮﻥ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺃ ﹼﻥ ﺗﺎﺭﻳﺦ ﻭﻓﺎﺓ ﺳﻠﻴﻤﺎﻥ ﻋﻠﻴﻪ ﺍﻟﺴّـﻼﻡ ﻫـﻮ‬ ‫‪٩٣٥‬ﻕ‪.‬ﻡ؟! ﺇﺫﺍ ﺃﺭﺍﺩ ﺍﻟﻘﺎﺭﺉ ﺇﺟﺎﺑﺔ ﺳﺮﻳﻌﺔ ﻓﺒﺈﻣﻜﺎﻧﻪ ﺃﻥ ﻳﺮﺟﻊ ﺇﱃ " ﺍﳌﻨﺠﺪ ﰲ‬ ‫ﺍﻟﻠﻐﺔ ﺍﻟﻌﺮﺑﻴﺔ ﻭﺍﻷﻋﻼﻡ"‪ ٦٧،‬ﰒ ﺇ ﹼﻥ ﺍﻟﻜﺜﲑ ﻣﻦ ﻛﺘﺐ ﺍﻟﺘﺎﺭﻳﺦ ﺗﺬﻛﺮ ﺃ ﹼﻥ ﻭﻓﺎﺗـﻪ‪،‬‬ ‫ﺴﻼﻡ‪ ،‬ﻛﺎﻧﺖ ﺳﻨﺔ ‪ ٩٣٥‬ﻕ‪.‬ﻡ‪ .‬ﰲ ﺍﳌﻘﺎﺑﻞ ﳒﺪ ﺃ ﹼﻥ ﻫﻨﺎﻙ ﻣﺮﺍﺟﻊ ﺃﺧﺮﻯ‬ ‫ﻋﻠﻴﻪ ﺍﻟ ّ‬ ‫ﺗﺬﻛﺮ ﺃ ﹼﻥ ﻭﻓﺎﺗﻪ‪ ،‬ﻋﻠﻴﻪ ﺍﻟﺴﻼﻡ‪ ،‬ﻛﺎﻧﺖ ﺳﻨﺔ ‪ ٩٣٠‬ﻕ‪.‬ﻡ‪ ،‬ﺃﻭ ‪ ٩٢٦‬ﻕ‪.‬ﻡ‪ .‬ﻭﺍﻟﻴﻮﻡ‬ ‫ﻻ ﻳﺴﻬﻞ ﺍﻟﺒﺖ ﺃﻭ ﺍﻟﺘﺮﺟﻴﺢ‪ ،‬ﺑﻞ ﻗﺪ ﻳﺴﺘﺤﻴﻞ‪ .‬ﻭﻧﻈﺮﹰﺍ ﻟﻠﻌﻼﻗـﺎﺕ ﺍﻟﺮّﻳﺎﺿـﻴّﺔ‬ ‫ﺍﻟﻼﻓﺘﺔ‪ ،‬ﻭﺍﻟﻨﺎﲡﺔ ﻋﻦ ﺍﻋﺘﺒﺎﺭ ﺳﻨﺔ ‪ ٩٣٥‬ﻕ‪.‬ﻡ ﻫﻲ ﺳﻨﺔ ﺍﻟﻮﻓﺎﺓ‪ ،‬ﻓﻘـﺪ ﺭﺃﻳﻨـﺎ ﺃﻥ‬ ‫ﻧﺮﺟﻊ ﺇﱃ ﺍﻟﻘﺮﺁﻥ ﺍﻟﻜﺮﱘ ﻟﻠﺘﺤﻘﻖ ﻣﻦ ﺫﻟﻚ‪ ،‬ﻭﱂ ﻳﻜﻦ ﺫﻟﻚ ﻣﺘﻴﺴّﺮﺍﹼ‪ ،‬ﺑﻞ ﱂ ﻳﻜﻦ‬ ‫ﻟﻴﺨﻄﺮ ﺑﺎﻟﺒﺎﻝ‪ ،‬ﻗﺒﻞ ﺃﻥ ﺗﻈﻬﺮ ﺇﺭﻫﺎﺻﺎﺕ ﺍﻹﻋﺠﺎﺯ ﺍﻟﻌﺪﺩﻱ ﰲ ﺍﻟﻘﺮﺁﻥ ﺍﻟﻜـﺮﱘ‪.‬‬ ‫ﻭﺇﻟﻴﻚ ﻋﺰﻳﺰﻱ ﺍﻟﻘﺎﺭﺉ ﺻﻮﺭﺓ ُﺟﺰﺋﻴّﺔ ﻋﻦ ﻣﺴﻠﻜﻨﺎ ﰲ ﺗﺮﺟﻴﺢ ﺍﻻﺣﺘﻤﺎﻻﺕ‪ ،‬ﺑﻌﺪ‬ ‫ﺍﻹﳌﺎﻡ ﺑﺎﻷﳕﺎﻁ ﺍﻟﻌﺪﺩﻳّﺔ ﰲ ﺍﻟﻘﺮﺁﻥ ﺍﻟﻜﺮﱘ‪:‬‬ ‫ﺴﻼﻡ ﺇﻻ ﰲ ﺍﻵﻳـﺔ‬ ‫ﱂ ﻳﺘﺤﺪﺙ ﺍﻟﻘﺮﺍﻥ ﺍﻟﻜﺮﱘ ﻋﻦ ﻭﻓﺎﺓ ﺳﻠﻴﻤﺎﻥ ﻋﻠﻴﻪ ﺍﻟ ّ‬ ‫‪ ٦٧‬ﻁ‪ -١٩٧٣ ،٧‬ﺍﳌﻄﺒﻌﺔ ﺍﻟﻜﺎﺛﻮﻟﻴﻜﻴﺔ‪-‬ﺑﲑﻭﺕ‪.‬‬ ‫‪٧٦‬‬ ‫ﺕ ﻣَﺎ َﺩﻟﹼﻬﻢ ﻋَﻠﻰ َﻣ ْﻮﺗِـ ِﻪ‪."..‬‬ ‫ﻀﻴْﻨﺎ َﻋ ﹶﻠ ْﻴ ِﻪ ﺍ ﹶﳌ ْﻮ َ‬ ‫)‪ (١٤‬ﻣﻦ ﺳﻮﺭﺓ ﺳﺒﺄ‪ " :‬ﹶﻓ ﹶﻠ ّﻤﺎ ﹶﻗ َ‬ ‫ﺣﺮﻑ ﺍﻟﻔﺎﺀ ﰲ ﻛﻠﻤﺔ )ﻓﻠﻤّﺎ( ﻫﻮ ﺣﺮﻑ ﺗﺮﺗﻴﺐ ﻭﺗﻌﻘﻴﺐ‪ ،‬ﻭﻫﻮ ﻫﻨـﺎ ﺣﻠﻘـﺔ‬ ‫ﺍﻟﻮﺻﻞ ﺑﲔ ﺍﳊﺪﻳﺚ ﻋﻦ ﺃﻭﺝ ﻣﻠﻚ ﺳﻠﻴﻤﺎﻥ ﻋﻠﻴﻪ ﺍﻟﺴّـﻼﻡ ﰲ ﺍﻵﻳـﺔ )‪،(١٣‬‬ ‫ﻭﺍﳊﺪﻳﺚ ﻋﻦ ﻣﻮﺗﻪ ﰲ ﺍﻵﻳﺔ )‪ .(١٤‬ﻭﻛﻠﻤﺔ )ﳌﹼﺎ( ﻫﻲ ﺍﻟﱵ ُﺗﺤﺪّﺩ ﺯﻣﻦ ﺍﳌﻮﺕ‪.‬‬ ‫ﻋﻠﻰ ﺿﻮﺀ ﺫﻟﻚ ﺇﻟﻴﻚ ﻫﺬﻩ ﺍﳌﻼﺣﻈﺎﺕ ﺍﻟﻌﺪﺩﻳّﺔ‪:‬‬ ‫ﻋﺪﺩ ﺍﳊﺮﻭﻑ ﻣﻦ ﺑﺪﺍﻳﺔ ﺳﻮﺭﺓ ﺳﺒﺄ‪ ،‬ﺇﱃ ﻬﻧﺎﻳﺔ ﺍﻵﻳﺔ )‪ ،(١٣‬ﺃﻱ ﻗﺒـﻞ‬ ‫ﺍﳊﺪﻳﺚ ﻋﻦ ﻣﻮﺗﻪ ﻋﻠﻴﻪ ﺍﻟﺴّﻼﻡ‪ ،‬ﻫﻮ ‪ ٩٣٤‬ﺣﺮﻓﹰﺎ‪ ،‬ﰒ ﺗﺎﰐ ﺍﻟﻔﺎﺀ ‪ -‬ﻭﺍﻟﱵ ﻫـﻲ‬ ‫ﺣﺮﻑ ﺗﺮﺗﻴﺐ ﻭﺗﻌﻘﻴﺐ ‪ -‬ﻣﻠﺘﺼﻘﺔ ﺑﻜﻠﻤﺔ )ﳌﹼﺎ( ﺍﻟﱵ ﲢﺪﺩ ﺯﻣﻦ ﺍﻟﻮﻓﺎﺓ‪ ،‬ﻓﻴﻜﻮﻥ‬ ‫ﺍﺠﻤﻟﻤﻮﻉ ﻫﻮ )‪ (٩٣٥‬ﺣﺮﻓﹰﺎ‪ .‬ﻭﺍﳌﺪﻫﺶ ﻫﻨﺎ ﺃ ﹼﻥ ﻫﺬﺍ ﻫﻮ ﺗﺎﺭﻳﺦ ﻭﻓﺎﺓ ﺳـﻠﻴﻤﺎﻥ‬ ‫ﻋﻠﻴﻪ ﺍﻟﺴّﻼﻡ‪.‬‬ ‫ﺴﻼﻡ ﰲ ﺍﻵﻳﺔ )‪ (١٤‬ﻣﻦ ﺳﻮﺭﺓ‬ ‫ﺑﻌﺪ ﺍﳊﺪﻳﺚ ﻋﻦ ﻭﻓﺎﺓ ﺳﻠﻴﻤﺎﻥ ﻋﻠﻴﻪ ﺍﻟ ّ‬ ‫ﺳﺒﺄ‪ ،‬ﺗﺘﺤﺪﺙ ﺍﻵﻳﺎﺕ ﺍﻟﱵ ﺗﻠﻴﻬﺎ ﻣﺒﺎﺷﺮﺓ ﻋﻦ ﻗﺼّﺔ ﺳﺒﺄ‪ " :‬ﻟﻘﺪ ﻛﺎﻥ ﻟﺴﺒﺄ ﰲ‬ ‫ﺴ ﹶﻜﻨﻬﻢ ﺀﺍﻳﺔ‪ "...‬ﻭﻳﺴﺘﻤﺮ ﺍﻟﻜﻼﻡ ﻋﻨﻬﺎ ﺣﱴ ﺍﻵﻳـﺔ )‪ .(٢١‬ﻭﺇﺫﺍ ﺃﺣﺼـﻴﻨﺎ‬ ‫َﻣ ْ‬ ‫ﺍﳊﺮﻭﻑ ﺑﻌﺪ ﺣﺮﻑ ﺍﻟﻔﺎﺀ ﻣﻦ ﻗﻮﻟﻪ ﺗﻌﺎﱃ‪ " :‬ﻓﻠﻤﺎ ﻗﻀﻴﻨﺎ ﻋﻠﻴﻪ ﺍﳌـﻮﺕ " ﺇﱃ‬ ‫ﺁﺧﺮ ﺍﻵﻳﺔ )‪ (٢١‬ﺳﻨﺠﺪ ﺃ ﹼﻥ ﺍﻟﻌﺪﺩ ﻫﻮ )‪ (٥٧٠‬ﺣﺮﻓﹰﺎ‪ .‬ﻭﺇﺫﺍ ﺭﺟﻌﻨﺎ ﺇﱃ ﺍﳌﻨﺠﺪ‬ ‫ﰲ ﺍﻟﻠﻐﺔ ﻭﺍﻷﻋﻼﻡ ﳒﺪ ﺃ ﹼﻥ ﺁﺧﺮ ﺍﻬﻧﺪﺍﻡ ﻟﺴﺪ ﻣﺄﺭﺏ ﻫﻮ ﺍﻟﻌﺎﻡ ‪٥٧٠‬ﻡ‪ ٦٨،‬ﺃﻱ ﺃ ﹼﻥ‬ ‫ﻬﻧﺎﻳﺔ ﺳﺒﺄ ﻛﺎﻧﺖ ﰲ ﺍﻟﻌﺎﻡ ‪٥٧٠‬ﻡ‪ .‬ﻭﺇﺫﺍ ﻛﺎﻧﺖ ﺍﳊﺮﻭﻑ ﺍﻟــ )‪ (٥٧٠‬ﺑﻌـﺪ‬ ‫ﺣﺮﻑ ﺍﻟﻔﺎﺀ ﻗﺎﺑﻠﺖ )‪ (٥٧٠‬ﺳﻨﺔ ﺑﻌﺪ ﺍﳌﻴﻼﺩ‪ ،‬ﻓﺈﻥ ﺍﻟـ )‪ (٩٣٥‬ﺣﺮﻓـﺎ ﺍﻟـﱵ‬ ‫‪ ٦٨‬ﺟﺎﺀ ﰲ ﺍﳌﻨﺠﺪ‪ " :‬ﻣﺄﺭﺏ‪ :‬ﻋﺎﺻﻤﺔ ﺍﳌﻤﻠﻜﺔ ﺍﻟﺴﺒﺌﻴﺔ‪...‬ﺍﺷﺘﻬﺮﺕ ﺑﺎﻟﺴّﺪ ﺍﳌﻌﺮﻭﻑ ﺑﺎﲰﻬﺎ‪...‬ﻳﻨﺴﺐ ﺧﺮﺍﺑﻪ ﺇﱃ ﺍﻟﺴّﻴﻞ ﺍﻟﻌَﺮِﻡ‬ ‫ﺑﲔ ‪." ٥٧٠-٥٤٢‬‬ ‫‪٧٧‬‬ ‫ﺳﺒﻘﺖ ﺗﻘﺎﺑﻞ ﺍﻟـ )‪ (٩٣٥‬ﺳﻨﺔ ﻗﺒﻞ ﺍﳌﻴﻼﺩ‪ .‬ﻭﻬﺑﺬﺍ ﻧﻜﻮﻥ ﻗﺪ ﺭﺟّﺤﻨﺎ ﺃ ﹾﻥ ﺗﻜﻮﻥ‬ ‫ﻭﻓﺎﺗﻪ ﻋﻠﻴﻪ ﺍﻟﺴﻼﻡ ﺳﻨﺔ ‪٩٣٥‬ﻕ‪.‬ﻡ‪ .‬ﻓﺘﺄﻣّﻞ!!‬ ‫ﻗﻠﻨﺎ ﺇ ﹼﻥ ﺍﻵﻳﺔ )‪ (١٣‬ﻣﻦ ﺳﻮﺭﺓ ﺳﺒﺄ ﺗﺘﺤﺪﺙ ﻋﻦ ﺃﻭﺝ ﻣﻠﻚ ﺳـﻠﻴﻤﺎﻥ‪،‬‬ ‫ﻋﻠﻴﻪ ﺍﻟﺴﻼﻡ‪ ،‬ﹼﰒ ﻳﻜﻮﻥ ﺍﻟﻜﻼﻡ ﻋﻦ ﻭﻓﺎﺗﻪ ﰲ ﺍﻵﻳﺔ )‪ ،(١٤‬ﻭﺑﻌﺪ ﺫﻟﻚ ﻣﺒﺎﺷـﺮﺓ‬ ‫ﻳﻜﻮﻥ ﺍﻟﻜﻼﻡ ﻋﻦ ﻗﺼﺔ ﺳﺒﺄ ﰲ ﺍﻵﻳﺎﺕ‪ .(٢١ – ١٥) :‬ﻭﺍﻟﻼﻓـﺖ ﻫﻨـﺎ ﺃ ﹼﻥ‬ ‫ﺍﻟﻜﻼﻡ ﺣﻮﻝ ﺳﺒﺄ ﺟﺎﺀ ﺑﻌﺪ ﺍﻟﻜﻼﻡ ﻋﻦ ﻭﻓﺎﺓ ﺳﻠﻴﻤﺎﻥ‪ ،‬ﻋﻠﻴﻪ ﺍﻟﺴﻼﻡ‪ ،‬ﻭﻣﻌﻠﻮﻡ ﺃ ﹼﻥ‬ ‫ﺳﻠﻄﺎﻥ ﺳﻠﻴﻤﺎﻥ‪ ،‬ﻋﻠﻴﻪ ﺍﻟﺴﻼﻡ‪ ،‬ﻗﺪ ﺍﻣﺘﺪ ﻟﻴﺸﻤﻞ ﳑﻠﻜﺔ ﺳﺒﺄ ﰲ ﺍﻟﻴﻤﻦ‪ ٦٩.‬ﻭﻋﻠﻴﻪ‬ ‫ﻓﺈﻧّﻪ ﻣﻦ ﺍﳌﺘﻮﻗﹼﻊ ﺃﻥ ﺗﻨﺸ ّﻖ ﺑﻼﺩ ﺍﻟﻴﻤﻦ ﺑﻌﺪ ﻭﻓﺎﺓ ﺳﻠﻴﻤﺎﻥ‪ ،‬ﻋﻠﻴﻪ ﺍﻟﺴّﻼﻡ‪ ،‬ﻛﻤـﺎ‬ ‫ﺣﺼﻞ ﰲ ﺍﻷﺭﺽ ﺍﳌﻘﺪّﺳﺔ‪ .‬ﻭﻣﻦ ﺍﳌﺘﻮﻗﹼﻊ ﺃﻳﻀﹰﺎ ﺃﻥ ﺗﺴﺮﻱ ﻋﺪﻭﻯ ﺍﻹﻓﺴﺎﺩ ﻣـﻦ‬ ‫ﻓﻠﺴﻄﲔ ﺇﱃ ﺍﻟﻴﻤﻦ‪ ،‬ﻭﻳﻌﺰﺯ ﺍﻟﻘﻮﻝ ﻬﺑﺬﺍ ﺍﻷﻣﻮﺭ ﺍﻵﺗﻴﺔ‪:‬‬ ‫ﺃﻭ ﹰﻻ‪ :‬ﻳﻼﺣﻆ ﺃ ﹼﻥ ﺍﻵﻳﺔ ‪ ١٨‬ﻣﻦ ﺳﻮﺭﺓ ﺳﺒﺄ ﺗﺘﺤﺪﺙ ﻋﻦ ﻋﻼﻗﺔ ﺑﻼﺩ ﺳـﺒﺄ ﰲ‬ ‫ﺍﻟﻴﻤﻦ ﺑﺎﻷﺭﺽ ﺍﳌﺒﺎﺭﻛﺔ‪) :‬ﻭ َﺟ َﻌﻠﹾﻨﺎ َﺑ ْﻴَﻨﻬُﻢ َﻭَﺑ ْﻴ َﻦ ﺍﻟﻘﺮﻯ ﺍﻟﱵ ﺑَﺎ َﺭﻛﹾﻨﺎ ﻓﻴﻬﺎ ﻗﹸـﺮﻯ‬ ‫ﻇﹶﺎ ِﻫﺮَﺓ‪ .(...‬ﹼﰒ ﻳﻜﻮﻥ ﺍﻟﻜﻼﻡ ﰲ ﺍﻵﻳﺔ ‪ ١٩‬ﻋﻦ ﺇﻓﺴﺎﺩ ﺍﻟﺴّـﺒﺌﻴﲔ ﻭﺗﺸـﺘﻴﺘﻬﻢ‪.‬‬ ‫ﺛﺎﻧﻴﹰﺎ‪ :‬ﻻ ُﻳﺘﺼـﻮّﺭ ﲤﺎﺳـﻚ ﺍﻷﻃـﺮﺍﻑ ﻣـﻊ ﻬﺗـﺎﻭﻱ ﻭﺗﻔﺘـﺖ ﺍﻟﻘﻠـﺐ‪.‬‬ ‫ﺛﺎﻟﺜﹰﺎ‪ :‬ﺟﺎﺀ ﺍﻟﻜﻼﻡ ﻋﻦ ﺇﻓﺴﺎﺩ ﺍﻟﺴّﺒﺌﻴﲔ‪ ،‬ﰲ ﺳﻮﺭﺓ ﺳﺒﺄ‪ ،‬ﺑﻌﺪ ﺍﻟﻜﻼﻡ ﺣﻮﻝ ﻭﻓﺎﺓ‬ ‫ﺳﻠﻴﻤﺎﻥ ﻋﻠﻴﻪ ﺍﻟﺴّﻼﻡ‪.‬‬ ‫ﺭﺍﺑﻌﹰﺎ‪ :‬ﳜﺘﺘﻢ ﺍﻟﻜﻼﻡ ﺣﻮﻝ ﺍﳌﻠﻚ ﺍﻟﻌﻈﻴﻢ ﻟﺴﻠﻴﻤﺎﻥ ﻋﻠﻴﻪ ﺍﻟﺴﻼﻡ‪ ،‬ﰲ ﺳﻮﺭﺓ ﺳﺒﺄ‪،‬‬ ‫ﻱ‬ ‫ﺑﻘﻮﻟﻪ ﺗﻌﺎﱃ ﰲ ﺍﻵﻳﺔ )‪..." :(١٣‬ﺍﻋﻤﻠﻮﺍ ﺀﺍ ﹶﻝ ﺩﺍﻭ َﺩ ﺷُﻜﺮﺍﹰ‪ ،‬ﻭﻗﻠﻴﻞﹲ ﻣﻦ ﻋﺒﺎﺩ َ‬ ‫ﺾ ﺑﺎﳌﻔﺴـﺪﻳﻦ‪.‬‬ ‫ﺍﻟﺸّﻜﻮﺭ"‪ .‬ﻭﰲ ﻫﺬﺍ ﻣﺪﺡ ﻵﻝ ﺩﺍﻭﺩ‪ ،‬ﻋﻠﻴﻬﻢ ﺍﻟﺴّﻼﻡ‪ ،‬ﻭﺗﻌﺮﻳ ٌ‬ ‫‪ ٦٩‬ﺭﺍﺟﻊ ﺍﻵﻳﺎﺕ‪ (٤٤-١٥) :‬ﻣﻦ ﺳﻮﺭﺓ ﺍﻟﻨﻤﻞ‪.‬‬ ‫‪٧٨‬‬ ‫ﺧﺎﻣﺴﹰﺎ‪ :‬ﺟﺎﺀ ﺍﻟﻜﻼﻡ ﺣﻮﻝ ﺇﻓﺴﺎﺩ ﺍﻟﺴّﺒﺌﻴﲔ ﻭﲤﺰﻳﻘﻬﻢ ﰲ ﺍﻵﻳﺔ )‪ (١٩‬ﻣﻦ ﺳﻮﺭﺓ‬ ‫ﺕ ﻟﻜـ ﹼﻞ ﺻَـﺒّﺎ ٍﺭ ﺷـﻜﻮ ٍﺭ "‬ ‫ﺳﺒﺄ‪ ،‬ﻭﲣﺘﻢ ﺑﻘﻮﻟﻪ ﺗﻌﺎﱃ‪..." :‬ﺇ ﹼﻥ ﰲ ﺫﻟﻚ ﻵﻳﺎ ٍ‬ ‫ﻭﺍﻟﻼﻓﺖ ﻫﻨﺎ ﺃ ﹼﻥ ﺍﻵﻳﺘﲔ‪١٣) :‬ﻭ‪ (١٩‬ﻗﺪ ُﺧﺘﻤﺘﺎ ﺑﻜﻠﻤﺔ )ﺷﻜﻮﺭ(‪ .‬ﻣﻊ ﺍﻟﻌﻠﻢ ﺑﺄ ﹼﻥ‬ ‫ﻫﺬﻩ ﺍﻟﻜﻠﻤﺔ‪ ،‬ﻛﺼﻔﺔ ﻟﻠﺒﺸﺮ‪ ،‬ﱂ ﺗﺘﻜﺮﺭ ﰲ ﺍﻟﻘﺮﺁﻥ ﺍﻟﻜﺮﱘ ﺇﻻ )‪ (٦‬ﻣﺮّﺍﺕ‪ .‬ﻭﻋﻠﻰ‬ ‫ﺿﻮﺀ ﺫﻟﻚ‪ ،‬ﺇﻟﻴﻚ ﻫﺬﻩ ﺍﳌﻼﺣﻈﺎﺕ ﺍﻟﻌﺪﺩﻳّﺔ‪:‬‬ ‫‪ (١‬ﻋﺪﺩ ﻛﻠﻤﺎﺕ ﻛﻞ ﺁﻳﺔ ﻣﻦ ﺍﻵﻳﺘﲔ‪ ١٣) :‬ﻭ‪ (١٩‬ﻣﻦ ﺳﻮﺭﺓ ﺳﺒﺄ ﻫﻮ )‪(١٩‬‬ ‫ﻛﻠﻤﺔ‪.‬ﻭﻻ ﻳﻮﺟﺪ ﺁﻳﺔ ﺃﺧﺮﻯ ﰲ ﺍﻟﺴّﻮﺭﺓ ﻋﺪﺩ ﻛﻠﻤﺎﻬﺗﺎ ‪.١٩‬‬ ‫‪ (٢‬ﻋﺪﺩ ﺣﺮﻭﻑ ﻛﻞ ﻣﻦ ﺍﻵﻳﺘﲔ ﻫﻮ )‪ (٨٤‬ﺣﺮﻓﹰﺎ‪ .‬ﻭﻫﺬﺍ ﺍﻟﺘﺴﺎﻭﻱ ﰲ ﻋـﺪﺩ‬ ‫ﺍﳊﺮﻭﻑ ﻭﺍﻟﻜﻠﻤﺎﺕ ﻳﻠﻔﺖ ﺍﻻﻧﺘﺒﺎﻩ‪.‬‬ ‫‪ (٣‬ﺇﺫﺍ ﺿﺮﺑﻨﺎ ﻋﺪﺩ ﺍﳊﺮﻭﻑ ﰲ ﻋﺪﺩ ﺍﻟﻜﻠﻤﺎﺕ‪ ،‬ﻳﻜﻮﻥ ﺍﻟﻨﺎﺗﺞ ﻫﻮ‪:‬‬ ‫) ‪ .١٥٩٦ = (٨٤×١٩‬ﻭﲟﺎ ﺃ ﹼﻥ ﺍﻵﻳﺔ ‪ ١٣‬ﻣﻦ ﺳﻮﺭﺓ ﺳﺒﺄ ﺗﺘﺤﺪﺙ ﻋﻦ ﺃﻭﺝ‬ ‫ﻣﻠﻚ ﺳﻠﻴﻤﺎﻥ‪ ،‬ﻋﻠﻴﻪ ﺍﻟﺴﻼﻡ‪ ،‬ﻗﺒﻞ ﺍﳊﺪﻳﺚ ﻋﻦ ﻭﻓﺎﺗﻪ ﰲ ﺍﻵﻳﺔ ‪ ،١٤‬ﻭﲟـﺎ ﺃ ﹼﻥ‬ ‫ﺍﻵﻳﺔ ‪ ١٩‬ﺗﺘﺤﺪﺙ ﻋﻦ ﺇﻓﺴﺎﺩ ﺍﻟﺴّﺒﺌﻴﲔ ﻭﲤﺰﻳﻘﻬﻢ‪ ،‬ﻭﺍﻟﺬﻱ ﳛﺘﻤـﻞ ﺃﻥ ﻳﻜـﻮﻥ‬ ‫ﻣﻮﺍﻛﺒﹰﺎ ﻹﻓﺴﺎﺩ ﺑﲏ ﺇﺳﺮﺍﺋﻴﻞ ﻭﲤﺰﻳﻖ ﺩﻭﻟﺘﻬﻢ‪ ،‬ﻭﲟﺎ ﺃ ﹼﻥ ﺍﻟﻌﺪﺩ ‪ ١٥٩٦‬ﻣﺸﺘﺮﻙ ﺑﲔ‬ ‫ﺍﻵﻳﺘﲔ‪ ،‬ﻓﻬﻨﺎﻙ ﺍﺣﺘﻤﺎﻝ ﺃﻥ ﻳﻜﻮﻥ ﻫﺬﺍ ﺍﻟﻌﺪﺩ ﻳﺸﲑ ﺇﱃ ﺑﺪﺍﻳﺔ ﻣﻠﻚ ﺳـﻠﻴﻤﺎﻥ‪،‬‬ ‫ﻋﻠﻴﻪ ﺍﻟﺴّﻼﻡ‪ ،‬ﻭﻋﻼﻗﺘﻪ ﺑﺎﻹﺳﺮﺍﺀ‪ .‬ﻭﺍﻟﺬﻱ ﻋﺰﺯ ﻟﺪﻳﻨﺎ ﻫﺬﺍ ﺍﻻﻓﺘﺮﺍﺽ ﺍﳌﻼﺣﻈﺎﺕ‬ ‫ﺍﻵﺗﻴﺔ‪:‬‬ ‫ﺃ( َﻣﻠﻚ ﺳﻠﻴﻤﺎﻥ ﻋﻠﻴﻪ ﺍﻟﺴﻼﻡ )‪ (٤٠‬ﺳﻨﺔ‪ ،‬ﻭﺫﻟﻚ ﻭﻓﻖ ﻣﺎ ﺟـﺎﺀ ﰲ ﺍﻟﻌﻬـﺪ‬ ‫ﺍﻟﻘﺪﱘ‪ .٧٠‬ﻭﻋﻠﻴﻪ ﻓﺈﺫﺍ ﺃﺿﻔﻨﺎ ﻫﺬﺍ ﺍﻟﻌﺪﺩ ﺇﱃ ﻋﺪﺩ ﺍﻟﺴﻨﲔ ﻣـﻦ ﻭﻓﺎﺗـﻪ‪ ،‬ﻋﻠﻴـﻪ‬ ‫‪ ٧٠‬ﺳﻔﺮ ﺍﳌﻠﻮﻙ ﺍﻷﻭﻝ‪ ،‬ﺍﻹﺻﺤﺎﺡ ﺍﳊﺎﺩﻱ ﻋﺸﺮ‪ ..." :‬ﻭﻛﺎﻧﺖ ﺍﻷﻳﺎﻡ ﺍﻟﱵ ﻣﻠﻚ ﻓﻴﻬـﺎ ﺳـﻠﻴﻤﺎﻥ ﰲ ﺃﻭﺭﺷـﻠﻴﻢ ﻋﻠـﻰ‬ ‫‪٧٩‬‬ ‫ﺍﻟﺴﻼﻡ‪ ،‬ﺇﱃ ﺳﻨﺔ ﺍﻹﺳﺮﺍﺀ‪ ،‬ﻳﻜﻮﻥ ﺍﻟﻨﺎﺗﺞ‪.١٥٩٦ = (٤٠ +١٥٥٦) :‬‬ ‫ﺏ( ﻋﺪﺩ ﻛﻠﻤﺎﺕ ﺁﻳﺎﺕ ﻗﺼﺔ ﺳﺒﺄ ﻫﻮ‪ (١١١) :‬ﻛﻠﻤﺔ‪ .‬ﻭﺍﻟﻼﻓﺖ ﻫﻨﺎ ﺃ ﹼﻥ ﻫﺬﺍ‬ ‫ﻫﻮ ﻋﺪﺩ ﺁﻳﺎﺕ ﺳﻮﺭﺓ ﺍﻹﺳﺮﺍﺀ‪.‬‬ ‫ﺝ( ﺍﳌﻔﺎﺟﺄﺓ ﻫﻨﺎ ﺃ ﹼﻥ ﻋﺪﺩ ﺍﻵﻳﺎﺕ ﻣﻦ ﺑﺪﺍﻳﺔ ﺳﻮﺭﺓ ﺍﻹﺳﺮﺍﺀ‪ ،‬ﺇﱃ ﺍﻵﻳﺔ ‪ ١٩‬ﻣﻦ‬ ‫ﺳﻮﺭﺓ ﺳﺒﺄ‪ ،‬ﻫﻮ )‪ (١٥٩٦‬ﺁﻳﺔ‪ .‬ﻓﺘﺄﻣّﻞ!!‬ ‫ﺇﺳﺘﻨﺎﺩﺍﹰ ﺇﱃ ﻣﺎ ﺳﺒﻖ ﺫﻛﺮﻩ ﳝﻜﻦ ﺃﻥ ﻧﻘﻮﻝ‪ :‬ﺇ ﹼﻥ ﺳﻠﻴﻤﺎﻥ ﻋﻠﻴﻪ ﺍﻟﺴّﻼﻡ ﻗﺪ‬ ‫ﺗﻮﰲ ﺳﻨﺔ ‪٩٣٥‬ﻕ‪.‬ﻡ‪ ،‬ﺍﳌﻮﺍﻓﻖ ‪ ١٥٥٦‬ﻗﺒﻞ ﺍﻹﺳﺮﺍﺀ‪ .‬ﻭﺍﻟﻼﻓﺖ ﻫﻨﺎ ﺃ ﹼﻥ ﳎﻤـﻮﻉ‬ ‫ﺃﺭﻗﺎﻡ ﻛ ﹼﻞ ﻣﻦ ﺍﻟﻌﺪﺩﻳﻦ ﻫﻮ )‪ ،(١٧‬ﻭﻻ ﻧﻨﺴﻰ ﺃ ﹼﻥ ﻫﺬﺍ ﻫـﻮ ﺗﺮﺗﻴـﺐ ﺳـﻮﺭﺓ‬ ‫ﺍﻹﺳﺮﺍﺀ ﰲ ﺍﳌﺼﺤﻒ‪ ،‬ﻭﺃ ﹼﻥ ﻋﺪﺩ ﻛﻠﻤﺎﺕ ﺍﻟﺴّﻮﺭﺓ ﻫﻮ ‪١٥٥٦‬ﻛﻠﻤﺔ‪ .‬ﻭﺇﺫﺍ ﲨﻌﻨﺎ‬ ‫ﺃﺭﻗﺎﻡ ﺍﻟﻌﺪﺩﻳﻦ ﻣﻌﹰﺎ ﻳﻜﻮﻥ ﺍﻟﻨﺎﺗﺞ‪ ٣٤ = (١٧+١٧) :‬ﻭﻫﺬﺍ ﺗﺮﺗﻴﺐ ﺳﻮﺭﺓ ﺳﺒﺄ‬ ‫ﰲ ﺍﳌﺼﺤﻒ‪.‬‬ ‫ﻛﻞ ﺇﺳﺮﺍﺋﻴﻞ ﺃﺭﺑﻌﲔ ﺳﻨﺔ"‪ .‬ﻭﳓﻦ ﻫﻨﺎ ﻧﺴﺘﺄﻧﺲ ﻭﻻ ﳒﺰﻡ‪ ،‬ﻷﻧﻨﺎ ﻧﻌﻠﻢ ﺃ ﹼﻥ ﺍﻟﻌﻬﺪ ﺍﻟﻘﺪﱘ ﻟﻴﺲ ﲝﺠﺔ ﰲ ﺍﻟﺘﺎﺭﻳﺦ‪.‬‬ ‫‪٨٠‬‬ ‫ﺣﺴﺎﺏ ﺍﳉﹸﻤﱠﻞ‬ ‫ﺗﺘﺄﻟﻒ ﺍﻷﺣﺮﻑ ﺍﳍﺠﺎﺋّﻴﺔ ﻟﻠﻐﺔ ﺍﻟﻌﺮﺑﻴﺔ ﻣﻦ ‪٢٩‬ﺣﺮﻓﺎﹰ‪ ،‬ﺃﻣّـﺎ ﺍﻷﺣـﺮﻑ‬ ‫ﺍﻷﲜﺪﻳﺔ ﻓﻬﻲ ‪ ٢٨‬ﺣﺮﻓﺎﹰ‪ ،‬ﻋﻠﻰ ﺍﻋﺘﺒﺎﺭ ﺃﻧﻪ ﻻ ﻓﺮﻕ ﰲ ﺍﻷﲜﺪﻳّﺔ ﺑـﲔ ﺍﻷﻟـﻒ‬ ‫ﻱ‪ ،‬ﻭﺍﺭﺗﺒﺎﻁ ﻫﺬﺍ ﺍﻟﺘﺮﺗﻴﺐ ﲟﺎ ﻳﺴﻤﻰ‬ ‫ﻭﺍﳍﻤﺰﺓ‪ .‬ﻭﺍﻟﺬﻱ ﻳﻬﻤﻨﺎ ﻫﻨﺎ ﺍﻟﺘﺮﺗﻴﺐ ﺍﻷﲜﺪ ّ‬ ‫ﺣﺴﺎﺏ ﺍﳉَﹸﻤّﻞ‪ ،‬ﻭﻫﻮ ﺣﺴﺎﺏ ﺍﺳﺘﺨﺪﻡ ﰲ ﺍﻟﻠﻐﺎﺕ ﺍﻟﺴّﺎﻣّﻴﺔ‪ ،‬ﻭﻣﻦ ﻫﻨﺎ ﳒـﺪ ﺃ ﹼﻥ‬ ‫ﺍﻷﲜﺪﻳّﺔ ﺍﻟﻌﱪﻳﺔ ﺗﺘﻄﺎﺑﻖ ﻣﻊ ﺍﻷﲜﺪّﻳﺔ ﺍﻟﻌﺮﺑﻴﺔ ﺣﱴ ﺣﺮﻑ )ﺍﻟﺘﺎﺀ(‪ ،‬ﻭﺗﺰﻳﺪ ﺍﻟﻌﺮﺑﻴﺔ‪:‬‬ ‫) ﺙ‪ ،‬ﺥ ‪ ،‬ﺫ ‪ ،‬ﺽ ‪ ،‬ﻅ ‪ ،‬ﻍ (‪.‬‬ ‫ﻱ‪ ،‬ﻭﻣﺎ ﺍﺭﺗﺒﻂ ﺑﻪ ﻣـﻦ‬ ‫ﻟﻴﺲ ﻣﻦ ﺍﻟﺴّﻬﻞ ﻣﻌﺮﻓﺔ ﺃﺳﺎﺱ ﺍﻟﺘﺮﺗﻴﺐ ﺍﻷﲜﺪ ّ‬ ‫ﺣﺴﺎﺏ ﰲ ﺍﻟﻠﻐﺎﺕ ﺍﻟﺴّﺎﻣﻴّﺔ؛ ﺇﺫ ﺗﻌﺪﺩﺕ ﺍﻷﻗﻮﺍﻝ ﰲ ﺫﻟﻚ‪ ،‬ﲝﻴﺚ ﻳﺼﻌﺐ ﺍﳉﺰﻡ‬ ‫ﺃﻭ ﺍﻟﺘﺮﺟﻴﺢ‪ .‬ﻭﻗﺪ ﻳﻜﻮﻥ ﳍﺬﺍ ﺍﳊﺴﺎﺏ ﺃﺳﺎﺱ ﺩﻳﲏ؛ ﻓﺮﺟﺎﻝ ﺍﻟﺪﻳﻦ ﺍﻟﻴﻬـﻮﺩﻱ‬ ‫ﻳﺴﺘﺨﺪﻣﻮﻧﻪ ﻛﺜﲑﺍﹰ‪ ،‬ﻭﻗﺪ ﺍﺳﺘﺨﺪﻣﻪ ﺍﳌﺴﻠﻤﻮﻥ ﰲ ﺍﻟﺘﺄﺭﻳﺦ‪ ،‬ﻭﺑﺎﻟﻐﺖ ﺍﳌﺘﺼﻮّﻓﺔ ﰲ‬ ‫ﺍﺳﺘﺨﺪﺍﻣﻪ‪،‬ﻛﻤﺎ ﺍﺳﺘﺨﺪﻣﻪ ﺃﻫﻞ ﺍﻟﺴّﺤﺮ ﻭﺍﻟﻜﻬﺎﻧﺔ‪ ،‬ﻭﺍﻟﺸﻌﻮﺫﺓ‪ .‬ﻭﻻ ﻳﺒﻌـﺪ‪،‬ﻛﻤﺎ‬ ‫ﻗﻠﻨﺎ‪ ،‬ﺃﻥ ﻳﻜﻮﻥ ﳍﺬﺍ ﺍﳊﺴﺎﺏ ﺃﺳﺎﺱ ﺩﻳﲏ‪ ،‬ﰒ ﺩﺧﻠـﻪ ﺍﻟﺘّﺤﺮﻳـﻒ ﻭﺍﻟﺘﺒـﺪﻳﻞ‬ ‫ﺴ ﱢﻲﺀ ‪.‬‬ ‫ﻭﺍﻟﺘﻮﻇﻴﻒ ﺍﻟ ﱠ‬ ‫ﻼ ﻋﻦ ﺍﻟﺘﺮﺗﻴﺐ ﺍﳌﺸﺘﻬﺮ‬ ‫ﻱ ﰲ ﺍﻟﺸﻤﺎﻝ ﺍﳌﻐﺮﰊ ﻗﻠﻴ ﹰ‬ ‫ﳜﺘﻠﻒ ﺍﻟﺘﺮﺗﻴﺐ ﺍﻷﲜﺪ ّ‬ ‫‪٨١‬‬ ‫ﺃ‬ ‫‪١‬‬ ‫ﺏ‬ ‫‪٢‬‬ ‫ﺝ‬ ‫‪٣‬‬ ‫ﺩ‬ ‫‪٤‬‬ ‫ﻫـ‬ ‫‪٥‬‬ ‫ﻭ‬ ‫‪٦‬‬ ‫ﺯ‬ ‫‪٧‬‬ ‫ﺡ‬ ‫‪٨‬‬ ‫ﻁ‬ ‫‪٩‬‬ ‫ﻙ‬ ‫‪٢٠‬‬ ‫ﻝ‬ ‫‪٣٠‬‬ ‫ﻡ‬ ‫‪٤٠‬‬ ‫ﻥ‬ ‫‪٥٠‬‬ ‫ﺱ‬ ‫‪٦٠‬‬ ‫ﻉ‬ ‫‪٧٠‬‬ ‫ﻑ‬ ‫‪٨٠‬‬ ‫ﺹ‬ ‫‪٩٠‬‬ ‫ﻕ‬ ‫‪١٠٠‬‬ ‫ﺭ‬ ‫‪٢٠٠‬‬ ‫ﺵ‬ ‫‪٣٠٠‬‬ ‫ﺕ‬ ‫‪٤٠٠‬‬ ‫ﺙ‬ ‫‪٥٠٠‬‬ ‫ﺥ‬ ‫‪٦٠٠‬‬ ‫ﺫ‬ ‫‪٧٠٠‬‬ ‫ﺽ‬ ‫‪٨٠٠‬‬ ‫ﻅ‬ ‫‪٩٠٠‬‬ ‫ﻍ‬ ‫‪١٠٠٠‬‬ ‫ﻱ‬ ‫‪١٠‬‬ ‫ﻭﺍﳌﺴﺘﺨﺪﻡ ﻗﺪﳝﹰﺎ ﻭﺣﺪﻳﺜﺎﹰ‪ ،‬ﻭﺍﻟﺬﻱ ﻫﻮ ‪ ) :‬ﺃﲜﺪ‪ ،‬ﻫـﻮﺯ‪ ،‬ﺣﻄـﻲ ‪،‬ﻛﻠﻤـﻦ‪،‬‬ ‫ﺳﻌﻔﺺ‪ ،‬ﻗﺮﺷﺖ‪ ،‬ﺛﺨﺬ‪ ،‬ﺿﻈﻎ (‪ .‬ﻭﺗﻨﺘﻬﻲ ﺍﻷﲜﺪﻳﺔ ﺍﻟﻌﱪﻳﺔ‪ ،‬ﻛﻤﺎ ﻗﻠﻨﺎ‪ ،‬ﻋﻨـﺪ‬ ‫)ﻗﺮﺷﺖ (‪ .‬ﻭﻗﺪ ﹸﺃﻋِﻄ َﻲ ﻛﻞ ﺣﺮﻑ ﻗﻴﻤﺔ ﻋﺪﺩﻳﺔ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺍﻟﺼﻮﺭﺓ ﺍﻵﺗﻴﺔ ‪:‬‬ ‫ﳉﻤّﻞ ( ﺃﻧﻪ ﻻ ﻓﺮﻕ ﰲ ﺍﻟﻘﻴﻤﺔ ﺍﻟﻌﺪﺩﻳّـﺔ ﺑـﲔ‬ ‫ﻳﻼﺣﻆ ﰲ ﺣﺴﺎﺏ )ﺍ ﹸ‬ ‫ﺍﻷﻟﻒ ﻭﺍﳍﻤﺰﺓ‪ ،‬ﻻﻋﺘﻤﺎﺩﻩ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺍﻷﺣﺮﻑ ﺍﻷﲜﺪﻳﺔ‪ ،‬ﻭﻟـﻴﺲ ﺍﳍﺠﺎﺋﻴّـﺔ‪ .‬ﻭﻗـﺪ‬ ‫ﺍﺳﺘﺨ ِﺪﻡ ﻫﺬﺍ ﺍﳊﺴﺎﺏ ﻷﻏﺮﺍﺽ ﻛﺜﲑﺓ‪ ،‬ﻭﺍﺳﺘﺨﺪﻣﻪ ﺍﳌﺴـﻠﻤﻮﻥ ﰲ ﺍﻟﺘـﺄﺭﻳﺦ‬ ‫ﻟﻠﻤﻌﺎﺭﻙ‪ ،‬ﻭﺍﻟﻮﻓﻴﺎﺕ‪ ،‬ﻭﺍﻷﺑﻨﻴﺔ‪ ،‬ﻭﻏﲑﻫﺎ‪ ...‬ﻭﻣﻦ ﺍﻷﻣﺜﻠﺔ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺫﻟﻚ‪:‬‬ ‫ﺴﻠﻄﺎﻥ ) ﺑﺮﻗﻮﻕ ( ﻭﻫﻮ ﻣﻦ ﺳﻼﻃﲔ ﺍﳌﻤﺎﻟﻴﻚ ﺍﻟﺒُﺮﺟﻴّﺔ‪،‬‬ ‫ﻋﻨﺪﻣﺎ ﺗﻮﰲ ﺍﻟ ّ‬ ‫ﻗﺎﻡ ﺑﻌﺾ ﺍﻟﻈﺮﻓﺎﺀ ﺑﺼﻴﺎﻏﺔ ﻋﺒﺎﺭﺓ ﲢﺪﺩ ﺗﺎﺭﻳﺦ ﻭﻓﺎﺗﻪ‪ ،‬ﻭﻫﻲ‪ ) :‬ﰲ ﺍﳌﺸـﻤﺶ (‪.‬‬ ‫ﻭﻋﻠﻴﻪ ﺗﻜﻮﻥ ﻭﻓﺎﺓ ﺑﺮﻗﻮﻕ ﰲ ﺍﳌﺸﻤﺶ‪ .‬ﻭﺍﻟﻘﻴﻤﺔ ﺍﻟﻌﺪﺩﻳﺔ ﳍﺬﻩ ﺍﻟﻌﺒـﺎﺭﺓ ﻫـﻲ‪:‬‬ ‫)‪ ٨٠١ = (٣٠٠+٤٠+٣٠٠+٤٠+٣٠+١+١٠+٨٠‬ﻭﻋﻠﻴﻪ ﺗﻜﻮﻥ‬ ‫ﻭﻓﺎﺓ ﺍﻟﺴّﻠﻄﺎﻥ )ﺑﺮﻗﻮﻕ ( ﺑﺘﺎﺭﻳﺦ ‪٨٠١‬ﻫـ‬ ‫ﻣﺜﺎﻝ ﺁﺧﺮ‪:‬‬ ‫‪٨٢‬‬ ‫ﺗﻮﰲ ﺷﺎﻋﺮ ﺍﲰﻪ )ﺍﻟﺪّﻟﻨﺠﺎﻭﻱ (‪ ،‬ﻓﺮﺛﺎ ُﻩ ﺻﺪﻳﻖ ﻟﻪ‪ ،‬ﻭﺃﺭّﺥ ﻟﻮﻓﺎﺗﻪ ﻓﻘﺎﻝ‪:‬‬ ‫ﻱ ﳊــﺪﻩ‬ ‫ﻭﻗﺪ ﺳﻜ َﻦ ﺍﻟﺪّﻟﻨﺠﺎﻭ ّ‬ ‫ﻚ ﻣﻦ ﺻﺪﻳ ٍﻖ‬ ‫ﺖ ﺍﻟﺸّﻌ َﺮ ﻫﻞ ﻟ َ‬ ‫ﺳﺄﻟ ُ‬ ‫ﻭﺃﺻﺒﺢ ﺭﺍﻗﺪﹰﺍ ﰲ ﺍﻟﻘﱪ ﻋﻨــﺪﻩ‬ ‫ﺡ ﻭﺧ ّﺮ ﻣﻐﺸﻴﺎﹰ ﻋﻠﻴــــﻪ‬ ‫ﻓﺼﺎ َ‬ ‫ﺖ‪ :‬ﻣﺎﺕ ﺍﻟﺸﻌ ُﺮ ﺑﻌـﺪﻩ‬ ‫ﻟﻘﺪ ﺃﺭّﺧ ُ‬ ‫ﺖ ﳌﻦ ﻳﻘﻮﻝ ﺍﻟﺸﻌﺮ ﺃﻗﹾﺼِــﺮ‬ ‫ﻓﻘﻠ ُ‬ ‫ﺃﻋﻄﻰ ﺍﻟﺸﺎﻋﺮ ﻛﻠﻤ ﹰﺔ ﻣﻔﺘﺎﺣﻴّﺔ ﺗﺪﻟﻨﺎ ﻛﻴﻒ ﳓﺴﺐ‪ ،‬ﺣﻴﺚ ﻗﺎﻝ‪ " :‬ﻟﻘﺪ‬ ‫ﺃﺭّﺧﺖ " ﺃﻱ‪ ،‬ﺍﺣﺴﺒﻮﺍ ﺍﻟﻌﺒﺎﺭﺓ ﺍﻟﱵ ﺗﺄﰐ ﺑﻌﺪ ﻛﻠﻤﺔ ) ﺃﺭّﺧﺖ (‪ .‬ﻭﻛﺎﻥ ﳝﻜـﻦ‬ ‫ﺃﻥ ﻳﺴﺘﺨﺪﻡ ﺍﻟﺸﺎﻋﺮ ﻛﻠﻤﺎﺕ ﺃﺧﺮﻯ ﻓﻴﻬﺎ ﻣﻌﲎ ﺍﳊﺴـﺎﺏ‪ ،‬ﺃﻭ ﺍﻹﺣﺼـﺎﺀ‪ ،‬ﺃﻭ‬ ‫ﺍﻟﻌﺪّ‪ ،‬ﺃﻭ ﺍﻟﺘﺄﺭﻳﺦ‪ ،‬ﺃﻭ ﻛﻠﻤﺎﺕ ﺗﺸﲑ ﺇﱃ ﺍﳉﹸﻤﻠﺔ ﺍﻟﱵ ﲢﻤﻞ ﺍﻟﻘﻴﻤﺔ ﺍﻟﻌﺪﺩّﻳﺔ ﺍﻟـﱵ‬ ‫ﺤﺪّﺩ ﻋﺒﺎﺭﺓ‪) :‬ﻣﺎﺕ ﺍﻟﺸﻌﺮ ﺑﻌﺪﻩ( ﺗﺎﺭﻳﺦ ﻭﻓﺎﺓ‬ ‫ﺃﺭﺍﺩﻫﺎ ﺍﻟﺸﺎﻋﺮ‪ .‬ﻭﰲ ﻫﺬﺍ ﺍﳌﺜﺎﻝ‪ُ ،‬ﺗ َ‬ ‫ﺍﻟﺪﻟﻨﺠﺎﻭﻱ‪:‬‬ ‫)‪= (٥+٤+٧٠+٢+٢٠٠+٧٠+٣٠٠+٣٠+١+٤٠٠+١+٤٠‬‬ ‫)‪١١٢٣‬ﻫـ(‪.‬‬ ‫ﻭﺍﺿﺢ ﺃ ﹼﻥ ﺍﺳﺘﺨﺪﺍﻡ ﻫﺬﺍ ﺍﳊﺴﺎﺏ ﰲ ﺍﻟﺘﺄﺭﻳﺦ ﻻ ﻏﺒﺎﺭ ﻋﻠﻴﻪ ﻣﻦ ﻭﺟﻬﺔ‬ ‫ﳉﻤﱠﻞ ﰲ‬ ‫ﺍﻟﻨﻈﺮ ﺍﻟﺸّﺮﻋﻴّﺔ‪ ،‬ﻷ ﹼﻥ ﺍﻷﻣﺮ ﻣﻦ ﻗﺒﻴﻞ ﺍﻻﺻﻄﻼﺣﺎﺕ‪ .‬ﺇﻻ ﺃ ﹼﻥ ﺍﺳﺘﺨﺪﺍﻡ ﺍ ﹸ‬ ‫ﺍﻟﺴّﺤﺮ‪ ،‬ﻭﺍﻟﺸﻌﻮﺫﺓ‪ ،‬ﻭﺍﻟﻜﻬﺎﻧﺔ‪ ،‬ﻭﺍﻟﺘﻨﺠﻴﻢ‪ ،‬ﺃﺳﺎﺀ ﺇﱃ ﻫﺬﺍ ﺍﳊﺴﺎﺏ ﺍﻟﱪﻱﺀ‪.‬‬ ‫ﳏﻤﺪ ﺑﻦ ﻋﻤﺮ ﻧﻮﻭﻱ ﺍﳉﺎﻭﻱ‪ ،‬ﻣﻔﺴّﺮ‪ ،‬ﻣﺘﺼﻮّﻑ‪ ،‬ﻣﻦ ﻓﻘﻬﺎﺀ ﺍﻟﺸﺎﻓﻌﻴﺔ‪،‬‬ ‫ﻫﺎﺟﺮ ﺇﱃ ﻣﻜﺔ ﺍﳌﻜﺮﻣﺔ‪ ،‬ﻭﺗﻮﰲ ﻓﻴﻬﺎ ﺳﻨﺔ ‪١٣١٦‬ﻫـ‪ ،‬ﻟﻪ ﻣﺼﻨّﻔﺎﺕ ﻛـﺜﲑﺓ‪،‬‬ ‫ﻣﻨﻬﺎ ﺗﻔﺴ ٌﲑ ﻳﺘﺄﻟﻒ ﻣﻦ ﳎﻠﺪﻳﻦ‪ ،‬ﺟﺎﺀ ﰲ ﻣﻘﺪّﻣﺘﻪ‪ " :‬ﻭﲰّﻴﺘﻪُ ﻣﻊ ﺍﳌﻮﺍﻓﻘﺔ ﻟﺘﺎﺭﳜﻪ‪:‬‬ ‫ﻣﺮﺍﺡ ﻟﺒﻴﺪ ﻟﻜﺸﻒ ﻣﻌﲎ ﻗﺮﺁﻥ ﳎﻴﺪ " ﻭﺍﺿﺢ ﻣﻦ ﻫﺬﺍ ﺍﻟﻜﻼﻡ ﺃ ﹼﻥ ﺍﳌﺆﻟﻒ ﻗـﺪ‬ ‫‪٨٣‬‬ ‫ﳉﻤّﻞ ﺗﺎﺭﻳﺦ ﺑﺪﺍﻳﺔ ﺗﺼﻨﻴﻔﻪ ﻟﻪ‪ ،‬ﻭﺍﻟـﺬﻱ‬ ‫ﺍﺧﺘﺎﺭ ﺍﺳﻢ ﺍﻟﺘﻔﺴﲑ ﻟﻴﻮﺍﻓﻖ ﰲ ﺣﺴﺎﺏ ﺍ ﹸ‬ ‫ﻫﻮ ‪١٣٠٤‬ﻫـ‪ .‬ﻭﻗﺪ ﻗﺼﺪﻧﺎ ﻬﺑﺬﺍ ﺍﳌﺜﺎﻝ ﺍﻟﺘّﻌﺮﻳﻒ ﲟﻮﻗﻒ ﺑﻌﺾ ﻋﻠﻤﺎﺀ ﺍﳌﺴﻠﻤﲔ‬ ‫ﳉﻤّﻞ ‪ ،‬ﺣﻴﺚ ﻻ ﳚﺪﻭﻥ ﻏﻀﺎﺿﺔ ﰲ ﺍﺳﺘﺨﺪﺍﻣﻪ ﻋﻨـﺪﻣﺎ‬ ‫ﻣﻦ ﻣﺴﺄﻟﺔ ﺣﺴﺎﺏ ﺍ ﹸ‬ ‫ﻳﺆﺭﺧﻮﻥ‪ ،‬ﺃﻭ ﻳﻄﻠﻘﻮﻥ ﺍﻷﲰﺎﺀ‪ ،‬ﺣﱴ ﻋﻨﺪﻣﺎ ﺗﻜﻮﻥ ﺍﻟﺘﺴﻤﻴﺔ ﻟﻜﺘﺎﺏ ﰲ ﺗﻔﺴـﲑ‬ ‫ﺍﻟﻘﺮﺁﻥ ﺍﻟﻜﺮﱘ‪ ،‬ﻭﻣﺎ ﺫﻟﻚ ﺇﻻ ﻋﻦ ﺗﻮﺍﺭﺙ‪ .‬ﻓﻠﻤﺎﺫﺍ ﻻ ﻧﻌﻴﺪ ﺍﻟﻨﻈﺮ‪ ،‬ﻭﻧﺆﺻّﻞ ﳍﺬﻩ‬ ‫ﺍﳌﺴﺄﻟﺔ‪ ،‬ﻓﻘﺪ ﻭﺟﺪﻧﺎ ﰲ ﺫﻟﻚ ﺍﳋﲑ ﺍﻟﻜﺜﲑ‪.‬‬ ‫ﺟﺎﺀ ﰲ ﺗﻔﺴﲑ ﺍﻟﺒﻴﻀﺎﻭﻱ ﻟﻔﺎﲢﺔ ﺳﻮﺭﺓ ﺍﻟﺒﻘﺮﺓ ‪ " :‬ﺃﻧﻪ ﻋﻠﻴﻪ ﺍﻟﺼـﻼﺓ‬ ‫ﻭﺍﻟﺴﻼﻡ‪ ،‬ﳌﹼﺎ ﺃﺗﺎﻩ ﺍﻟﻴﻬﻮﺩ ﺗﻼ ﻋﻠﻴﻬﻢ ﺃﱂ ﺍﻟﺒﻘﺮﺓ‪ ،‬ﻓﺤﺴﺒﻮﻩ ﻭﻗﺎﻟﻮﺍ‪ :‬ﻛﻴﻒ ﻧـﺪﺧﻞ‬ ‫ﰲ ﺩﻳﻦ ﻣ ّﺪﺗﻪ ﺇﺣﺪﻯ ﻭﺳﺒﻌﻮﻥ ﺳﻨﺔ‪ ،‬ﻓﺘﺒﺴﻢ ﺭﺳﻮﻝ ﺍﷲ‪ ،‬ﺻﻠﻰ ﺍﷲ ﻋﻠﻴﻪ ﻭﺳﻠﻢ‪.‬‬ ‫ﻓﻘﺎﻟﻮﺍ‪ :‬ﻓﻬﻞ ﻏﲑﻩ ؟ ﻓﻘﺎﻝ ‪ :‬ﺍﳌﺺ‪ ،‬ﻭﺍﻟﺮ‪ ،‬ﻭﺍﳌﺮ‪ .‬ﻓﻘﺎﻟﻮﺍ ﺧﻠﻄﺖ ﻋﻠﻴﻨﺎ ﻓﻼ ﻧﺪﺭﻱ‬ ‫ﺑﺄﻳﻬﺎ ﻧﺄﺧﺬ " ﻳﻘﻮﻝ ﺍﻟﺒﻴﻀﺎﻭﻱ ﻣﻌﻘﺒﺎﹰ ﻋﻠﻰ ﻫﺬﺍ ﺍﳊﺪﻳﺚ‪ " :‬ﻓﺈﻥ ﺗﻼﻭﺗﻪ ﺇﻳّﺎﻫﺎ‬ ‫ﻬﺑﺬﺍ ﺍﻟﺘﺮﺗﻴﺐ ﻋﻠﻴﻬﻢ‪ ،‬ﻭﺗﻘﺮﻳﺮﻫﻢ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺍﺳﺘﻨﺒﺎﻃﻬﻢ‪ ".. .‬ﺇﺫﻥ ﻳﻌﺘﱪ ﺍﻟﺒﻴﻀﺎﻭﻱ ﺃ ﹼﻥ‬ ‫ﺍﻟﺮﺳﻮﻝ‪ ،‬ﺻﻠﻰ ﺍﷲ ﻋﻠﻴﻪ ﻭﺳﻠﻢ‪ ،‬ﻗﺪ ﺃﻗ ّﺮ ﺍﻟﻴﻬﻮﺩ ﰲ ﺍﺳـﺘﻨﺒﺎﻃﻬﻢ ‪ .‬ﻭﺟـﺎﺀ ﰲ‬ ‫)ﺣﺎﺷﻴﺔ ﺍﻟﺸﻬﺎﺏ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺗﻔﺴﲑ ﺍﻟﺒﻴﻀﺎﻭﻱ(‪ " :‬ﻫﺬﺍ ﺍﳊﺪﻳﺚ ﺃﺧﺮﺟﻪ ﺍﻟﺒﺨـﺎﺭﻱ‬ ‫ﰲ ﺗﺎﺭﳜﻪ‪ ،‬ﻭﺍﺑﻦ ﺟﺮﻳﺮ‪ ،‬ﻋﻦ ﻃﺮﻳﻖ ﺍﺑﻦ ﺇﺳﺤﺎﻕ ﺍﻟﻜﻠﱯ‪ ...‬ﻭﺳﻨﺪﻩ ﺿﻌﻴﻒ"‪.‬‬ ‫ﻭﻋﻠﻴﻪ ﻻ ﻧﺴﺘﻄﻴﻊ ﺃﻥ ﻧﺮﻛﻦ ﺇﱃ ﺍﺳﺘﻨﺒﺎﻁ ﺍﻟﺒﻴﻀﺎﻭﻱ‪ ،‬ﻭﻟﻜﻦ ﰲ ﺍﳌﻘﺎﺑﻞ ﱂ ﻳﺮﺩ‬ ‫ﳉﻤﱠﻞ‬ ‫ﺷﻲﺀ ﻋﻦ ﺍﻟﺮﺳﻮﻝ‪ ،‬ﺻﻠﻰ ﺍﷲ ﻋﻠﻴﻪ ﻭﺳﻠﻢ‪ ،‬ﻳﻨﻔﻲ ﺃﻥ ﻳﻜﻮﻥ ﳊﺴﺎﺏ ﺍ ﹸ‬ ‫ﺃﺻﻞ ﺩﻳﲏ‪ ،‬ﻭﱂ ﺗﻘﻢ ﺍﳊﺠّﺔ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺍﻟﻨﻔﻲ ﺃﻭ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺍﻹﺛﺒﺎﺕ‪ ،‬ﻭﺇﻥ ﻛﺎﻥ ﺍﻹﺛﺒﺎﺕ‬ ‫ﻀﻌﻴﻒ‪ .‬ﻭﻻ ﻧﺴﺘﻄﻴﻊ ﺃﻥ ﻧﺒﲏ ﻋﻠﻰ ﻫﺬﺍ‬ ‫ﺃﺭﺟﺢ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺿﻮﺀ ﻫﺬﺍ ﺍﳊﺪﻳﺚ ﺍﻟ ّ‬ ‫ﺍﻟﺮﺟﺤﺎﻥ‪ ،‬ﻭﻟﻜﻦ ﳝﻜﻦ ﻟﻨﺎ ﺑﺎﻻﺳﺘﻘﺮﺍﺀ ﺃﻥ ﻧﺜﺒﺖ ﺑﺄ ﹼﻥ ﺍﻟﻘﺮﺁﻥ ﺍﻟﻜﺮﱘ ﻗﺪ ﺍ ّﺩﺧّﺮ‬ ‫‪٨٤‬‬ ‫ﺕ‪ ،‬ﺃﻭ ﺟُ َﻤ ٍﻞ‪ .‬ﻭﻟﺪﻳﻨﺎ ﻣﻦ ﺍﻟﺸﻮﺍﻫﺪ ﺍﻟﻘﺮﺁﻧﻴّﺔ‬ ‫ﻑ‪ ،‬ﺃﻭ ﻛﻠﻤﺎ ٍ‬ ‫ﺑﻌﺾ ﺍﻷﺳﺮﺍﺭ ﰲ ﺣﺮﻭ ٍ‬ ‫ﳉﻤﱠﻞ ﰲ ﺍﻷﻟﻔﺎﻅ ﻭﺍﻟﻌﺒﺎﺭﺍﺕ ﺍﻟﻘﺮﺁﻧﻴّﺔ‪ ،‬ﻛﻴﻒ ﻻ‪ ،‬ﻭﻗﺪ‬ ‫ﻣﺎ ﻳﺆﻛﹼﺪ ﻭﺟﻮﺩ ﺣﺴﺎﺏ ﺍ ﹸ‬ ‫ﰊ‪ .‬ﻭﻣﺎ ﺍﻟﻔﺮﻕ ﺑﲔ ﻗﻮﻟﻨﺎ‪ :‬ﺇ ﹼﻥ ﻣﻦ ﻣﻌﺎﱐ ﺍﻟﺒﺎﺀ‪،‬‬ ‫ﻧﺰﻝ ﺍﻟﻘﺮﺁﻥ ﺍﻟﻜﺮﱘ ﺑﻠﺴﺎ ٍﻥ ﻋﺮ ّ‬ ‫ﺍﻹﻟﺼﺎﻕ‪ ،‬ﻭﺍﻟﺘﺒﻌﻴﺾ‪ ،‬ﻭﻗﻮﻟﻨﺎ‪ :‬ﺇ ﹼﻥ ﻣﻦ ﻣﻌﺎﱐ ﺍﻟﺒﺎﺀ ﺍﺛﻨﺎﻥ ؟! ﻭﻟﻜﻦ ﻛﻴﻒ ﳝﻜﻨﻨﺎ‬ ‫ﺃﻥ ﻧﻌﺮﻑ ﺃ ﹼﻥ ﻋﺒﺎﺭﺓ ﻣﺎ ﰲ ﺍﻟﻘﺮﺁﻥ ﺍﻟﻜﺮﱘ ﲢﻤﻞ ﺳ ّﺮﹰﺍ ﻋﺪﺩّﻳﺎ ً؟! ﻧﻘﻮﻝ‪ :‬ﻻ ﺑﺪ ﺃﻥ‬ ‫ﻼ‪ .‬ﻭﺳﻴﺠﺪ ﺍﻟﻘﺎﺭﺉ‬ ‫ﻳَﺜﺒُﺖ ﺫﻟﻚ ﺑﻄﺮﻳﻖ ﻣﻦ ﻃﺮﻕ ﺍﻹﺛﺒﺎﺕ ﺍﳌﻘﺒﻮﻟﺔ ﺷﺮﻋﹰﺎ ﺃﻭ ﻋﻘ ﹰ‬ ‫ﺖ ﺑﺼﻠﺔ ﺇﱃ ﻣﺴﻠﻚ ﺍﳌﺘﺼﻮّﻓﺔ‪،‬‬ ‫ﺃ ﹼﻥ ﻣﺴﻠﻜﻨﺎ ﰲ ﻫﺬﻩ ﺍﳌﺴﺄﻟﺔ ﻣﺴﻠﻚ ﺟﺪﻳﺪ‪ ،‬ﻻ ﳝ ﱡ‬ ‫ﺃﻭ ﻏﲑﻫﻢ‪ ،‬ﳑﻦ ﺃﺻﺎﺑﻮﺍ ﺃﻭ ﺃﺧﻄﺄﻭﺍ‪ ،‬ﺃﻭ ﺍﳓﺮﻓﻮﺍ‪.‬‬ ‫ﳉﻤﱠﻞ ﺻِﺪﻗّﻴﺔ ﻋﻨﺪﻣﺎ ﻧﻌﻠﻢ ﺃ ﹼﻥ َﺭﺳْﻢ ﺍﻟﻘﺮﺁﻥ ﺍﻟﻜﺮﱘ‪،‬‬ ‫ﻳﻜﺘﺴﺐ ﺣﺴﺎﺏ ﺍ ﹸ‬ ‫ﻭﺍﻟﺬﻱ ﻳﺴ ّﻤﻰ ﺑﺎﻟﺮﺳﻢ ﺍﻟﻌﺜﻤﺎﱐ‪ ،‬ﻫﻮ ﺭﺳﻢ ﺗﻮﻗﻴﻔ ّﻲ‪ ،‬ﺃﻱ ﺑﺈﺷﺮﺍﻑ ﺍﻟﺮﺳﻮﻝ ﺻﻠﻰ‬ ‫ﺍﷲ ﻋﻠﻴﻪ ﻭﺳﻠﻢ ﻭﺣﻴﺎﹰ‪ ،‬ﻭﻫﺬﺍ ﻣﺎ ﻋﻠﻴﻪ ﲨﺎﻫﲑ ﺍﻟﻌﻠﻤﺎﺀ‪َ .‬ﻭَﻳﺴﻬُﻞ ﺍﻟﻴﻮﻡ ﺇﺛﺒﺎﺕ ﺫﻟﻚ‬ ‫ﺑﻌﺪ ﺍﻛﺘﺸﺎﻑ ﺑﻌﺾ ﺍﻟﺒﲎ ﺍﻟﺮّﻳﺎﺿﻴّﺔ ﺍﳌﻌﺠﺰﺓ ﻟﻠﻘﺮﺁﻥ ﺍﻟﻜﺮﱘ‪ .‬ﻭﻗﺪ ﺗﺒﲔ ﻟﻨـﺎ ﺃ ﹼﻥ‬ ‫ﳍﺬﺍ ﺍﻟﺮﺳﻢ ﺃﺳﺮﺍﺭﺍﹰ‪ ،‬ﻗﺪ ﳝﻜﻦ ﺍﻟﺘﻮﺻﻞ ﺇﻟﻴﻬﺎ ﻋﻦ ﻃﺮﻳﻖ ﺣﺴـﺎﺏ ﺍﳉﹸﻤّـﻞ‪ ،‬ﺃﻭ‬ ‫ﻏﲑﻩ‪ .‬ﻭﻟﻜﻨﻨﺎ ﺳﻨﻜﺘﻔﻲ ﻫﻨﺎ ﺑﺬﻛﺮ ﻣﺎ ﻟﻪ ﻋﻼﻗﺔ ﲟﻮﺿﻮﻉ ﻫﺬﺍ ﺍﻟﻜﺘﺎﺏ‪ ،‬ﻭﻋﻠـﻰ‬ ‫ﻭﺟﻪ ﺍﳋﺼﻮﺹ ﺍﳌﺴﺎﺋﻞ ﺍﻟﱵ ﺗﻌﻴﺪ ﺗﺄﻛﻴﺪ ﻭﺭﺳﻢ ﻣﺎ ﻭﺭﺩ ﰲ ﺍﻟﻔﺼﻮﻝ ﺍﻟﺴﺎﺑﻘﺔ‪.‬‬ ‫ﺟﺎﺀ ﰲ ﻛﺘﺎﺏ )ﺇﺳﻼﻣﻨﺎ(‪ ،‬ﻟﻠﺪﻛﺘﻮﺭ ﻣﺼﻄﻔﻰ ﺍﻟﺮﻓـﺎﻋﻲ‪ ..." :‬ﻣـﺎ‬ ‫ﺫﻛﺮﻩ ﺻﺎﺣﺐ ﻛﺘﺎﺏ ﻣﺸﺎﺭﻕ ﺃﻧﻮﺍﺭ ﺍﻟﻴﻘﲔ‪ ،‬ﺍﳊﺎﻓﻆ ﺭﺟﺐ ﺍﻟﱪﺳﻲ‪ ،‬ﻣﻦ ﺃﻧـﻪ‬ ‫ﺭﻭﻱ ﻋﻦ ﺍﺑﻦ ﻋﺒﺎﺱ‪ ،‬ﰲ ﺗﻔﺴﲑ ﻗﻮﻟﻪ ﺗﻌﺎﱃ‪َُ " :‬ﻭﻛ ﹼﻞ ﺷ ٍﺊ ﹶﻓﺼّﻠﻨﺎ ُﻩ ﺗﻔﺼـﻴﻼﹰ "‬ ‫ﻗﻮﻟﻪ‪ :‬ﻣﻌﻨﺎﻩ ﺷﺮﺣﻨﺎﻩ ﺷﺮﺣﹰﺎ ﺑﻴّﻨﹰﺎ ﲝﺴﺎﺏ ﺍﳉﹸﻤّﻞ‪٧١."...‬ﻭﻋﻠﻴﻪ ﺳـﻨﻘﻮﻡ ﻫﻨـﺎ‬ ‫‪ ٧١‬ﺻﻔﺤﺔ ‪.١٩٧‬‬ ‫‪٨٥‬‬ ‫ﺑﺎﺳﺘﻌﺮﺍﺽ ﺑﻌﺾ ﻣﺴﺎﺋﻞ ﻫﺬﺍ ﺍﳊﺴﺎﺏ‪ ،‬ﻭﻋﻠﻰ ﻭﺟﻪ ﺍﳋﺼﻮﺹ ﺍﳌﺴﺎﺋﻞ ﺍﳌﺘﻌﻠﹼﻘﺔ‬ ‫ﻬﺑﺬﺍ ﺍﻟﺒﺤﺚ‪:‬‬ ‫‪ (١‬ﺟﺎﺀ ﰲ ﺍﻵﻳﺔ ‪ ١٠٤‬ﻣﻦ ﺳﻮﺭﺓ ﺍﻹﺳﺮﺍﺀ‪ " :‬ﻭﻗﻠﻨﺎ ﻣﻦ ﺑﻌﺪ ِﻩ ﻟﺒﲏ ﺇﺳـﺮﺍﺋﻴ ﹶﻞ‬ ‫ﺍﺳﻜﻨﻮﺍ ﺍﻷﺭﺽ‪ ،‬ﻓﺈﺫﺍ ﺟﺎ َﺀ ﻭﻋ ُﺪ ﺍﻵﺧﺮﺓِ ﺟﺌﻨﺎ ﺑﻜﻢ ﻟﻔﻴﻔﹰﺎ "‪ .‬ﺳﺒﻖ ﺃﻥ ﺃﺷـﺮﻧﺎ‬ ‫ﺇﱃ ﺃ ﹼﻥ ﺗﺮﺗﻴﺐ ﻛﻠﻤﺔ )ﻟﻔﻴﻔﹰﺎ(‪ ،‬ﰲ ﺣﺎﻟﺔ ﺑﺪﺃﻧﺎ ﺍﻟﻌ ّﺪ ﻣﻦ ﺑﺪﺍﻳﺔ ﺍﻟﻜﻼﻡ ﰲ ﻧﺒـﻮﺀﺓ‬ ‫ﺍﻹﺳﺮﺍﺀ‪ ،‬ﻫﻮ ‪ .١٤٤٣‬ﻭﻗﺪ ﺗﻜﺮﺭﺕ ﲨﻠﺔ‪ " :‬ﻓﺈﺫﺍ ﺟﺎﺀ ﻭﻋﺪ ﺍﻵﺧﺮﺓ " ﻣ ّﺮﺗﺎﻥ‬ ‫ﻋﻨﺪ ﺍﳊﺪﻳﺚ ﻋﻦ ﺯﻭﺍﻝ ﺍﻹﻓﺴﺎﺩ ﺍﻟﺜﺎﱐ‪ .‬ﻭﺇﺫﺍ ﻋﻠﻤﻨﺎ ﺃ ﹼﻥ ﻛﻠﻤﺔ )ﺍﻵﺧﺮﺓ( ﺗُﻘـﺮﺃ‬ ‫ﺃﻳﻀﹰﺎ )ﺍﻻﹾﺧﺮﺓ( ﺗﻜﻮﻥ ﺍﳌﻔﺎﺟﺄﺓ ﺃ ﹼﻥ ﺟُﻤﱠﻞ‪ " :‬ﻓﺈﺫﺍ ﺟﺎﺀ ﻭﻋ ُﺪ ﺍﻻﹾﺧﺮ ِﺓ ﺟﺌﻨﺎ ﺑﻜﻢ‬ ‫ﻟﻔﻴﻔﹰﺎ " ﻫﻮ ‪ ٢٠٢٢‬ﻓﺘﺄﻣّﻞ!!‬ ‫‪ (٢‬ﻗﻠﻨﺎ ﺇ ﹼﻥ ﺗﺮﺗﻴﺐ ﻛﻠﻤﺔ )ﻟﻔﻴﻔﺎ( ﰲ ﻧﺒﻮﺀﺓ ﺳﻮﺭﺓ ﺍﻹﺳﺮﺍﺀ ﻫﻮ ‪ ،١٤٤٣‬ﻭﻗﻠﻨـﺎ‬ ‫ﺇ ﹼﻥ ﺟُﻤّﻞ‪ ) :‬ﹶﻓِﺈﺫﹶﺍ ﺟَﺎ َﺀ َﻭ ْﻋﺪُ ﺍ ﹾﻻ ِﺧ َﺮ ِﺓ ِﺟ ﹾﺌﻨَﺎ ِﺑ ﹸﻜ ْﻢ ﹶﻟﻔِﻴﻔﹰﺎ ( ﻫﻮ ‪ ،٢٠٢٢‬ﻭﻓﻖ ﻗﺮﺍﺀﺓ‬ ‫ﻭﺭﺵ ﻟﻜﻠﻤﺔ )ﺍﻻﹾﺧﺮﺓ(‪ .‬ﻭﻫﻨﺎ ﻧﺴﺄﻝ ﺃﻳﻦ ﺍﻟﻌﺎﻡ ﺍﻟﻌﱪﻱ ‪ ٥٧٨٢‬ﺍﳌﻮﺍﻓﻖ ﻟﻠﻌـﺎﻡ‬ ‫‪٢٠٢٢‬ﻡ ﻭﺍﻟﻌﺎﻡ ‪ ١٤٤٣‬ﻫـ ؟‪.‬‬ ‫ﺇ ﹼﻥ ﺗﺮﺗﻴﺐ ﻛﻠﻤﺔ ﻟﻔﻴﻔﺎ ﰲ ﺍﻟﻨﺒﻮﺀﺓ ﻫﻮ ‪،١٤٤٣‬ﻭﻫﺬﺍ ﻳﻌﲏ ﺃﻥ ﺗﺮﺗﻴﺐ ﺍﻟﻜﻠﻤﺎﺕ‬ ‫ﺍﻷﺭﺑﻊ ﺍﻟﱵ ﺗـﺄﰐ ﺑﻌـﺪ ﻟﻔﻴﻔـﺎ ﻫـﻮ‪١٤٤٧ ،١٤٤٦ ،١٤٤٥ ،١٤٤٤ :‬‬ ‫ﺤ ﱢﻖ َﻧﺰَﻝ …" ﻭﺍﳌﻔـﺎﺟﺊ ﻫﻨـﺎ ﺃ ﹼﻥ‬ ‫ﺤ ﱢﻖ ﹶﺃْﻧ َﺰﹾﻟﻨَﺎ ُﻩ َﻭﺑِﺎﹾﻟ َ‬ ‫ﻭﺍﻟﻜﻠﻤﺎﺕ ﻫﻲ‪َ " :‬ﻭﺑِﺎﹾﻟ َ‬ ‫ﳎﻤﻮﻉ ﺗﺮﺗﻴﺐ ﻫﺬﻩ ﺍﻟﻜﻠﻤﺎﺕ ﻫﻮ ‪.٥٧٨٢‬‬ ‫‪ (٣‬ﺳﺒﻖ ﺃﻥ ﻟﻔﺘﻨﺎ ﺍﻻﻧﺘﺒﺎﻩ ﺇﱃ ﺃ ﹼﻥ )‪ ٥‬ﺁﺫﺍﺭ( ﻫﻮ ﻳﻮﻡ ﺍﻛﺘﻤﺎﻝ ﺍﻟـ )‪ (٧٦‬ﺳﻨﺔ‬ ‫ﻗﻤﺮّﻳﺔ‪ ،‬ﺍﺑﺘﺪﺍ ًﺀ ﻣﻦ ‪١٩٤٨/٦/١٠‬ﻡ‪ ،‬ﻭﺍﻟﺬﻱ ﻫﻮ ﺗﺎﺭﻳﺦ ﺍﳍﺪﻧﺔ ﺍﻷﻭﱃ‪ ،‬ﻭﺑﺎﻟﺘﺎﱄ‬ ‫ﺍﻟﻘﻴﺎﻡ ﺍﻟﻔﻌﻠﻲ ﻟﺪﻭﻟﺔ ﻹﺳﺮﺍﺋﻴﻞ‪ .‬ﻭﻋﻠﻴﻪ ﺇﻟﻴﻚ ﻫﺬﻩ ﺍﳌﻼﺣﻈﺎﺕ‪:‬‬ ‫‪٨٦‬‬ ‫‪ ٥‬ﺁﺫﺍﺭ ‪٢٠٢٢‬ﻡ ﻫﻮ ﻳﻮﻡ ﺳﺒﺖ‪ .‬ﻭﺇﺫﺍ ﺑﺪﺃﻧﺎ ﺍﻟﻌ ّﺪ ﻣﻦ ﻳـﻮﻡ ‪ ٥‬ﺁﺫﺍﺭ ﺇﱃ ﻬﻧﺎﻳـﺔ‬ ‫ﺍﻟﺴﻨﺔ‪ ،‬ﻳﻜﻮﻥ ﳎﻤﻮﻉ ﻋﺪﺩ ﺍﻷﻳﺎﻡ ﻫﻮ ‪،٣٠٢‬ﻭﺍﻟﻼﻓﺖ ﻫﻨﺎ ﺃ ﹼﻥ ﻫﺬﺍ ﻫﻮ ُﺟﻤّـﻞ‬ ‫)ﺇﺳﺮﺀﻳﻞ( ﻭﻓﻖ ﺭﺳﻢ ﺍﳌﺼﺤﻒ‪.‬‬ ‫ﺟُﻤّﻞ ﺍﻟﺴﺒﺖ ‪ + ٥ +‬ﺟُﻤّﻞ ﺁﺫﺍﺭ = ‪١٤٠١‬‬ ‫‪٩٠٣ + ٥ + ٤٩٣‬‬ ‫= ‪١٤٠١‬‬ ‫ُﺟﻤّﻞ‪) :‬ﺃﻟﻔﺎﻥ ﻭﺍﺛﻨﻦ ﻭﻋﺸﺮﻭﻥ(‪١٤٠١ = ٧٢‬‬ ‫ﻭﻋﻠﻴﻪ ﻳﻜﻮﻥ ﳎﻤﻮﻉ‪) :‬ﺍﻟﺴﺒﺖ ‪ + ٥ +‬ﺁﺫﺍﺭ ‪ +‬ﺃﻟﻔﺎﻥ ﻭﺍﺛﻨﻦ ﻭﻋﺸﺮﻭﻥ( ﻫـﻮ‬ ‫ﺖ ﻋﻠـﻰ ﺍﻟـﺬﻳﻦ‬ ‫‪ ٢٨٠٢‬ﻭﻫﺬﺍ ﻫﻮ ﺟُﻤﱠﻞ ﻗﻮﻟﻪ ﺗﻌﺎﱃ‪ " :‬ﺇﻧّﻤﺎ ﺟُ ِﻌ ﹶﻞ ﺍﻟﺴّـﺒ ُ‬ ‫ﺍﺧﺘﻠﻔﻮﺍ ﻓﻴﻪ‪٧٣"...‬ﻭﻫﺬﻩ ﺁﺧﺮ ﺁﻳﺔ ﰲ ﺗﺮﺗﻴﺐ ﺍﳌﺼﺤﻒ ُﻳﺬﻛﺮ ﻓﻴﻬـﺎ ﻛﻠﻤـﺔ‬ ‫ﺴﻨﲔ ﻣﻦ ﺳﻨﺔ ﺍﻹﺳـﺮﺍﺀ ‪٦٢١‬ﻡ ﺇﱃ‬ ‫ﺴﺒﺖ‪ .‬ﻭﺍﻟﻼﻓﺖ ﰲ ﻫﺬﺍ ﺍﳌﻘﺎﻡ ﺃ ﹼﻥ ﻋﺪﺩ ﺍﻟ ّ‬ ‫ﺍﻟ ّ‬ ‫‪٢٠٢٢‬ﻡ ﻫﻮ ﺃﻳﻀﹰﺄ‪١٤٠١ = (٦٢١ – ٢٠٢٢) :‬‬ ‫‪ (٤‬ﻋﻨﺪﻣﺎ ﻧﺄﺧﺬ ﺍﻟﺘﺎﺭﻳﺦ ﺍﻟﺮﺍﺟﺢ ﻋﻨﺪ ﺍﻟﻌﻠﻤﺎﺀ‪ ،‬ﳒﺪ ﺃ ﹼﻥ ﺣﺎﺩﺛﺔ ﺍﻹﺳـﺮﺍﺀ ﻗـﺪ‬ ‫ﻭﻗﻌﺖ ﰲ ﺍﻟﻴﻮﻡ )‪ (٧٦‬ﻣﻦ ﺍﻟﺴﻨﺔ ﺍﻟﻘﻤﺮﻳّﺔ‪ .٧٤‬ﻭﻗﺪ ﻻﺣﻈﻨﺎ ﺗﻜﺮﺭ ﻫﺬﺍ ﺍﻟﻌﺪﺩ ﰲ‬ ‫ﺳﻮﺭﺓ ﺍﻹﺳﺮﺍﺀ‪ ،‬ﻭﻻ ﻧﻨﺴﻰ ﺃﻧّﻪ ﺍﻟﻌﻤﺮ ﺍﳌﺘﻮﻗﹼﻊ ﻟﺪﻭﻟﺔ ﺇﺳﺮﺍﺋﻴﻞ‪ .‬ﻭﻓﺎﺟﺄﺗﻨﺎ ﺍﻵﻳﺔ ‪٧٦‬‬ ‫ﻋﻨﺪﻣﺎ ﺩﺭﺳﻨﺎ ﺍﻟﻜﻠﻤﺎﺕ ﺍﳌﺸﺘﻘﹼﺔ ﻣﻦ ﺍﳉﺬﺭ ﻓﺰﺯ‪ .‬ﻭﺇﻟﻴﻚ ﺍﻵﻥ ﻫﺬﻩ ﺍﳌﻔﺎﺟﺄﺓ‪:‬‬ ‫ُﻋﺮّﻑ ﺍﳌﺴﺠﺪ ﺍﻷﻗﺼﻰ ﰲ ﺍﻟﻘﺮﺁﻥ ﺍﻟﻜﺮﱘ ﺑـ‪ " :‬ﺍﻟﺬﻱ ﺑﺮﻛﻨﺎ ﺣﻮﻟﻪ " ﻭ ُﺟﻤﱠﻞ‬ ‫ﻫﺬﻩ ﺍﻟﻌﺒﺎﺭﺓ ﻭﻓﻖ ﺭﲰﻬﺎ ﺍﻟﻌﺜﻤﺎﱐ ﻫﻮ ‪ ١٠٦٣‬ﻓﻤﺎ ﻫﻲ ﺍﻟﻜﻠﻤﺔ ﺍﻟﱵ ﺗﺮﺗﻴﺒﻬﺎ ﺑﲔ‬ ‫‪ ٧٢‬وردت آﻠﻤﺔ )اﺛﻨﺎن( ﻓﻲ اﻟﻘﺮﺁن اﻟﻜﺮیﻢ أیﻀ ًﺎ ﺑﺪون أﻟﻒ هﻜﺬا )اﺛﻨﻦ(‪.‬‬ ‫‪٧٣‬‬ ‫ﺍﻟﻨﺤﻞ‪ .١٢٤ :‬ﺭﺍﺟﻊ ﺑﺎﺏ ﺍﻟﺴﺒﻮﺕ ﺑﻌﺪ ﻗﻠﻴﻞ‪.‬‬ ‫‪٧٤‬‬ ‫ﺃﻱ ‪ ١٧‬ﺭﺑﻴﻊ ﺃﻭﻝ‪.‬‬ ‫‪٨٧‬‬ ‫ﻛﻠﻤﺎﺕ ﺳﻮﺭﺓ ﺍﻹﺳﺮﺍﺀ ‪ ١٠٦٣‬؟‪:‬‬ ‫ﺃ( ﺇﻧّﻬﺎ ﻛﻠﻤﺔ )ﻳﻠﺒﺜﻮﻥ(‪ ،‬ﻭﺍﻟﻠﺒﺚ ﻳﺘﻌﻠﹼﻖ ﺑﺎﻟﺰﻣﻦ‪.‬‬ ‫ﺏ( ﺍﻟﻼﻓﺖ ﺃ ﹼﻥ ﻫﺬﻩ ﺍﻟﻜﻠﻤﺔ ﻭﺭﺩﺕ ﰲ ﺍﻵﻳﺔ ‪ ٧٦‬ﻣﻦ ﺳﻮﺭﺓ ﺍﻹﺳﺮﺍﺀ‪.‬‬ ‫ﺝ( ﺟُﻤﱠﻞ )ﻳﻠﺒﺜﻮﻥ( ﻫﻮ ‪ ٥٩٨‬ﻓﻤﺎﺫﺍ ﻟﻮ ﺃﺿﻔﻨﺎ ﺇﻟﻴﻪ ‪ ١٠٦٣‬؟‬ ‫‪٧٥‬‬ ‫)‪ ١٦٦١ = (١٠٦٣+٥٩٨‬ﻭﺍﳌﻔﺎﺟﺄﺓ ﻫﻨﺎ ﺃ ﹼﻥ ﻫﺬﺍ ﻫﻮﺍﻟﻌﺪﺩ ‪ ١٤٤٣‬ﻣﻀﺎﻓﹰﺎ‬ ‫ﺇﻟﻴﻪ ﺟُﻤﱠﻞ ﻛﻠﻤﺔ )ﻫﺠﺮﻱ(‪ ١٦٦١ = (٢١٨+١٤٤٣) :‬ﻓﺘﺄﻣّﻞ!!‬ ‫‪ (٥‬ﺃﺳﻘﻂ ﺍﻷﺷﻮﺭﻳّﻮﻥ ﺩﻭﻟﺔ ﺇﺳﺮﺍﺋﻴﻞ ﺳﻨﺔ ‪٧٢٢‬ﻕ‪.‬ﻡ‪ ،‬ﻭﺑﺎﻟﺘﺎﱄ ﱂ ﻳﺒﻖ ﰲ ﺫﻟﻚ‬ ‫ﺍﻟﻌﺎﻡ ﺇﻻ ﺩﻭﻟﺔ ﻳﻬﻮﺫﺍ‪ ،‬ﻭﺍﻟﱵ ﺍﺳﺘﻤﺮ ﻭﺟﻮﺩﻫﺎ ﺣﱴ ﺳـﻨﺔ ‪٥٨٦‬ﻕ‪.‬ﻡ‪ .‬ﻭﻋﻨـﺪ‬ ‫ﺳﻘﻮﻁ ﺩﻭﻟﺔ ﺇﺳﺮﺍﺋﻴﻞ ﻛﺎﻥ ﺗﺮﺗﻴﺐ ﺍﳌﻠﻚ ﻫﻮ ‪ ١٩‬ﻭﺍﲰﻪ )ﻫﻮﺷﻊ(‪ .٧٦‬ﻭﻋﻨـﺪ‬ ‫ﺳﻘﻮﻁ ﻳﻬﻮﺫﺍ ﻛﺎﻥ ﺗﺮﺗﻴﺐ ﺍﳌﻠﻚ ﺃﻳﻀﹰﺎ ‪ ١٩‬ﻭﺍﲰﻪ )ﺻِﺪﻗِﻴّﺎ(‪ .‬ﻭﺇﻟﻴـﻚ ﻫـﺬﻩ‬ ‫ﺍﳌﻔﺎﺟﺄﺓ‪:‬‬ ‫ﺃ( ﺟُﻤﱠﻞ ﻛﻠﻤﺔ ﻳﻬﻮﺫﺍ ﻫﻮ ‪ ٧٢٢‬ﻭﻻ ﻧﻨﺴﻰ ﺃﻧّﻬﺎ ﺍﻟﺪﻭﻟﺔ ﺍﻟﱵ ﺑﻘﻴﺖ ﺑﻌﺪ ﺍﻟﻌـﺎﻡ‬ ‫‪٧٢٢‬ﻕ‪.‬ﻡ‪.‬‬ ‫ﺏ( ﺑﺴﻘﻮﻁ ﺩﻭﻟﺔ ﺇﺳﺮﺍﺋﻴﻞ ﺯﺍﻝ ﺍﻹﻓﺴﺎﺩ ﺍﻷﻭﻝ ﺟُﺰﺋﻴّـﺎﹰ‪ ،‬ﻭﺍﻛﺘﻤـﻞ ﺍﻟـﺰﻭﺍﻝ‬ ‫ﺻﺪﻗﻴّﺎ( ﻫﻮ‬ ‫ﺑﺴﻘﻮﻁ ﺩﻭﻟﺔ ﻳﻬﻮﺫﺍ ‪٥٨٦‬ﻕ‪.‬ﻡ‪ .‬ﻭﺍﻟﻼﻓﺖ ﻫﻨﺎ ﺃ ﹼﻥ ﺟُﻤﱠﻞ )ﻫﻮﺷﻊ ‪ِ +‬‬ ‫‪ ٥٨٦‬ﻓﺘﺄﻣّﻞ!!‬ ‫‪ (٦‬ﺳﻮﺭﺓ ﺍﻹﺳﺮﺍﺀ ﻫﻲ ﺍﻟﺴّﻮﺭﺓ ﺍﻟﱵ ﺗﺘﺤﺪﺙ ﻋﻦ ﻧﺒﻮﺀﺓ ﻭﻋﺪ ﺍﻵﺧﺮﺓ‪ ،‬ﻭﻛﺄﻬﻧﺎ‬ ‫ﺳﻮﺭﺓ ﺍﻟﻮﻋﺪ‪ ،‬ﻭﻗﺪ ﻟﻔﺖ ﺍﻧﺘﺒﺎﻫﻨﺎ ﺃ ﹼﻥ ﺟُﻤﱠﻞ ﻛﻠﻤﺔ )ﺍﻟﻮﻋﺪ( ﻫﻮ )‪ (١١١‬ﻭﻫـﺬﺍ‬ ‫‪٧٥‬‬ ‫‪٧٦‬‬ ‫ﺃﻱ ﻧﻀﻴﻒ ﺇﱃ ﺟُﻤﱠﻞ ﺍﻟﻜﻠﻤﺔ ﺗﺮﺗﻴﺒﻬﺎ ﰲ ﺍﻟﺴﻮﺭﺓ‪ .‬ﻭﻫﺬﺍ ﻣﺴﻠﻚ ﻳﺘﻜﺮﺭ ﻛﺜﲑﹰﺍ ﰲ ﲝﻮﺛﻨﺎ ﺍﻟﻌﺪﺩﻳﺔ‪.‬‬ ‫ﻛﻞ ﻣﻨﻬﻤﺎ ﻫﻮ ‪.١٩‬‬ ‫ﺍﳌﻘﺼﻮﺩ ﺃ ﹼﻥ ﻋﺪﺩ ﺍﳌﻠﻮﻙ ﻣﻦ ﺑﺪﺍﻳﺔ ﺍﻧﺸﻘﺎﻕ ﺍﻟﺪﻭﻟﺘﲔ ﺇﱃ ﺯﻭﺍﻝ ًّ‬ ‫‪٨٨‬‬ ‫ﻋﺪﺩ ﺁﻳﺎﺕ ﺳﻮﺭﺓ ﺍﻹﺳﺮﺍﺀ‪.‬‬ ‫‪٨٩‬‬ ‫ﺍﻟﺴّﺒﻮﺕ‬ ‫ﺍﻟﺴّﺒﺖ ﰲ ﺍﻟﻴﻬﻮﺩﻳّﺔ‪:‬‬ ‫ﺟﺎﺀ ﰲ ﺳﻔﺮ )ﺍﻟﻼﻭﻳﲔ(‪ ،‬ﺍﻹﺻﺤﺎﺡ )‪" : (٢٥‬ﻭﻗﺎﻝ ﺍﻟﺮﺏ ﳌﻮﺳﻰ ﰲ ﺟﺒـﻞ‬ ‫ﺳﻴﻨﺎﺀ‪ :‬ﺃﻭﺹ ﺑﲏ ﺇﺳﺮﺍﺋﻴﻞ‪ :‬ﻣﱴ ﺟﺌﺘﻢ ﺇﱃ ﺍﻷﺭﺽ ﺍﻟﱵ ﺃﻫﺒﻜﻢ‪ ،‬ﻻ ﺗﺰﺭﻋﻮﻫﺎ ﰲ‬ ‫ﺍﻟﺴﻨﺔ ﺍﻟﺴﺎﺑﻌﺔ‪ ،‬ﺍﺯﺭﻉ ﺣﻘﻠﻚ ﺳﺖ ﺳﻨﻮﺍﺕ‪ ،‬ﻭﻗﹼﻠﻢ ﻛﺮﻣﻚ ﺳـﺖ ﺳـﻨﻮﺍﺕ‪،‬‬ ‫ﻭﺍﲨﻊ ﻏﻠﺘﻬﻤﺎ‪ .‬ﻭﺃﻣﺎ ﺍﻟﺴﻨﺔ ﺍﻟﺴﺎﺑﻌﺔ ﻓﻔﻴﻬﺎ ﺗﺮﻳﺢ ﺍﻷﺭﺽ ﻭﺗﻌﻄﻠﻬﺎ ﺳﺒﺘﹰﺎ ﻟﻠﺮﺏ‪،‬‬ ‫ﻻ ﺗﺰﺭﻉ ﻓﻴﻬﺎ ﺣﻘﻠﻚ‪ ،‬ﻭﻻ ُﺗﻘﹼﻠﻢ ﻛﺮﻣﻚ‪ .‬ﻻ ﲢﺼﺪ ﺯﺭﻋﻚ ﺍﻟﺬﻱ ﳕﺎ ﺑﻨﻔﺴـﻪ‪،‬‬ ‫ﻭﻻ ﺗﻘﻄﻒ ﻋﻨﺐ ﻛﺮﻣﻚ ﺍ ﹸﳌﺤْﻮﻝ‪ ،‬ﺑﻞ ﻳﻜﻮﻥ ﺳﻨﺔ ﺭﺍﺣ ٍﺔ ﻟـﻸﺭﺽ " ﻭﺑﻌـﺪ‬ ‫ﺗﻔﺼﻴﻞ ﺃﺣﻜﺎﻡ ﺷﺮﻳﻌﺔ ﺍﻟﺴﻨﺔ ﺍﻟﺴﺎﺑﻌﺔ ﻫﺬﻩ‪ ،‬ﻳﻘﻮﻝ ﰲ ﺍﻹﺻـﺤﺎﺡ )‪..." :(٢٦‬‬ ‫ﻭﻟﻜﻦ ﺇﻥ ﻋﺼﻴﺘﻤﻮﱐ ﻭﱂ ﺗﻌﻤﻠﻮﺍ ﺑﻜﻞ ﻫﺬﻩ ﺍﻟﻮﺻﺎﻳﺎ‪ ،‬ﻭﺇﻥ ﺗﻨ ﹼﻜﺮﰎ ﻟﻔﺮﺍﺋﻀـﻲ‬ ‫ﻭﻛﺮﻫﺘﻢ ﺃﺣﻜﺎﻣﻲ‪ ،‬ﻭﱂ ﺗﻌﻤﻠﻮﺍ ﺑﻜﻞ ﻭﺻﺎﻳﺎﻱ‪ ،‬ﺑﻞ ﻧﻜﺜﺘﻢ ﻣﻴﺜﺎﻗﻲ‪ ،‬ﻓﺈﱐ ﺍﺑﺘﻠﻴﻜﻢ‬ ‫ﺑﺎﻟﺮﻋﺐ ﺍﳌﻔﺎﺟﺊ‪ ...‬ﺃﹸﺷﺘﺘﻜﻢ ﺑﲔ ﺍﻟﺸﻌﻮﺏ‪ ،‬ﻭﺃ َﺟ ّﺮ ُﺩ ﻋﻠﻴﻜﻢ ﺳﻴﻔﻲ ﻭﺃﹸﻻﺣﻘﻜﻢ‪،‬‬ ‫ﻭﺃﹸﺣ ّﻮﻝ ﺃﺭﺿﻜﻢ ﺇﱃ ﻗﻔﺮ‪ ،‬ﻭﻣﺪﻧﻜﻢ ﺇﱃ ﺧﺮﺍﺋﺐ‪ .‬ﻋﻨﺪﺋﺬٍ ﺗﺴﺘﻮﰲ ﺍﻷﺭﺽ ﺭﺍﺣﺔ‬ ‫ﺳﺒﻮﻬﺗﺎ ﻃﻮﺍﻝ ﺳﻨﲔ ﻭﺣﺸﺘﻬﺎ ﻭﺃﻧﺘﻢ ﻣﺸﺘﺘﻮﻥ ﰲ ﺩﻳﺎﺭ ﺃﻋﺪﺍﺋﻜﻢ‪ .‬ﺣﻴﻨﺌ ٍﺬ ﺗﺮﺗـﺎﺡ‬ ‫ﺍﻷﺭﺽ‪ ،‬ﻭﺗﺴﺘﻮﰲ ﺳﻨﲔ ﺳﺒﻮﻬﺗﺎ‪ ،‬ﻓﺘﻌ ّﻮﺽ ﰲ ﺃﻳﺎﻡ ﻭﺣﺸﺘﻬﺎ ﻋﻦ ﺭﺍﺣﺘﻬﺎ ﺍﻟﱵ ﱂ‬ ‫‪٩٠‬‬ ‫ﺗﻨﻌﻢ ﻬﺑﺎ ﰲ ﺳﻨﻮﺍﺕ ﺳﺒﻮﺗﻜﻢ ﻋﻨﺪﻣﺎ ﻛﻨﺘﻢ ﺗُﻘﻴﻤﻮﻥ ﻋﻠﻴﻬﺎ‪...‬‬ ‫"‪.٧٧‬‬ ‫ﻭﺟﺎﺀ ﰲ ﺳﻔﺮ )ﺃﺧﺒﺎﺭ ﺍﻷﻳﺎﻡ ﺍﻟﺜﺎﱐ( ﺍﻹﺻﺤﺎﺡ )‪ ..." :(٣٦‬ﻭﺳـﱮ‬ ‫ﻧﺒﻮﺧﺬ ﻧﺼّﺮ ﺍﻟﺬﻳﻦ ﳒﻮﺍ ﻣﻦ ﺍﻟﺴﻴﻒ ﺇﱃ ﺑﺎﺑﻞ‪ ،‬ﻓﺄﺻﺒﺤﻮﺍ ﻋﺒﻴﺪﺍﹰ ﻟﻪ ﻭﻷﺑﻨﺎﺋـﻪ ﺇﱃ‬ ‫ﺃﻥ ﻗﺎﻣﺖ ﳑﻠﻜﺔ ﻓﺎﺭﺱ‪ .‬ﻭﺫﻟﻚ ﻟﻜﻲ ﻳﺘﻢ ﻛﻼﻡ ﺍﻟﺮﺏ ﺍﻟﺬﻱ ﻧﻄﻖ ﺑﻪ ﻋﻠﻰ ﻟﺴﺎﻥ‬ ‫ﺇﺭﻣﻴﺎ؛ ﺣﱴ ﺗﺴﺘﻮﰲ ﺍﻷﺭﺽ ﺳﺒﻮﻬﺗﺎ‪ ،‬ﺇﺫ ﺃﻬﻧﺎ ﺑﻘﻴﺖ ﻣﻦ ﻏﲑ ﺇﻧﺘﺎﺝ ﻛـﻞ ﺃﻳـﺎﻡ‬ ‫ﺧﺮﺍﻬﺑﺎ ﺣﱴ ﺍﻧﻘﻀﺎﺀ ﺳﺒﻌﲔ ﺳﻨﺔ "‪ .٧٨‬ﻭﻭﺭﺩﺕ ﻫﺬﻩ ﺍﻟﻌﺒﺎﺭﺓ ﺑﺼﻴﻐﺔ ﺃﺧـﺮﻯ‪:‬‬ ‫"‪...‬ﺣﱴ ﺍﺳﺘﻮﻓﺖ ﺍﻷﺭﺽ ﺳﺒﻮﻬﺗﺎ‪ ،‬ﻷﻬﻧﺎ ﺳﺒﺘﺖ ﰲ ﻛﻞ ﺃﻳﺎﻡ ﺧﺮﺍﻬﺑﺎ‪ ،‬ﻹﻛﻤـﺎﻝ‬ ‫ﺳﺒﻌﲔ ﺳﻨﺔ "‬ ‫‪.٧٩‬‬ ‫ﺴﺒﺖ ﰲ ﺍﻟﻘﺮﺁﻥ ﺍﻟﻜﺮﱘ‪:‬‬ ‫ﺍﻟ ّ‬ ‫ﺴﺒﻮﺕ ﰲ ﺍﻟ ﹼﺬﺍﻛﺮﺓ ﺍﻟﻴﻬﻮﺩّﻳﺔ ﺑﺎﻟﺰﻭﺍﻝ‪ ،‬ﻭﻋﻠﻰ ﻭﺟﻪ ﺍﳋﺼﻮﺹ ﲟـﺎ‬ ‫ﺍﺭﺗﺒﻂ ﺍﻟ ّ‬ ‫ﻳﺘﻌﻠﻖ ﺑﺎﻷﺭﺽ ﺍﳌﻘﺪّﺳﺔ‪ ،‬ﻭﻗﺪ ﻭﺟﺪﻧﺎ ﺃ ﹼﻥ ﺑﻌﻀﻬﻢ ﻳﻌﺘﻘﺪ ﺑﺄ ﹼﻥ ﺍﻟﺪﻧﻴﺎ ﺳـﺘﺰﻭﻝ ﰲ‬ ‫ﺍﻟﻌﺎﻡ )‪ (٦٠٠٠‬ﻋﱪﻱ‪ ،‬ﻭﻫﺬﺍ ﻷﻥ ﺍﻷﻟﹾﻒ ﺍﻟﺴﺎﺑﻌﺔ ﺗﻌﲏ ﺍﻟﺰﻭﺍﻝ‪ .‬ﻭﺧﻼﺻﺔ ﺍﻷﻣﺮ‬ ‫ﺴﺒﻮﺕ ﻟﻪ ﻋﻼﻗﺔ ﺑﺎﻟﻌﺪﺩ )‪ .(٧‬ﻭﻭﺍﺿﺢ ﰲ ﺍﻟﻘـﺮﺁﻥ ﺍﻟﻜـﺮﱘ ﺃ ﹼﻥ ﺷـﺮﻳﻌﺔ‬ ‫ﺃ ﹼﻥ ﺍﻟ ّ‬ ‫ﺴﺒﺖ ﳍﺎ ﻭﺟﻮﺩ ﰲ ﺩﻳﻦ ﻣﻮﺳﻰ ﻋﻠﻴﻪ ﺍﻟﺴﻼﻡ‪ ،‬ﺑﻐﺾ ﺍﻟﻨﻈﺮ ﻋﻦ ﺍﻟﺘﻔﺼـﻴﻼﺕ‪.‬‬ ‫ﺍﻟ ّ‬ ‫ﺴﺒﺖ( ﺗﻜﺮﺭﺕ ﰲ ﺍﻟﻘﺮﺁﻥ ﺍﻟﻜﺮﱘ )‪ (٥‬ﻣـﺮّﺍﺕ‪،‬‬ ‫ﻭﳑﺎ ﻳﻠﻔﺖ ﺍﻟﻨﻈﺮ ﺃ ﹼﻥ ﻛﻠﻤﺔ )ﺍﻟ ّ‬ ‫‪ ٧٧‬ﺍﻟﻜﺘﺎﺏ ﺍﳌﻘﺪﺱ ‪ -‬ﻛﺘﺎﺏ ﺍﳊﻴﺎﺓ ‪ -‬ﺗﺮﲨﺔ ﺗﻔﺴﲑﻳﺔ ‪ -‬ﺹ ‪ ١٦٣‬ﻭﺹ ‪.١٦٦‬‬ ‫‪ ٧٨‬ﺍﳌﺮﺟﻊ ﺍﻟﺴﺎﺑﻖ ‪.‬‬ ‫‪ ٧٩‬ﺍﻟﻜﺘﺎﺏ ﺍﳌﻘﺪﺱ ‪ -‬ﲨﻌﻴﺎﺕ ﺍﻟﻜﺘﺎﺏ ﺍﳌﻘﺪﺱ ﺍﳌﺘﺤﺪﺓ ‪ - ١٩٤٦‬ﺍﳌﻄﺒﻌﺔ ﺍﻷﻣﺮﻳﻜﺎﻧﻴﺔ ‪ -‬ﺑﲑﻭﺕ ﺻﻔﺤﺔ ‪.٤٤٥‬‬ ‫‪٩١‬‬ ‫ﻭﺇﺫﺍ ﺃﺿﻴﻒ ﺇﻟﻴﻬﺎ ﻛﻠﻤﱵ )ﺳﺒﺘﻬﻢ‪ ،‬ﻳﺴﺒﺘﻮﻥ(‪ ،‬ﻳﻜﻮﻥ ﺍﺠﻤﻟﻤـﻮﻉ ‪ ٧‬ﻣـﺮّﺍﺕ‪.‬‬ ‫ﻭﻳﻠﻔﺖ ﺍﻟﻨﻈﺮ ﺃﻳﻀﹰﺎ ﺃ ﹼﻥ ‪ ٣‬ﻛﻠﻤﺎﺕ ﻣﻨﻬﺎ ﻭﻫﻲ‪) :‬ﺍﻟﺴﺒﺖ‪ ،‬ﺳﺒﺘﻬﻢ‪ ،‬ﻳﺴـﺒﺘﻮﻥ(‪،‬‬ ‫ﻭﺭﺩﺕ ﰲ ﺍﻟﺴّﻮﺭﺓ ﺍﻟﱵ ﺗﺮﺗﻴﺒﻬﺎ ﰲ ﺍﳌﺼﺤﻒ ‪ ٨٠.٧‬ﻭﺃ ﹼﻥ ﺁﺧﺮ ِﺫﻛـﺮ ﻟﻜﻠﻤـﺔ‬ ‫ﺴﺒﺖ ﰲ ﺍﻟﻘﺮﺁﻥ ﺍﻟﻜﺮﱘ ﺗﺮِﺩ ﰲ ﺍﻵﻳﺔ ‪ ١٢٤‬ﻣﻦ ﺳﻮﺭﺓ ﺍﻟﻨﺤﻞ‪ ،‬ﺃﻱ ﰲ ﺧﻮﺍﺗﻴﻢ‬ ‫ﺍﻟ ّ‬ ‫ﺍﻟﺴﻮﺭﺓ ﺍﻟﱵ ﺗﺴﺒﻖ ﺳﻮﺭﺓ ﺍﻹﺳﺮﺍﺀ‪.‬‬ ‫ﺍﻟﺴّﺒﻮﺕ ﰲ ﺍﻟﺘﺎﺭﻳﺦ‪:‬‬ ‫ﰲ ﻛﻞ ُﺳﺒﻮﺕ ﺗﻜﻮﻥ ﻗﺪ ﻣﻀﺖ ‪ ٧‬ﺳﻨﻮﺍﺕ‪ .‬ﻓﻜﻢ ﺗﺰﻳﺪ ﺍﻟﺸﻤﺴّﻴﺔ ﻓﻴﻬﺎ ﻋـﻦ‬ ‫ﺍﻟﻘﻤﺮّﻳﺔ ؟ ﺍﻟﻼﻓﺖ ﻟﻼﻧﺘﺒﺎﻩ ﺃﻬﻧﺎ ﺗﺰﻳﺪ ‪ ٧٦‬ﻳﻮﻣﹰﺎ‪ .‬ﻭﻫﺬﺍ ُﻳﺬ ﹼﻛﺮﻧﺎ ﺑـﺎﻟﺮﻗﻢ ‪ ٧٦‬ﰲ‬ ‫ﺳﻮﺭﺓ ﺍﻹﺳﺮﺍﺀ‪ ،‬ﻭﻋﻠﻰ ﻭﺟﻪ ﺍﳋﺼﻮﺹ ﺍﻵﻳﺔ ‪ ٧٦‬ﺍﻟﱵ ﺗﺘﺤﺪﺙ ﻋﻦ ﺍﻹﺧـﺮﺍﺝ‪.‬‬ ‫ﺃﻣﺎ ﺍﻵﻳﺔ ‪ ٧٧‬ﻓﻬﻲ ﺗﻨﺺ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺃ ﹼﻥ ﻣﺎ ﺫﻛﺮ ﰲ ﺍﻵﻳﺔ ‪ ٧٦‬ﻫﻮ ﺳُـﻨﱠﺔ ﰲ ﺍﳌﺎﺿـﻲ‬ ‫ﻭﺍﳌﺴﺘﻘﺒﻞ‪ .‬ﻭﺍﻟﻼﻓﺖ ﺃ ﹼﻥ ﻋﺪﺩ ﻛﻠﻤﺎﻬﺗﺎ ﻫﻮ ‪ ١١‬ﻛﻠﻤﺔ‪ .‬ﻭﻋﻠﻴﻪ‪= (١١÷٧٧) :‬‬ ‫‪ .٧‬ﻭﻳﻠﺤﻆ ﺃ ﹼﻥ ﻋﺪﺩ ﺍﻟﻜﻠﻤﺎﺕ ﻣﻦ ﺍﻵﻳﺔ )‪ (١٢٤‬ﻣﻦ ﺳﻮﺭﺓ ﺍﻟﻨﺤﻞ‪ ،‬ﻭﺍﻟﱵ ﻫﻲ‬ ‫ﺁﺧﺮ ﺁﻳﺔ ﰲ ﺗﺮﺗﻴﺐ ﺍﳌﺼﺤﻒ ﻳﺬﻛﺮ ﻓﻴﻬﺎ ﺍﻟﺴﺒﺖ‪ ،‬ﻭﺣﱴ ﻗﻮﻟﻪ ﺗﻌﺎﱃ ﻣﻦ ﺳﻮﺭﺓ‬ ‫ﺍﻹﺳﺮﺍﺀ‪ " :‬ﻭﺁﺗﻴﻨﺎ ﻣﻮﺳﻰ ﺍﻟﻜﺘﺎﺏ‪ "...‬ﻫﻮﺃﻳﻀﹰﺎ )‪ (٧٧‬ﻛﻠﻤﺔ‪.‬‬ ‫ﻟﻘﺪ ﺭﺃﻳﻨﺎ ﺃﻥ ﻧﺘﺨﺬ ﻣﻦ ﺍﻟﺮﻗﻢ ‪ ٧‬ﻭﺣﺪﺓ ﺭﻳﺎﺿﻴّﺔ‪ ،‬ﻓﻮﺟـﺪﻧﺎ ﺃ ﹼﻥ ﳍـﺬﺍ‬ ‫ﺍﻟﻌﺪﺩ ﻋﻼﻗﺔ ﺑﺘﺎﺭﻳﺦ ﺍﻷﺭﺽ ﺍﳌﻘ ّﺪﺳﺔ‪ .‬ﻭﺍﳌﺪﻫﺶ ﺃﻥ ﳒﺪ ﳍﺬﺍ ﻛﻠﻪ ﻋﻼﻗﺔ ﲜُﻤﱠﻞ‬ ‫‪ ٨٠‬ﺍﻷﻋﺮﺍﻑ‪.١٦٣ :‬‬ ‫‪٩٢‬‬ ‫ﺍﻟﻜﻠﻤﺎﺕ ﻭﺍﻟﻌﺒﺎﺭﺍﺕ ﺍﻵﺗﻴﺔ‪) :‬ﺍﳌﺴﺠﺪ ﺍﳊﺮﺍﻡ‪ ،‬ﺍﳌﺴﺠﺪ ﺍﻷﻗﺼﻰ‪ ،‬ﺑﻨﻮﺍ ﺇﺳﺮﺀﻳﻞ‪،‬‬ ‫ﺴﺒﺖ‪ ،‬ﺍﻹﺳﺮﺍﺀ(‪ .‬ﻭﺑﻌﺾ ﻫﺬﻩ ﺍﻟﻜﻠﻤﺎﺕ‬ ‫ﺑﲏ ﺇﺳﺮﺀﻳﻞ‪ ،‬ﺑﲏ ﺇﺳﺮﺍﺀﻳﻞ‪ ،‬ﺇﺳﺮﺀﻳﻞ‪ ،‬ﺍﻟ ّ‬ ‫ﳜﺘﻠﻒ ﻟﻔﻈﻬﺎ ﻋﻦ ﻛﺘﺎﺑﺘﻬﺎ‪ ،‬ﻭﻓﻖ ﺭﺳﻢ ﺍﳌﺼﺤﻒ ﺍﻟﻌﺜﻤﺎﱐ‪ .‬ﻓﻜﻠﻤﺔ )ﺇﺳـﺮﺍﺋﻴﻞ(‬ ‫ﺗﻜﺘﺐ ﰲ ﺍﳌﺼﺤﻒ )ﺇﺳﺮﺀﻳﻞ( ﻭﺍﻻﺧﺘﻼﻑ ﻫﺬﺍ ﻳـﺆﺩّﻱ ﺇﱃ ﺍﻻﺧـﺘﻼﻑ ﰲ‬ ‫ﺴﺒﻮﺕ ﰲ ‪ ١٣‬ﺳـﻨﺔ‬ ‫ﺍﻟﻘﻴﻤﺔ ﺍﻟﻌﺪﺩﻳّﺔ ﻟﻠﻜﻠﻤﺔ‪ .‬ﻭﳚﺪﺭ ﺃﺧﲑﹰﺍ ﻣﻼﺣﻈﺔ ﺃ ﹼﻥ ﻋﺪﺩ ﺍﻟ ّ‬ ‫ﻼ‪ ،‬ﻫﻮ ﺳﺒﻮﺕ ﻭﺍﺣﺪ‪ ،‬ﻛﻤﺎ ﻫﻮ ﰲ ﺍﻟـ ‪ ٧‬ﺳﻨﻮﺍﺕ‪ ،‬ﺣﱴ ﺗﻜﺘﻤﻞ ‪ ١٤‬ﺳـﻨﺔ‬ ‫ﻣﺜ ﹰ‬ ‫ﻭﻫﻜﺬﺍ‪...‬‬ ‫ﳉ ّﻤﻞ ﻫﻲ ‪،٣٦٥‬‬ ‫ﺍﻟﻘﻴﻤﺔ ﺍﻟﻌﺪﺩّﻳﺔ ﻟﻌﺒﺎﺭﺓ‪) :‬ﺑﲏ ﺇﺳﺮﺍﺀﻳﻞ( ﻭﻓﻖ ﺣﺴﺎﺏ ﺍ ﹸ‬ ‫ﺴﻨﺔ ﺍﻟﺸﻤﺴّﻴﺔ‪ .‬ﻭﻟﻜﻦ ﻭﻓﻖ ﺍﻟ ّﺮﺳﻢ ﺍﻟﻌﺜﻤﺎﱐ ﻟﻠﻤﺼـﺤﻒ‬ ‫ﻭﻫﺬﺍ ﻫﻮ ﻋﺪﺩ ﺃﻳﺎﻡ ﺍﻟ ّ‬ ‫ﺗﻨﻘﺺ )ﺃﻟﻔﹰﺎ(‪ ،‬ﻫﻜﺬﺍ‪) :‬ﺑﲏ ﺇﺳﺮﺀﻳﻞ( ﻓﺘﺼﺒﺢ ﺍﻟﻘﻴﻤﺔ ﺍﻟﻌﺪﺩّﻳﺔ )‪ .(٣٦٤‬ﺃ ّﻣﺎ ﻋﺒﺎﺭﺓ‬ ‫)ﺑﻨﻮ ﺇﺳﺮﺍﺀﻳﻞ( ﻓﻘﻴﻤﺘﻬﺎ ﺍﻟﻌﺪﺩّﻳﺔ )‪ .(٣٦١‬ﻭﻻ ﲣﺘﻠﻒ ﻫﺬﻩ ﺍﻟﻘﻴﻤﺔ ﰲ ﺍﻟ ّﺮﺳـﻢ‬ ‫ﺍﻟﻘﺮﺁﱐ‪ ،‬ﻷ ﹼﻥ ﺍﻷﻟﻒ ﺍﻟﱵ ﺣُﺬﻓﺖ ﻣﻦ ﻛﻠﻤﺔ )ﺇﺳﺮﺀﻳﻞ( ﺃﹰﺿـﻴﻔﺖ ﺇﱃ ﻛﻠﻤـﺔ‬ ‫)ﺑﻨﻮﺍ(‪ ،‬ﻓﺘﻜﺘﺐ ﻫﻜﺬﺍ‪) :‬ﺑﻨﻮﺍ ﺇﺳﺮﺀﻳﻞ(‪ ،‬ﻭﻋﻠﻴﻪ ﻳﻜﻮﻥ ﺍﺠﻤﻟﻤﻮﻉ ﺃﻳﻀـﹰﺎ )‪(٣٦١‬‬ ‫ﻭﻫﺬﺍ ﻫﻮ )‪ .(١٩×١٩‬ﻭﺍﻟﻼﻓﺖ ﻫﻨﺎ ﺃ ﹼﻥ ﺍﻟﻘﻴﻤﺔ ﺍﻟﻌﺪﺩّﻳﺔ ﻟﻌﺒـﺎﺭﺓ‪) :‬ﺍﳌﺴـﺠﺪ‬ ‫ﺍﻻﻗﺼﺎ( ﻭﻓﻖ ﺍﻟﺮﺳﻢ ﺍﻟﻌﺜﻤﺎﱐ‪ ،‬ﻫﻲ ﺃﻳﻀﹰﺎ )‪ (٣٦١‬ﻣﻊ ﻣﻼﺣﻈﺔ ﺃ ﹼﻥ ﺍﳌﺴـﺠﺪ‬ ‫ﺍﻷﻗﺼﻰﱂ ﻳﺬﻛﺮ ﰲ ﺍﻟﻘﺮﺁﻥ ﺍﻟﻜﺮﱘ ﺇﻻ ﰲ ﺳﻮﺭﺓ ﺍﻹﺳﺮﺍﺀ‪ ،‬ﻭﺍﻟﱵ ﺗﺴﻤﻰ ﺃﻳﻀـﹰﺎ‬ ‫ﺳﻮﺭﺓ )ﺑﲏ ﺇﺳﺮﺍﺋﻴﻞ(‪ ،‬ﻭﻣﻦ ﻏﲑ ﺇﺿﺎﻓﺔ )ﺑﻨﻮﺍ ﺇﺳﺮﺍﺀﻳﻞ(!! ﻭﺍﻟﻘﻴﻤـﺔ ﺍﻟﻌﺪﺩﻳّـﺔ‬ ‫ﻟﻜﻠﻤﺔ )ﺇﺳﺮﺀﻳﻞ( ﻭﻓﻖ ﺍﻟﺮﺳﻢ ﺍﻟﻌﺜﻤﺎﱐ ﻫﻲ )‪ .(٣٠٢‬ﰲ ﺣـﲔ ﺃ ﹼﻥ ﺍﻟﻘﻴﻤـﺔ‬ ‫ﺍﻟﻌﺪﺩّﻳﺔ ﻟﻜﻠﻤﺔ )ﺍﻟﺴﺒﺖ( ﻫﻲ )‪ ،(٤٩٣‬ﺃ ّﻣﺎ ﺍﻟﻘﻴﻤﺔ ﺍﻟﻌﺪﺩﻳﺔ ﻟﻌﺒﺎﺭﺓ )ﺍﳌﺴـﺠﺪ‬ ‫ﺍﳊﺮﺍﻡ( ﻓﻬﻲ )‪ (٤١٨‬ﻭﻫﺬﺍ ﻫﻮ )‪ .(٢٢×١٩‬ﻭﻋﻠﻴﻪ ﻳﻜﻮﻥ ﳎﻤـﻮﻉ ﺟُﻤﱡـﻞ‪:‬‬ ‫‪٩٣‬‬ ‫)ﺍﳌﺴﺠﺪ ﺍﻷﻗﺼﺎ ‪ +‬ﺍﳌﺴﺠﺪ ﺍﳊﺮﺍﻡ( ﻫﻮ )‪ (٧٧٩‬ﺃﻱ )‪.(٤١×١٩‬‬ ‫ﻛﺎﻥ ﻓﻨﺎﺀ ﺍﳌ ّﺮﺓ ﺍﻷﻭﱃ ﺑﺎﻟﻜﺎﻣﻞ ﺳـﻨﺔ ‪ ٥٨٦‬ﻕ‪.‬ﻡ‪ ،٨١‬ﺇﺫ ﹼﰎ ﺩﺧـﻮﻝ‬ ‫ﺍﻟﻘﺪﺱ ﻭﺗﺪﻣﲑ ﺍﳍﻴﻜﻞ‪ ،‬ﻛﻤﺎ ﺳﺒﻖ ﻭﺃﺳﻠﻔﻨﺎ‪ .‬ﺃ ّﻣﺎ ﺣﺼﻮﻝ ﺍﳌﺮﺓ ﺍﻟﺜﺎﻧﻴﺔ ﻓﻜـﺎﻥ‪،‬‬ ‫ﻛﻤﺎ ﺗﻘ ّﺪﻡ‪ ،‬ﻋﻠﻰ ﻣﺮﺣﻠﺘﲔ؛ ﺍﳌﺮﺣﻠﺔ ﺍﻷﻭﱃ ﺳﻨﺔ ‪١٩٤٨‬ﻡ‪ ،‬ﻭﺍﳌﺮﺣﻠـﺔ ﺍﻟﺜﺎﻧﻴـﺔ‬ ‫ﺑﺪﺧﻮﻝ ﺍﻟﻘﺪﺱ ﺳﻨﺔ ‪١٩٦٧‬ﻡ‪ .‬ﻭﺳﺒﻖ ﺃﻥ ﺃﺷﺮﻧﺎ ﺇﱃ ﺃ ﹼﻥ ﻗﻴﺎﻡ ﺇﺳﺮﺍﺋﻴﻞ ﺍﳉﹸﺰﺋـﻲ‬ ‫ﻛﺎﻥ ﰲ ‪١٩٤٨/٦/١٠‬ﻡ ﻭﻫﻮ ﺗﺎﺭﻳﺦ ﺍﳍﺪﻧﺔ ﺍﻷﻭﱃ‪ .‬ﻭﻛﺎﻧﺖ ﻫﺪﻧـﺔ ‪١٩٦٧‬ﻡ‬ ‫ﺑﺘﺎﺭﻳﺦ ‪ ٦/١٠‬ﺃﻳﻀﹰﺎ‪ .٨٢‬ﻓﺈﺫﺍ ﻋﺮﻓﻨﺎ ﺃ ﹼﻥ ﺗﺪﻣﲑ ﺍﳍﻴﻜﻞ ﺍﻷﻭﻝ ﻭﺍﳍﻴﻜﻞ ﻭﺍﻟﺜـﺎﱐ‬ ‫ﻛﺎﻥ ﰲ ‪ ٨‬ﺁﺏ ﻋﺎﻡ ‪ ٥٨٦‬ﻕ‪.‬ﻡ ﺃﺩﺭﻛﻨـﺎ ﺃ ﹼﻥ ﺗـﺎﺭﻳﺦ )‪ (٦/١٠‬ﰲ ﺍﻟﻌـﺎﻣﲔ‬ ‫)‪١٩٤٨‬ﻡ ‪١٩٦٧ ،‬ﻡ( ﳚﻌﻞ ﺃﻱ ﲨﻊ ﻟﻠﺴﻨﲔ ﻣﻦ )‪ ٥٨٦‬ﻕ‪ .‬ﻡ ‪١٩٤٨ -‬ﻡ(‬ ‫ﻭﻣﻦ )‪ ٥٨٦‬ﻕ‪.‬ﻡ ‪١٩٦٧ -‬ﻡ( ﻳﻨﻘﺺ ﻋﻦ ﺍﻻﻛﺘﻤﺎﻝ ﺷﻬﺮﻳﻦ‪ .‬ﻭﻋﻠﻴﻪ ﳒـﺪ ﺃ ﹼﻥ‬ ‫ﺴﺒﻮﺕ ﺑﲔ )‪ ٥٨٦‬ﻕ‪١٩٤٨ - .‬ﻡ( ﻫﻮ ‪ ٣٦١‬ﺳﺒﻮﺗﺎﹰ‪ ،‬ﻭﻫﺬﺍ ﻫﻮ ُﺟﻤﱠﻞ‬ ‫ﻋﺪﺩ ﺍﻟ ّ‬ ‫)ﺑﻨﻮﺍ ﺇﺳﺮﺀﻳﻞ( ﻭ ُﺟﻤﱠﻞ )ﺍﳌﺴﺠﺪ ﺍﻷﻗﺼﺎ( ﻭﻓﻖ ﺭﺳﻢ ﺍﳌﺼـﺤﻒ‪ .‬ﻭﺃ ﹼﻥ ﻋـﺪﺩ‬ ‫ﺴﺒﻮﺕ ﺑﲔ )‪ ٥٨٦‬ﻕ‪.‬ﻡ ‪ ١٩٦٧ -‬ﻡ( ﻫﻮ )‪ (٣٦٤‬ﻭﻫﺬﺍ ﻫﻮ ُﺟﻤﱠﻞ )ﺑـﲏ‬ ‫ﺍﻟ ّ‬ ‫ﺴﺒﻮﺕ ﺭﻗﻢ‬ ‫ﺇﺳﺮﺀﻳﻞ( ﻭﻓﻖ ﺭﺳﻢ ﺍﳌﺼﺤﻒ‪ .‬ﻭﺑﻌﺪ ﺩﺧﻮﻝ ﺍﻟﻴﻬﻮﺩ ﺍﻟﻘﺪﺱ ﻛﺎﻥ ﺍﻟ ّ‬ ‫)‪ (٣٦٥‬ﻭﻫﺬﺍ ﻫﻮ ﺟُﻤﱠﻞ )ﺑﲏ ﺇﺳﺮﺍﺀﻳﻞ( ﻭﻓﻖ ﺍﻟﻠﻔﻆ‪ ،‬ﻭﺑﺬﻟﻚ ﺍﻛﺘﻤﻠـﺖ ﺩﻭﺭﺓ‬ ‫ﻓﻠﻜﻴﺔ‪.٨٣‬‬ ‫ﺩ ّﻣﺮ ﺍﻷﺷﻮﺭﻳﻮﻥ ﳑﻠﻜﺔ ﺇﺳﺮﺍﺋﻴﻞ ﺳﻨﺔ )‪ ٧٢٢‬ﻕ‪.‬ﻡ(‪ ،‬ﻭﺩ ّﻣﺮ ﺍﻟﻜﻠﺪﺍﻧﻴﻮﻥ‬ ‫‪ ٨١‬ﺭﺍﺟﻊ ﺍﻟﻔﺼﻞ ﺍﻷﻭﻝ ﻭﻛﺬﻟﻚ ﺍﻟﻔﺼﻞ ﺍﻟﺜﺎﱐ‪.‬‬ ‫‪٨٢‬‬ ‫)‪١٩ = (١٩٤٨ -١٩٦٧‬‬ ‫‪ ٨٣‬ﻷﻥ )‪ (٣٦٥‬ﻫﻮ ﻋﺪﺩ ﺍﳌﺮﺍﺕ ﺍﻟﱵ ﺗﺪﻭﺭﻫﺎ ﺍﻷﺭﺽ ﺣﻮﻝ ﻧﻔﺴﻬﺎ ﰲ ﺍﻟﻮﻗﺖ ﺍﻟﺬﻱ ﺗﻜﻮﻥ ﻓﻴﻪ ﻗﺪ ﺩﺍﺭﺕ ﺣﻮﻝ ﺍﻟﺸﻤﺲ‬ ‫ﻣﺮ ﹰﺓ ﻭﺍﺣﺪﺓ‪.‬‬ ‫‪٩٤‬‬ ‫ﳑﻠﻜﺔ ﻳﻬﻮﺫﺍ ﺳﻨﺔ )‪ ٥٨٦‬ﻕ‪.‬ﻡ(‪ ،‬ﺃﻱ ﺃ ﹼﻥ ُﻋﻤﺮ ﳑﻠﻜﺔ )ﻳﻬﻮﺫﺍ( ﺍﻣﺘ ّﺪ ﺃﻛﺜـﺮ ﲟـﺎ‬ ‫ﻳﻘﺎﺭﺏ ﺍﻟـ )‪ (١٣٦‬ﺳﻨﺔ‪ ،‬ﻭﰲ ﻫﺬﻩ ﺍﳌﺪّﺓ ﻫﻨﺎﻙ )‪ (١٩‬ﺳﺒﻮﺗﺎﹰ‪.‬‬ ‫ﺍﻟﻠﻐﺔ ﺍﺻﻄﻼﺡ ﺑﺸﺮﻱ‪ ٨٤،‬ﻭﻗﺪ ﻧﺰﻟﺖ ﺍﻟ ّﺮﺳـﺎﻻﺕ ﺑﻠﻐـﺎﺕ ﺍﻷﻗـﻮﺍﻡ‬ ‫ﺍﳌﺨﺘﻠﻔﺔ‪ .‬ﻭﻧﺮﻯ ﺃ ﹼﻥ ﺍﻟﺘﺄﺭﻳﺦ ﺑﺎﳍﺠﺮﻱ‪ ،‬ﺃﻭ ﺑﺎﳌﻴﻼﺩﻱ‪ ،‬ﻫﻮ ﺃﻳﻀـﹰﺎ ﻣـﻦ ﻗﺒﻴـﻞ‬ ‫ﻼ ﺇ ﹼﻥ ﻫﺬﺍ ﺍﻟﻌﺎﻡ ﻫﻮ ‪ ١٩٩٣‬ﺑﻌﺪ ﻣﻴﻼﺩ ﺍﳌﺴﻴﺢ‪ ،‬ﻓـﺈ ﹼﻥ‬ ‫ﺍﻻﺻﻄﻼﺡ؛ ﻓﺈﺫﺍ ﻗﻴﻞ ﻣﺜ ﹼ‬ ‫ﺫﻟﻚ ﻻ ﻳﻌﲏ ﺃﻧﻨﺎ ﳒﺰﻡ ﺑﺄﻥ ﺍﳌﺴﻴﺢ ﻋﻠﻴﻪ ﺍﻟﺴﻼﻡ ﻗﺪ ﻭﻟﺪ ﻗﺒـﻞ ‪١٩٩٣‬ﺳـﻨﺔ‪،‬‬ ‫ﻭﻟﻜﻨﻨﺎ ﺗﻮﺍﻃﺄﻧﺎ ﻋﻠﻰ ﻫﺬﺍ ﺍﻻﺻﻄﻼﺡ‪ ،‬ﺍﻟﺬﻱ ﻗﺪ ﻳﻜﻮﻥ ﻭﺍﻗﻌﻴﺎﹰ‪ ،‬ﻭﻗﺪ ﻻ ﻳﻜﻮﻥ‪.‬‬ ‫ﻭﻋﻠﻰ ﺍﻟ ﱡﺮﻏﻢ ﻣﻦ ﺫﻟﻚ ﻓﺈ ﹼﻥ ﺍﺟﺘﻤﺎﻋﻨﺎ ﻋﻠﻰ ﻫـﺬﺍ ﺍﻟﺘـﺄﺭﻳﺦ ﳚﻌﻠـﻪ ﻣﻌﺘﻤـﺪﹰﺍ‬ ‫ﻭﺻﺤﻴﺤﹰﺎ‪،‬ﻛﻤﺎ ﻫﻲ ﺍﻟﻠﻐﺔ‪.‬‬ ‫ﺟﺎﺀ ﰲ ﻛﺘﺎﺏ )ﺍﷲ ﻭﺍﻹﻧﺒﻴﺎﺀ ﰲ ﺍﻟﺘّﻮﺭﺍﺓ ﻭﺍﻟﻌﻬﺪ ﺍﻟﻘﺪﱘ(‪ ..." :‬ﻭﻳﻨﺘﻬﻲ‬ ‫ﺍﻟﺪﻛﺘﻮﺭ )ﻣﻮﺭﻳﺲ ﺑﻮﻛﺎﻱ( ﺇﱃ ﺗﺄﻳﻴﺪ ﻓﺮﺿﻪ ﺑﺄ ﹼﻥ ﻓﺮﻋﻮﻥ ﺍﳋﺮﻭﺝ ﻫﻮ )ﻣﻨﺒﺘﺎﺡ(‬ ‫ﺍﺑﻦ ﺭﻣﺴﻴﺲ ﺍﻟﺜﺎﱐ‪ .‬ﻭﲟﺎ ﺃ ﹼﻥ ﻣﻨﺒﺘﺎﺡ ﺗﺴّﻨﻢ ﻋﺮﺵ ﻣﺼـﺮ ﺳـﻨﺔ ‪ ١٢٢٤‬ﻕ‪ .‬ﻡ‪،‬‬ ‫ﻭﺣﻜﻢ ﻣﺼﺮ ﳌﺪﺓ ﻋﺸﺮ ﺳﻨﻮﺍﺕ ﰲ ﺃﺣﺪ ﺍﻷﻗﻮﺍﻝ‪ ،‬ﻭﻋﺸﺮﻳﻦ ﻋﺎﻣﹰﺎ ﰲ ﻗﻮ ٍﻝ ﺛﺎﻥٍ‪،‬‬ ‫ﻓﺈﻥ ﺳﻨﺔ ﺍﳋﺮﻭﺝ ﺇ ّﻣﺎ ﺃﻥ ﺗﻜﻮﻥ ﺳـﻨﺔ )‪ ١٢١٤‬ﻕ‪.‬ﻡ( ﺃﻭ )‪ ١٢٠٤‬ﻕ‪ .‬ﻡ( "‬ ‫‪٨٥‬‬ ‫ﻭﻋﻠﻰ ﺿﻮﺀ ﻣﺎ ﺳﻠﻒ ﺇﻟﻴﻚ ﻫﺬﻩ ﺍﳌﻼﺣﻈﺎﺕ‪:‬‬ ‫‪ ١٢٠٤‬ﻕ‪.‬ﻡ ﻛﺎﻥ ﺍﳋﺮﻭﺝ ﻣﻦ ﻣﺼﺮ‪.٨٦‬‬ ‫‪ ٩٥٣‬ﻕ‪.‬ﻡ ﻛﺎﻧﺖ ﻭﻓﺎﺓ ﺳﻠﻴﻤﺎﻥ ﻋﻠﻴﻪ ﺍﻟﺴﻼﻡ‪.‬‬ ‫‪ ٨٤‬ﻫﻨﺎﻙ ﻣﻦ ﺍﻟﻌﻠﻤﺎﺀ ﻣﻦ ﻳﺮﻯ ﺃ ﹼﻥ ﺍﻟﻠﻐﺔ ﺍﻟﻌﺮﺑﻴّﺔ ﺗﻮﻗﻴﻔﻴّﺔ‪ ،‬ﻭﳓﻦ ﻫﻨﺎ ﻻ ﻧﻘﺼﺪ ﺃﻥ ﻧﺮﺟّﺢ ﻗﻮﻻ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺁﺧﺮ‪.‬‬ ‫‪ ٨٥‬ﺍﷲ ﻭﺍﻷﻧﺒﻴﺎﺀ ﰲ ﺍﻟﺘﻮﺭﺍﺓ ﻭﺍﻟﻌﻬﺪ ﺍﻟﻘﺪﱘ ‪ -‬ﺩ‪ .‬ﳏﻤﺪ ﻋﻠﻲ ﺍﻟﺒﺎﺭ ‪ -‬ﻁ‪١٩٩٠ - ١‬ﻡ ‪ -‬ﺍﻟﺪﺍﺭ ﺍﻟﺸﺎﻣﻴﺔ – ﺑﲑﻭﺕ‪ ،‬ﻭﺩﺍﺭ‬ ‫ﺍﻟﻘﻠﻢ ‪ -‬ﺩﻣﺸﻖ ﺹ‪.٢٢٩‬‬ ‫‪ ٨٦‬ﻣﻊ ﻣﻼﺣﻈﺔ ﺃﻧﻪ ﺃﺣﺪ ﺍﺣﺘﻤﺎﻟﲔ‪.‬‬ ‫‪٩٥‬‬ ‫ﺸﻤﺎﻟﻴﺔ‪.‬‬ ‫‪ ٧٢٢‬ﻕ‪.‬ﻡ ﻛﺎﻥ ﺗﺪﻣﲑ ﺩﻭﻟﺔ ﺇﺳﺮﺍﺋﻴﻞ ﺍﻟ ّ‬ ‫‪ ٥٨٦‬ﻕ‪.‬ﻡ ﻛﺎﻥ ﺗﺪﻣﲑ ﺩﻭﻟﺔ ﻳﻬﻮﺫﺍ ﺍﳉﻨﻮﺑﻴﺔ‪.‬‬ ‫‪١٩٤٨‬ﻡ ﻭ ‪١٩٦٧‬ﻡ ﻭ ‪٢٠٢٢‬ﻡ ﻫﻲ ﺳﻨﻮﺍﺕ‪ :‬ﻗﻴـﺎﻡ ﺇﺳـﺮﺍﺋﻴﻞ‪ ،‬ﹼﰒ ﺩﺧـﻮﻝ‬ ‫ﺍﻟﻘﺪﺱ‪ ،‬ﹼﰒ ﺍﻟﺰﻭﺍﻝ ﺍﳌﺘﻮﹼﻗﻊ ﺗﻮﹼﻗﻌﹰﺎ ﺭﺍﺟﺤﹰﺎ‪ .‬ﻭﺍﻟﻼﻓﺖ ﻟﻼﻧﺘﺒﺎﻩ ﻓﻴﻤﺎ ﺳﻠﻒ ﺃ ﹼﻥ‪:‬‬ ‫ﺴﻨﲔ ﺍﻟﻌﱪّﻳﺔ ﻗﺒﻞ ﻋﺎﻡ ‪١٢٠٤‬ﻕ‪.‬ﻡ ﻳﺴﺎﻭﻱ‪ ٣٦٥‬ﺳـﺒﻮﺗﹰﺎ‪ ،‬ﻭﻫـﺬﺍ‬ ‫ﺃ( ﻋﺪﺩ ﺍﻟ ّ‬ ‫ﻳﺴﺎﻭﻱ ﺩﻭﺭﺓ ﻓﻠﻜﻴّﺔ ﻭﺍﺣﺪﺓ ﻟﻸﺭﺽ ﺣﻮﻝ ﺍﻟﺸﻤﺲ‪.‬‬ ‫ﺏ( ﻣﻦ ﺍﻟﻌﺎﻡ ‪ ١٢٠٤‬ﻕ‪.‬ﻡ ﺇﱃ ﺍﻟﻌـﺎﻡ ‪ ٩٣٥‬ﻕ‪.‬ﻡ ﻫﻨـﺎﻙ ‪ ٣٨‬ﺳـﺒﻮﺗﹰﺎ‪ ،‬ﺃﻱ‬ ‫)‪.(٢×١٩‬‬ ‫ﺝ( ﻣﻦ ﺯﻭﺍﻝ ﺍﻟ ّﺪﻭﻟﺔ ﺍﻷﻭﱃ ﻋﺎﻡ ‪ ٧٢٢‬ﻕ‪.‬ﻡ ﺇﱃ ﺯﻭﺍﻝ ﺍﻟﺪﻭﻟﺔ ﺍﻟﺜﺎﻧﻴـﺔ ﻋـﺎﻡ‬ ‫‪ ٥٨٦‬ﻕ‪.‬ﻡ ﻫﻨﺎﻙ )‪ (١٩‬ﺳﺒﻮﺗﺎ‪.‬‬ ‫ﺩ( ﻣﻦ ﺯﻭﺍﻝ ﺍﳌ ّﺮﺓ ﺍﻷﻭﱃ ‪ ٥٨٦‬ﻕ‪.‬ﻡ ﺇﱃ ﻗﻴﺎﻡ ﺍﳌﺮﺓ ﺍﻟﺜﺎﻧﻴـﺔ ‪١٩٤٨‬ﻡ ﻫﻨـﺎﻙ‬ ‫‪ ٣٦١‬ﺳﺒﻮﺗﺎﹰ‪ .‬ﺃﻱ )‪(١٩×١٩‬‬ ‫‪.٨٧‬‬ ‫ﻫـ( ﻣﻦ ﺍﳋﺮﻭﺝ ﻋﺎﻡ ‪ ٥٨٦‬ﻕ‪.‬ﻡ ﺇﱃ ﺍﻟﻌﻮﺩﺓ ﻋـﺎﻡ ‪١٩٦٧‬ﻡ ﻫﻨـﺎﻙ ‪٣٦٤‬‬ ‫ﺳﺒﻮﺗﺎﹰ‪ .‬ﻭﻫﺬﺍ ﻛﻤﺎ ﺃﺳﻠﻔﻨﺎ ﺟُﻤﱠﻞ )ﺑﲏ ﺇﺳﺮﺀﻳﻞ(‪ ،‬ﻭﻓﻖ ﺭﺳﻢ ﺍﳌﺼﺤﻒ‪.‬‬ ‫ﺴﺒﻮﺕ ﺭﻗﻢ )‪ (٣٦٥‬ﻳﻜﻮﻥ ﺑﻌﺪ ﺩﺧﻮﻝ ﺍﻟﻘﺪﺱ‪ ،‬ﻭﺑﺬﻟﻚ ﺗﻜﺘﻤـﻞ ﺩﻭﺭﺓ‬ ‫ﻭ( ﺍﻟ ّ‬ ‫ﺴﺒﻮﺕ ﻗﺒﻞ ﺗﺎﺭﻳﺦ ﺍﳋﺮﻭﺝ ﻣﻦ‬ ‫ﻓﻠﻜﻴّﺔ ﻭﺍﺣﺪﺓ ﻣﻦ ﺍﻟﺴّﺒﻮﺕ‪ .‬ﻭﻫﻮ ﺍﻟﻌﺪﺩ ﻧﻔﺴﻪ ﻟﻠ ّ‬ ‫ﻣﺼﺮ‪ ،‬ﻛﻤﺎ ﻭﺭﺩ ﰲ ﺍﻟﺒﻨﺪ ﺃ‪ .‬ﻭﻫﻮ ﺟُﻤﱠﻞ )ﺑﲏ ﺇﺳﺮﺍﺀﻳﻞ(‪ ،‬ﻭﻓﻖ ﺍﻟﻠﻔﻆ‪.‬‬ ‫ﺴﺒﻮﺕ ﻣﻦ ﻭﻓﺎﺓ ﺳﻠﻴﻤﺎﻥ ﻋﻠﻴﻪ ﺍﻟﺴـﻼﻡ ‪٩٣٥‬ﻕ‪.‬ﻡ‬ ‫ﺯ( ﻋﺪﺩ ﺍﻟ ّ‬ ‫ﺇﱃ ﺍﻟﺰﻭﺍﻝ ﺍﳌﺘﻮﻗﻊ ﻋـﺎﻡ ‪٢٠٢٢‬ﻡ ﻫـﻮ )‪ .(٤٢٢‬ﻭﻋـﺪﺩ‬ ‫‪ ٨٧‬ﺭﺍﺟﻊ ﺍﻟﺼﻔﺤﺎﺕ ﺍﻟﻘﻠﻴﻠﺔ ﺍﻟﺴﺎﺑﻘﺔ‪.‬‬ ‫‪٩٦‬‬ ‫ﺴﺒﻮﺕ ﻣﻦ ﺑﺪﺍﻳﺔ ﺍﻟﺘﺄﺭﻳﺦ )ﺍﻟﻌﱪﻱ( ﺣـﱴ ﺗـﺎﺭﻳﺦ ﻭﻓـﺎﺓ‬ ‫ﺍﻟ ّ‬ ‫ﺳﻠﻴﻤﺎﻥ ﻋﻠﻴﻪ ﺍﻟﺴﻼﻡ ﻫﻮ )‪ (٤٠٣‬ﺳﺒﻮﺗﺎﹰ‪ ،‬ﻭﻋﻠﻴـﻪ ﻳﻜـﻮﻥ‬ ‫ﺍﻟﻔﺮﻕ ‪١٩‬ﺳﺒﻮﺗﺎﹰ‪.‬‬ ‫ﺡ( ﻋﺪﺩ ﺍﻟﺴّﺒﻮﺕ ﻣﻦ ﻭﻓﺎﺓ ﺳﻠﻴﻤﺎﻥ ﻋﻠﻴﻪ ﺍﻟﺴّﻼﻡ ‪ ٩٣٥‬ﻕ‪.‬ﻡ ﺇﱃ ‪٢٠٢٢‬ﻡ ﻫﻮ‬ ‫‪ ،٤٢٢‬ﻓﻤﺎ ﻫﻮ ﻫﺬﺍ ﺍﻟﻌﺪﺩ ؟!‬ ‫ﺇﺫﺍ ﲨﻌﻨﺎ ﺗﺮﺗﻴﺐ ﺳﻮﺭﺓ ﺍﻹﺳﺮﺍﺀ‪ ،‬ﺇﱃ ﻋﺪﺩ ﺁﻳﺎﻬﺗﺎ‪ ،‬ﺇﱃ ﺟُﻤّﻞ ﺍﲰﻬـﺎ‪ ،‬ﻳﻜـﻮﻥ‬ ‫ﺍﻟﻨﺎﺗﺞ‪ + ١٧ ) :‬ﺍﻹﺳﺮﺍﺀ ‪. ٤٢٢ = (١١١ + ٢٩٤‬‬ ‫ﻁ( ﺍﻟﻌﺎﻡ ‪٢٠٢٢‬ﻡ ﻳﻮﺍﻓﻖ ﺍﻟﻌﺎﻡ ﺍﻟﻌﱪﻱ ‪ .٥٧٨٢‬ﻭﻗﺪ ﻭﺟﺪﻧﺎ ﺃ ﹼﻥ ﻋﺪﺩ ﺍﻟﺴّﺒﻮﺕ‬ ‫ﺣﱴ ﻫﺬﺍ ﺍﻟﻌﺎﻡ ﻫﻮ‪ ٨٢٦ = (٧ ÷ ٥٧٨٢) :‬ﻭﻣﻌﻠﻮﻡ ﺃ ﹼﻥ ﺍﻟﺴﺒﻮﺕ ﻓﻴﻪ ﻣﻌـﲎ‬ ‫ﺍﻻﻧﻘﻄﺎﻉ‪ .‬ﻭﺍﳌﻔﺎﺟﺊ ﻫﻨﺎ ﺃ ﹼﻥ ُﺟﻤّﻞ )ﺳﺒﺖ ﺑﲏ ﺇﺳﺮﺀﻳﻞ( ﻫﻮ ﺃﻳﻀﹰﺎ ‪.٨٢٦‬‬ ‫ﻱ( ﰲ ﺍﻟﻌﺎﻡ ‪١٩٦٩‬ﻡ ﺍﻛﺘﻤﻠﺖ ﺩﻭﺭﺓ ﻓﻠﻜﻴـﺔ ﻣـﻦ ﺍﻟﺴـﺒﻮﺕ‪ ،‬ﺃﻱ )‪(٣٦٥‬‬ ‫ﺳﺒﻮﺗﺎﹰ‪ ،‬ﺍﺑﺘﺪﺍ ًﺀ ﻣﻦ ﺯﻭﺍﻝ ﺍﻟ ّﺪﻭﻟﺔ ﺍﻷﻭﱃ ﻭﺍﳋﺮﻭﺝ ﻣﻦ ﺍﻟﻘﺪﺱ‪ .‬ﻭﰲ ﻫﺬﺍ ﺍﻟﻌـﺎﻡ‬ ‫ﺴﻨﲔ ﳝﺜـﻞ‬ ‫ﻳﺼﺎﺩﻑ ﺍﻟﻌﺎﻡ ﺍﻟﻌﱪﻱ )‪ (٥٧٣٠‬ﻭﺍﻟﻼﻓﺖ ﻫﻨﺎ ﺃ ﹼﻥ ﻫﺬﺍ ﺍﻟﻌﺪﺩ ﻣﻦ ﺍﻟ ّ‬ ‫ﻓﺘﺮﺓ ﻧﺼﻒ ﺍﻟﻌﻤﺮ ﻟﻠﻜﺮﺑﻮﻥ ‪ ،٨٨١٤‬ﻭﺍﻟﺬﻱ ﻳُﺴﺘﺨﺪﻡ ﻣﻦ ِﻗﺒﻞ ﻋﻠﻤﺎﺀ ﺍﻵﺛـﺎﺭ‬ ‫ﻟﺘﺤﺪﻳﺪ ﻋﻤﺮ ﺍﻹﻧﺴﺎﻧﻴّﺔ‪ ،‬ﻭﺍﳊﻀﺎﺭﺍﺕ ﺍﻟﺒﺸﺮّﻳﺔ‪ .‬ﻭﻳﻘﻊ ﻫﺬﺍ ﺍﻟﻌـﺎﻡ ﰲ ﺍﻟـﺪّﻭﺭﺓ‬ ‫‪ ٣٠٢‬ﻟﻠﻌﺪﺩ ‪ ٨٩.١٩‬ﻭﺍﻟﻌﺪﺩ )‪ (٣٠٢‬ﻫﻮ ﺟُﻤﱠﻞ ﻛﻠﻤﺔ )ﺇﺳﺮﺀﻳﻞ( ﻭﻓﻖ ﺍﻟﺮﺳﻢ‬ ‫‪٨٨‬‬ ‫ﺹ ‪Physics - Principles and Problems - James T. Murphy ٤٩٧‬‬ ‫‪Charles E. Merril Publishing Co.‬‬ ‫‪ ٨٩‬ﻛﻞ ‪ ١٩‬ﺳﻨﺔ ﻫﻨﺎﻙ ﺩﻭﺭﺓ ﻓﻠﻜﻴّﺔ ﺗﺴﻤّﻰ ﺍﻟﺪّﻭﺭﺓ ﺍﳋﺴﻮﻓّﻴﺔ‪ ،‬ﻭﺍﻟﺪﻭﺭﺓ ﺭﻗﻢ ‪ ٣٠٢‬ﺗﺒﺪﺃ ‪ ٥٧١٩‬ﻭﺗﻨﺘﻬﻲ ‪٥٧٣٨‬‬ ‫ﻭﺑﺆﺭﺓ ﺍﻟﺪﻭﺭﺓ ﻫﻲ ﺍﻟﻌﺎﻡ ‪ .٥٧٢٩‬ﻭﻫﺬﺍ ﻳﻮﺍﻓﻖ ﻋﺎﻡ ‪١٩٦٩‬ﻡ‪ ،‬ﺍﻟﺬﻱ ﻳﻮﺍﻓﻖ ﺃﻳﻀﹰﺎ ‪٥٧٣٠‬‬ ‫‪٩٧‬‬ ‫ﺍﻟﻌﺜﻤﺎﱐ‪ .‬ﺃﻱ ﺃ ﹼﻥ ﺩﻭﻟﺔ ﺇﺳﺮﺍﺋﻴﻞ ﺍﺣﺘﻠﺖ ﺍﻟﻘﺪﺱ ﰲ ﺍﻟﺪّﻭﺭﺓ ﺇﺳﺮﺀﻳﻞ ﻟﻠﻌﺪﺩ ‪١٩‬‬ ‫ﳉ ﱠﻤﻞ ﻫﻲ )‪ ،(٩٥‬ﻭﻋﻠﻴﻪ‪:‬‬ ‫ﻙ( ﻗﻴﻤﺔ ﻛﻠﻤﺔ )ﻣﻴﻼﺩﻱ( ﰲ ﺍ ﹸ‬ ‫)‪ + ٢٠٢٢‬ﻣﻴﻼﺩﻱ ‪ ٢١١٧ = ( ٩٥‬ﻭﰲ ﻫﺬﺍ ﺍﻟﻌﺪﺩ )‪ (٣٠٢‬ﺳﺒﻮﺕ‪ .‬ﻓﻬﻞ‬ ‫ﻳﺪﻝ ﺫﻟﻚ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺳﺒﻮﺕ ﺇﺳﺮﺍﺋﻴﻞ‪ ،‬ﺃﻱ ﺍﻧﻘﻄﺎﻋﻬﺎ ؟! ﻭﻻ ﻧﻨﺴﻰ ﺃ ﹼﻥ ﺁﺧـﺮ ﻭﺭﻭﺩ‬ ‫ﻟﻜﻠﻤﺔ )ﺍﻟﺴﺒﺖ( ﺟﺎﺀﺕ ﰲ ﺧﻮﺍﺗﻴﻢ ﺳﻮﺭﺓ ﺍﻟﻨﺤﻞ‪ ،‬ﻭﺍﻟﱵ ﻳﺄﰐ ﺑﻌﺪﻫﺎ ﰲ ﺗﺮﺗﻴﺐ‬ ‫ﺍﳌﺼﺤﻒ ﺳﻮﺭﺓ ﺍﻹﺳﺮﺍﺀ‪.‬‬ ‫ﻝ( ﺳﺒﻖ ﺃﻥ ﻗﻠﻨﺎ ﺇ ﹼﻥ ﻫﻨﺎﻙ ﺳﺒﻮﺗﺎﹰ ﻭﺍﺣﺪﺍ ًﰲ ﻛﻞ ﺳﺒﻊ ﺳﻨﲔ‪ ،‬ﻭﻗﺪ ﻟﻔﺖ ﺍﻧﺘﺒﺎﻫﻨﺎ‬ ‫ﺃ ﹼﻥ ﺟُﻤﱠﻞ ﻋﺒﺎﺭﺓ )ﺳﺒﻊ ﺳﻨﲔ( ﻫﻮ ‪ ،٣٠٢‬ﺃﻱ ﺟُﻤﱠﻞ ﺇﺳﺮﺀﻳﻞ‪ .‬ﻓﺘﺄﻣﱠﻞ!!‬ ‫ﺴﻨﲔ ﻣﻦ ‪٩٣٥‬ﻕ‪.‬ﻡ ﺇﱃ ‪٦٢١‬ﻡ ﻫﻮ ‪ ١٥٥٦‬ﺳـﻨﺔ ﴰﺴـﻴّﺔ‪.‬‬ ‫ﻋﺪﺩ ﺍﻟ ّ‬ ‫ﻭﻋﺪﺩ ﺍﻟﺴﻨﲔ ﺍﻟﺸﻤﺴﻴّﺔ ﻣﻦ ‪٦٢١‬ﻡ ﺇﱃ ‪٢٠٢٢‬ﻡ‪ ،‬ﻛﻤﺎ ﺳﺒﻖ ﻭﺃﻥ ﺑﻴّﻨﻨﺎ‪ ،‬ﻫـﻮ‪:‬‬ ‫‪ ١٤٠٠,٤‬ﺳﻨﺔ ﴰﺴﻴّﺔ‪ .‬ﻭﻋﻠﻴﻪ ﻳﻜﻮﻥ ﺍﻟﻔﺮﻕ‪ ١٥٥,٦ :‬ﺳﻨﺔ ﴰﺴﻴّﺔ‪ .‬ﻭﺳـﺒﻖ‬ ‫ﺃﻥ ﺑﻴّﻨﻨﺎ ﺃ ﹼﻥ ﻫﺬﺍ ﻫﻮ ‪١‬ﻋﻠﻰ ‪ ١٩‬ﻣﻦ ﳎﻤﻮﻉ ﺍﻟﻔﺘﺮﺗﲔ‪ .‬ﻓـﺈﺫﺍ ﻗﻤﻨـﺎ ﺑﻄـﺮﺡ‬ ‫‪ ١٥٥,٦‬ﺳﻨﺔ ﻣﻦ ﺍﻟﻌﺎﻡ ‪٩٣٥‬ﻕ‪.‬ﻡ ﻓﺴﻨﻜﻮﻥ ﻋﻨـﺪﻫﺎ ﰲ ﺍﻟﻌـﺎﻡ ‪٧٧٩‬ﻕ‪.‬ﻡ‪.‬‬ ‫ﻭﻳﺘﻤﻴّﺰ ﻫﺬﺍ ﺍﻟﻌﺎﻡ ﺑﺎﻷﻣﻮﺭ ﺍﻵﺗﻴﺔ‪:‬‬ ‫ﺃ( ‪ ٧٧٩‬ﻫﻮ )‪.(٤١×١٩‬‬ ‫ﺏ( ﺑﻌﺪ ‪ ٥٧‬ﺳﻨﺔ ﻣﻦ ﺍﻟﻌﺎﻡ ‪٧٧٩‬ﻕ‪.‬ﻡ ﺯﺍﻟﺖ ﺩﻭﻟﺔ ﺇﺳـﺮﺍﺋﻴﻞ ﺍﻷﻭﱃ‪ ،‬ﺃﻱ ﰲ‬ ‫ﻋﺎﻡ ‪٧٢٢‬ﻕ‪.‬ﻡ‪ .‬ﻭﺑﻌﺪ ‪ ٥٧‬ﺳﻨﺔ ﻣﻦ ﺍﻟﻌﺎﻡ ‪١٩٦٧‬ﻡ‪ ٩٠‬ﻳﺘﻮﻗﹼﻊ ﺃﻥ ﺗﺰﻭﻝ ﺇﺳﺮﺍﺋﻴﻞ‬ ‫ﺍﻟﺜﺎﻧﻴﺔ‪٩١.‬ﻭﺇﺫﺍ ﺿﺮﺑﻨﺎ ﺍﻟﻌﺪﺩ ‪ ٧٢٢‬ﰲ ‪ ٢‬ﻳﻜﻮﻥ ﺍﻟﻨﺎﺗﺞ‪١٤٤٤ = (٢×٧٢٢) :‬‬ ‫‪ ٩٠‬ﳎﻤﻮﻉ ﺃﺭﻗﺎﻡ ﺍﻟﻌﺪﺩ ‪ ٧٧٩‬ﻫﻮ ‪ ٢٣‬ﻭﻫﺬﺍ ﺃﻳﺼﹰﺎ ﳎﻤﻮﻉ ﺃﺭﻗﺎﻡ ﺍﻟﻌﺪﺩ ‪.١٩٦٧‬‬ ‫‪ ٥٧ ٩١‬ﻫﻮ ﺃﻳﻀﹰﺎ )‪.(٣×١٩‬ﻭﺍﻟﻌﺪﺩ ‪ ٧٢٢‬ﻫﻮ )‪ (٣٨×١٩‬ﺃﻱ )‪(٢×١٩×١٩‬‬ ‫‪٩٨‬‬ ‫ﻭﺍﻟﻼﻓﺖ ﻫﻨﺎ ﺃ ﹼﻥ ﻫﺬﺍ ﺍﻟﻌﺪﺩ ﻫﻮ ﺍﳌﻀﺎﻋﻒ ‪ ١٩‬ﻟﻌﻤﺮ ﺇﺳﺮﺍﺋﻴﻞ ﺍﳌﺘﻮﻗﹼﻊ‪ ،‬ﺃﻱ ‪٧٦‬‬ ‫ﻭﻫﻮ ﺃﻳﻀﹰﺎ ﻋﺪﺩ ﺍﻟﺴﻨﲔ ﺍﻟﻘﻤﺮﻳّﺔ ﻣﻦ ‪٦٢١‬ﻡ ﺇﱃ ‪٢٠٢٢‬ﻡ‪.‬‬ ‫ﺝ( ﺟُﻤﱠﻞ )ﺍﳌﺴﺠﺪ ﺍﻷﻗﺼﺎ( ﻫﻮ ‪ .٣٦١‬ﻭ ُﺟﻤﱠﻞ )ﺍﳌﺴﺠﺪ ﺍﳊﺮﺍﻡ( ﻫـﻮ ‪.٤١٨‬‬ ‫ﳉﻤﱠﻠﲔ ﻫﻮ )‪ .(٥٧‬ﻭﺍﺠﻤﻟﻤﻮﻉ ﻫـﻮ‪.٧٧٩ = (٤١٨+٣٦١) :‬‬ ‫ﻭﺍﻟﻔﺮﻕ ﺑﲔ ﺍ ﹸ‬ ‫ﻭﻫﺬﺍ )‪ .(٤١×١٩‬ﻭﺍﻟﻼﻓﺖ ﻫﻨﺎ ﺃ ﹼﻥ )‪ (٤١‬ﻫﻮ ﺟُﻤﱠﻞ )ﺇﱃ(‪ .‬ﻭﺍﻧﻈﺮ ﻣﻌـﻲ ﺇﱃ‬ ‫ﻣﻮﻗﻊ ﻛﻠﻤﺔ )ﺇﱃ( ﻣﻦ ﻗﻮﻟﻪ ﺗﻌﺎﱃ ﰲ ﻓﺎﲢﺔ ﺳﻮﺭﺓ ﺍﻹﺳﺮﺍﺀ‪) :‬ﺳُـ ْﺒﺤﺎ ﹶﻥ ﺍﻟـﺬﻱ‬ ‫ﺠ ِﺪ ﺍ َﻷ ﹾﻗﺼَﺎ‪.(...‬‬ ‫ﺴِ‬ ‫ﺠ ِﺪ ﺍﳊﹶﺮﺍ ِﻡ ﺇﱃ ﺍﳌ ْ‬ ‫ﺴِ‬ ‫ﻼ ﻣ َﻦ ﺍﳌ ْ‬ ‫ﹶﺃﺳْﺮﻯ ِﺑ َﻌ ْﺒﺪ ِﻩ ﻟ ْﻴ ﹰ‬ ‫ﻣﺎﺫﺍ ﻋﻦ ﳎﻤﻮﻉ ﺍﻟﺴّﺒﻮﺕ‪:‬‬ ‫ﳉ ّﻤﻞ ﻓﺎﻥ ﺍﻟﻘﻴﻤﺔ ﺍﻟﻌﺪﺩّﻳﺔ ﻟﻜﻠﻤـﺔ )ﺍﻟﺴـﺒﺖ( ﻫـﻲ‬ ‫ﻭﻓﻖ ﺣﺴﺎﺏ ﺍ ﹸ‬ ‫ﺴﺒﻮﺕ ﻫﻮ ﺍﻟﺴﻨﺔ ﺍﻟﺴﺎﺑﻌﺔ ﺍﻟﱵ ﻳﺴﺒﻘﻬﺎ )‪ (٦‬ﺳﻨﻮﺍﺕ‬ ‫)‪ .(٤٩٣‬ﻭﻛﻤﺎ ﺭﺃﻳﻨﺎ ﻓﺈﻥ ﺍﻟ ّ‬ ‫ﺴﺎﺑﻌﺔ‪ .‬ﻓﻤﺎ ﻫﻲ ﺍﻟﺴّﻨﻮﺍﺕ ﺍﻟﺴّـﺖ ﺍﻟـﱵ‬ ‫ﻣﻦ ﺍﻟﻌﻤﻞ‪ ،‬ﹼﰒ ﻳﻜﻮﻥ ﺍﻻﻧﻘﻄﺎﻉ ﰲ ﺍﻟ ّ‬ ‫ﺗﺴﺒﻖ ﺍﻻﻧﻘﻄﺎﻉ؟! ﺇﺫﺍ ﻗﻤﻨﺎ ﺑﻀﺮﺏ ُﺟﻤﱠﻞ ﻛﻠﻤﺔ )ﺍﻟﺴﺒﺖ( ﰲ ﺍﻟﻌﺪﺩ )‪ (٦‬ﻳﻜﻮﻥ‬ ‫ﺴﻨﲔ ﻣﻦ ﺑﺪﺍﻳﺔ ﺍﻟﻌﺎﻡ ﺍﻟﺬﻱ‬ ‫ﺍﻟﻨﺎﺗﺞ‪ ٢٩٥٨ = ( ٦×٤٩٣) :‬ﻭﻫﺬﺍ ﻫﻮ ﻋﺪﺩ ﺍﻟ ّ‬ ‫ﺑﺪﺃ ﻓﻴﻪ ﺍﻹﻓﺴﺎﺩ ﺍﻷﻭّﻝ‪ ،‬ﺃﻱ ‪ ٩٣٥‬ﻕ‪.‬ﻡ‪ ،‬ﺇﱃ ﻬﻧﺎﻳﺔ ﺍﻟﻌﺎﻡ ﺍﻟـﺬﻱ ﻳـﺰﻭﻝ ﻓﻴـﻪ‬ ‫ﺍﻹﻓﺴﺎﺩ ﺍﻟﺜﺎﱐ‪٢٠٢٢ ،‬ﻡ‪.‬‬ ‫ﺍﻷﻣﺮ ﺍﳌﺪﻫﺶ ﺃ ﹼﻥ ﺍﻟﻌﺪﺩ ‪ ٢٩٥٨‬ﻫﻮ ﳎﻤﻮﻉ ُﺟﻤﱠﻞ ﺍﻟﻌﺒﺎﺭﺍﺕ‬ ‫ﻭﺍﻟﻜﻠﻤﺎﺕ ﺍﻟﱵ ﹼﰎ ﺍﳊﺪﻳﺚ ﻋﻨﻬﺎ ﻗﺒﻞ ﻗﻠﻴﻞ‪ ،‬ﻣُﻀﺎﻓﹰﺎ ﺇﻟﻴﻬﺎ ﺟُﻤﱠﻞ )ﺍﻹﺳﺮﺍﺀ(‪،‬‬ ‫ﻭﻫﻲ‪):‬ﺍﳌﺴﺠﺪ ﺍﳊﺮﺍﻡ‪ ،‬ﺍﳌﺴﺠﺪ ﺍﻷﻗﺼﺎ‪ ،‬ﺑﻨﻮﺍ ﺇﺳﺮﺀﻳﻞ‪ ،‬ﺍﻟﺴﺒﺖ‪ ،‬ﺍﻹﺳﺮﺍﺀ(‪.‬‬ ‫‪٩٩‬‬ ‫ﻭﻫﺬﻩ ﻻ ﳜﺘﻠﻒ ُﺟﻤﱠﻠﻬﺎ ﻛﺘﺎﺑﺔ ﺃﻭ ﻟﻔﻈﹰﺎ‪ .‬ﺃﻣّﺎ ﺍﻟﱵ ﳜﺘﻠﻒ ُﺟﻤﱠﻠﻬﺎ ﻛﺘﺎﺑ ﹰﺔ ﻭﻟﻔﻈﹰﺎ‬ ‫ﻓﻬﻲ‪) :‬ﺑﲏ ﺇﺳﺮﺀﻳﻞ‪ ،‬ﺑﲏ ﺇﺳﺮﺍﺀﻳﻞ‪ ،‬ﺇﺳﺮﺀﻳﻞ(‪ .‬ﻭﺍﻻﺧﺘﻼﻑ ﻛﻤﺎ ﻫﻮ ﻣﻠﺤﻮﻅ‬ ‫ﰲ ﻛﻠﻤﺔ ﺇﺳﺮﺀﻳﻞ‪ .‬ﻭﱂ ﻳﺮﺩ ﰲ ﻣﻼﺣﻈﺎﺗﻨﺎ ﺍﻟﺘﺎﺭﳜﻴّﺔ ﺍﻟﻌﺪﺩ ‪ ٣٠٣‬ﺑﻞ ﺍﻟﻌﺪﺩ‬ ‫‪ ٣٠٢‬ﻭﺍﻟﺬﻱ ﻫﻮ ُﺟﻤﱠﻞ ﻛﻠﻤﺔ ﺇﺳﺮﺀﻳﻞ‪ ،‬ﻭﻓﻖ ﺍﻟﺮﺳﻢ ﺍﻟﻌﺜﻤﺎﱐ‪ .‬ﻭﻓﻴﻤﺎ ﻳﺄﰐ‬ ‫ﺟﺪﻭﻝ ﺗﻮﺿﻴﺤ ّﻲ‪:‬‬ ‫ﺍﳌﺴﺠﺪ ﺍﳊﺮﺍﻡ‬ ‫‪٤١٨‬‬ ‫ﻛﺘﺎﺑﺔ ﻭﻻ ﳜﺘﻠﻒ ﻟﻔﻈﹰﺎ‬ ‫ﺍﳌﺴﺠﺪ ﺍﻷﻗﺼﺎ‬ ‫‪٣٦١‬‬ ‫ﻛﺘﺎﺑﺔ ﻭﻻ ﳜﺘﻠﻒ ﻟﻔﻈﹰﺎ‬ ‫ﺑﻨﻮﺍ ﺇﺳﺮﺍﺋﻴﻞ‬ ‫‪٣٦١‬‬ ‫ﻛﺘﺎﺑﺔ ﻭﻻ ﳜﺘﻠﻒ ﻟﻔﻈﹰﺎ‬ ‫ﺑﲏ ﺇﺳﺮﺀﻳﻞ‬ ‫‪٣٦٤‬‬ ‫ﻛﺘﺎﺑﺔ‬ ‫ﺑﲏ ﺇﺳﺮﺍﺀﻳﻞ‬ ‫‪٣٦٥‬‬ ‫ﻟﻔﻈﹰﺎ‬ ‫ﺇﺳﺮﺀﻳﻞ‬ ‫‪٣٠٢‬‬ ‫ﻛﺘﺎﺑﺔ ﻭﱂ ﻳﺮﺩ ﻟﻔﻈﹰﺎ‬ ‫ﺍﻟﺴﺒﺖ‬ ‫‪٤٩٣‬‬ ‫ﻛﺘﺎﺑﺔ ﻭﻻ ﳜﺘﻠﻒ ﻟﻔﻈﹰﺎ‬ ‫ﺍﻹﺳﺮﺍﺀ‬ ‫‪٢٩٤‬‬ ‫ﻛﺘﺎﺑﺔ ﻭﻻ ﳜﺘﻠﻒ ﻟﻔﻈﹰﺎ‬ ‫ﺍﺠﻤﻟﻤﻮﻉ‬ ‫‪٢٩٥٨‬‬ ‫‪١٠٠‬‬ ‫ﺃﺭﺑﻊ ﺩﻭﺭﺍﺕ‬ ‫ﺍﻟﻔﺮﻕ ﺑﲔ ﻋﺪﺩ ﺃﻳﺎﻡ ﺍﻟﺴﻨﺔ ﺍﻟﺸﻤﺴّﻴﺔ ﻭﺍﻟﺴﻨﺔ ﺍﻟﻘﻤﺮّﻳﺔ ﻫﻮ )‪ (١١‬ﻳﻮﻣـﺎ‪،‬‬ ‫ﻱ ﻳﻮﻡ ﻣـﻦ ﺃﻳّـﺎﻡ ﺍﻟﺴّـﻨﺔ‬ ‫ﻭﻋﻠﻰ ﻭﺟﻪ ﺍﻟ ّﺪﻗﺔ )‪ .(١٠,٨٧٥٢‬ﻭﻫﺬﺍ ﻳﻌﲏ ﺃ ﹼﻥ ﺃ ّ‬ ‫ﺍﻟﻘﻤﺮّﻳﺔ ﻳﻌﻮﺩ ﺇﱃ ﺍﻟﻌﻼﻗﺔ ﻧﻔﺴﻬﺎ ﻣﻊ ﺍﻟﺴﻨﺔ ﺍﻟﺸﻤﺴﻴّﺔ ﻛﻞ )‪ (٣٣,٥٨٤٨٧‬ﺳﻨﺔ‬ ‫ﺴﻨﲔ ﻣﻦ ﺯﻭﺍﻝ ﺍﻹﻓﺴﺎﺩ ﺍﻷﻭﻝ ﻭﺍﳋـﺮﻭﺝ‬ ‫ﴰﺴﻴّﺔ ﻣﺮّﺓ‪ .‬ﻭﻗﺪ ﻭﺟﺪﻧﺎ ﺃ ﹼﻥ ﻋﺪﺩ ﺍﻟ ّ‬ ‫ﻣﻦ ﺍﻟﻘﺪﺱ ﺳﻨﺔ ‪ ٥٨٦‬ﻕ‪ .‬ﻡ‪ ،‬ﺇﱃ ﺩﺧﻮﻝ ﺍﻟﻘﺪﺱ ﰲ ﺍﳌـﺮﺓ ﺍﻟﺜﺎﻧﻴـﺔ ‪١٩٦٧‬ﻡ‬ ‫ﻳﺸﻜﻞ ‪ ٧٦‬ﺩﻭﺭﺓ‪ ،‬ﻭﺍﻷﻣﺮ ﻣﻦ ﺍﻟﺪﻗﹼﺔ ﲝﻴﺚ ﺗﻜﺘﻤﻞ ﺃﻳّﺎﻡ ﻫﺬﻩ ﺍﻟﺪّﻭﺭﺓ ﰲ ﺍﻟﻌـﺎﻡ‬ ‫‪١٩٦٧‬ﻡ‪ .‬ﻭﻋﻠﻴﻪ ﻳﻜﻮﻥ ﻫﻨﺎﻙ ﺍﻛﺘﻤﺎﻝ ﻷﺭﺑﻊ ﺩﻭﺭﺍﺕ ﺑﻌﺪ ﺩﺧﻮﻝ ﺍﻟﻘﺪﺱ‪:‬‬ ‫ﺴﺒﻮﺕ‪ ،‬ﺃﻱ )‪ ،(٣٦٥‬ﻭﺫﻟﻚ ﻣﻦ ﺍﳋﺮﻭﺝ ﻋﺎﻡ ‪٥٨٦‬ﻕ‪.‬ﻡ‬ ‫ﺃ( ﺩﻭﺭﺓ ﻓﻠﻜﻴﺔ ﻣﻦ ﺍﻟ ّ‬ ‫ﺇﱃ ﻣﺎ ﺑﻌﺪ ﺩﺧﻮﻝ ﻋﺎﻡ ‪١٩٦٧‬ﻡ ﺑﻘﻠﻴﻞ‪ ،‬ﺃﻱ ﻋﺎﻡ ‪١٩٦٩‬ﻡ‪ .‬ﻓﻠﻢ ﺗﻜﺘﻤﻞ ﻫـﺬﻩ‬ ‫ﺍﻟﺪّﻭﺭﺓ ﺇ ﹼﻻ ﺑﻌﺪ ﺩﺧﻮﻝ ﺍﻟﻘﺪﺱ‪.‬‬ ‫ﺴﻨﺔ ﺍﻟﻌﱪّﻳﺔ ﺑﻌﺪ‬ ‫ﺏ( ﺩﻭﺭﺓ ﺍﻟﻜﺮﺑﻮﻥ ‪ ١٤‬ﻭﺍﻟﱵ ﻫﻲ ‪ ٥٧٣٠‬ﺳﻨﺔ‪ ،‬ﻭﻫﺬﺍ ﻳﻮﺍﻓﻖ ﺍﻟ ّ‬ ‫ﺩﺧﻮﻝ ﺍﻟﻘﺪﺱ ﺑﻘﻠﻴﻞ‪ ،‬ﺃﻱ ﻋﺎﻡ ‪١٩٦٩‬ﻡ‪ .‬ﻓﻠﻢ ﺗﻜﺘﻤﻞ ﻫﺬﻩ ﺍﻟـﺪّﻭﺭﺓ ﺇ ﹼﻻ ﺑﻌـﺪ‬ ‫ﺩﺧﻮﻝ ﺍﻟﻘﺪﺱ‪.‬‬ ‫ﺝ( ﺍﻟ ّﺪﻭﺭﺓ ‪ ٣٠٢‬ﻟﻠﻌﺪﺩ ‪ ١٩‬ﺃﻱ ﺍﻟ ّﺪﻭﺭﺓ ﺇﺳﺮﺀﻳﻞ ﻟﻠﻌﺪﺩ ‪ ١٩‬ﻭﻓﻖ ﺍﻟﺘـﺄﺭﻳﺦ‬ ‫ﺍﻟﻌﱪﻱ‪ .‬ﻭﺗﺒﺪﺃ ﻫﺬﻩ ﺍﻟﺪّﻭﺭﺓ ﻣﻦ ﺳﻨﺔ ‪ ،٥٧١٩‬ﻭﺗﻨﺘﻬﻲ ﺳﻨﺔ ‪ .٥٧٣٨‬ﻭﻋﻠﻴﻪ ﻳﻘﻊ‬ ‫ﺍﻟﻌﺎﻡ ‪١٩٦٩‬ﻡ‪ ،‬ﰲ ﺑﺆﺭﺓ ﻫﺬﻩ ﺍﻟﺪّﻭﺭﺓ‪ ،‬ﻛﻤﺎ ﺃﺷﺮﻧﺎ ﺳﺎﺑﻘﹰﺎ‪.‬‬ ‫‪١٠١‬‬ ‫ﺩ( ‪ ٧٦‬ﺩﻭﺭﺓ ﻛﻞ ﻭﺍﺣﺪﺓ ﻣﻨﻬﺎ )‪ (٣٣,٦‬ﺳﻨﺔ ﴰﺴﻴﺔ‪ .‬ﻭﺗﺒﺪﺃ ﻣـﻦ ﺧـﺮﻭﺝ‬ ‫‪٥٨٦‬ﻕ‪.‬ﻡ ﻭﺍﻛﺘﻤﻠﺖ ﰲ ﺍﻟﻌﺎﻡ ‪١٩٦٧‬ﻡ‪.‬‬ ‫ﻗﻠﻨﺎ ﺇ ﹼﻥ ﻫﻨﺎﻙ ﺩﻭﺭﺓ ﲤﺜﻞ ﺍﻟﻌﻼﻗﺔ ﺑﲔ ﺍﻟﺴـﻨﺔ ﺍﻟﺸﻤﺴـﻴﺔ ﻭﺍﻟﻘﻤﺮﻳـﺔ‪،‬‬ ‫ﻭﻣﻘﺪﺍﺭﻫﺎ )‪ (٣٣،٦‬ﺳﻨﺔ ﴰﺴﻴﺔ‪ .‬ﻭﻫﺬﺍ ﻳﻌﲏ ﺃ ﹼﻥ ﺍﻟ ّﺪﻭﺭﺓ )‪ (١٩‬ﺑﻌﺪ ﺍﳌﻴﻼﺩ ﺗﻘﻊ‬ ‫ﺗﻘﺮﻳﺒﺎﹰ ﺑﲔ )‪٦٠٤‬ﻡ ‪٦٣٨ -‬ﻡ(‪ .‬ﻭُﻳﻠﺤﻆ ﺃ ﹼﻥ ﺍﻟﺮﺳﻮﻝ‪ ،‬ﺻﻠﻰ ﺍﷲ ﻋﻠﻴﻪ ﻭﺳـﻠﻢ‪،‬‬ ‫ُﺑ ِﻌﺚ ﺑﻌﺪ ﺑﺪﺍﻳﺔ ﺍﻟ ّﺪﻭﺭﺓ ﲟﺎ ﻳﻘﺎﺭﺏ )‪ (٦‬ﺳﻨﻮﺍﺕ‪ ،‬ﺃﻱ )‪ ٦١٠‬ﻡ(‪ .‬ﻭﺗﻮﰲ ﺻﻠﻰ‬ ‫ﺍﷲ ﻋﻠﻴﻪ ﻭﺳﻠﻢ ﻗﺒﻞ ﻬﻧﺎﻳﺔ ﺍﻟ ّﺪﻭﺭﺓ ﲟﺎ ﻳﻘﺎﺭﺏ )‪ (٦‬ﺳﻨﻮﺍﺕ ﺃﻳﻀﺎ‪ ،‬ﺃﻱ )‪٦٣٢‬ﻡ(‪.‬‬ ‫ﻛﻤﺎ ﻭُﻳﻠﺤﻆ ﺃ ﹼﻥ ﺑﺆﺭﺓ ﺍﻟ ّﺪﻭﺭﺓ )‪ (١٩‬ﻫﻮ ﻋﺎﻡ )‪ ٦٢٢‬ﻡ(‪ ،‬ﻭﺍﻟﺬﻱ ﻫـﻮ ﻋـﺎﻡ‬ ‫ﺍﳍﺠﺮﺓ‪ .‬ﻭﻋﻠﻴﻪ ﺗﻜﻮﻥ ﺳﻨﺔ ﺑﺪﺍﻳﺔ ﺍﻟﺘﻘﻮﱘ ﺍﳍﺠﺮﻱ ﻣﻮﺍﻓﻘﺔ ﻟﺒﺪﺍﻳﺔ ﺍﻟـ ّﺪﻭﺭﺓ ‪١٩‬‬ ‫ﻱ‪.‬‬ ‫ﻱ ﻭﺍﳌﻴﻼﺩ ّ‬ ‫ﻱ‪ ،‬ﺃﻱ ﺑﲔ ﺍﳍﺠﺮ ّ‬ ‫ﺸﻤﺴ ّﻲ ﻭﺍﻟﻘﻤﺮ ّ‬ ‫ﻟﻠﻌﻼﻗﺔ ﺑﲔ ﺍﻟ ّ‬ ‫‪١٠٢‬‬ ‫ﻗﺒﻞ ﺃﻥ ﳔﺘﻢ‬ ‫ﳉ ﱠﻤﻞ ﻟﹻ‪) :‬ﺑﻨﻮ ﺇﺳـﺮﺀﻳﻞ(‪،‬‬ ‫ﻻﺣﻈﻨﺎ ﺃ ﹼﻥ ﺍﻟﻘﻴﻤﺔ ﺍﻟﻌﺪﺩّﻳﺔ ﻭﻓﻖ ﺣﺴﺎﺏ ﺍ ﹸ‬ ‫)ﺍﳌﺴﺠﺪ ﺍﻻﻗﺼﺎ(‪) ،‬ﺍﳌﺴﺠﺪ ﺍﳊﺮﺍﻡ(‪) ،‬ﺑﲏ ﺇﺳـﺮﺍﺀﻳﻞ(‪) ،‬ﺑـﲏ ﺇﺳـﺮﺀﻳﻞ(‪،‬‬ ‫ﺴﺒﺖ(‪) ،‬ﺇﺳﺮﺀﻳﻞ(‪) ،‬ﺍﻹﺳﺮﺍﺀ(‪ ،‬ﺟﺎﺀﺕ ﻛﻠﻬﺎ ﻣﻮﺍﻓﻘﺔ ﻟﻠﻤﻌﺎﺩﻟـﺔ ﺍﻟ ّﺮﻳﺎﺿـّﻴﺔ‬ ‫)ﺍﻟ ّ‬ ‫ﻟﺘﺎﺭﻳﺦ ﺑﲏ ﺇﺳﺮﺍﺋﻴﻞ‪ ،‬ﻭﺟﺎﺀﺕ ﻣُﻨﺴﺠﻤﺔ ﻣﻊ ﺍﳌﺴﺎﺭ ﺍﻟﺘﺎﺭﳜﻲّ ﺍﻟﺬﻱ ﰎ ﺍﳊـﺪﻳﺚ‬ ‫ﻋﻨﻪ ﰲ ﻫﺬﺍ ﺍﻟﻜﺘﺎﺏ‪.‬‬ ‫ﺗﻠﻚ ﻣﻼﺣﻈﺎﺕ ﺟﺎﺀﺕ ﺗﺆ ﹼﻛﺪ ﺻﺤﺔ ﻣﺴﻠﻜﻨﺎ ﰲ ﺍﻟﺒﺤﺚ ﻋﻦ ﻗـﺎﻧﻮ ٍﻥ‬ ‫ﺟﺎﻣﻊ ﳛﻜﻢ ﺍﻟﺘﺎﺭﻳﺦ‪ ،‬ﻭﻳﻀﺒﻂ ﺣﺮﻛﺘﻪ‪ .‬ﻻ ﺷﻚ ﺃّﻧﻪ ﺃﻣ ٌﺮ ﻋﺠﻴـﺐ؛ ﺃﻥ ﻳﺴـﲑ‬ ‫ﺍﻟﺘﺎﺭﻳﺦ ﻭﻓﻖ ﻗﺎﻧﻮﻥ ﺭﻳﺎﺿ ّﻲ ﻛﻤﺎ ﰲ ﻋﺎﱂ ﺍﳌﺎﺩﺓ‪ .‬ﻭﻫﺬﺍ ﳚﻌﻠﻨﺎ ﲝﺎﺟﺔ ﺇﱃ ﺇﻋﺎﺩﺓ‬ ‫ﺕ ﺍﻟﺘﺎﺭﻳﺦ ﻭﻗﻮﺍﻧﻴﻨﻪ‪ .‬ﻓﻬﻞ ﳝﻜﻦ ﺃﻥ ﺗﻜﻮﻥ ﻫﺬﻩ ﺍﻟﻘﻮﺍﻧﲔ‬ ‫ﺍﻟﻨﻈﺮ ﰲ ﺑﻌﺾ ُﻣﺴﹼﻠﻤﺎ ٍ‬ ‫ﺕ ﻭﺟُﻤ ٍﻞ ﻗﺮﺁﻧﻴّﺔ ﻫﻲ ﺭﻣﻮﺯ ﻭ)ﺷﻴﻔﺮﺍﺕ(‪ ،‬ﻭﻫـﻞ‬ ‫ﻗﺪ ﺍ ّﺩﺧِﺮﺕ ﰲ ﺻﻮﺭﺓ ﻛﻠﻤﺎ ٍ‬ ‫ﳚﻮﺯ ﻟﻨﺎ ﺑﻌﺪ ﻫﺬﺍ ﺃﻥ ﻧﻀﺮﺏ ﺻﻔﺤﹰﺎ ﻋﻦ ﻣﺘﺎﺑﻌﺔ ﻣﺜـﻞ ﻫـﺬﻩ ﺍﳌﻼﺣﻈـﺎﺕ‬ ‫ﺍﻻﺳﺘﻘﺮﺍﺋّﻴﺔ ؟!‬ ‫ﺣﱴ ﻻ ﻳﻈ ّﻦ ﺍﻟﺒﻌﺾ ﺃﻧﻨﺎ ﻧﺘﻌﺎﻣﻞ ﰲ ﻫﺬﻩ ﺍﳌﻼﺣﻈﺎﺕ ﻣـﻦ ﻣﻨﻄﻠـﻖ‬ ‫ﺍﻟّﺘﺴﻠﻴﻢ ﺑﺼﺤﺔ ﺍﻟﻌﻬﺪ ﺍﻟﻘﺪﱘ ﻭﺻﺪﻕ ﻧﺒﻮﺀﺍﺗﻪ‪ .‬ﻭﺣﱴ ﻻ ﻳﺘﻮﻫﻢ ﺃ ﹼﻥ ﺻﺪﻕ ﺑﻌﺾ‬ ‫ﺻﺪِﻗّﻴﺘﻪ‪ .‬ﻭﻟﻜﻲ ﻻ ﺗﻮﺣﻲ ﺩﺭﺍﺳﺘﻨﺎ ﻟـﺒﻌﺾ‬ ‫ﻼ ﻋﻠﻰ ِ‬ ‫ﻫﺬﻩ ﺍﻟﻨﺒﻮﺀﺍﺕ ﻳﺸﻜﻞ ﺩﻟﻴ ﹰ‬ ‫ﺍﻟﺘﺸﺮﻳﻌﺎﺕ ﺍﻟﺘﻮﺭﺍﺗﻴﺔ ﺃﻧّﻬﺎ ﺇﻗﺮﺍ ٌﺭ ﻭﺇﳝﺎﻥ؛ ﻓﺈﻧﻨﺎ ﻧُﺆﻛﺪ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺍﻵﰐ‪:‬‬ ‫‪ -١‬ﻛﺎﻥ ﻛﻞﱡ ﺭﺳﻮ ٍﻝ ُﻳﺒﻌﺚ ﺇﱃ ﻗﻮﻣﻪ ﺧﺎﺻﺔ‪ ،‬ﻭﺑﻌﺚ ﳏﻤﺪ ﺻـﻠﻰ ﺍﷲ ﻋﻠﻴـﻪ‬ ‫ﻭﺳﻠﻢ ﺇﱃ ﺍﻟﻨﺎﺱ ﻛﺎﹼﻓﺔ‪ .‬ﻭﻣﻦ ﻫﻨﺎ ﺟﺎﺀﺕ ﺍﻟﺸﺮﻳﻌﺔ ﺍﻹﺳﻼﻣﻴﺔ ﻧﺎﺳﺨﺔ ﻟﻠﺸـﺮﺍﺋﻊ‬ ‫‪١٠٣‬‬ ‫ﺍﻟﺴﺎﺑﻘﺔ‪.‬‬ ‫ﺤ ِﻤ ﹾﻞ َﻋ ﹶﻠﻴْﻨﺎ ﺇﺻـ َﺮﹰﺍ‬ ‫‪ -٢‬ﺟﺎﺀ ﰲ ﺁﺧﺮ ﺁﻳﺔ ﻣﻦ ﺳﻮﺭﺓ ﺍﻟﺒﻘﺮﺓ‪َ ...." :‬ﺭﺑّﻨﺎ ﻭَﻻ َﺗ ْ‬ ‫ﹶﻛﻤَﺎ َﺣ َﻤﻠﹾَﺘﻪُ َﻋﻠﹶﻰ ﺍﻟﺬﻳﻦَ ِﻣ ْﻦ ﹶﻗ ْﺒ ِﻠﻨَﺎ‪ ."..‬ﻭﻣﻦ ﻫﻨﺎ ﻗﺪ ﺗﺒﺪﻭ ﺑﻌﺾ ﺍﻟﺘﺸـﺮﻳﻌﺎﺕ‬ ‫ﺴﻤﺤﺔ؛ ﻓﻤﺎ ﻳﻜﻮﻥ ﻣﻨﺎﺳﺒﹰﺎ ﻟﻌﺼـ ٍﺮ‬ ‫ﺍﻟﺴﺎﺑﻘﺔ ﻏﺮﻳﺒﺔ ﻣﻘﺎﺭﻧ ﹰﺔ ﺑﺎﻟﺸﺮﻳﻌﺔ ﺍﻹﺳﻼﻣّﻴﺔ ﺍﻟ ّ‬ ‫ﻣﻦ ﺍﻟﻌﺼﻮﺭ ﻭﹸﺃ ّﻣﺔ ﻣﻦ ﺍﻷﻣﻢ‪ ،‬ﻗﺪ ﻻ ﻳﻜﻮﻥ ﻣﻨﺎﺳﺒﹰﺎ ﳉﻤﻴﻊ ﺍﻷﻣﻢ ﻭﺍﻟﻌﺼﻮﺭ‪.‬‬ ‫ﺤﺔ ﺍﻟﻜﻞ‪ .‬ﻷﻧﻨﺎ‬ ‫ﺤﺔ ﺟﺰ ٍﺀ ﻣﻦ ﺍﻟﻌﻬﺪ ﺍﻟﻘﺪﱘ ﻻ ﻳﻌﲏ ﺻ ّ‬ ‫‪ُ -٣‬ﺣ ﹾﻜ ُﻢ ﺍﳌﺴﻠﻤﲔ ﺑﺼ ّ‬ ‫ﻧﻌﺘﻘﺪ ﻭﺟﻮﺩ ﺟﺰﺀ ﻣﻦ ﺍﳊﻘﻴﻘﺔ ﰲ ﺍﻟﺘﻮﺭﺍﺓ ﺍﶈﺮّﻓﺔ‪ ،‬ﻭﻧﻌﺘﻘﺪ ﺣﺼﻮﻝ ﺍﻟﺘﺤﺮﻳـﻒ‬ ‫ﻭﻟﻴﺲ ﺍﻟﺘﺒﺪﻳﻞ ﺍﻟﻜﺎﻣﻞ‪.‬‬ ‫‪ -٤‬ﺑﻌﺚ ﺍﷲ ﺗﻌﺎﱃ ﺍﻟﺮﺳﻞ ﻭﺃﻧﺰﻝ ﺍﻟﺮﺳﺎﻻﺕ‪ ،‬ﻭﳛﻔﻆ ﻣﻨﻬﺎ ﻣﺎ ﻳﺸﺎﺀ ﳊﻜﻤـ ٍﺔ‬ ‫ﻳﺮﻳﺪﻫﺎ‪ ،‬ﻭﻳُﻨﺴﻲ ﻣﻨﻬﺎ ﻣﺎ ﻳﺸﺎﺀ ﳊﻜﻤﺔ ﺃﻳﻀﹰﺎ‪ .‬ﺍﻧﻈﺮ ﻗﻮﻟﻪ ﺗﻌﺎﱃ‪:‬‬ ‫ﺠﺪُﻭَﻧﻪُ َﻣ ﹾﻜﺘُﻮﺑَـﹰﺎ ِﻋﻨْـ َﺪﻫُﻢ ﻓِـﻲ ﺍﻟﺘـﻮﺭَﺍﺓِ‬ ‫ﱯ ﺍﻷُﻣ ّﻲ ﺍﻟﺬﻱ َﻳ ِ‬ ‫)‪ ..‬ﺍﻟﺮﺳُﻮ ﹶﻝ ﺍﻟﻨ ّ‬ ‫ﻭَﺍﻹْﻧﺠِﻴ ِﻞ(‪.٩٢‬‬ ‫‪ -٥‬ﺍﻷﺻﻞ ﺃ ﹾﻥ ﺗﺘﻔﻖ ﺍﻷﺩﻳﺎﻥ ﺍﻟﺴﻤﺎﻭﻳﺔ ﰲ ﺍﳉﺎﻧﺐ ﺍﻟﻌﻘﺎﺋـﺪﻱ‪ ،‬ﻷ ﹼﻥ ﺍﻟﻌﻘﻴـﺪﺓ‬ ‫ﺃﺧﺒﺎﺭ‪ ،‬ﻭﺍﳋﱪ ﺍﻟﺼﺎﺩﻕ ﻻ ﳜﺘﻠﻒ ﻣﻦ ﺭﺳﻮﻝ ﺇﱃ ﺁﺧﺮ‪ .‬ﺃ ّﻣﺎ ﺍﳉﺎﻧﺐ ﺍﻟّﺘﺸـﺮﻳﻌ ّﻲ‬ ‫ﻓﺎﻷﺻﻞ ﺃﻥ ﳒﺪ ﻓﻴﻪ ﺍﺧﺘﻼﻓﹰﺎ؛ ﻟﺘﺒﺎﻳﻦ ﺍﻟﻌﺼﻮﺭ ﻭﺍﻷﻣﻢ‪ ،‬ﺣﱴ ﻧﺰﻟـﺖ ﺍﻟﺸـﺮﻳﻌﺔ‬ ‫ﺸﺎﻣﻠﺔ‪.‬‬ ‫ﺍﻹﺳﻼﻣﻴﺔ ﺍﻟﻜﺎﻣﻠﺔ ﻭﺍﻟ ّ‬ ‫‪ ٩٢‬ﺳﻮﺭﺓ ﺍﻷﻋﺮﺍﻑ‪.١٥٧ :‬‬ ‫‪١٠٤‬‬ ‫ﺍﳋﺎﲤﺔ‬ ‫‪ ...‬ﻭﺑﻌﺪ‪:‬‬ ‫ﺐ ﺃﻥ ﺃﺧﻮﺽ ﰲ ﻣﺜﻞ ﻫﺬﻩ ﺍﻟﻘﻀﺎﻳﺎ‪ ،‬ﻭﻟﻜﻦ َﻭﺟَـ ْﺪﺗُﲏ‬ ‫ﺖ ﺃﹸﺣ ّ‬ ‫ﻣﺎ ﻛﻨ ُ‬ ‫ﺖ ﺃ ﹼﻥ ﻣﻦ ﻭﺍﺟـﱯ ﺃﻥ‬ ‫ﻣﺪﻓﻮﻋﹰﺎ ﰲ ﻫﺬﺍ ﺍﳌﺴﺎﺭ ﻣﻦ ﺧﻼﻝ ﻋﻤﻠّﻴﺔ ﺍﺳﺘﻘﺮﺍﺋّﻴﺔ؛ ﻓﺮﺃﻳ ُ‬ ‫ﺃﺿﻊ ﺍﻟﺒﺤﺚ ﺑﲔ ﻳﺪﻱ ﺍﻟﻘﺎﺭﺉ‪ ،‬ﻷ ﹼﻥ ﺫﻟﻚ ﻣﻦ ﺣﻘﹼﻪ ﻋﻠﻴﻨﺎ‪ .‬ﺃ ّﻣﺎ ﺍﳊﻜـ ُﻢ ﻋﻠـﻰ‬ ‫ﺍﳌﻘﺪّﻣﺎﺕ ﻭﺍﻟﻨﺘﺎﺋﺞ ﻓﻤﻦ ﻣﺴﺌﻮﻟﻴّﺘﻪ‪.‬‬ ‫ﻣﺎ ﺃﻇﻦ ﺃ ﹼﻥ ﻫﺬﺍ ﻫﻮ ﻬﻧﺎﻳﺔ ﺍﳌﻄﺎﻑ‪ ،‬ﻓﻜﻠﻤﺎ ﺃﻋﺪﻧﺎ ﺍﻟّﻨﻈﺮ ﻭﺟﺪﻧﺎ ﺟﺪﻳﺪﺍﹰ‪.‬‬ ‫ﺕ ﻓﺼﱠﻠﻨﺎ ﺍﳊﺪﻳﺚ ﻋﻨـﻬﺎ ﰲ ﻛﺘـﺎﺏ‬ ‫ﻭﻣﻦ ﺃﻣﺜﻠﺔ ﺫﻟﻚ‪ ،‬ﻣﺎ ﻭﺟﺪﻧﺎ ﻣﻦ ﻣﺆﻳﱢﺪﺍ ٍ‬ ‫)ﻭﻟﺘﻌﻠﻤﻮﺍ ﻋﺪﺩ ﺍﻟﺴﻨﲔ ﻭﺍﳊﺴﺎﺏ ‪ ( ٣٠٩‬ﻭﻛﺬﻟﻚ ﻛﺘـﺎﺏ )ﺍﳌﻴـﺰﺍﻥ ‪٤٥٦‬‬ ‫ﲝﻮﺙ ﰲ ﺍﻟﻌﺪﺩ ﺍﻟﻘﺮﺁﱐ(‪ .‬ﻣﻦ ﻫﻨﺎ ﻧﺮﺟﻮ ﺃﻥ ﻻ ﻳﺒﺨﻞ ﻋﻠﻴﻨﺎ ﺍﻟﻘـﺎﺭﺉ ﺍﻟﻜـﺮﱘ‬ ‫ﲟﻼﺣﻈﺎﺗﻪ‪ ،‬ﻭﻋﻠﻰ ﻭﺟﻪ ﺍﳋﺼﻮﺹ ﺇﺫﺍ ﻣﺎ ﻭﻗﻊ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺟﺪﻳﺪ ﰲ ﺍﳌﺴﺎﻟﺔ‪ ،‬ﺃﻭ ﺭﺃﻯ‬ ‫ﺍﻋﻮﺟﺎﺟﹰﺎ ﻻ ُﺑﺪّ ﻣﻦ ﺗﻘﻮﳝﻪ‪.‬‬ ‫ﻭﺍﷲ ﻫﻮ ﺍﳌﻮﻓﻖ‪.‬‬ ‫‪١٠٥‬‬ ١٠٦